summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/67438-0.txt8332
-rw-r--r--old/67438-0.zipbin156397 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h.zipbin897506 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/67438-h.htm12045
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/cover.jpgbin260740 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_068.jpgbin68227 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_126.jpgbin62099 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_204.jpgbin64056 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_288.jpgbin66365 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_333.jpgbin68163 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_356.jpgbin66010 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpgbin86208 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_logo.jpgbin27804 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_title.jpgbin84691 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/67438-h/images/i_titlelogo.jpgbin30793 -> 0 bytes
18 files changed, 17 insertions, 20377 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..10cf18d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #67438 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/67438)
diff --git a/old/67438-0.txt b/old/67438-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 9a15eb0..0000000
--- a/old/67438-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,8332 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg eBook of A United States Midshipman in the
-Philippines, by Yates Stirling, Jr.
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
-most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
-of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you
-will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before
-using this eBook.
-
-Title: A United States Midshipman in the Philippines
-
-Author: Yates Stirling, Jr.
-
-Illustrator: Ralph L. Boyer
-
-Release Date: February 18, 2022 [eBook #67438]
-
-Language: English
-
-Produced by: D A Alexander, David E. Brown, University of Michigan for
- the original scans and the color image of the cover, and
- the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
- https://www.pgdp.net (This file was produced from images
- generously made available by the Library of Congress.)
-
-*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN
-THE PHILIPPINES ***
-
-
-[Illustration: _SOME ONE TURNED ON THE CURRENT_]
-
-
-
-
- A
- UNITED STATES
- MIDSHIPMAN
- IN THE
- PHILIPPINES
-
- _by_
-
- Lt. Com. Yates Stirling Jr. U.S.N.
-
- Author of
-
- “A U.S. Midshipman Afloat”
- “A U.S. Midshipman in China”
- “A U.S. Midshipman in Japan”
- “A U.S. Midshipman in the South Seas”
-
- [Illustration]
-
- Illustrated _by_ Ralph L. Boyer
-
- THE PENN PUBLISHING
- COMPANY PHILADELPHIA
- MCMXIII
-
-
-
-
- COPYRIGHT
- 1910 BY
- THE PENN
- PUBLISHING
- COMPANY
-
- [Illustration]
-
-
-
-
-Introduction
-
-
-The writer has attempted to describe in this volume the life of two
-young midshipmen of the United States Navy, serving in a small gunboat
-in Philippine waters.
-
-The fighting between the United States troops and the lawless bands
-of Filipino bandits (for they were bandits, more or less, after
-Aguinaldo’s army had been dispersed) was in most cases “hand to hand”
-and to the death. The navy had but small share in this war, but in some
-instances the helpful coöperation of their web-footed brothers saved
-the soldiers from embarrassing situations.
-
-Midshipman Philip Perry and his classmate at Annapolis, Sydney Monroe,
-first made their appearance in “A United States Midshipman Afloat.”
-They had a part in stirring adventures during one of the frequent South
-American revolutions. Here they became involved in diplomatic intrigue,
-and had some success; but unfortunately diplomatic successes cannot
-always be proclaimed to the world.
-
-“A United States Midshipman in China” told of the adventures of the
-same boys in China during a threatened uprising of fanatical Chinese
-against the foreigners. Here again diplomacy counseled silence, and
-their reward for saving the day was a mild rebuke from their admiral.
-One of the principal characters in all three books is Jack O’Neil, a
-typical modern man-of-war’s man.
-
-These books are written in an endeavor to portray the life led by young
-officers in the naval service. The writer’s own experiences warrant
-the belief that the incidents are not unusual. The midshipmen are not
-merely automatons. To one of Napoleon’s pawns an order was an order,
-to be obeyed, right or wrong. But the doctrine, “their’s not to reason
-why” when “some one has blundered” is no longer accepted as an excuse
-for poor results. In these days of progress we court-martial an officer
-who stubbornly obeys an order, when he knows that to do so will injure
-the cause he has sworn to uphold.
-
-Further account of the boys’ stirring adventures will be found in “A U.
-S. Midshipman in Japan” and “A U. S. Midshipman in the South Seas.”
-
-
-
-
-Contents
-
-
- I. THE START FOR PALILO 9
-
- II. A POLITE CAPTOR 25
-
- III. A LEAK OF MILITARY INFORMATION 41
-
- IV. LANDED IN CAPTIVITY 54
-
- V. CAPTAIN BLYNN MARCHES 71
-
- VI. THE “MINDINAO” 83
-
- VII. THE GUNBOAT COÖPERATES 101
-
- VIII. THE PRIVILEGES OF RANK 119
-
- IX. THE KATIPUNAN SOCIETY 138
-
- X. IN THE SHADOW OF A SUSPICION 158
-
- XI. A TRAITOR UNMASKED 175
-
- XII. THE MIDSHIPMEN RECONNOITRE 189
-
- XIII. UNWELCOME COMPANIONS 212
-
- XIV. CLEVERLY OUTWITTED 225
-
- XV. A NIGHT OF ALARM 241
-
- XVI. A FILIPINO MARTYR 259
-
- XVII. A DARING PLAN 277
-
- XVIII. A RIVER EXPEDITION 292
-
- XIX. A WILLING CAPTIVE 308
-
- XX. THE STRUGGLE FOR THE STRONGHOLD 324
-
- XXI. THE GUNBOAT TAKES A HAND 336
-
- XXII. THE ESCAPED OUTLAW 346
-
- XXIII. COLONEL MARTINEZ 355
-
- XXIV. THE GUNBOAT ON GUARD 366
-
- XXV. CONCLUSION 377
-
-
-
-
-Illustrations
-
-
- PAGE
-
- SOME ONE TURNED ON THE CURRENT _Frontispiece_
-
- HERE WAS FREEDOM WITHIN HIS GRASP 69
-
- “I AM IN COMMAND HERE!” 126
-
- “HELLO, HERE ARE SOME CANOES!” 205
-
- UP THE FACE OF THE CLIFF 288
-
- HE GAZED DOWN INTO THE STILL FACE 333
-
- A MAN STEPPED SILENTLY FROM BEHIND A TREE 356
-
-
-
-
-A United States Midshipman In the Philippines
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-THE START FOR PALILO
-
-
-The “Isla de Negros,” a small inter-island steamer, lay moored
-alongside the dock in the turbulent waters of the Pasig River, the
-commercial artery of the city of Manila. As the last of its cargo was
-noisily carried on board by a swarm of half-naked stevedores, the
-slender lines which held the steamer to the stone quay were cast off,
-and with many shrill screeches from its high treble whistle the steamer
-swung its blunt bow out into the strength of the current.
-
-On the upper deck of the vessel, clad in white naval uniforms, two
-United States midshipmen stood in silent contemplation of the activity
-about them. They watched with undisguised interest the hundreds
-of toiling orientals; resembling many ant swarms, traveling and
-retraveling incessantly between the countless hulls of steamers and
-lorchas and the long rows of hastily constructed storehouses facing
-the river frontage. Here and there stood a khaki-clad sentry, rifle
-in hand and belt filled with ball cartridges, America’s guardian of
-the precious stores now being idly collected. Into these spacious
-storehouses the sinews of war for the army of occupation were being
-hoarded to be afterward redistributed among the small steamers plying
-between the metropolis, Manila, and the outlying islands of the
-archipelago.
-
-The American army in the Philippines, always too small for the
-stupendous task before it, was at last, owing to the added disaffection
-of the tribes in the Southern islands, receiving the attention from
-home which had long been withheld, and its numbers were being increased
-by the arrival of every transport from the far-away homeland.
-
-“We are here at last, Syd,” Midshipman Philip Perry exclaimed, a ring
-of triumph in his voice as he turned toward his fellow midshipman,
-Sydney Monroe. Friends of long standing were these two; for four
-years at the Naval Academy at Annapolis they had been companions and
-classmates, and during the past year they had together witnessed
-stirring service in South America and in China.
-
-“We’ve missed nearly six months of the war,” Sydney replied
-querulously; “from the last accounts, Aguinaldo is on the run. Why,”
-he ended mirthlessly, “the war may be over before we even see the
-‘Mindinao.’”
-
-“Pessimistic as usual,” Phil laughingly retorted; “where we are going,
-in the words of the immortal John Paul Jones, they ‘haven’t begun to
-fight.’”
-
-The steamer had now swung her bow down river, and the chug of the
-engines told the lads that they were fairly started on their voyage
-to Palilo, the capital of the island of Kapay, where the gunboat
-“Mindinao” was awaiting them.
-
-“Hello, what’s this?” Phil exclaimed, while the engine bell rang with
-throaty clanks, and the chugging of the engines ceased. The two lads
-leaning inquiringly over the rail, saw a small navy launch steam
-alongside the moving steamer; then a tightly lashed bag and hammock
-were thrown on deck, and finally from the depths of the white canopied
-awning there appeared the familiar form of a sailor, who sprang nimbly
-on board, waving a parting good-bye to his mates, while the launch
-swung away; and again the “Negros’” engines chugged noisily.
-
-“Jack O’Neil!” the two lads cried, their faces beaming with surprised
-pleasure as they grasped the newcomer’s hand.
-
-“It’s me, sir,” the sailor declared ungrammatically though heartily,
-highly delighted at his enthusiastic reception. “Telegraphic orders
-from the admiral to report to Midshipman Perry, commanding the gunboat
-‘Mindinao.’”
-
-“But where’s your old ship, the ‘Monadnock’?” Sydney questioned
-blankly. “We looked for her this morning as we came in on the cattle
-boat from Hongkong. Is she in the bay?”
-
-“Sure, sir, she is,” returned O’Neil, “over there at Paranaque keeping
-the ladrones out of the navy-yard with her ten-inch guns. They made a
-rush for it once, about six months ago, then the gugus had an army
-and we were kept guessing; but a few brace of hot ten-inch birds,
-exploding near them from our coffee kettle of a monitor soon made
-’em change their minds. They decided they hadn’t lost nothing at the
-navy-yard after all. But,” he ended, the enthusiasm dying out of his
-voice, “that, I said, was six months ago; we’ve been bailing out there
-ever since, awnings furled, guns loaded, expecting to be boarded every
-night.” He made a gesture of utter disgust as he stopped.
-
-“They don’t know anything, these gugus,” he began again, seeing that
-his friends didn’t understand his disjointed explanation; “they won’t
-try to board a man-of-war. They’ll attack you on shore; but as for
-paddling out in their canoes to capture a steel monitor, it’s too
-absurd. Yet we stood watch on and watch off every night waiting for
-’em to board. Do you blame me, sir, for feeling happy when I got these
-orders?” tapping his telegram against an awning stanchion. “This means
-life again; like we had in the dago country and up with them pigtailed
-chinks.”
-
-The midshipmen slapped the loquacious sailor joyfully on the back.
-
-“You’re not half as glad to be with us as we are to have you,” Phil
-exclaimed frankly. “We’re just aching for something worth while--we’ve
-been roasting up on the Yangtse River since you left us, doing nothing
-except watch the grass burn up and the water in the river fall. I never
-felt such heat.”
-
-While the Americans were talking the little steamer slipped noisily
-down the busy river and out on the bay made famous by Admiral Dewey on
-that memorable May morning.
-
-Corregidor Island lifted itself slowly out of a molten sea to the
-westward. The “Negros’” bow was pointed out through the southern
-channel, passing close to the precipitous island, standing like an
-unbending sentinel on guard between the wide portals of the Bay of
-Manila.
-
-“A few guns over there on Corregidor would soon stop this talk of
-our waking up some morning and finding Manila at the mercy of an
-enemy,” Phil declared after studying the landscape earnestly. “But
-these islands are too far away for our people at home to take much
-interest. Half of them would be glad to see another nation wrest them
-from us.--Hello! there’s one of those native lorchas,”[1] he added as
-his keen eye discovered a sail some miles away almost ahead of their
-steamer; “we passed one coming in this morning on the ‘Rubi.’ I looked
-at her through the captain’s spy-glass; her crew were the ugliest
-looking cutthroats I’ve ever seen. They reminded me of that picture
-‘Revenge.’ Do you know it?” he asked suddenly turning to Sydney, and
-then describing the picture in mock tragic tones: “A half score of
-scowling Malays, in the bow of their ‘Vinta’; their curved swords in
-their mouths and their evil faces lustful with passion and hope of
-blood, approaching their defenseless victims. I hope the captain gives
-them a wide berth, for I haven’t even a revolver.”
-
-The Americans had so far discovered but few people on board the
-steamer; the captain and pilot were on the bridge while on the lower
-decks there were scarcely a dozen lazy natives, listlessly cleaning the
-soiled decks and coiling up the confused roping.
-
-“Do you think we are the only passengers?” Sydney asked as they entered
-their stateroom to make ready for the evening meal.
-
-Phil shook his head.
-
-“No, there must be others, for I heard a woman’s voice in a cabin near
-ours.”
-
-As they again emerged on deck and walked aft to where their steamer
-chairs had been placed, a young Filipino girl rose from her seat
-and bowed courteously to the two young officers. Phil noticed as he
-saluted that she was a remarkably pretty girl of the higher class
-dressed in becoming native costume, and from her dark eyes there shone
-intelligence and knowledge.
-
-“Have I one of the señor’s chairs?” she asked in excellent Spanish. “It
-was very stupid of me to have forgotten mine.”
-
-Both lads remarked at once the air of good breeding and the pleasing
-voice; the guttural lisp so common in the Malay was lacking. She could
-not have appeared more at her ease and yet they saw by her dark skin
-and straight black hair that no other blood than the native flowed in
-her veins.
-
-“This is my small brother,” she explained as a slight lad of about
-seven came toward them from behind a small boat, resting on the skids
-of the upper deck. “He is my only companion,” she added half shyly.
-
-The midshipmen were at a loss how to talk to this girl of an alien
-race. If her skin had been fair they would have welcomed her gladly,
-seeing before them a pleasant two days of companionship before they
-would arrive at their destination; but she belonged to a race whose
-color they had been taught to believe placed her on a social footing
-far beneath their own.
-
-The girl seemed to divine the hesitancy in the midshipmen’s manner, and
-for a second a slight flush spread over her dark cheeks.
-
-Phil was the first to recover and break the embarrassing silence,
-heartily ashamed of himself for his boorish manner.
-
-“We are glad, señorita,” he commenced haltingly in Spanish which had
-become rusty through lack of practice, “to have you use our chairs, and
-also,” he ended lamely, “to have you with us. I fear we are the only
-passengers.”
-
-A few moments later a servant announced dinner, and the four took
-their seats at a table spread on the upper deck after the custom of the
-tropics.
-
-“The captain will not be with us,” the girl explained as Phil’s eyes
-rested inquiringly on the seat at the head of the table; “he begs that
-we will excuse him, for he is navigating the ship through the entrance
-to the bay.”
-
-They sat down in silence; Phil’s seat was next to this remarkable girl.
-
-In a few moments both lads had quite forgotten that her skin was dark,
-so skilfully did she preside over the plentiful board, attentive to
-their wants with the natural grace of one accustomed to dispense
-hospitality.
-
-“Juan and I are on our way to Palilo to join our father,” she explained
-after the meal had fairly started. “I am very much concerned over
-the bad news I have heard. Oh! I hope we shall not have war in our
-beautiful island,” she added appealingly, “but the Filipinos are so
-ignorant; they will follow blindly where they are led, and so many of
-our educated men are at heart bad.”
-
-“There has been some fighting there already?” Phil questioned.
-
-“Yes,” she answered, “but it has been only guerilla warfare so far. My
-father fears that reinforcements may come from the north. The natives
-in Luzon are of the Tagalo race, and if they come after being driven
-from their island by the American troops, we shall have the horrors of
-war on Kapay.”
-
-The midshipmen’s eyes sparkled; they were just about to express their
-delight at this possibility when they suddenly realized that she was of
-the same blood as those they were wishing to fight.
-
-Phil was the first to see the reproving look in the girl’s eyes.
-
-“You must not blame us, señorita,” he hastened to say apologetically.
-“You see fighting is our business; we look for it the same as a
-merchant looks for trade or a fisherman for fish.”
-
-“I think your ideas are wrong, señor,” she replied quickly, but in a
-caressing tone, to soften the sting. “Your duty is not necessarily
-to fight, but to prevent fighting. The sisters in the convent taught
-us that a soldier’s duty was to uphold the honor of his country. If
-fighting only will accomplish this duty, then it is just to fight, but
-in this case no honor is at stake. How can our people hurt the honor of
-a great nation like yours?”
-
-Phil blushed half angrily, half in shame. This girl of a dark race had
-the temerity to tell him what was his duty, and he was defenseless, for
-she was in the right.
-
-“It is true, señorita, what you say,” Sydney came to the rescue, “but
-peace for us is very monotonous, always the same eternal grind. War is
-exciting; it stirs the blood and makes men of us.”
-
-“Yes, señor,” the girl answered in a low, hard voice, “and it arouses
-all the evil passions in us. We forget all our training, all our
-ideals, all our instincts for good, and give way to the instincts of
-the beasts. My people in war are not men, señor, they are demons.”
-
-While the girl was talking the steamer had drawn closer to the lorcha
-which Phil had sighted earlier in the afternoon. The night was not
-bright; a crescent moon cast a dim light on the hull scarcely a hundred
-yards on the weather bow. The breeze had freshened, and with wind free
-the lorcha’s sails bellied out, giving it a speed almost equal to that
-of the steamer.
-
-“Why doesn’t he give that sail a wider berth?” Phil exclaimed suddenly
-as the girl’s voice died away. “If she should yaw now, she’d be into
-us.”
-
-“Look out!” Sydney cried in alarm as the lorcha suddenly sheered to
-leeward and the great mass of tautening canvas careened toward the
-unsuspecting steamer.
-
-The midshipmen were on their feet in an instant, while O’Neil came
-running up from the deck below.
-
-The Spanish captain, calling loudly to all his saints to witness that
-it was not his fault, jammed the helm to starboard, throwing the
-steamer’s bow away from the rapidly approaching lorcha. The engine bell
-clanked riotously, as the excited Spanish captain rang for more speed.
-Then the Americans’ blood froze in their veins, for the chugging of
-the noisy engines had ceased in a wheezy wail, and the “Negros” lay
-helpless, almost motionless in the path of the strange sail to windward.
-
-The lads looked at each other in consternation. The suddenness of the
-emergency had rendered them powerless to act.
-
-“Was it only a stupid blunder? Or was it by design that the silent
-lorcha had shifted its helm and stood down upon the demoralized
-steamer?” were the questions that came into their minds.
-
-A guttural hail from the lorcha accompanied by a fusillade of
-rifle-shots put an end to all doubt.
-
-“Pirates!” O’Neil gasped as he dislodged an iron crowbar from a boat
-skid. “And there isn’t a gun among us.”
-
-A bright glare suddenly darted from the bridge of the steamer as some
-one turned on the current for the search-light, and the Americans saw
-in the bright beam a motley crew of natives lining the lorcha’s rail,
-their eager bodies crouched ready to spring upon the deck of their
-helpless victim.
-
-“Tagalos,” the girl cried out in sudden alarm as she instinctively put
-her small brother behind her, shielding him from the flying bullets.
-
-“Don’t do it, sir,” O’Neil commanded hoarsely as Phil started
-precipitously forward. “We can’t stand them off, we’re too few. Here
-we can make a stand if they attack us. We can’t save the ship.”
-
-The lads saw at once the wisdom in O’Neil’s advice. No power could save
-the ship from the terrible onslaught of that savage horde. The two
-vessels came together with a mighty crash, and the air was rent with
-harsh cries of triumph as the captors leaped on board, firing their
-guns and slashing with their sharp bolos. The cries for mercy from the
-cringing crew were soon swallowed up in the shrieks of pain and anger
-as the vengeful victors satisfied their inherent love for blood.
-
-The triumphant natives scaled the bridge deck, and in the bright glow
-from the search-light, the Americans were horrified to see those on the
-bridge, in spite of their hands held aloft in supplication, cruelly
-butchered where they stood.
-
-The Americans in mortal dread pressed their bodies close within the
-deep shadow of the boats. The blinding glare from the search-light
-aided them in their attempt to hide from the searching eyes of their
-assailants. Phil and Sydney had manfully lifted the native girl and
-her brother into the boat behind them and stood their ground ready to
-protect them with their lives. So this was to be the end of their hopes
-for adventure?--to be butchered, unarmed and in cold blood by a band of
-lawless murderers.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-A POLITE CAPTOR
-
-
-The Americans were not kept long in suspense, although to the anxious
-boys, huddled helplessly in the shadow of the boat, the time seemed
-hours until the victorious and jubilant natives moved aft, bent on
-annihilating those whom they believed were hiding from their search.
-
-O’Neil grasped his weapon firmly, while the lads made a mental resolve
-to seize the arms of the first natives within reach and sacrifice their
-own lives as dearly as possible.
-
-Suddenly the beam of the search-light swung directly aft, revealing to
-the pirates the defenseless band of spectators to the recent tragedy.
-
-The helpless passengers were confident now that all was over. As if in
-broad daylight, they were visible to the outlaws. A volley from their
-rifles would send them all to death.
-
-Blinded by the bright light, they could but speculate as to the
-movement of their enemies, but they well knew that they must surely be
-advancing slowly, only awaiting the word to throw themselves on their
-helpless victims.
-
-What could be done? Phil realized only too vividly that something must
-be done and quickly. A false move would condemn them all. Once those
-wild men, steeped in the blood of the innocent, had commenced, even the
-power of their leader could not stop them.
-
-Then a girl’s voice, clear and commanding from behind them, made the
-Americans gasp in wonder. O’Neil with his great club raised to strike
-the misty figures just beyond his reach stiffened. The girl’s words
-were unintelligible to the Americans, but to the advancing natives they
-were like a flash of lightning from out of a clear sky. They stopped
-short, and for a few seconds a deep silence reigned. The girl was
-speaking in her native tongue. Phil cast a swift glance behind him; she
-stood boldly upright in the bow of the boat, like a beautiful bronze
-statue. The light threw her face in high relief against the black
-background of sky. He saw the flashing eyes, the quivering straight
-nostrils, and the scornful curve of her mouth. She finished speaking,
-and still the silence was unbroken. From the gathered crowd the leader
-advanced, his hand held above his head in mute sign of peace. Phil
-could scarcely believe his eyes, but the girl’s low voice in his ear
-caused his heart to beat tumultuously.
-
-“He has accepted your surrender.” She spoke in Spanish. Then, with her
-hands placed lightly on Phil’s shoulder she jumped down to the deck and
-advanced to meet the native leader. At a few paces from her he halted,
-and the Americans held their breath in wonder to see the bandit bow
-low before her, raising her hand to his lips. Then he turned and gave
-several harsh commands to his followers, who quietly dispersed.
-
-Inside of but a few minutes the lorcha had disappeared in the night and
-the “Negros” resumed its journey, the noisy engines chugging away just
-as faithfully under their new masters.
-
-The Americans, as they gathered about the table to finish the meal long
-forgotten in the excitement of the attack, marveled at the outcome of
-the affair.
-
-“Who can she be?” Sydney whispered. “Why, she orders the ladrone leader
-around as if she were a princess.”
-
-Phil was about to reply when the girl herself appeared from the
-shadows, followed by the native chief.
-
-The lads regarded him with a mixture of feelings, admiration for his
-soldierly bearing and disgust at the thought of the wilful butchery
-they had seen him permit on the bridge of the steamer.
-
-They recognized at once that these two were of the highest caste among
-their people. The man’s face, almost perfect in contour, except in the
-cruel lines of the mouth, beamed hospitably upon them.
-
-The girl spoke quickly, breathlessly.
-
-“Colonel Martinez wishes to meet the brave Americans who would have
-fought unarmed against overwhelming odds and who had no thoughts of
-asking for quarter.”
-
-The Americans bowed, but the Filipino advanced, his hand outstretched.
-Phil took it with almost a shudder. Why had this hand been withheld
-while the Spanish captain and his officers were asking for mercy
-scarcely five minutes before? Yet he knew that he had no choice but to
-take the proffered fingers; he and his companions were in the power of
-this man, the lines of whose mouth told what might happen if the native
-leader’s pride was offended.
-
-After shaking hands, Colonel Martinez went straight to the point. “You
-belong to the country of our enemy, and being such you must remain
-prisoners of war. We shall land at Dumaguete to-morrow, and if you will
-give me your solemn parole not to bear arms against us, I shall send
-you with an escort and safe conduct to Palilo. If not, I must send you
-to the headquarters of my superior, General Diocno.”
-
-Phil as spokesman bowed.
-
-“We shall not give you our parole, colonel,” he said emphatically. “We
-prefer to remain prisoners of war.”
-
-“As you will,” the insurgent answered coldly, but his swarthy face
-betrayed his admiration. “I shall assure you of my good offices with
-our general. And now, I shall leave you, but I warn you that your lives
-will be in danger if you leave this deck, or if you make the slightest
-attempt to thwart my plans. I shall have your belongings brought back
-here. You see I can take no chances, and I appreciate that you three
-Americans are no mean antagonists.” He cast a look of admiration at
-O’Neil, who had been listening in silence, his muscular fingers still
-clasping the stout crowbar with which he would like to have brained
-this pompous little Filipino.
-
-“Beggars can’t be choosers, Mr. Perry,” O’Neil exclaimed with a wry
-smile after the officer had departed, “and I guess it was a good thing
-the girl knew how to get the ear of that there little bantam rooster.
-In another minute, I’d have brained one of them, and then those words
-she spoke would have had as much chance to be heard as the chairman’s
-voice in a state convention.”
-
-The Americans’ belongings were brought to them from their cabin by
-several evil-looking natives, and very soon all were comfortable under
-the awning, protected from the wind by the boat against which an hour
-ago they had been about to make their last stand.
-
-The sun awakened the Americans at an early hour the next morning. While
-they were sipping their morning coffee, the lads gazed in admiration
-at the beautiful scenery about them. The little steamer had during
-the night wound its way past myriads of small islands, now but black
-smudges astern. The high mountains of Kapay Island rose boldly from the
-sea on their starboard hand. Ahead, becoming more distinct, was the
-shore line toward which the steamer was now traveling at an increased
-speed as told by the more rapid chugging of her engines.
-
-“Hello,” Phil exclaimed as he cast a glance toward the bridge,
-“something’s happening.”
-
-Sydney and O’Neil followed his gaze. There on the bridge were Martinez
-and the native pilot, who had apparently been spared in the attack of
-the night before. Martinez was walking up and down excitedly, casting
-an anxious glance ever and again off on the port quarter.
-
-It was O’Neil who was the first to discover the reason for the evident
-excitement of their captors.
-
-“Smoke,” he exclaimed laconically, characteristically jerking his thumb
-toward the islands astern fast being swallowed up in the glassy sea.
-“They ain’t taking no chances. That stretch of shore yonder,” he added,
-his gaze on the shore line ahead, “must be the mouth of the Davao
-River.”
-
-The lads gazed eagerly at the faint curl of smoke astern, but it gave
-them but scant encouragement, for it was only too evident that before
-the stranger, if it were one of the many small gunboats patrolling the
-islands, could hope to get within gunshot of the “Negros,” the steamer
-would have crossed the shallow bar of the Davao River and be safe from
-the pursuit of the deeper vessel.
-
-“If we could only stop her,” Phil lamented. “Smash those rickety
-engines or haul fires in the boiler.”
-
-O’Neil in answer cast a comprehensive glance at the sentries on guard
-on the upper deck. The evil-looking natives were squatted in plain
-sight, their loaded rifles held tightly in their brown fingers.
-
-“Oh! for three good Krag rifles,” Sydney cried petulantly; “we could
-clear this deck and then jam the steering gear there, and by the time
-they could overpower us the gunboat, if it is one, would make them
-heave to.”
-
-In a short time the girl and her brother joined them, and the native
-guards arose and moved farther away.
-
-“It is one of your gunboats,” she announced smiling mischievously
-at the evident pleasure of the midshipmen; “Colonel Martinez has
-recognized her through his telescope. She is giving chase, but
-Dumaguete is now scarcely twenty-five miles ahead, so I fear there will
-not be a rescue.”
-
-Phil calculated quickly. If Martinez could see the gunboat with his
-glass to recognize her she could not be over ten to twelve miles
-astern. The “Negros’” best speed was ten knots, which meant two and a
-half hours before she could reach the river bar. He knew that several
-of the gunboats were good for fifteen knots. If this were one of the
-fast ones, which he earnestly prayed it was, in two hours and a half
-the gunboat would be up to the “Negros.” His face brightened as these
-figures awakened his hopes.
-
-While the Americans went through the pretense of breakfast the “Negros”
-steamed swiftly toward the shore, and they saw with rising hopes the
-white hull of a large vessel raise itself slowly out of the deep blue
-of the tropical sea.
-
-Phil eyed the Filipino girl questioningly. He could tell nothing from
-her sphynx-like face. Would she be glad to be rescued from this band
-of outlaws or was she at home and safe among them? The respect shown
-her by the leader and his men seemed to point to the conclusion that
-she was of importance among her people. He knew not what were those
-crisp words spoken the night before to prevent the fierce onslaught of
-the natives, but they had calmed the storm. She had saved their lives,
-that much was certain; and for that, even though she was at heart in
-sympathy with this band of pirates, he owed her his gratitude.
-
-His whole heart rebelled against the thought of captivity among the
-insurgents. He knew it would be a living death. Poorly nourished and
-without the necessities of life; exposed to the savage temper of a
-people whose spirits fluctuated more rapidly than a tropical barometer,
-there seemed but little to live for. Perhaps death would be happier!
-His thoughts dwelt upon the stories he had heard of the atrocities
-committed by this same Diocno upon American soldiers who had been
-captured. Some of them he had buried alive in an ant-hill all but their
-heads, with their mouths propped open and a train of sugar leading
-to their swollen tongues. A cold shiver ran down his spine as his
-imagination pictured the agony of these men as they slowly died.
-
-“It’s the ‘Albany,’” O’Neil cried joyfully a minute later, “and do you
-see the bone in her teeth? She’s making nearly twenty knots. Why, it’s
-all over but the shouting. These little yellow runts will look well
-when they are lined up against the wall at Cavite and shot for piracy.”
-
-Phil held up his hand to demand silence from the excited sailor. He did
-not know how much English the girl might know, and the ladrone leader
-might learn the dire wish of the sailorman for him and his followers.
-Then if the “Negros” escaped, his anger could be vented upon the
-Americans. But the girl’s face did not betray that she had understood
-the meaning of O’Neil’s words. The “Albany” was fast approaching, but
-Phil knew that O’Neil must be overestimating the cruiser’s speed; the
-most she could make, without special preparation, would be fifteen
-knots, but, and his joy welled up into his eyes,--her six-inch guns! He
-had seen them fired with accuracy at four miles.
-
-The shore line ahead had now become distinct. The deep cut in the
-surrounding hills betrayed the presence of the Davao River as it flowed
-through them to the sea. Groves of high-topped palm trees appeared, a
-deeper green against the emerald background, while the water stretching
-toward them from the land polluted the sea with a dull brown stain--the
-muddy water of the river. The town of Dumaguete could not be seen,
-but from the curls of rising smoke, Phil knew it must be beyond the
-first bend of the river and screened from view by the spur-like hill
-stretching its length from the mountains behind to the water’s edge.
-
-The girl sat between the two midshipmen, her small brother innocently
-unconscious of the tragedy being enacted about him, playing joyfully
-about the decks. Phil watched the child as a relief to his overanxious
-mind. He had dislodged a wedge-shaped block of wood from under the
-quarter boat, and was using it to frighten a large monkey which was
-eying him grotesquely from on top of the tattered awning. The monkey
-apparently did not enjoy the game, for he suddenly flew screeching at
-the boy, his mouth opened viciously. The boy in his haste to escape
-dropped the block of wood almost on Phil’s foot and the midshipman
-determinedly placed his foot upon it. In that instant an idea had
-occurred to him. His pulse beat faster, as the thought flashed into his
-mind. He would use it as a last resort, even though it would bring the
-howling mob of natives vengefully about their heads.
-
-“Now she’s talking,” O’Neil exclaimed grimly, as a flash and a puff
-of brownish smoke belched from the bow of the distant cruiser. The
-Americans arose to their feet, their eyes held fascinatingly on the
-cruiser. They knew that a hundred-pound shell was speeding toward
-them at a speed of a mile in three seconds. The Filipino girl sat
-unconcernedly sipping her coffee. She was as yet ignorant of the
-meaning of that flash from a vessel nearly five miles away.
-
-Far astern a column of water arose in the air and the distant shock of
-the discharge came to their expectant ears.
-
-Phil saw with sinking heart that the “Negros” had entered the
-discolored water from the river. Ahead less than two miles the
-ever-present bamboo fish weirs showed the commencement of the shallows
-of the Davao River. His hopes died within him. The cruiser was not
-making the speed he had hoped. She would hardly be in range before
-the “Negros” had put the high spur of land between her and the enemy.
-The cruiser, apparently seeing the quarry was about to escape, opened
-a rapid fire in hopes of intimidating or crippling its prey; but the
-range was too great. The shells hissed close to the stern of the
-fleeing vessel; the boasted accuracy of American gunners was lacking.
-
-“If she was only a thousand yards closer,” O’Neil cried in bitter
-disappointment. “It’s only a matter of luck at this distance. Look
-out,” he yelled as a shell struck the water with the noise of an
-express train, within fifty feet of the fleeing “Negros.”
-
-The Filipino girl’s face blanched, while the boy ran cowering to his
-sister’s side. The danger to them seemed almost supernatural. The
-girl’s lips moved, and Phil saw that she was praying. For a moment a
-fear seized him. The thought of their danger was certainly unnerving.
-A single shell exploding near them would send them all to eternity.
-The fish weirs were now abreast the ship and the “Negros’” bow was
-being guided into the narrow, tortuous channel of the delta. The
-Filipino pilot on the bridge spun his steering wheel from side to side,
-following the twisting channel. The quadrant with its rusty chain,
-connecting the wheel and the rudder, clanked loudly at Phil’s feet. Now
-was the time to put his daring plan in operation. He saw that the four
-guards had taken refuge behind the boats, from which they peered out
-with frightened eyes at the oncoming cruiser, dodging out of sight at
-each screech of a shell. They had apparently forgotten the prisoners
-whom they were guarding, for their rifles and belts were resting on
-the hatch several yards away.
-
-“When I give the word, you jump for those rifles and belts,” Phil said
-in a low, intense voice, glancing covertly at the terrified girl at his
-side. “I am going to jam the steering quadrant. When you get the guns,”
-he continued, “take cover behind the boats. It may cost us our lives,
-but anything is better than imprisonment among these people.”
-
-O’Neil and Sydney breathed a gasping assent to the bold plan. Phil
-watched carefully the quadrant; he saw it move slowly over until it
-was hard astarboard. He reached down, grasping the boy’s block of wood
-under his foot, then slid it slowly, amid the terrific noise of a
-passing shell, toward the quadrant. He knew the wedge would hold the
-rudder over and the “Negros,” unable to steer, would ground on the
-edge of the channel, thus leaving her helpless to be captured by the
-cruiser. He opened his mouth to give the signal for his companions to
-act, when a shrill warning cry sounded in his ears and he was roughly
-drawn back into his chair and the wedge dropped from his hands a foot
-from its goal.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-A LEAK OF MILITARY INFORMATION
-
-
-Brigadier-General Wilson sat at his desk in the headquarters building
-at Palilo. In the spacious corridors outside orderlies hurried to and
-fro, carrying messages from the several officers of the staff whose
-offices joined that of the general.
-
-Before him was a chart of his military district, and while he pondered
-he juggled a score or more of different colored pins with little tags
-attached to them. Those pins with blue heads represented soldiers of
-his command in the field against the enemy while the ones with the
-green heads were the ladrones or insurrectos, whom he had been fighting
-without success for nearly six months.
-
-“They jump about as if they were mounted in balloons,” he exclaimed
-testily as he drew out several green-headed pins and replaced them in
-accordance with recent information in other localities on the map. The
-big headquarters clock ticked away in silence, while the gray-haired
-veteran again lapsed into thought over his problem.
-
-“Here are two regiments in the field,” he complained querulously;
-“Gordon with two companies at San Juan, Baker with a company at
-Binalbagan, Anderson and a battalion at Barotoc, Huse and a company
-at Estancia, Pollard with two companies at Kapiz, Shanks with three
-companies at Carles, Stewart with his rough-riders at Dumangas and Bane
-with his two battalions as a flying column. That ought to give us some
-results, and yet what have we to show for it?”
-
-The general raised his thoughtful eyes, as his orderly’s step sounded
-on the soft matting at his side.
-
-“A telegram,” he exclaimed with a show of interest. “Tell Major Marble
-I wish to see him,” he added, tearing open the yellow envelope.
-
-“Whew!” he whistled in sudden consternation as he read the unwelcome
-message. “They not only avoided Gordon but attacked San Juan in his
-absence, cutting up ten of his men left to guard the town. This thing
-has got to be stopped. There is a leak somewhere and I am going to put
-my hand on it before I send out another expedition.”
-
-He pushed the chart back on his desk and rose suddenly to his feet.
-
-“Major,” he cried as the adjutant-general’s active figure entered the
-office, “we are all a set of ninnies. Don’t start and look indignant,
-sir,” he added in mock severity. “You are as bad as the rest, but Blynn
-there is the worst of us all, for he can’t do what he’s employed to
-do--you and I are only plain, blunt soldiers, while he is supposed,”
-with fine scorn, “to be in addition lawyer and detective; a regular
-secret service sleuth and all that.
-
-“Here, read that,” he ended throwing the telegram on the desk. “You
-see it’s the same old story, and ten more men butchered through our
-stupidity.”
-
-The general paced up and down his office with quick, energetic steps.
-
-“I’ve a good mind to go out in the field myself,” he exclaimed, half to
-himself. “I am tired of these silly, costly blunders.” Then he glanced
-through the open door into the next office to his own. “Come here,
-Blynn!” he hailed.
-
-A stout, dark-visaged officer arose from a desk littered with countless
-papers and came energetically toward him.
-
-The older officer’s eyes roamed searchingly over his judge-advocate
-general’s strong, massive frame; he gazed with kindling eyes at the
-bronzed cheeks, the unbending directness of his black eyes, the firm
-set to the bulldog jaws. Here surely was no weakling. He waved his hand
-toward the adjutant-general, standing in stunned silence, the telegram
-crumpled in his hand.
-
-“That may interest you,” the general exclaimed as he turned away.
-
-“The information was first hand, sir,” Captain Blynn’s bass voice
-insisted after he had straightened the paper and read the unwelcome
-message. “There’s been a leak.”
-
-“Of course there’s been a leak,” the general announced hotly, “any
-idiot would see that, but where? Where? that’s the question!”
-
-Captain Blynn returned to his desk and drew out a bundle of papers
-from a locked drawer. He glanced over them hurriedly. Every word was
-familiar to him. Could he have made a mistake? Every witness whom he
-had examined had given the same information. These natives had not
-been coerced; they had come to him of their own volition. Espinosa had
-vouched for each. Then he stopped, the papers fell from his hand to the
-desk. No! it could not be possible! Espinosa was surely loyal. That
-much was sure. For the space of a minute he was lost in thought. “I
-shall test him,” he muttered, while he pressed a bell at his side.
-
-“Tell Señor Espinosa over the telephone that I shall call on him in an
-hour on important business,” he instructed the orderly who answered his
-summons.
-
-An hour later Captain Blynn mounted the high stairs of the wealthy
-Filipino’s dwelling.
-
-“Buenos Dias, El Capitan,” Señor Manuel Espinosa cried delightedly as
-he pushed a chair forward for his visitor. But the smile died quickly
-on the native’s face as Captain Blynn waved away the chair impatiently,
-almost rudely, and in his typical way jumped into the very midst of the
-matter in hand.
-
-“Señor,” he exclaimed angrily, “I’ve been betrayed! Do you understand?”
-he cried menacingly, his flashing eyes fixed on the crafty face
-opposite him, while he shook his big, strong fist before the eyes of
-the startled Presidente of Palilo. “Betrayed, that’s the word, and if
-I can lay my hand on the hound, I’ll swing him to the eaves of his own
-house-top.”
-
-Señor Espinosa was silent, his crafty, bead-like eyes regarding closely
-the angry, excited face of the judge-advocate.
-
-“Captain Gordon went on a wild-goose chase, and when he returned he
-found the insurgents had been in San Juan in his absence. Ten soldiers,
-American men, were caught, trapped, and butchered. The natives who
-brought me the information were vouched for by you and now you’ve got
-to prove to me that you’re not a sneaking traitor!”
-
-The captain’s words tumbled one after another so fast that the little
-Filipino could grasp only half their meaning, but the last could not
-be misunderstood. His brown face turned a sickly yellow, while his
-frightened eyes sought instinctively for some weapon of defense from
-this terrible American, who was strong enough to tear his frail body
-limb from limb.
-
-“Ah, señor capitan, is this your much-boasted American justice?” he
-gasped in a weak voice. “Am I then judged guilty without hearing my
-defense?” His voice became stronger as he proceeded. “Let us look over
-this calmly,” he begged. “I, myself, have been betrayed. In embracing
-the American cause, I have made many enemies among my people. I live
-constantly in fear of assassination.” He stopped abruptly, his voice
-choking and his eyes filled with tears of self-pity.
-
-Captain Blynn had dealt with many different classes of men in his
-twenty odd years of service. He had been a terror to the ruffians on
-the Western frontier where he had been stationed during the several
-Indian wars. The “bad men” had said when they had found Blynn against
-them, “We might as well own up--we can’t fool Blynn.”
-
-But here was a case that baffled him. In the hour before going to
-this house he had after deep thought believed that after all Espinosa
-was a traitor, and he had avowedly intended to force him to confess
-his treason; but now in spite of these resolves, the captain was
-weakening. After all might not the Filipino be innocent? At all events
-he would listen to his defense.
-
-Captain Blynn dropped his muscular hands, which had been creeping
-menacingly toward the thin yellow throat of the Presidente, and sat
-down suddenly in the chair which the native had previously offered him.
-
-“Go on!” he ordered harshly. “I’ll suspend judgment, but remember, if
-you can’t prove your innocence, I’ll give you water. Do you understand,
-water! I’ve never given it, and I don’t believe in it, but if you can’t
-show me how these men were butchered, I’ll fill you up to the neck with
-it.”
-
-Espinosa wetted his lips with his tongue and swallowed hard, but the
-captain by taking the proffered chair had removed the native from the
-terrifying influence of those powerful twitching fingers which he had
-seen ready to throttle him, and he, in proportion to the distance away
-of the cause of his fear, grew bolder.
-
-“The señor capitan must know of my sincerity,” he pleaded in a weak
-voice. “Have I not taken the oath of allegiance to the United States?
-Do I not know the punishment for breaking that oath?”
-
-Captain Blynn nodded his head. “Go ahead,” he commanded impatiently;
-“cut that out, give me the unvarnished story.”
-
-“The information which I gave you and which was sworn to by three
-witnesses came from Juan Rodriguez,” Espinosa continued, dropping his
-voice to a whisper and approaching closer to the American. Then he
-stopped and glanced covertly at his listener’s startled face.
-
-“Juan Rodriguez!” the judge-advocate general exclaimed half rising in
-his excitement. “Then you believe that he has deliberately furnished
-false information of the insurgents’ movements?”
-
-While the two were talking a servant brought refreshments, which the
-army man waved impatiently aside. Espinosa helped himself and as he did
-so he followed his servant’s eye to a tightly rolled piece of paper
-inside the salva. He drew it out hastily, unrolling it in silence,
-feeling rather than seeing the captain’s eyes upon him, then he read
-the few lines written therein. Here was a chance to redeem his good
-name or at least save himself for this time from the fierce American.
-He asked a question in the native language and received a monosyllabic
-answer.
-
-“This is very important,” he exclaimed suddenly turning to the American
-officer. His voice was now joyful, full of confidence. “Two hundred
-riflemen have landed at Dumaguete from Luzon. To-night they will be
-encamped on a hill near Banate. You can attack them there before they
-can join Diocno.”
-
-Captain Blynn jumped to his feet, reaching out for the paper; he took
-it, scrutinizing it closely--then stuck it quietly into his pocket.
-Espinosa held out a trembling hand, bent upon regaining the note, but
-Captain Blynn had turned away, picking up his hat and whip from the
-table behind him.
-
-“I shall myself go in command of this expedition,” he announced gruffly
-as he moved toward the stairs, “and I shall expect you to accompany me,
-señor. We shall start at sunset.”
-
-Señor Espinosa feebly murmured his willingness, and after waiting
-to see the burly figure of his visitor pass out through the wide
-entrance, he turned and called for his servant.
-
-“Tell the messenger I will speak to him,” he said as the muchacho
-noiselessly entered.
-
-A moment later a ragged native stood tremblingly before him, twisting
-his dirty head-covering in his nervous hands.
-
-Espinosa seated himself luxuriously in the chair recently vacated
-by Captain Blynn. He had now regained his old confidence and cruel
-arrogance, while he fired question after question at the uncomfortable
-native.
-
-The Presidente sat motionless in his chair long after his messenger
-had gone. His servant came noiselessly into the room several times
-but tiptoed away, believing his master was asleep. But Espinosa was
-far from sleep, his brain was actively at work. How could he hold his
-position and yet remain undiscovered to this terrible Captain Blynn? He
-shuddered as he remembered those big hands as they worked longingly to
-grasp his slender neck. He was not a fighting man; the inheritance of
-his father’s Chinese blood mixed with the cruelty in the native strain
-qualified him only for plotting. Others could do the fighting. His
-brain and cunning would furnish them the means and opportunity. But
-Rodriguez--he was too honest, and knew too much; he stood a menacing
-figure in his path as the leader of his people. He had, however, set
-the train of powder on fire, and now he would watch it burn. Once
-Rodriguez was removed there were no others strong enough to thwart
-him. Even Diocno bowed to his superior sagacity. Then he could cast
-off this halter that he felt tightening about his neck. With Diocno
-and Rodriguez out of the way, he could make terms with these childlike
-Americans, and then with his fortune made shake the dust of the islands
-forever from his feet.
-
-An hour before sunset he arose and dressed himself for his ride,
-ordering his servant to have his horse ready. The messenger had three
-hours’ start; that would insure the escape of the Tagalos. Captain
-Blynn would find that his information was true. He could not blame him
-if the enemy had taken alarm and fled. As for the other matter, if the
-Americans would only arrest Rodriguez he would see that he did not
-interfere with his cherished plans for power. As he buckled on his
-English made leggings, he whistled gaily an old Spanish air, one he
-had heard in Spain; in his mind he saw the brightly lighted theatre,
-the richly dressed people in the boxes. Some day he would be rich and
-he would then be able to recline in a gilded box and cast disdainful
-glances at an admiring crowd.
-
-His joy would have been indeed short-lived and his castles in Spain
-would have fallen as flat as the surface of the sea on a calm day if
-he could have known that at that moment his messenger was lying dead
-in the trail but half-way to his destination, suddenly overcome by the
-terrible scourge of the camp, cholera.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-LANDED IN CAPTIVITY
-
-
-Phil was too angry and humiliated to do more than glare at the girl who
-had so cleverly thwarted him in his daring plan to strand the steamer.
-His companions had started to spring toward the coveted rifles of their
-enemy, but now they sank back into their seats and hopelessly looked
-into the menacing muzzles of these same rifles in the hands of the four
-aroused sentries. The girl had risen to her feet, her face flushed with
-excitement; she raised her hand to the natives, motioning them to put
-up their weapons.
-
-Phil scrambled to his feet and sheepishly dropped again into his chair.
-His breathing was quick and his eyes dilated with suppressed rage and
-mortification. At that moment he could have quite forgotten his natural
-instinct of gallantry and would have taken pleasure in throttling this
-slight girl who had come between them and freedom.
-
-“They would have all been shot,” she said in quick accents of
-excitement. “You see I can understand a little English. I could not be
-a traitor to my own blood as long as I had power to prevent it.”
-
-For answer Phil gave her a look of loathing.
-
-The girl recoiled under his menacing glance.
-
-“I am sorry for you,” she hastened to add, “for now Colonel Martinez
-will have to keep you closer prisoners, unless you give me your word
-that you will not again try to prevent the escape of the steamer.”
-
-Phil shook his head savagely, his eyes on the steering quadrant within
-easy reach of his hand. The girl waited breathlessly for an answer,
-then finding none was forthcoming she gave a sharp command in her
-own language and immediately the four sentries closed in around the
-Americans, their rifles pointed toward their prisoners.
-
-“For goodness’ sake, Phil,” Sydney exclaimed in an agony of doubt,
-“don’t be foolhardy. We are absolutely in their power. See,” he cried
-desperately, “the ‘Albany’ has stopped and sheered away. She has given
-up the chase.”
-
-Phil realized that Sydney was right--nothing could be gained by giving
-in to his rash anger. He saw that O’Neil had dropped the crowbar and
-had been led away by two of the natives, going as peacefully as a lamb.
-However his pride stood in the way of an outward surrender, and instead
-of agreeing to make no attempts to disable the steamer he arose and
-moved away from the tempting steering quadrant.
-
-The “Negros” had meanwhile threaded her way among the dangerous shoals
-and was now in the river; the cruiser had disappeared behind the land.
-
-A great crowd of natives ashore had witnessed the escape of the steamer
-from the war-ship and these lined the banks of the river shouting
-joyfully as the “Negros” steamed quietly to the bamboo pier in front of
-the village.
-
-As soon as the dock had been reached, the girl dismissed the guards and
-the Americans once more gathered about the breakfast table.
-
-A few moments later Colonel Martinez, his face wreathed in smiles, left
-the bridge and joined them.
-
-“You are to be given the freedom of the town,” he said as he took a
-cup of coffee from the servant’s hands and sipped it gratefully, “but
-I warn you if you attempt to escape you will be shot, and even if you
-escaped, without guides you would be lost in the jungle and be killed
-by ladrones.”
-
-Phil bowed his head in sign of submission. They were certainly
-prisoners, without hope of rescue.
-
-“To-morrow morning,” Colonel Martinez added, “we shall leave the
-village and march inland. I have already sent to notify our leader that
-I have successfully arrived. I think for your own good it would be
-wiser for you to remain on board here until we start. I do not trust
-the temper of the people. Americans are not just now in favor.” He
-finished with an amused smile on his face.
-
-After their captors had left them, the three terribly disappointed men
-sat bemoaning their fate.
-
-“We might just as well make the best of it,” Sydney philosophically
-assured the others. “There certainly isn’t any way to escape that I
-can see. After all, we’ve been in just as tight places and have come
-out of them; we don’t make matters any better by crying over spilled
-milk.”
-
-“If that girl hadn’t betrayed us,” Phil moaned, “we would have been on
-board the ‘Albany’ this minute.”
-
-“Mr. Perry,” O’Neil broke in apologetically, “it ain’t like you
-to be unfair to anybody, most of all a woman. These are her own
-people--Colonel Martinez must be a friend of hers, or otherwise we
-wouldn’t have been living to see the ‘Albany.’ If she had only been an
-ordinary native girl, these ladrones wouldn’t have stopped and bowed
-and scraped and then given us the freedom of the after deck of the
-ship. No, sir, she’s a person of consequence. She saved our lives and
-then afterward she saved the lives of Colonel Martinez and his band
-of cutthroats, for if they had fallen into the hands of the crew of
-the ‘Albany’ they would have all been shot or swung at her yard-arm.
-Seizing this merchant ship and killing her captain is piracy.”
-
-“I think O’Neil is right,” Sydney exclaimed patting the sailor on the
-back enthusiastically. “The girl’s all right--I’ll take my hat off to
-her every time.”
-
-“It was my own stupidity, I suppose,” Phil declared, his face sobering
-slightly. “I thought she was too frightened to know what was happening;
-in fact I really didn’t believe she would understand what I intended
-doing.”
-
-“Who do you suppose she is?” Sydney asked eagerly. “Isn’t it queer she
-has never told us her name?”
-
-“It probably wouldn’t aid us if she had,” Phil replied; “she’s probably
-the daughter of some rich Filipino, who holds a fat position under our
-civil government. By the way she talked when we first met her I thought
-she was dead against war, yet she appears to know and welcome these
-cutthroat Tagalos with open arms.”
-
-“There you go, Phil,” Sydney admonished, “unfair again. She has so far
-shown herself willing to help both sides. In your heart, when you’ve
-recovered from your disappointment and humiliation at being handled so
-roughly by a girl, you’ll see that she acted in a way that was just to
-both the insurgents and ourselves.”
-
-The next morning at daylight the Americans were up and dressed, ready
-for the march with their captors.
-
-“Colonel Martinez has secured enough horses for you and your companions
-to ride,” the girl told them as a half dozen small Filipino ponies were
-led down to the end of the wharf. “Your belongings will be carried
-by natives whom he has secured, so I hope you will not be put to too
-great hardships. The soldiers are used to marching, but for those
-unaccustomed to the country it is very tedious.”
-
-Phil thanked her not ungraciously. He had during many hours of a
-sleepless night brooded over the situation and had awakened with much
-kindlier thoughts for this girl than he had held the night before.
-
-The Americans, with Colonel Martinez, the girl and her brother
-rode at the head of the long file of armed insurgent soldiers. As
-the procession passed through the streets of the town the natives
-gathered and gave excited and enthusiastic yells of pleasure. Great
-curiosity was shown as to the white captives, but Colonel Martinez took
-precautions that they should not be disturbed by the evident dislike
-of the people. Phil read hatred in many eyes as they wended their
-way through the curious crowds, and he quite believed the insurgent
-colonel’s words that they would not be safe among them.
-
-The trail which they were following led steadily inland, and constantly
-climbed above the level of the sea. After a few miles had been covered
-all signs of habitation disappeared, the country was bleak and barren
-of cultivation. At first they had passed through groves of cocoanut,
-banana and many varieties of tropical fruit trees and afterward the
-velvety green of rice fields lay on either hand, but now the earth
-was scorched and brown, the high jungle bush lay thick on either side
-of the trail. The Americans realized the hardships of a campaign in
-such a country against a wild and determined foe. They had marched for
-about four hours without a rest when a signal of warning was given from
-scouts in front. The leader stopped, giving a low order to a soldier at
-his elbow.
-
-“What is it?” Phil breathed, forcing his pony forward eagerly.
-
-“They’ve seen something,” O’Neil whispered; “probably a company of our
-soldiers on a ‘hike.’”
-
-The Americans were ordered to dismount, and a dozen riflemen quietly
-surrounded them. Colonel Martinez spurred ahead while the entire band
-dissolved in the jungle, leaving the trail clear. Scarcely twenty feet
-from the trail the Americans were roughly seized, their hands secured
-tightly behind their backs and gags were forced into their mouths. They
-submitted peaceably. Suddenly, scarcely fifty yards away, a column
-of khaki-clad soldiers appeared marching down the trail. Phil caught
-a glimpse through a vista in the dense brush of these men, swinging
-lightly along, ignorant of the presence, so near them, of over two
-hundred armed enemies. His pulse beat fast and his heart seemed ready
-to burst within him. Were these Americans walking innocently into an
-ambush? He tried to scream a warning, but he emitted no sound save a
-faint gurgle, which his guards heard, and for his pains struck him
-down with their knees until he lay with his face pressed close to the
-prickly earth. He could hear the tramp of shod feet and an occasional
-snatch of a song. Once he heard a sharp command in English and at
-another time a jest which called forth local laughter. It seemed an
-age since he had seen the head of this column appear, and yet the
-earth trembled under the tread of a multitude of feet. Finally the
-sounds died away. The soldiers had passed, and no attack had been made.
-After a long hour of waiting their guards brought out the Americans
-and unbound their hands, taking out the cruel gags from their mouths.
-Colonel Martinez appeared, still mounted upon his small gray pony.
-
-“I am very sorry,” he said politely, “but I could not run the
-risk of detection. That was Colonel Bane with two battalions of
-the Seventy-eighth Infantry. I had been warned that he was in the
-neighborhood. I was not strong enough to attack him.”
-
-Phil could have cried aloud at the utter uselessness of this warfare.
-Their movements heralded far and wide whenever a column moved, in a
-country well-nigh impenetrable, how were the Americans ever to put down
-this ugly rebellion?
-
-At sunset the band halted and went into camp. Phil saw that the site
-selected was a strong one and one that could be easily defended from
-attack if the attackers came by trail, and there seemed no other way
-through the impenetrable brush.
-
-“We shall remain here until my messenger returns,” Phil overheard
-Colonel Martinez say to the girl. “Will you wait until your father
-sends for you, or will you accept an escort from me?”
-
-“I shall remain here,” she said; “the morning should bring my own
-people.”
-
-Shortly afterward the girl took her brother’s hand and led him away
-to the part of the camp that had been set aside for her own use, and
-Colonel Martinez joined the disconsolate Americans.
-
-“The señorita,” he said as he sat down on the ground near Phil, “has
-told me of the brave conduct of my prisoners, and I wish it were in
-my power to set you free. I have known many American navy men before
-this war began and my treatment by them has always been courteous and
-considerate. I have the power to take your parole, and knowing the
-hardships which you must undergo as prisoners among our soldiers I
-advise you to give it. To-morrow morning you can be on your way to
-Palilo.”
-
-It was certainly a grave temptation, but the midshipmen knew that in
-giving their parole all hopes of taking part in the war would vanish;
-and then, the insurgents not being recognized as belligerents, the Navy
-Department might even see fit to order them to break their parole.
-
-“Thank you, señor,” Phil finally replied. “We shall take our chances
-as your prisoners. We shall always remember your considerate treatment
-of us, and if by the chances of war the situation is reversed you can
-count on us to repay our obligations to a chivalrous enemy.”
-
-“If you and your companions were to remain in my keeping,” the Filipino
-answered, a pleased smile on his face at Phil’s subtle compliment, “I
-should have no concern, but I must give you over to the mercies of
-General Diocno; he is a Tagalo, and has known nothing but war since
-his youth; he would never surrender to the Spaniards, and for years a
-price has been upon his head; he is said to be cruel to those who fall
-into his hands.”
-
-Phil shuddered at the frank words of his captor. He saw in the
-earnestness of his face that this gruesome information was being given
-for the Americans’ own good.
-
-“Your friends,” the colonel continued, “will doubtless attempt a
-rescue, and that will only add to your danger.”
-
-After Colonel Martinez had said good-night Phil told his companions of
-the unpleasant and disquieting reports concerning their future captor,
-but nothing could shake O’Neil’s good spirits.
-
-“It’s all in the game, Mr. Perry,” he said philosophically. “They can’t
-do more than kill us, and as we’ve got to die some day, it might just
-as well be in Kapay as any other place. But as long as we’ve got our
-senses and our strong arms, there are going to be some little brown men
-hurt before I give up my mess number.
-
-“What I’ve been trying to study out,” the sailor continued, seeing the
-two lads still silent, “is how all those American soldiers could pass
-along that trail and not find out that this band of natives had just
-left it. Where are all the old Indian fighters we used to have in the
-army?”
-
-Phil and Sydney both raised their heads, a look of surprise in their
-faces.
-
-“I hadn’t thought of that,” Sydney exclaimed. “Our trail must have been
-there; the native soldiers all go barefooted and leave but indistinct
-tracks on this hard soil, but our pony tracks must have been in plain
-sight.”
-
-“The solution is,” Phil broke in sadly, “those men were volunteers, the
-Seventy-eighth Infantry, the colonel said; there probably wasn’t an old
-soldier among them. They fight like demons when they see the enemy, but
-are as helpless as children against a savage foe skilled in woodcraft.
-If that had been a battalion of regulars there’d have been a fight and
-we would now be free, or,” he added with an unconscious shiver, “dead
-there in the jungle, for the native guarding me would have been only
-too happy to stick his bolo into me.”
-
-O’Neil had already rolled himself in his blanket, apparently resigned
-to the tricks of fate, and the midshipmen, realizing, after their long
-day’s ride in spite of their troubled minds, that they were in need
-of rest, were soon comfortably settled on the bundles of dry grass
-given them to lie upon. As Phil dropped into a troubled sleep, he was
-conscious of the four native guards, pacing to and fro just outside of
-ear-shot. These four men were all that stood between them and liberty;
-for once they had escaped, he felt confident that O’Neil could be
-depended upon to follow the track of those half a thousand soldiers who
-had marched past so carelessly only a few hours before.
-
-After what seemed an incredibly short time, although he had slept for
-hours, he awakened with a start; sitting bolt upright, he gazed quickly
-about him. A faint streak of light in the eastern sky told him the
-night had nearly passed. His brain, keenly alive, grasped for a reason;
-what had stirred him to wakefulness? All was quiet about the camp. The
-guards were no longer on their feet, but he could see their shadowy
-forms squatting on the ground, their rifles in their hands. With a
-disappointed sigh, for what he did not know, he dropped back upon his
-bundle of straw, but he soon found he was too wide awake for more
-sleep. He finally arose, stretching himself as though just awakened,
-and by an impulse which he was powerless to disobey, walked slowly
-toward the guards. As he advanced he saw with surprise that they did
-not move. Stealthily he went on until he stood over the nearest one,
-squatting naturally, the butt of his rifle between his bare feet. The
-guard was sound asleep. Farther on he saw in the dim mysterious light
-of early dawn that the other three were also silently sleeping, their
-bodies propped up against the trunks of the dwarf pine-trees. Phil’s
-heart beat fast. Here was freedom within his grasp. He leaned forward,
-seizing the rifle barrel of an unconscious guard, drawing it slowly
-from his relaxed fingers. The butt still rested between his feet and as
-he slowly, steadily drew the rifle toward him, the sleeping native’s
-body settled itself inch by inch upon the ground.
-
-[Illustration: _HERE WAS FREEDOM WITHIN HIS GRASP_]
-
-A twig snapped close by, sending the blood coursing through his veins
-while his hand shook from the sudden start. Terrified he cast his
-startled eyes into the jungle behind him. The dim shadow of a man
-stood scarcely a hundred yards away, silently watching him. In the
-dim light the figure seemed of heroic size. He retreated toward it and
-back to his sleeping companions, the rifle clasped in his hand. Then
-suddenly the silence was broken by a volley of rifle-shots and the hiss
-of bullets sounded everywhere about him. Stunned, unable to explain
-the meaning of this, he dropped to the ground and lay silent, his face
-in the straw of his bed. The next second a line of shouting, excited
-khaki-clad men streamed past, firing their rifles as they charged upon
-their hidden native foes.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-CAPTAIN BLYNN MARCHES
-
-
-As night fell, Captain Blynn led his battalion of regulars from
-their barracks, across the bridge and on to the trail leading to
-the northward of Palilo. The American officer rode in the lead, the
-Filipino Presidente at his side. The soldiers behind him, eight full
-companies, each under its own officer, swung along with the long,
-untiring step of the American soldier. They each knew that before the
-night was over and the sun had lifted its fiery head above the misty
-mountains to the eastward twenty miles of rough trail must be covered,
-and then they had been promised to be brought face to face with an
-enemy whose shadows they had chased during these many long, tiresome
-months.
-
-Espinosa, as he rode in silence by the side of the big American,
-chuckled inwardly at the fruitlessness of this expedition. “These
-childlike American dogs,” he thought, “they will arrive in time to see
-the smouldering fires where our men have cooked their morning rice,
-while they will be high in the hills, looking down on them derisively,
-and possibly will fire a few shots at long range to show their
-contempt.”
-
-Captain Blynn’s restless gaze contemplated his companion from time to
-time as the native signaled the right trail. They were now in a narrow
-defile between two hills that rose precipitously to a height of over a
-thousand feet. Captain Blynn, as he contemplated his surroundings with
-a soldier’s eyes, drew his revolver from its holster and laid it gently
-across the pommel of his saddle.
-
-“A nice place for an ambush,” he said in a low, insinuating voice. “I
-suppose, señor, you are prepared to stand before your Maker.”
-
-The native shuddered. He saw only too clearly the accusation and threat
-in this terrible American’s words. If there was to be an ambush, he
-knew nothing of it, but if a single hostile shot was fired, he would
-pay the penalty with his life.
-
-The Filipino forced an uneasy laugh. “As far as I know, señor capitan,
-there are no insurgents this side of Banate.”
-
-“For your sake, I hope you are right,” the American replied. “As you
-see, I am taking no chances. You are our guide; if you get us into
-trouble, you pay, that’s all.”
-
-Captain Blynn ordered a halt and called a lieutenant from the leading
-company.
-
-“Take ten men, Simpson,” he said, “and act as the point. If you are
-attacked, retreat and fall back on the main body.”
-
-Lieutenant Simpson picked his men quickly and disappeared quietly
-down the trail. Captain Blynn watched them until swallowed up in the
-darkness, and then set the long line in motion again. Every soldier
-took, instinctively, a tighter grip upon his musket, and loosened the
-sharp sword bayonet from its scabbard. Each knew that when “Black Jack”
-Blynn took precautions there was reason to scent trouble.
-
-Half-way through the defile a guarded whistle of warning came to
-Blynn’s ears from the point. As one man the long column halted; the
-soldiers’ heavy breathing was distinctly audible above the tremor
-of the metallic rattling of accoutrements. Each soldier sought his
-neighbor’s face for a key to the solution of the problem. Blynn,
-motioning Espinosa to follow, rode silently forward. In the trail a
-hundred paces ahead he saw Lieutenant Simpson bending over a dark
-object.
-
-“What is it?” Blynn asked in a harsh whisper.
-
-“A dead native,” Simpson answered shortly. Espinosa was off his horse
-instantly; bending down quickly he struck a match, illuminating the
-native’s dead face. He started, turning a sickly yellow. His heart
-stopped beating, and his knees shook under him, but Captain Blynn
-was too much occupied with the silent figure to notice the peculiar
-behavior of his guide. They turned the dead man over, revealing the
-terrible havoc accomplished in but a few hours by the tropical scourge.
-
-“Poor chap!” Blynn exclaimed. “Only a common ‘Tao’ stricken by cholera
-and dead before he knew what had hit him.”
-
-They moved the body off the trail, and again the command was set in
-motion.
-
-In the flash of the match Espinosa had recognized his messenger
-although his face was horribly disfigured by his last mortal suffering.
-He shuddered at the consequences of this man’s death--Martinez would
-not get his warning message and would fall into the trap set for him.
-He, Espinosa, could never explain his actions. He would doubtless pay
-for this treachery with his life. But his cruel mind was instantly made
-up as to his future actions. He feared this American too thoroughly
-not to take them to the place where the Tagalos under Martinez were
-encamped; above all else Captain Blynn must be made to believe that he
-was sincere; all depended upon that. Everything must be sacrificed for
-his final great ambition. Martinez would not be taken alive. That was
-a necessity, he would see to that. Once he was killed his part in the
-night’s expedition must remain a secret among the Americans.
-
-Casting from him his first fears he straightened his slight frame and
-rode boldly, with head erect, beside the American leader.
-
-One hour before sunrise Captain Blynn disposed his command in a single
-circular line about the base of a high hill; its sides were covered
-with a dense jungle while a single trail led to the top.
-
-Under the guardianship of Espinosa the command moved forward, straight
-up through the high clutching brush; the men were so close to each
-other that their neighbors on each side were always in sight. Captain
-Blynn and one company marched fearlessly up the trail. A few feet from
-where the round top hill had been cleared he halted and waited for the
-remainder of his men to join him. His enemy’s camp was silent, but
-his keen eyes could discern shadowy forms lying prone on the ground.
-He searched for a sentry, but no movement could be seen. Were they
-all asleep, believing themselves secure in their surroundings? No!
-there directly in front of him he saw a white figure standing upright
-beside a dark form on the ground. This must be an officer, for the
-native soldiers do not wear white--something familiar in the pose and
-cut of the uniform struck him. Could it be possible, was it a navy
-uniform? At that instant the soldiers on both sides reached the edge
-of the clearing. As yet the enemy were unaware of their presence. Not
-a moment must be lost; they must attack at once. Firing his revolver,
-Captain Blynn plunged forward, straight toward the white-clad figure.
-Several of his men passed him while he stopped to find why the figure
-had thrown itself face downward in the grass at the discharge of his
-revolver.
-
-The next moment he was shaking hands with three almost tearfully joyful
-fellow countrymen.
-
-As soon as Phil realized that they were again free his thoughts were
-for the Filipino girl and her little brother. Was she in danger?
-With the rifle he had taken from the sentry in his hands, he rushed
-anxiously in the direction that he believed she might be found. He
-recognized some of her belongings on the ground at his feet, but the
-girl had vanished. Fearful at the thought of finding them killed by his
-own people, he sought her everywhere, repeatedly risking his life as
-the terrified natives, finding themselves trapped, flung at him with
-their long, sharp knives or discharged their weapons almost in his
-face. He gave them but little heed, not giving a thought to the reason
-why he had not been killed, although a faithful sailor at his elbow was
-the only tangible cause. A score of times O’Neil had saved his young
-officer at the risk of his own life.
-
-A small group of struggling men on the right near the edge of the
-jungle suddenly caught his restless eye and desperately he plunged
-downward toward them. On the ground two men struggled in a death
-embrace, while the girl and her brother stood wild-eyed with fright,
-unwilling spectators to the fierce duel. Phil gave a gasp of relief
-as he stood beside the girl. The two combatants uttered no sound save
-their sharp gasps for breath while they struggled for supremacy. Phil
-saw with wonder that the men were both natives and then for the first
-time realized that they were alone; no soldier was within a hundred
-yards of them. Behind them the soldiers were relentlessly, stubbornly
-herding the natives into a mass of flashing, frenzied humanity at the
-top of the hill.
-
-“It is Colonel Martinez,” the girl gasped seizing Phil’s arm. “Oh, save
-him, señor, he will be murdered.” Phil saw the other native, by an
-effort almost superhuman, free his right arm, and in it a bright blade
-flashed in the dim light. The girl’s appealing face looked into his for
-an instant, and the next moment the lad had thrown himself between the
-two men; seizing the hand with the knife he bent it slowly backward,
-finally wrenching it from its firm grasp. O’Neil was beside him. The
-sailor caught the two natives as if they had been fighting dogs and
-held them for a second in his powerful arms clear of the ground.
-Espinosa fell limply as the sailor released his hold, and lay breathing
-heavily, too exhausted for speech. Colonel Martinez quickly regained
-his revolver, and was immediately the man of action. He gazed boldly
-at the Americans, his revolver held menacingly, and the while edging
-slowly away from his captors. Phil turned his eyes to the figure on
-the ground and the angry glare he received disconcerted him; the next
-second as he looked about him he saw that Colonel Martinez had gone;
-from the gloom of the jungle he heard the rustle of brush and caught a
-glimpse of misty forms. He raised his rifle half-way and then lowered
-it. In his heart he rejoiced that he had not taken him prisoner.
-
-In the next second Espinosa leaped toward him. Phil was stunned by a
-stinging blow; but before it could be repeated O’Neil interposed and
-Espinosa had measured his length on the ground.
-
-“Where did Colonel Martinez go?” Phil asked quietly.
-
-“I didn’t see,” O’Neil answered, his face as solemn as that of a judge.
-
-Phil smiled and put out his hand. The two men exchanged clasps. “I
-believe he would have done as much for us,” Phil said.
-
-Before the sun had risen above the sea to the eastward, the fight was
-over. But few of the enemy had escaped. Asking no quarter, fighting to
-the last man, they had died as they had lived. Two hundred rifles were
-the spoils of the fight.
-
-Captain Blynn and the midshipmen were seated after their victory on the
-bloody battle-field, while the lads gave a hurried account of their
-capture.
-
-Suddenly from the grass a horribly disfigured face confronted them.
-It was Espinosa. His cunning gave him counsel that he must control his
-ungovernable temper. He could gain nothing by accusing these Americans
-of wilfully aiding Martinez in his escape. “I am sorry to inform you,
-señor captain, that Colonel Martinez escaped. These gentlemen can tell
-you the details. I was about to kill him. They doubtless had good
-reasons for permitting him to escape.”
-
-Captain Blynn turned quickly to the midshipmen, a surprised look on his
-face at the words of his guide.
-
-“Is this true?” he asked angrily.
-
-Phil felt as he had before the court-martial that had tried him for
-disobeying orders.
-
-“I alone am to blame, captain,” the lad replied quietly, after an
-effort. “I saw these two men on the ground and separated them, seeing
-they were both natives. This man attacked me afterward, so of course he
-was knocked down.”
-
-“But it was Colonel Martinez! His capture is worth far more than all
-these men and rifles,” the captain exclaimed angrily, pointing to the
-heaps of slain being laid side by side in the narrow trench dug by the
-soldiers.
-
-“He escaped,” Phil said, his throat dry, but his eyes looking
-fearlessly into those of the enraged officer.
-
-“You will have to explain this, sir,” Captain Blynn cried hoarsely,
-cutting short any explanation. “You are under my command here. If you
-have deliberately allowed this man to escape, I shall prosecute you to
-the utmost of my power, and you know the articles of war sufficiently
-to understand the penalty for such an unauthorized act.”
-
-Phil was stunned; but his conscience had acquitted him of all guilt.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-THE “MINDINAO”
-
-
-Captain Blynn rested his tired soldiers until the cool of the evening
-and then the march was begun back to Palilo, carrying with them the
-spoils of the fight.
-
-The judge-advocate general, in spite of the complete victory, was
-not friendly to the Americans whom he had rescued from a torturing
-captivity. The escape of the Filipino leader, Colonel Martinez, was
-indeed a severe blow to his pride. Both Sydney and O’Neil, while giving
-the officer their gratitude for their deliverance, were hurt at his
-stern attitude toward Phil.
-
-“Why did you allow him to escape?” Sydney asked as they were riding
-side by side along the back trail which the soldiers had taken the
-night before.
-
-Phil looked at his friend, a hurt expression in his eyes.
-
-“He was armed,” Phil said quietly, a catch in his voice which he
-could not control, “and I knew he would not be taken alive. I couldn’t
-kill him,” he added, “before the girl’s eyes, and there seemed no
-other way. Something tells me that there is a strong blood tie between
-those two. I can’t explain, Syd,” he cried in confusion. “It may sound
-sentimental, but the look in the girl’s eyes when she realized what
-might happen made me lower the muzzle of the rifle to the ground.”
-
-Sydney was silent. He believed implicitly in Phil and if opportunity
-had offered he was sure that he would have acted the same.
-
-“But why didn’t you give Captain Blynn your reasons for allowing this
-insurgent to escape? You must see how he now views the occurrence and a
-word from you would have set matters straight.”
-
-A sudden anger came into Phil’s face. “I would have told him all, but
-you saw how he cut off my explanation and arraigned me before that
-despicable spy Espinosa. After that a mule team couldn’t drag the story
-from me. I’ll tell it in good time, but not to Captain Blynn. Syd,”
-he added confidingly, “I don’t like that fellow Espinosa’s looks. He
-reminds me of a domesticated coyote. He will bite the hands that feed
-him some day. You see if he doesn’t!”
-
-“I haven’t any use for these men who are traitors to their own
-countrymen,” O’Neil joined in as he rode up alongside of Phil, the
-trail having widened to allow three abreast. “The soldiers tell me he
-is the white-haired old boy with Captain Blynn. It was he that betrayed
-the Tagalos. How he gets his information no one seems to know. Did
-you notice,” he asked suddenly, “the expression on his face when I
-dragged him away from the insurgent colonel? He wanted that man’s life
-the worst kind, and the girl’s too, I guess. We’ve made an enemy, Mr.
-Perry,” the sailor added decidedly, “and one who won’t soon forget us.”
-
-Phil gave a mirthless laugh.
-
-“I don’t mind making that sort of an enemy,” he said, “but we shall
-have to keep our eyes open hereafter, I suppose, for Señor Espinosa.”
-
-It was broad daylight before the expedition arrived in Palilo and after
-a formal parting from the other Americans, which O’Neil described
-as “the frozen mit,” the naval men separated from the soldiers and
-took the street leading to the water-front. There in front of the
-quartermaster’s depot they saw the gunboat “Mindinao” moored snugly to
-the stone jetty.
-
-A wave of pride swept through Phil’s body as he took in the trim
-outlines of his command, one of which any lad would be proud to be
-captain.
-
-A score of curious faces peered at them from the gunboat as they drew
-rein at the gangway and dismounted.
-
-An exclamation of surprised inquiry met their ears from the
-quarter-deck of the vessel and a second later Ensign Marshall was
-wringing their hands warmly.
-
-“Well, if this isn’t luck,” he cried. “I am partly packed and there’s a
-steamer for Manila this afternoon. But,” and he stopped, precipitously
-gazing with frank astonishment at their soiled and mud-stained
-uniforms, “where did you come from? I expected you by boat.”
-
-While the Chinese servants set before their hungry eyes a tempting
-breakfast, Phil and Sydney in turn gave Marshall the exciting incidents
-of their journey from Manila. O’Neil meanwhile had turned forward and
-was at once the centre of an admiring crowd of sailors; his big voice
-and hearty laugh sounded distinctly over the quiet water-front.
-
-“If you aren’t the luckiest lambs I’ve ever seen,” Marshall laughed
-admiringly; “you’re a regular lodestone, the three of you. Everything
-you touch turns to excitement. Now I’ve been here for three months,
-most of the time cooling my heels at the dock with no one to talk to
-except a lot of hayseed volunteers who haven’t even been to sea, and
-now you come along and relieve me and I suppose, ‘presto,’ there’ll be
-something doing at once.”
-
-“I hope not until we can get a little sleep,” Phil exclaimed, smiling
-at Marshall’s sincerity. “I am sleepy enough to drop off standing up.”
-
-“Well,” Marshall said as he pushed back his chair and arose from the
-table, “I’ll be finished packing in an hour, and then you can read your
-orders and take command. I don’t want to miss that boat, for she makes
-easy connections with the transport for home. Think of it, Perry, home!
-Doesn’t it sound fine?” Then, seeing that the name had not stirred
-his listeners to a great degree of enthusiasm, he exclaimed, “Well,
-if you’d been living by yourself for nearly a year and hadn’t seen
-anything but these natives, home would sound good to you, too.”
-
-The lads were soon asleep in steamer chairs under the quarter-deck
-awning, while Marshall busied himself with his packing. The Chinese
-servants moved about noiselessly and with deft hands quickly filled the
-two open trunks. Finally Marshall remade his toilet and appeared spick
-and span in a fresh and spotless white uniform.
-
-Refreshed by even this short nap the midshipmen opened their trunks,
-which had been carried over nearly sixty miles of rough country on the
-shoulders of stalwart native carriers, and in an incredibly short time
-appeared on deck as fresh in appearance as if they had both stepped
-from the proverbial band-box.
-
-A shrill whistle sounded on the gunboat followed by the call, “Lay aft,
-everybody.”
-
-The men filed aft on the miniature quarter-deck, lining themselves
-obediently on each side, and there waited.
-
-A smile stole irrepressibly to Phil’s face. Here on board this tiny
-ship, scarcely a hundred feet long and of a little over one hundred
-tons displacement, the far-reaching navy regulations were being carried
-out with as much form and punctiliousness as they would be on the
-biggest battle-ship.
-
-In a graceful speech Marshall bade farewell to his small crew and then
-he unfolded the paper in his hand signed by no less a personage than
-the admiral commanding the Asiatic fleet.
-
-“You are, upon the reporting of your relief, Midshipman Philip Perry,
-U. S. Navy, detached from the command of the U. S. S. ‘Mindinao’ and
-will proceed immediately to Manila, reporting your arrival, for passage
-to your home, to the senior officer present.”
-
-As soon as Marshall’s voice died away, Phil began to read his
-own orders, which he had kept safely pinned to the inside of his
-breast-pocket during the last few exciting days.
-
-“You are hereby detached from the U. S. S. ‘Phœnix’ and will proceed
-to Palilo, Island of Kapay, Philippine Islands, and upon your arrival
-assume command of the U. S. S. ‘Mindinao’ as the relief of Ensign
-Charles Marshall, U. S. Navy.”
-
-For a moment there was complete silence, broken in an instant by a
-hoarse voice.
-
-“Three cheers for Captain Marshall.”
-
-From twenty-five strong chests the cheers were given, while the happy
-man honored blushed with pleasurable pride and manly tears welled to
-his eyes. And then Phil’s turn came to blush and look confused, and as
-he said afterward, foolish, when the same loud voice proposed, “Three
-cheers for Captain Perry.”
-
-Immediately the cheering was over the boatswain’s mate’s pipe sounded
-shrilly and the men, touching their caps respectfully, returned to
-their quarters forward.
-
-The lads saw Marshall sail away on a small island steamer similar to
-the one on which they had commenced their journey four days before and
-then returned to sit upon the quarter-deck of their gunboat and enjoy
-the intense gratification of being their own masters on their own ship.
-
-“Think of it, Syd. If I want to get under way all I have to do is to
-tell the machinist to get up steam and off we go. It’s like having
-your own yacht,” Phil exclaimed contentedly, leaning back luxuriantly
-in his chair and cocking his feet up comfortably on the rail. “Let me
-see,” he added banteringly, “I am the captain; you are the executive
-officer, navigator, ordnance officer, all the watch officers and the
-chief engineer. Don’t you feel heavy with all those titles?”
-
-Sydney smiled happily. “Well, if the ‘old man’ doesn’t expect too much
-of a poor midshipman, I’ll do my best to uphold the dignity of them
-all,” he replied.
-
-After they had settled themselves in their new homes and had inspected
-every foot of the clean, trim little craft, admired the powerful
-battery of six long three-pounder guns, with auxiliaries of two
-one-pounders and a much sinned-against Colt gun, they started over the
-gangway bent upon paying their respects to the general commanding the
-troops in the military district of Kapay.
-
-It was with a decided feeling of uneasiness that Phil sent his card by
-the orderly to the general. He knew that Captain Blynn had before this
-given his superior officer a full account of his expedition and he felt
-sure that the escape of Martinez with his consequent blame had not
-been forgotten in the telling. However, his high spirits could not be
-easily dampened by even these sinister thoughts. His greatest ambition
-had been achieved. Was he not the commander of an American man-of-war?
-He was not even under the command of that awe-inspiring figure he could
-see dimly at the desk, on whose shoulders the direction of an army
-rested.
-
-In spite of this feeling of independence the lad’s pulse beat faster as
-the orderly beckoned him to enter the general’s office.
-
-A short, sharp-featured officer, whose hair and beard were as white as
-his spotless clothes, arose from his chair and gave a welcoming hand to
-the visitors in turn, inviting them in silence to be seated.
-
-Phil fidgeted restlessly in his chair, while the general paced slowly
-toward the open window and back again to his desk. Phil was on the
-point of speaking several times, but each time he waited, seeing in the
-army man’s face that he was about to speak.
-
-“Captain Blynn has made his report,” came in metallic tones from the
-old campaigner, “and I am deeply distressed to hear that you, Captain
-Perry, deliberately allowed a prisoner to escape; one whom above
-all I wished to lay my hands on. Blynn is for asking the admiral to
-court-martial you at once; but I am sure you must have some good reason
-for your action.”
-
-He ended and glanced questioningly at the abashed Phil.
-
-“My reason was,” the lad blurted out, his feelings much hurt at the
-severe arraignment, “that in order to capture Colonel Martinez, I would
-have had to kill him in cold blood. I couldn’t bring myself to do it
-for he had behaved handsomely toward us while we were his prisoners.”
-
-“But,” the general retorted, “Señor Espinosa would have saved you the
-trouble if you had not interfered.”
-
-Phil’s wrath blazed forth.
-
-“How did I know that the man who was about to murder Martinez was a
-traitor to his own people? I saw the two natives on the ground, one
-with a knife upraised to bury it in the body of a man lying helplessly
-beneath him, and then when I had separated them with the help of a
-sailor, I saw that Martinez was armed, and I knew by a glance at his
-face that he could not be taken alive.” The lad stopped suddenly,
-the girl’s face coming suddenly before his eye. Did the general know
-of her? He remembered that her presence at the scene had not been
-mentioned. Had Espinosa failed to discover her presence? If not, why
-had he failed to mention her in his report to Captain Blynn?
-
-General Wilson’s parchment-like face betrayed a suspicion of a smile
-while he listened patiently to the midshipman’s impetuous defense of
-his own actions.
-
-“Captain Perry,” he said slowly, “after you have been fighting these
-natives longer your sensibilities will become more blunted. The excuse
-of allowing an enemy to escape simply because you did not wish to kill
-him would be laughed at by those who have been through these six months
-of fighting. But,” he added, “I respect the delicacy of the situation
-and shall tell Captain Blynn that I approve of your actions.”
-
-Phil’s gratitude was fully expressed in the look he gave the officer as
-he murmured his thanks.
-
-“I do not wish you to believe,” the general added hastily, “that I
-approve of useless bloodshed, but in a warfare such as has been forced
-upon us the higher instincts of generosity to a fallen foe have but
-small place. It is an eye for an eye with us now.”
-
-As the general finished speaking the adjutant-general, Major Marble,
-entered and greeted the newcomers warmly. Both the lads had known him
-in their Annapolis days.
-
-“Major Marble will give you the situation,” the general said as the
-midshipmen shook his hand in parting. “I suppose you are ready to get
-under way on summons.”
-
-Phil answered promptly in the affirmative.
-
-The major took the lads to his own comfortable quarters, facing the
-Plaza, and then told them briefly of the perplexing conditions under
-which the general was struggling.
-
-“The insurgents will only fight,” the major told them earnestly, “when
-they can surprise us, and with these untrained volunteers that has been
-very frequent of late.”
-
-The midshipmen told him how the American troops had marched
-unsuspectingly past Colonel Martinez’s party the day before Captain
-Blynn attacked them.
-
-Major Marble shook his head sadly.
-
-“Colonel Bane is not a soldier and never will be. He has blundered into
-more traps than any officer in the island.”
-
-A heavy footfall sounded on the stairs. Major Marble stopped talking
-suddenly, and walked quickly to the door as Captain Blynn’s stalwart
-figure emerged from the stairway. “Come here, Blynn,” he called.
-
-The judge-advocate general approached; upon his face was a good-natured
-smile which changed suddenly to an ugly frown as he caught sight of
-his brother officer’s guests. He would have turned sullenly away,
-but Major Marble put out a restraining hand. The lads had risen to
-their feet. Phil felt his own face suffuse with blood as he caught
-the glint of annoyance in Captain Blynn’s eyes. The midshipman turned
-his back quietly and looked out the window. A moment later he heard
-the captain’s heavy tread in the hall and a door slam loudly. When he
-turned Major Marble’s face was pale and his blue eyes flashed angrily.
-
-“Blynn’s a boor, sometimes,” he hastened to apologize. “I’ve heard
-the story. He’s so absorbed in his work that any one who thwarts him
-arouses his dislike. He cannot see the human side. He’s a veritable
-bull in a china shop. He and Espinosa are doing splendid service. All
-of our success so far has been through their secret service work.
-You’ll be friends after you’ve been here a while. Martinez’s escape
-hurts his pride just now. Martinez is something like the man with the
-iron mask. He comes from Luzon, but no one knows who he is. We have
-wired Manila and they answer that they know of no insurgent officer
-of that name. Yet he’s here, and from all accounts has been expected.
-Most of his party were destroyed by Blynn, but about seventy-five
-are believed to have escaped, and Espinosa says that his followers
-are landing every day in the neighborhood of Dumaguete. I think the
-general’s plan is to have you cruise off there in hopes of intercepting
-some of their war parties.”
-
-Phil had composed his ruffled feelings and listened eagerly while Major
-Marble was talking. His heart sank within him as there flashed through
-his mind thoughts as to whom Martinez might be. Maybe no less a
-personage than Aguinaldo himself, or General Rios, had been within his
-grasp. Small wonder that Captain Blynn was put out at his escape. Yet
-he could not have done otherwise with the girl’s beseeching, pleading
-eyes upon him.
-
-After leaving Major Marble’s quarters the lads took a turn around
-the small Spanish town, loitering before the many shops and gazing
-admiringly up at the great churches, gray with age. They finally hired
-a carramata, the native cab, and drove through the city and out on the
-military road, begun by the Spaniards years before but, as was the
-custom of the country, never finished. As they drove into the Plaza
-on their return they came face to face with Señor Espinosa, riding a
-blooded horse which was prancing and pawing the earth, and making vain
-attempts to unseat its rider. Espinosa drew rein and bowed pointedly
-and courteously to the Americans.
-
-“Señores,” he called eagerly, “may I have a word with you?”
-
-Phil ordered his cochero to stop, while Espinosa dismounted, throwing
-his reins to a small native gamin near by. The native advanced to the
-carriage hat in hand and with as much ceremony as if he were about to
-speak to some exalted personage.
-
-“I am extremely mortified at my actions of yesterday,” he exclaimed in
-his fluent and grandiloquent Spanish. “I have just seen the general. I
-abjectly apologize for my rudeness. May I count upon the friendship of
-the señores?” he asked in a suave, appealing voice.
-
-Phil flinched unconsciously. He felt as if some reptile was drawing him
-toward him against his will. Espinosa’s eyes were mild and his smile
-was urbane; yet he felt that treachery was hidden behind this mask of
-friendliness. Espinosa read the struggle in the lad’s eyes and for an
-instant the mildness died in his own and a savage gleam took its place,
-but Phil’s gaze had wandered, and this vision of the true man was lost.
-
-“I don’t bear you any ill will for that,” Phil replied, his voice
-unconsciously accenting the last word. “I suppose you felt you had been
-cheated of your victory over Colonel Martinez.” Then the lad stopped
-suddenly, a question trembling on his lips. Why should he not ask
-it? Wherein was the harm? “Who was the girl with him?” Phil suddenly
-questioned.
-
-Espinosa’s face paled and in his eyes fear crept. “The girl,” he
-gasped, “was there a girl?”
-
-Phil nodded. “Yes, and her small brother; they came on the steamer with
-us.”
-
-“And escaped with Martinez,” Espinosa exclaimed excitedly. “I didn’t
-see her; it was too dark. While I was struggling I thought I heard a
-woman’s scream, but afterward I saw only Martinez.”
-
-Phil saw the native was unduly agitated. What did it mean? How and why
-had the presence of this woman so greatly excited him?
-
-As the midshipmen drove toward their ship this question was still in
-Phil’s thoughts.
-
-“Is Espinosa playing a double game?” he asked Sydney suddenly. “Does he
-fear detection by his own people? Does he believe that Martinez did not
-recognize him and that his identity as a traitor is safe?”
-
-Sydney shook his head over the mystery.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-THE GUNBOAT COÖPERATES
-
-
-As the two midshipmen stepped over the gangway of the “Mindinao” a
-figure arose from a seat on the quarter-deck and hurried eagerly toward
-them.
-
-“I’ve been waiting an hour for you,” Major Marble exclaimed excitedly.
-“The general wants you to start as soon as possible for Binalbagan.
-Baker’s men have had a fight; we got some news, and then the wire was
-cut; our signal corps men have already gone out to find the break.
-Tillotson and fifty men will be on board inside of an hour.”
-
-The midshipmen’s eyes opened wide with excitement.
-
-“We’re getting up steam, sir,” O’Neil volunteered. “I thought something
-was in the wind when I seen the major come aboard, so I asked him and
-he told me what we was to do.”
-
-“Good for you,” Phil exclaimed, throwing an appreciative glance at the
-trusty boatswain’s mate.
-
-“Baker is in the field and a sergeant and twenty men are holding the
-post,” Major Marble continued, “but if the natives are in great force
-such a handful cannot last long.”
-
-An hour later, Lieutenant Tillotson, a thin, blonde-haired youngster,
-marched his khaki-clad men on board and joined the little group of
-officers about the table on the quarter-deck.
-
-Phil gave the young soldier a look of close scrutiny as he unbuckled
-the revolver from about his slim waist and laid it on the hatch top.
-There was nothing soldierly in the newcomer’s appearance, and Phil
-unconsciously gave a sigh of disappointment. On the officer’s collar
-between the crossed rifles was a single numeral.
-
-“And a regular, too,” he thought.
-
-“Good luck,” Major Marble cried as he passed over the gangway on to the
-dock while the gunboat heaved up its anchor from the muddy bottom of
-the river and steamed swiftly for the outer harbor.
-
-Phil studied carefully the chart in his miniature wheel house forward.
-“Ninety miles,” he mused as he stepped off the distance to Binalbagan.
-“At this speed we’ll be in by daylight.”
-
-The three sat long over their dinner on the cool quarter-deck, while
-the gunboat sped rapidly along the coast of Kapay. Forward, the
-soldiers and sailors fraternized, speculating upon the morrow’s work.
-
-The naval men’s faces were keenly excited. The long-looked-for fun had
-commenced. They were almost willing to hope that Captain Baker’s men
-were having a stiff time of it, so that the guns of their boat could
-have a chance to speak their disapproval to the insurgents. Lieutenant
-Tillotson sat coolly contemplating his coffee cup. To him these
-expeditions meant but one thing: discomfort.
-
-“What’s the chance for a fight?” Sydney asked the army man.
-
-Tillotson shook his head. “None,” he replied, “unless we can catch them
-by surprise. This gunboat would scare off an army of insurgents. They
-don’t like them.”
-
-“But we shall surprise them,” Phil cried enthusiastically. “We’ll get
-there before daylight, hit the enemy from behind and crumple him up. I
-dare say, though, the fight will be finished before we arrive.”
-
-Tillotson shook his head. He was non-committal. “News travels fast in
-this country, and it’s only twenty-five miles by road to Binalbagan,”
-he said.
-
-“Have you been there?” Phil asked, all interest.
-
-“No,” Tillotson replied carelessly.
-
-“What is your plan?” Phil inquired quickly.
-
-Tillotson eyed the lad, his blue eyes wide with astonishment, while a
-superior smile curved the corners of his mouth.
-
-“Plan?” he asked. “Why, just to land, that’s all; isn’t that enough?”
-
-“Yes, but,” Phil urged, “it’ll be dark, and if fighting is going on,
-we may get between the two fires. I got myself in that fix once, and I
-know how it feels.”
-
-Tillotson’s eyes opened wider. He took a closer look at this young
-midshipman.
-
-“What does he know of being under fire?” he thought. Tillotson was a
-first lieutenant; he had served in Cuba and in the Philippines, but
-his active duty until his assignment to the regiment whose number he
-now wore on his collar had been only at a desk at headquarters.
-
-“What service have you seen?” he inquired of Phil in a patronizing
-voice. “Were you in the battle of Santiago, or Manila Bay, perhaps?”
-
-“No--not those,” Phil answered quickly, awe in his voice; “only a few
-skirmishes, that’s all,” he added sheepishly, “in South America and in
-China.”
-
-“Have we then had trouble in those places recently?” Tillotson inquired
-in mild surprise, and in a voice calculated to annoy his listeners.
-
-“Not very lately,” Phil answered; “the South American trouble was
-over a year ago and in China about six months ago. They were only
-small rumpuses. I dare say you didn’t hear about them.” Phil’s pride
-was touched, for he knew that many papers had given full and even
-exaggerated accounts of both fights, and his name and Sydney’s had been
-glowingly mentioned.
-
-“I suppose I must have been out in the field at the time,” Tillotson
-explained indifferently, “so I didn’t see the papers.”
-
-“Hadn’t we best make up a plan of just how we’re going to do this
-thing?” Phil urged, returning to his point and being guided by his
-training at the Naval Academy, which had taught him to be methodical in
-all things.
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson regarded the lad coldly. “You can plan for
-yourself,” he replied. “I’ve been fighting these insurgents for some
-months and my men know my plans by heart: they comprise just one word:
-‘Forward.’”
-
-After the lieutenant had gone to his cot and was sound asleep, the
-midshipmen adjourned to the brightly lighted chart house to discuss the
-situation.
-
-“This rank business is what is hurting the army and navy too,” Phil
-exclaimed testily. “Just because a man has one more stripe on his
-sleeve he thinks he knows more than every one below him, and considers
-a suggestion from a subordinate unpardonable insubordination, almost
-akin to mutiny. Well, Mr. Tillotson can keep his own plan, but, Syd, I
-am going to work out our end of it.” While Phil spoke he drew the chart
-toward him and glanced carefully at the land in the neighborhood of
-Binalbagan.
-
-“Do you see that marsh behind the town?” he exclaimed suddenly to
-Sydney whose eyes were upon the chart. “That’s probably mangrove, and
-they can’t get through that, so if they’re attacking, it’ll be from
-the side. If Tillotson lands his men to the northward and we take a
-position to the southward we ought to make a big haul. I told O’Neil to
-have the Colt gun ready and if it comes out as I hope it will, we’ll
-land it there,” pointing to a spot on the chart showing a low hill to
-the left of the town.
-
-Sydney agreed heartily with Phil’s plans, and berated soundly the
-attitude of the army man.
-
-“I suppose,” Phil said in apology for him as they parted, one to turn
-in, the other to keep watch until midnight, “that he’s had so much
-fighting he’s grown careless.”
-
-At midnight Phil was awakened, and relieved Sydney on the bridge, while
-the latter went below to get a few hours’ sleep before he would be
-needed in the work to be accomplished. Phil gazed through the darkness
-ahead of the gunboat; the dim outline of the land along which they
-were traveling could be seen on the port hand. The coast was bald and
-he knew he could without danger run as close as he desired to its
-precipitous cliffs. The more he thought of the scornful carelessness
-of the young lieutenant the angrier he became. What right had he to
-consider such an expedition one to require no plans? What if he landed
-in an ambush?
-
-“He should consider the lives of his men,” he exclaimed hotly.
-
-The midshipman already knew that a large part of the garrison were
-not at Binalbagan, having gone on an expedition to the north coast; a
-sergeant and twenty men had remained to guard the men’s barracks and
-supplies, to say nothing of the natives who had professed friendship to
-the Americans and lived close under their protection. These poor souls,
-Phil knew, were between two fires; if the soldiers were defeated they
-would be killed by their enraged countrymen, while if their countrymen
-claimed and received aid from them they would at once be put in prison
-by the Americans, and yet if they refused to subscribe to the cruel
-demands of the insurgents their lives would pay for their rashness as
-soon as they wandered outside of their village.
-
-He paced restlessly the silent bridge. His men he could see sleeping
-under the awning just below him. The man at the wheel, his eyes on the
-compass, and the lookout on the forecastle were alone awake and alert.
-The hours dragged by. A faint blush of dawn was visible on the eastern
-horizon when Phil through his powerful night-glass could recognize the
-chief landmark near the town of Binalbagan, a deep notch in the rugged
-coast hills through which the river in the season of rains flowed to
-the sea. It was as yet too dark to discover the town, and Phil knew
-that the hull of the gunboat could not be seen from shore until the
-sun had almost risen above the horizon. The last point of land was
-rounded, and the gunboat’s bow was directed toward the locality where
-he knew the town was even then in the throes of an attack from a savage
-enemy. His heart rose in his throat as his mind dwelt upon the gruesome
-possibilities if the handful of soldiers had been overpowered by their
-numerous foe. It was almost with a sigh of relief that, as the gunboat
-approached nearer the shore, he indistinctly recognized the faint
-flashes of flame from rifle fire. At least the soldiers, or some of
-them, were still alive.
-
-All hands had been called, and on the deck of the “Mindinao” there was
-a scene of great activity. Boats were cast loose and supplied with the
-accessories of war. A grim Colt gun was mounted on its tripod ready to
-be carried ashore to hurl its five hundred shots a minute at the foe.
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson, after a rapid inspection of his men, approached
-the two midshipmen on the bridge. Phil had slowed the gunboat. With
-a leadsman in the chains, calling out the depth of water, he was
-now steering directly for the small, serpent-like flashes showing
-distinctly against the dark background of the hills.
-
-“It looks like a big fight,” Phil exclaimed excitedly as the lieutenant
-reached his side.
-
-“These people make a lot of noise,” the latter replied nervously. “I
-am not afraid of their rifles; the bolo is their weapon. By Jove!” he
-exclaimed, after taking another long look at the scene. “It is a big
-fight. I’d no idea they had so many rifles on the island. My fifty men
-won’t be a drop in the bucket.” He turned upon Phil, alarm in his eyes.
-“I shan’t land under that fire. Our men are doubtless intrenched in the
-convent and can hold out till daylight, then when it gets light enough
-to see, you can easily drive the insurgents off with your guns.”
-
-Phil gazed at the army man in undisguised surprise. What did he mean?
-Was this the same Tillotson whose only order was “forward”? Here they
-were, undiscovered, with fifty soldiers, a Colt gun and a gunboat. It
-was a chance a landing party seldom had to deal its enemy a severe blow.
-
-“There must be five hundred riflemen surrounding the town,” Tillotson
-continued, with more assurance, believing from Phil’s silence that he
-had agreed with his plan of attack. “It would be foolhardy to risk my
-men against such odds.”
-
-“He does think of his men, then,” Phil thought contemptuously.
-
-The gunboat had now stopped and lay motionless on the quiet sea.
-Without orders four boats fully manned with ready sailormen were
-noiselessly lowered from the davits. Stalwart arms lifted the Colt gun
-and placed it in the bow of a cutter. Phil gave a last careful search
-through his glass at the shore line, scarce a thousand yards away.
-He could see the shadowy form of the big white cathedral from which
-tongues of flame darted incessantly. To the right the long, low convent
-building was silent. The soldiers had seized the church and inside its
-shelter they were making their last stand. Phil was assured that they
-would be safe until their ammunition was exhausted, and his experience
-had taught him that soldiers in such straits, unless there was an
-officer to control them, would use up their last cartridge before
-thinking of the dire consequences. To husband ammunition was not their
-concern. Even as the lad gazed the enemy’s flashes appeared closer to
-the cathedral. They were closing in; a final rush might land these
-savages under the very walls of the church. His hand shook violently
-and almost a sob escaped him as a bright flame suddenly appeared on the
-convent roof.
-
-“They have set the convent on fire,” Phil exclaimed in an awed whisper.
-Then he turned fiercely on the army man.
-
-“What are your plans now?” he asked almost roughly.
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson drew himself up stiffly.
-
-“At sunrise all will be clear,” he angrily insisted. “It would be worse
-than murder to land now; as you said last night,” he added, seemingly
-grasping at a straw, “we would be between two fires.”
-
-Phil gave him an impatient glance. “Come on, Syd!” he exclaimed
-eagerly, leading the way down from the bridge.
-
-O’Neil had his four boats ready at the gangway; two for the soldiers
-and the others for the men of the gunboat who could be spared from the
-guns.
-
-The lads gripped each other’s hand in silence as Phil stepped on the
-gangway ladder leading to the boat. The soldiers by one accord had
-crowded aft, their rifles in hand and cartridge belts bulging with
-extra ammunition. Some had even filled the inside of their blue flannel
-shirt with more precious cartridges.
-
-“Aren’t we going, sir?” the sergeant asked, gazing through the darkness
-for his lieutenant.
-
-Phil shook his head. He was too angry to speak. Then suddenly without
-command the soldiers filed, at first hesitatingly, casting anxious
-glances behind them, into the awaiting boats.
-
-“Syd,” Phil said in a low, tense voice, “you know the plan. Keep those
-cordite shells away from our own men. Get as close in as you can; don’t
-hesitate to run her ashore if necessary. If I am not mistaken we’ve got
-these natives in the closest box they’ve ever been in.”
-
-The four boats waited in silence at the gangway. Phil had taken his
-place with O’Neil in the boat carrying the Colt gun.
-
-“Tell Lieutenant Tillotson we’re ready,” Phil said in his natural voice
-to Sydney on the gangway.
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson strolled aft slowly, his eyes on the streak of
-dawn ever increasing in the eastern sky.
-
-“Come on, Tillotson,” Phil said harshly; “we’ve wasted too much time
-already.”
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson stopped on the gangway and glared angrily at the
-composed midshipman below him.
-
-“I’d like to know,” he sneered, “what business a midshipman has to give
-orders to his superior officer.”
-
-“I’ll give you one more chance, Tillotson,” Phil said in a stern, tense
-whisper; he did not wish the men to hear. He could see even in the dim
-light the surprised, incredulous look on the faces of his sailors.
-“Will you please get aboard?”
-
-The lieutenant remained motionless, a dark scowl on his face.
-
-“Shove off,” Phil ordered harshly.
-
-The boats cleared the gangway. The sailors dipped their oar blades,
-ready to follow the leading boat in which was Phil and the trusty Colt.
-
-“Come back here,” the lieutenant cried, seeing he had gone too far. But
-Phil’s jaw was set and he turned to him a deaf ear.
-
-“It’s his own fault,” Phil confided to O’Neil at his side. “I didn’t
-order his men in the boats; they got in without orders, as any decent
-men would do. What is it, O’Neil, just pure cold feet?” he asked
-suddenly.
-
-“Partly that, sir,” O’Neil answered, “but Lieutenant Tillotson is not a
-coward; he’s just overcautious and a bit of a braggart. He didn’t like
-attacking in the dark.”
-
-The four boats pulled with oars muffled in toward the dim shore. Phil
-steered his boat for a point behind the long fringe of flashes, where
-the insurgent firing line was established, creeping ever closer to
-the handful entrenched behind walls that would soon be too hot to
-hold them. He had abandoned his first plan and now was landing all of
-his mixed command to the left of the town. If he could land without
-discovery, the first the enemy would know of his presence would be the
-horrifying, crackling report of the machine gun.
-
-“There, steer for that,” Phil breathed as a mound-like hill took shape
-out of the darkness.
-
-With eyes straining and faculties alert for the first premonition of
-danger, Phil directed his boat forward. The gunboat had been swallowed
-up in the night astern. The shore grew more distinct. The church now
-stood out prominently, silhouetted against the background of flames
-from the burning convent. Even as he gazed the gun fire from the church
-seemed to slacken and against the bright glow he could see indistinctly
-natives swarming toward the burning building. Their number seemed
-myriad; surely those could not be all riflemen. Then he turned cold as
-he suddenly grasped the sinister meaning--they were bolo-men. For each
-rifleman, at least four natives armed with bolos are assigned. They are
-the guardians of the precious rifle. To obtain an insurgent gun, five
-men must be slain. These men, armed with weapons in the use of which
-every native is proficient, were advancing to rush upon the trapped
-men when the heat of the fire and the smoke had driven them from the
-shelter of the church’s protecting walls.
-
-So intent had Phil been that the boat, before he realized it, had
-grounded on the sandy beach and the men had jumped overboard into the
-shallow water. Once on the beach, he superintended the securing of the
-boats and then led the way toward the point he had selected for the
-first position to be occupied. The enemy were only a few hundred yards
-away, but so intent were they on the accomplishment of their cruel
-purposes, that the shadowy forms of the men from the sea, stealing
-quietly through the short grass and against a background of darkness,
-were not discovered.
-
-Phil’s quick eyes suddenly discovered some one approaching from a
-direction away from the enemy. He gripped his revolver firmly, not
-knowing how many more men might be behind the figure discovered. As the
-Americans approached the newcomer, a native suddenly raised his hand
-and called loudly:
-
-“Amigo, hua carta.”[2]
-
-A blow from O’Neil’s revolver butt was the answer, while Phil grasped
-the letter which had been held in the stricken man’s hand, placing it
-carefully in his breast-pocket. Then a warning cry rang out, followed
-by a rifle-shot, the hot blast of which almost burned Phil’s cheek,
-while a wiry form struck boldly right and left with his keen blade in
-the very midst of the startled Americans.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-THE PRIVILEGES OF RANK
-
-
-“There was two of ’em, captain,” the infantry sergeant exclaimed, in
-that purely official calm voice for which the army non-commissioned
-officers are noted even under the most trying and hazardous
-circumstances, while he pushed away the body from beneath his feet,
-after making sure the native was not shamming. “They was messengers,
-telling the gugus of the coming of the gunboat, I reckon.”
-
-The small band of soldiers and sailors moved cautiously through the
-rank grass and sparse cocoanut palms. The enemy before the town had
-been too much occupied to discover the disturbance in their rear.
-
-Phil saw that the fire had grown apace and now the conflagration
-threatened the entire town, but the greatest danger was to the church,
-for the dawn breeze was carrying the hot, stifling smoke and flame
-high on the church walls. It would be but a matter of minutes before
-the church itself would be on fire. The sun was slowly approaching the
-horizon; Phil saw the broad white band of light stretching across the
-eastern sky. Out on the water to the right of the town the lofty spars
-and smoke-stack of the “Mindinao” were indistinctly visible; Sydney was
-ready to begin his allotted work when the day had broken so that he
-could recognize friend from foe.
-
-“If that fellow Tillotson hadn’t funked,” the midshipman whispered
-fiercely, his teeth set firmly, “and we could have had his men to the
-right of the town, we could have flayed ’em alive. Now they’ll all
-escape past the gunboat--unless we let the gunboat open the ball and
-drive them all this way.--I’ll do it,” he cried determinedly.
-
-They had now reached the grassy-topped mound, the Colt gun placed in
-battery, and the first string of cartridges fed into its steel maw.
-
-“Sergeant,” Phil commanded tersely, “deploy your men to the right and
-left, and take shelter. Don’t fire without orders.”
-
-The sergeant saluted and gave a quick, sharp command. The soldiers
-melted from sight. This was a new experience for them. Six months in
-the islands and the only real fights they had seen were included in
-a few shots at the disappearing brown men after they had fired their
-volley from ambush, killing and wounding several of their comrades. Now
-here were over five hundred yelling natives worked up to the wildest
-pitch of savage triumph before their eyes, within range of their trusty
-guns, and as yet no orders to fire.
-
-“Stop your grumbling,” O’Neil overheard the sergeant tell one of his
-soldiers in language more forceful than polite. “This is something
-that your thick skulls can’t savvy. It’s naval strategy. Wait till
-the ball opens and every mother’s son of you can prove his claim to a
-sharpshooter’s medal.”
-
-When all was ready, Phil could only wait patiently for the sun to give
-Sydney enough light for his gunners to see to shoot, but meanwhile
-he saw with ever-increasing impatience that the enemy was gradually
-closing in about the church and convent. If the dawn were too long
-coming! If the terrible, irresistible rush came before Sydney had
-opened fire, then their attack would have failed, for the loss of
-twenty American soldiers could not be repaid by the death or capture
-of the whole insurgent army. It seemed to the awaiting midshipman that
-hours must have passed since his men had entrenched themselves on this
-small hillock. Surely the sun had stopped in its movement around the
-earth! The flames in the town became higher and the smoke arose in
-greater volume while the crackling of burning bamboo added its sinister
-sound to the discharges of the rifles, ever drawing nearer the besieged
-garrison. With heart beating rapidly and youthful indecision stamped on
-his face, he gazed anxiously at the “Mindinao.” He breathed a sigh of
-partial relief as he saw she was close inshore and was clearly visible.
-Surely it was light enough to see, or if not yet the enemy must soon
-discover the presence of the unwelcome and much-feared visitor. When
-they fled, their retreat would be toward where he and his machine-gun
-and sixty-five American rifles were awaiting them.
-
-Moisture stood out on the youngster’s forehead in great beads and his
-tongue lay like cotton against the roof of his mouth.
-
-“I couldn’t have stood it another second,” he breathed, as a jet of
-flame shot out from the gunboat’s bow and a sharp report followed by
-thunderous reverberations awakened for the first time an unknown terror
-in the hearts of the savage attackers, and brought courage and joy to
-the hopeless men inside the stifling walls of the church.
-
-The little gunboat belched flame from her three-pounders and the eager
-and delighted watchers on the mound of earth, clustered about the Colt
-gun, gazed with admiration and awe as the high explosive shells tore
-great gaps in the earth, scattering the demoralized natives in all
-directions. The avenue of escape to the right was closed; the enemy
-dared not approach nearer that death-dealing war-ship, and with one
-accord, an uncontrolled, terrified mob of human beings, without method
-or leaders, they turned and retreated directly toward the mound on
-which Phil and his men were impatiently awaiting them.
-
-O’Neil had taken his place at the Colt gun. Seated in the bicycle
-saddle, he squinted carefully down the massive rifle barrel, while
-the seething mass of brown came ever closer. When the insurgents had
-arrived at a distance of two hundred yards, Phil gave the order “Open
-fire,” in a voice scarcely recognizable as his own, it trembled so with
-excitement.
-
-Bang--bang--bang, faster than one could count, resembling the
-explosions in the cylinders of a high power touring car, only
-infinitely louder and more sonorous, the Colt gun hurled a solid leaden
-stream of bullets into the charging mass.
-
-As coolly as if he were merely steering a boat, O’Neil played the
-leaden hose on the startled enemy. They went down like chaff before the
-reaper; while from behind urging them onward, the cordite shells of the
-gunboat, which had followed them, burst with terrific havoc.
-
-Throwing down their rifles--it did not enter their heads to ask for
-the quarter which the Americans would have been only too willing to
-give--they turned inland directly toward the burning town.
-
-“Cease firing,” Phil cried out in alarm, as he saw suddenly appear,
-almost in the path of the routed natives, the small band of men who
-had come so near death at their hands. Rifles in hand, the relieved
-soldiers advanced toward the now terrified insurgents and poured a
-deadly fire into their already mortally stricken ranks.
-
-“Come on,” yelled Phil, leading the way on a run, followed by his men.
-“We can bag them all in that swamp.” But the lad did not realize what
-fear can do for a native Filipino. The Colt gun on the left where
-O’Neil had advanced it on the run, and the rifles of the threescore
-jubilant soldiers lent wings to their enemy’s feet as those finding
-themselves miraculously spared from instant death plunged into that
-impenetrable mangrove thicket. Volley after volley was fired in the
-direction in which they had disappeared, and the crash of the bullets
-could be distinctly heard, but no white man could have followed where
-they fled.
-
-The sun was now above the horizon and the light of day showed a
-gruesome sight to Phil’s eyes. Many hundreds of natives lay dead or in
-their death agonies on the sandy soil. The doctor from the garrison
-and his assistants attempted to help the sufferers, but after one
-hospital man had been maimed for life by a wounded native to whom he
-was administering, there could be little more to do. Graves were at
-once dug in the little cemetery back of the church and there they were
-placed one on top of the other in long rows and then the earth was
-thrown on top and covered with rock to keep out the hungry mongrel
-dogs, more savage even than their masters.
-
-The fight had hardly terminated before a small boat came quickly ashore
-from the gunboat. Phil’s good spirits left him as he saw Lieutenant
-Tillotson come swaggering up to the group of soldiers and sailors.
-Sergeant Sweeney, who had been in command of the small garrison,
-had been excitedly giving Phil the details of the attack, when the
-lieutenant’s flushed, angry face brought him to a sudden stop.
-
-“Well, sergeant,” he cried in an insolent harsh voice, “make your
-report to me; I am in command here; this man has no standing.”
-
-Phil was so stunned at the words that he didn’t understand or at least
-realize its meaning.
-
-Then his righteous anger and loathing welled into his throat.
-
-[Illustration: “_I AM IN COMMAND HERE!_”]
-
-“How dare you talk of me that way before your men?” he cried, his face
-pale as death, and his strong fists clinched.
-
-“Well, who are you, anyway?” Tillotson exclaimed swaggeringly. “A
-midshipman!--ashore you have no status, so from now on please mind your
-own business.”
-
-“Come on, sir,” O’Neil whispered, grasping firmly but respectfully
-Phil’s arm. The sailor felt the lad’s muscles standing out like
-whip-cords. He foresaw that something was about to happen. “Don’t spoil
-all our fun, sir. If you hit him, which he richly deserves, you’ll lose
-your ship, and where will Mr. Monroe and Jack O’Neil be then?”
-
-In spite of his anger and mortification the remark of his favorite
-brought a faint smile to Phil’s face.
-
-“I guess you’re right, Jack,” he replied, his voice shaking with
-emotion, calling him unconsciously by the name which he always used in
-his thoughts, and allowed himself to be led away.
-
-The midshipman called his men together and walked quietly toward the
-beach, while Lieutenant Tillotson took entire charge of gathering up
-the spoils.
-
-“The lieutenant’s compliments, sir,” spoke an orderly at Phil’s side as
-he was about to step into his boat to go to the “Mindinao,” where at
-least he did have some status. “And he says, he orders you to send your
-men to report to him to put things in order.”
-
-Phil turned on the messenger fiercely, and then in time remembered the
-soldier was but the innocent bearer of this insolent command.
-
-“Come on, O’Neil,” the lad said with a tone of humiliation in his
-voice, leading the way back toward the burning town. “I suppose I must
-pocket my pride. I am only a midshipman, after all, and on shore here I
-am under his orders.”
-
-After Sydney had anchored the gunboat he hailed a boat from the shore
-and soon stood by Phil’s side. The fire was quite beyond their control
-and inside of a few hours a great part of the nipa town was in ashes.
-By almost superhuman efforts most of the supplies and ammunition of the
-garrison were rescued, and piled in the little plaza in front of the
-church, where tents were pitched and all preparations made to receive
-the soldiers of Captain Baker when they returned from their expedition
-to the northward. In interrupted and fragmentary sentences Phil told
-Sydney of the insults offered him by the army man. Sydney’s eyes blazed
-in anger.
-
-“The dastardly coward,” he exclaimed after the story had been unfurled
-before him. “While you were risking your life, he was sitting on the
-quarter-deck apparently glad to be in a place of safety, and now he
-comes and wants to reap all the reward. I don’t see how he has the face
-to appear before his men.”
-
-“He’s not a regular, anyway,” Phil exclaimed in a relieved voice.
-“O’Neil says the sergeant told him he was some rich politician’s son,
-a black sheep, appointed in a regular regiment. That explains him
-somewhat.”
-
-“He’s a yellow dog, that’s what he is,” Sydney exploded, “and I’d like
-to tell him so to his face, and I will, the first chance I get.”
-
-“No, you won’t, Syd,” Phil said firmly; “remember ashore here we’re
-under his orders. Don’t give him an opportunity to make it unpleasant.
-It’s bad enough as it stands.
-
-“There’s where we can be of service,” he suddenly exclaimed as his eye
-followed the trailing end of a wire. “The telegraph instruments were
-saved and are over there in the grass; we’ll connect up and see if we
-can get Palilo.”
-
-After a half hour’s work with the help of the single signal corps
-man, the instrument had been remounted inside of a tent and the lads
-watched eagerly as the operator endeavored to call up headquarters. The
-instrument clicked rhythmically for a fraction of a minute and as it
-ceased the receiving relay clicked loudly in return.
-
-“The line’s O. K., sir,” the soldier said as his hand rested on the
-sending key, and he looked up for orders. “Shall I tell Palilo that
-we’re all right?”
-
-Phil was about to answer when he suddenly remembered the stinging words
-of the lieutenant. Pocketing his pride once more he shook his head.
-“Report to the lieutenant that the line is through,” he said as the two
-lads turned away.
-
-A few moments afterward, while they stood outside the tent they heard
-the clicks of the sending key. Each listened intently; not with any
-idea of eavesdropping but because on board ship it had been a custom
-formed in their Annapolis days to read all signals. In this way they
-both had perfected themselves in all forms of signaling and could read
-in all codes.
-
- “_To Adjutant-General, Palilo_:
-
- “I attacked insurgents besieging garrison at daylight. Placing the
- gunboat on one flank, I sent guard with Colt gun on the other. Attack
- was a perfect success. We have captured nearly two hundred rifles. We
- have no casualties. Baker still away.
-
- “TILLOTSON.”
-
-The midshipmen read the message, their eyes opening wide with wonder as
-the busy little instrument proceeded.
-
-“Well, of all the nerve!” Phil exclaimed as the signature was reached.
-“I attacked, I placed the gunboat, I sent guard. But where was he?--he
-doesn’t say, does he!”
-
-At noontime the midshipmen found themselves unwilling guests at
-Lieutenant Tillotson’s table for the midday meal. Phil had asked
-permission to withdraw his men on board ship but the lieutenant had
-curtly refused.
-
-Napkins were a luxury not supplied, and after finishing his dinner,
-consisting of wholesome army rations, Phil drew out of his pocket his
-handkerchief to use in place of the missing square of linen. The letter
-taken from the dead native fell at his feet. The excitement and worry
-of the last few hours had driven the knowledge of its presence from his
-mind.
-
-Tillotson’s keen eye was upon the letter and he stretched out his hand
-for it in stony silence. Phil gave it up instantly. The lieutenant
-broke the seal and ran his eyes quickly over its contents. His face
-showed keen interest as he read; then he put the letter carefully
-into his own pocket. The midshipmen regarded him with interest, half
-expecting to hear the purport of its contents; but were disappointed,
-for in a few minutes he arose and left them without a word.
-
-“The rest of the garrison are returning, captain,” O’Neil announced,
-joining the midshipmen after his dinner with the soldiers. “You can see
-their dust down the beach.”
-
-The lads watched with ill-concealed delight, much to Tillotson’s
-discomfiture, the arrival of Captain Baker and his eighty dust-covered
-soldiers. As they swung into the Plaza, apparently for the first time,
-they realized that something extraordinary had happened, for they
-quickened their pace and Captain Baker, unable to control his anxiety
-further, shouted eagerly to ask what had happened.
-
-Tillotson, assurance in his every motion, walked out to meet him.
-
-Phil could not refrain from comparing these two figures--one that of
-Captain Baker, alert, muscular, tanned by the sun, his uniform dirty
-and stained by travel, with grime on his soldierly countenance, while
-the other, slender, his clothes neat and of a dandified cut, seemed
-more in place in a drawing-room than in the jungles of the Philippines.
-
-“I saw the gunboat when we struck the beach below there,” Captain Baker
-exclaimed, his anxiety relieved after Tillotson had assured him all was
-safe, and he advanced hand outstretched, a hearty smile of greeting on
-his strong face. “Is this the new captain of the ‘Mindinao’? I am glad
-to meet you both,” he said as he shook the hands of the midshipmen in
-turn. “I suppose we are once more indebted to the navy.”
-
-Tillotson frowned. “I have fifty men with me,” he exclaimed
-protestingly. “Of course the gunboat was useful in bringing us here and
-shelling the beach.”
-
-“What’s become of all the town natives?” Captain Baker asked suddenly.
-
-“They all left town yesterday morning,” the sergeant replied. “That’s
-how we knew that all was not going just right.”
-
-“The cowardly beggars!” Captain Baker exclaimed. “You’d have thought we
-were their best friends. Well, I suppose they’ve got to look out for
-themselves. Have you buried all the bodies?” he asked suddenly.
-
-“Yes, sir,” Tillotson replied, “but your sergeant has the names of all
-those he recognized; apparently there were some of the town people in
-the attack.”
-
-Captain Baker nodded his head, a sorrowful expression on his face. “Who
-can we trust among these people?” he said in a low voice as he scanned
-the list handed him. “Even my own servant against us. Pedro might have
-stuck a knife in me any night he wished.”
-
-“A telegram, sir,” the captain’s orderly announced handing him a sheet
-of paper.
-
-“Send gunboat ‘Palilo.’ If desirable retain Tillotson and men.”
-
-Captain Baker read the message aloud, then his soldier eye gazed
-intently at the lieutenant. The inspection from the expression on the
-captain’s face had not been reassuring; however, in a second he turned
-a smiling face to Phil.
-
-“Captain Perry, I am sorry I am not to have the pleasure longer;
-however, I am deeply grateful to you and the navy for saving my men.
-Tillotson, you can return; I’ll keep your men.”
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson’s face, which had become sorely troubled as the
-telegram had been read, suddenly cleared. Phil felt that he would
-have died if a soldier of Captain Baker’s standing and reputation
-had even hinted at his uselessness, as he had at this hard-skinned,
-self-satisfied lieutenant.
-
-After a night’s run the “Mindinao” was again tied up to the dock at
-Palilo. On the trip down the lads had left their unpleasant passenger
-severely alone, while he had spent his evening writing, filling sheet
-after sheet of paper with closely spaced lines.
-
-“Official report of a spectator,” Sydney whispered loud enough
-purposely for Tillotson to hear. The latter looked up and scowled.
-
-After breakfast the next morning Phil reported at the general’s office.
-Major Marble received him with a grave face.
-
-“For the land’s sake, Perry! What have you done to Tillotson? He
-denounces you in scathing terms in his official report to the general;
-accuses you of weakening his authority before his men; humiliating him
-on your own ship; deliberately shoving off from the ship without him
-because he did not approve of the entire plan which you devised without
-his concurrence, and lastly reports you for insubordination when under
-his orders ashore and treating your superior officer with contempt. In
-fact,” Major Marble ended, “he has started at the top and gone to the
-bottom of all the military offenses.”
-
-Phil gasped in astonishment. Major Marble stood gazing compassionately
-at his young friend, apparently hoping to hear him clear up the
-mystery. But Phil was silent. He must have time to think.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX
-
-THE KATIPUNAN SOCIETY
-
-
-After Phil had reached his ship he scarcely remembered how he had
-behaved to his anxious and sympathetic friend, Major Marble. The boy’s
-mind was dazed. He had not believed that Tillotson would dare make
-charges against him, but now that they had been made, how should he
-act? The mere words of each charge were only too true but Phil felt
-that he had had strong and sufficient reasons for acting as he did. But
-now he must refute these charges or else go before a court-martial.
-But how could he refute them? There was but one way and that was to go
-to General Wilson and tell his story, which would be corroborated by
-Sydney. It would be tantamount to telling the general that one of his
-officers was an arrant coward and unfit to be trusted with hazardous
-expeditions. And even then the charges would still hold. They were true
-in substance, every one of them. As commanding officer of a gunboat
-Phil was within his rights when he laid his plans as to where the
-attack of the gunboat should be and the locality to land his own men;
-but he could only advise the army man from his nautical experience as
-to where the best place would be to land the soldiers in order that
-their coöperation might be harmonious. Lieutenant Tillotson was free to
-accept his suggestions or refuse them as he saw fit. So long as they
-were both afloat the army officer could give no orders to him, nor
-could Phil give orders to his superior in rank. To the anxious lad it
-was certainly a perplexing situation. His conscience was quite clear
-upon the soundness of the plan he had proposed, and he felt that in
-carrying it out they had struck a severe blow at the insurrection and
-had saved the beleaguered garrison. The lieutenant’s action might in
-feeble minds be excused through the plea of caution, but no strong man
-would hesitate to say that it was a case where caution should not have
-been considered.
-
-Sydney was beside himself with indignation when he learned of the
-spiteful charges of the lieutenant and was for seeking him out and
-bestowing personal vengeance, but Phil dissuaded him from any such rash
-act.
-
-“I should have ordered his men out of the boats,” Phil said bitterly,
-“when I saw Tillotson was not coming. We might have won without them,
-although they were a great comfort, and if the Colt gun had gone back
-on us they would have been a necessity.”
-
-“What will you do?” Sydney asked, exasperated at the apparent
-indecision of his friend. “Tell the straight story to the general and
-he’ll make it hot for that dandified gentleman soldier.”
-
-“The worst of it is,” Phil replied gravely, “Tillotson is the son of
-an influential man in the Philippine government, and if he takes our
-part the general will incur the father’s displeasure, for a father will
-never believe wrong of a son. A general has been suspended for less,
-and that would ruin his army career. I think our best plan is to try to
-compromise with Tillotson, and if he won’t listen to reason then ask
-the general to send us to another part of the island.”
-
-Major Marble, as much as he disliked the task, was in duty bound
-to hand this report to the general through his judge-advocate
-general. Captain Blynn believed he was a fair man and was proud of
-his reputation of being scrupulously honest, yet when he read this
-arraignment of the young midshipman, a smile, almost of pleasure,
-passed over his face. Here was a case in which he took the greatest
-delight. The captain instinctively disliked Tillotson. He saw that he
-did not have the making of a soldier, and this expedition had been one
-of the few with which he had been entrusted. On another occasion his
-command had suffered severely from an ambush of bolo-men, and there had
-been vague rumors that Tillotson had not behaved as it was traditional
-a ----th Infantry officer should, but there had been nothing official,
-thanks doubtless to his father’s influence. As Captain Blynn read he
-recognized the work of a law graduate. Each charge was described at
-length in an enclosed letter. Undoubtedly the circumstances were true.
-
-“Queer youngster, that fellow Perry,” Captain Blynn exclaimed almost in
-admiration as he finished and folded the communication preparatory to
-laying it before his chief. “He’s got grit, but I fear bad judgment.
-I could never see why he allowed that Martinez to escape. Espinosa
-says it was deliberate. Well, he must pay for his ill-judged acts. I
-don’t want any one about here who’s going to have qualms of conscience
-about killing a Filipino who won’t surrender. He handled that attack at
-Binalbagan splendidly, though,” he thought. “But I am afraid we’ve got
-to make an example of him.”
-
-As Captain Blynn approached the general’s office, he caught the sound
-of voices from within, and soon saw that the midshipman himself was
-talking earnestly with the general. Captain Blynn was not deterred;
-with him business was business and here was the officer charged with a
-grave offense.
-
-“I have a letter here, sir,” he said in his cold, official voice
-addressing his chief, “written by Lieutenant Tillotson, making very
-serious charges of misconduct against Midshipman Perry.”
-
-“Captain Perry has just told me that he had heard of these charges,”
-the general replied in an annoyed voice. “It seems to me, Perry, you
-have stirred up quite a hornet’s nest in the few days you have been in
-Kapay.”
-
-Phil blushed furiously, and his eyes flared forth his indignation at
-such an unfair remark. Especially as he could make no answer to an
-officer of such rank.
-
-The general adjusted his glasses and read from beginning to end the
-report placed on his desk by the captain; then he glanced up, a puzzled
-look on his deeply lined face.
-
-“This is a very ugly business,” he said sharply. “We have no time to
-investigate such matters. We are busy putting down this rebellion. Yet
-such conduct as charged in this report, Mr. Perry, cannot go unheeded.
-There’s but one thing to do,” he continued after a moment’s thought.
-“Wire to the admiral at Manila and request your detachment for private
-reasons.”
-
-“That would be a tacit acknowledgment that I am in the wrong,” Phil
-cried out, his voice trembling with anger at the injustice in the
-general’s words.
-
-“Read this letter,” the general said brusquely, “and if you can clear
-yourself do so before Captain Blynn and myself.”
-
-Phil took the letter and read page after page of incriminating evidence
-against him. It told of the disagreement as to the plan of landing and
-the time of landing. Then of the departure of the expedition from the
-gunboat, when the accuser claimed that Phil had deliberately shoved off
-without him, “doubtlessly jealous of being outranked,” the report read.
-Then of his insubordination ashore after the attack when he, Tillotson,
-had taken charge of the work of clearing up the battle-field. Of the
-withdrawal of the sailors and their refusal to help until an imperative
-order had been sent the midshipman not to go to the gunboat, but to
-return and give aid to the soldiers.
-
-Phil’s heart thumped as he read. The report was untrue in so far as
-the imputations on his reasons were concerned, but the incidents were
-only too true, and except by bringing a charge of cowardice and calling
-soldiers and sailors to corroborate him, he could not deny the report.
-Tillotson’s report stated further that both midshipmen had during the
-return trip acted toward him in a manner which lessened the respect of
-the sailors for him. That one of them had made remarks derogatory to
-his character as a soldier.
-
-Phil handed the report back, his eyes swimming. His anger was rife
-within him and he dared not speak.
-
-“This is a case for a Court of Inquiry,” Captain Blynn said to the
-general, “but I cannot see how an army court can decide on the case of
-a naval officer. Mr. Perry apparently cannot deny these charges, so
-if he is disinclined to wire the admiral, I suggest that you send a
-message asking to have him relieved.”
-
-The general nodded his head in the affirmative and Captain Blynn
-withdrew to prepare the fatal telegram.
-
-“I am sorry, Mr. Perry,” the general said, his face softening. “I have
-heard of your fight, and it was a masterpiece. I believe you have the
-stuff in you; but insubordination cannot be condoned. You must learn to
-obey and be respectful to officers higher in rank.”
-
-“Why couldn’t he tell the general just how everything had happened?” he
-thought as he listened to the kindly voice, “not to ask that he might
-retain his ship but simply to clear his name of this cloud.”
-
-Captain Blynn appeared, telegram in hand, which he laid before the
-general for his signature.
-
-“Before I send this,” the latter said turning to Phil, “see Lieutenant
-Tillotson yourself, and if he is willing to withdraw this report I
-shall forget the incident.”
-
-Phil left the office, knowing that it was but a respite. He had passed
-Tillotson on the street when on the way to the general’s office and had
-saluted and spoken, but his greeting had been ignored.
-
-It was dark when Phil left the headquarters building and walked toward
-the docks. As he passed slowly through a narrow street, the forbidding
-windowless walls towering over him with here and there a dark alleyway,
-where an assassin might lurk, he instinctively felt for the handle of
-his navy revolver lying in its holster slung to his left hip. At the
-end of the street near the river and but a few paces from the gunboat
-he saw a calesa drawn up, its curtains drawn closely, just beyond the
-glare of a street lamp, and he was surprised to see a hand wave to him
-from the gloom inside.
-
-Stepping cautiously to the side of the awaiting vehicle, he heard his
-name called in a familiar woman’s voice. It was the unknown girl of the
-“Negros.”
-
-“Señor Perry, may I speak to you?” she inquired excitedly in Spanish.
-
-Phil took her outstretched hand eagerly, forgetting for the moment his
-own trouble.
-
-“What is it, señorita?” he asked eagerly.
-
-“Come to-night to the northeast corner of the Plaza, at nine o’clock;
-bring some of your men with you. Maria Rodriguez will show her
-gratitude to the brave American officers.” He would have detained her,
-to learn more, but her sharp command to the alert driver had come
-before he could recover from the startling summons and the next moment
-the calesa was racing madly up the street.
-
-Full of his news, he boarded the gunboat and confided to Sydney the
-girl’s message.
-
-“Maria Rodriguez,” Sydney exclaimed. “She’s the daughter of Juan
-Rodriguez, the wealthiest Filipino in Kapay. I wonder what’s up? Her
-father, you know, refuses to join the insurgents, and yet will not aid
-the Americans, and the general will not molest him. He lives on his
-estates just beyond the city on the river.”
-
-O’Neil was summoned and told to make up a party of five good men to
-accompany them and then the midshipmen sat down to dinner; but neither
-had an appetite for food.
-
-Phil told Sydney of the outcome of his visit to the general and the
-latter was cast down with gloom.
-
-“I shan’t stay without you,” he asserted. “Can’t something be done? Is
-there no way to make this man Tillotson back down?”
-
-Phil shook his head. “I shan’t try. I’ll just take my medicine. It’s
-bitter, but every one who was there knows that he was in the wrong.”
-
-Nine o’clock saw the small party at the northeast corner of the Plaza.
-The city seemed deserted. There was no one on the streets. Suddenly
-the clanking of a sword was heard and the sailors slunk quietly out of
-sight into the shadow of a near-by doorway.
-
-“It’s Lieutenant Tillotson,” Phil whispered, “inspecting sentries; he’s
-officer of the guard to-night.”
-
-After the officer had passed, the party waited anxiously for several
-minutes and then a native appeared walking slowly toward them from a
-cross street. He stopped fifty yards away and beckoned; then turned
-quickly and walked away.
-
-Phil and Sydney leading, they followed the vanishing figure ahead of
-them. He guided them through street after street, leading farther and
-farther away from the occupied part of the city. Suddenly the native
-stopped, beckoned with his hand, and entered a doorway of a pretentious
-Filipino dwelling.
-
-“Your men must wait here, señor; it is the señorita’s order,” the
-native told the lads. “The officers are to come with me.” He raised his
-finger to his lips to caution silence. “If we are discovered it will
-mean death, señor.”
-
-“What’s the game, sir?” O’Neil asked eagerly, not having heard the
-whispered words of the native.
-
-“You’re to stay here out of sight,” Phil explained quietly. “If we need
-help I’ll fire my revolver.”
-
-With a parting caution the midshipmen stealthily followed their guide
-up the street, hugging the dark shadow of the houses, and entered the
-wide archway of a large native building. Inside was total darkness, and
-it needed all their confidence in the girl who had invited them to come
-to still their awakening suspicions.
-
-The guide gave a low whistle and the slight sound caused their hearts
-to beat faster amid the profound silence within.
-
-“Señores, you have come,” a woman’s musical voice dispelled their
-fears. “Please step this way; I am sorry there can be no light.”
-
-Phil quietly led the way in the direction of the voice, and his eyes
-soon discerned the figure of the girl, a darker object among the
-surrounding gloom. He felt a warm, confiding hand in his, and allowed
-himself to be led deeper into the blackness of the building.
-
-The midshipmen followed blindly; their eyes, unaccustomed to the
-darkness, could see nothing. They knew from an occasional contact
-with a wall that they were in a narrow passage and from the damp odor
-they knew it must be some depth below the ground. Several times their
-heavily shod feet slipped on the muddy floor, and occasionally they
-could hear the tinkly drip of water. The passageway led gradually
-downward, the dampness increasing.
-
-Finally the girl stopped and the sound of the heavy breathing of the
-four people filled the narrow limits of their surroundings.
-
-“These are underground passages, built years ago during a threatened
-uprising of the natives against the Spaniards,” Señorita Rodriguez
-whispered. “This passage leads to the secret chamber of the ‘Sociedad
-de Katipunan.’ To be present at a meeting the penalty for a non-member
-is to take the oath or suffer death. Only the direst necessity has
-brought me here to-night. I have no right to ask you, señores,” she
-said pleadingly, “to take this great risk for my sake, and if you so
-decide we can now turn back. Lopez, my father’s trusted patron, will go
-with me.”
-
-“We will go with you, señorita,” Phil answered without a second’s
-hesitation. “What are we to see?” he asked, unable to control his
-curiosity at the mystery of it all.
-
-“Come, you shall discover for yourself,” she said as she moved forward,
-her hand still in Phil’s, while Sydney held his companion by the coat
-sleeve and Lopez, as noiseless as an Apache, brought up the rear. “The
-meeting will not take place for some time, and meanwhile we shall have
-time to talk.”
-
-Silently they moved forward until presently, from the sound of their
-footfalls, Phil knew that the walls had receded and that they had
-entered a large chamber.
-
-“The stairs, señor,” Maria whispered, and the lads found themselves
-mounting earthen steps. Again their feet struck wooden boards and they
-knew that they had ascended from the passage and were in a large room
-directly over the one which they had just left.
-
-“This is the old Spanish inquisition room,” the girl said in a low
-voice, “and a fitting meeting-place for the Katipunan murderers. But
-come, they may be here any moment.”
-
-Phil admired the daring of this frail girl. She had led them into the
-very nest of these traitorous outlaws, for it now dawned upon him what
-was the true meaning of these meetings.
-
-“Do they enter the same way as we have come?” he asked anxiously,
-casting an apprehensive glance behind him.
-
-“No,” Maria answered, a smile on her face as she felt the lad’s hand
-tremble imperceptibly on her own. “We are not in the room; it is beyond
-us, as you shall see soon. We are in a covered gallery which is secret
-and known to but few even of the society. The passage through which
-we came has not been used for years, and until last night was closed
-with earth. Lopez has spent all day with some of his most trusty men
-clearing it in order that we might pass.”
-
-Phil cautiously peered about him, but his eyes could not penetrate
-the darkness. He knew that his feet were on boards, and that his hand
-rested upon a wall which was rough and dry. Then suddenly as if by a
-flash of lightning a vivid picture of his surroundings was shown him.
-
-“They are coming,” Maria whispered in a startled voice. “Lie down and
-for your life do not speak.” The next second all was again blackness.
-The lads and their companions had noiselessly thrown themselves down on
-the floor and were holding their breath in an agony of suspense. The
-cool handle of Phil’s revolver, which he had unconsciously drawn from
-its holster, brought back his confidence. At least they would not die
-without some injury to their enemy.
-
-Again came the flash of light; it flickered and seemed on the point of
-extinction, and then continued dimly. Phil recognized that this time
-the match had not gone out in the room over which their gallery looked,
-and that a candle was dimly burning. Then another and another candle
-was lighted and little by little the great room was exposed to their
-view.
-
-Figures of men could be seen clustered about a table in the far end
-of the hall, some seated in chairs, but most of them on the ground in
-native fashion, while beyond the table was a niche in which an image
-glittered. The midshipmen soon discovered that it was an exaggerated
-emblem of the Katipunan society which they had seen on insurgent flags;
-the sun within a flaming triangle, all of pure silver.
-
-A noise of feet and guarded voices came to their ears as the room
-slowly filled with men. As the light from the many candles shone upon
-their faces the anxious watchers saw that each man was masked.
-
-After an interminable interval of time all was hushed and a man arose
-from a seat near the symbol of the society and beckoned one of the
-others to approach.
-
-Phil felt the girl beside him tremble violently, and give a sharp gasp
-of pain.
-
-“Garcia,” she breathed, “my father’s trusted friend.”
-
-“Our unknown brother,” the leader said in Spanish, which Phil was to
-learn was the accepted language of the society, “has been summoned to
-join our society; his name is recorded secretly in the recording book;
-his number is one thousand and ten.” The leader then drew from his
-scabbard a sharp glistening bolo and circled it with the adroitness
-of a juggler about the head of the newly enrolled member. Gradually
-one after another of the masked natives arose, their keen-bladed bolos
-held aloft, while in single file they moved slowly with a rhythmical
-dancing step toward the silent “one thousand and ten.” As they advanced
-a weird chant broke from twoscore throats. It was not loud, but the
-volume filled the high vaulted chamber and lent an uncanny air to the
-mysterious initiation. It seemed to Phil as he watched, his eyes
-fairly bulging from their sockets, that the unfortunate man would
-surely be severed into a thousand pieces by these fierce, savage
-fanatics, but he stood silent, his arms folded across his breast, while
-his eyes gleamed in exultant excitement.
-
-Slowly the members danced by their new comrade and returned to their
-seats.
-
-Then the new member, by sign from the leader, advanced and prostrated
-himself before the emblem.
-
-“The sign of giving his life to the cause,” Maria whispered. Then she
-stiffened and a stifled sob broke from between her clenched lips as the
-voice of the speaker filled the room.
-
-“Rodriguez has refused the summons. He is no longer our friend. He has
-gone over to the despised Americans. Through him our men were attacked
-and killed at Banate, and also at Binalbagan. He holds his servants
-from joining our cause only through fear. Once he is removed they will
-all join us.”
-
-“It is all untrue!” Maria’s voice, clear, low, and distinct, sounded
-through the room, and at once the assemblage was on its feet, gazing
-distrustfully at each other. Phil’s hand had grasped the girl’s arm
-with a grip of steel, fearing that in her indignation and anger she
-would expose herself to the view of these twoscore traitors.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X
-
-IN THE SHADOW OF A SUSPICION
-
-
-Phil’s heart beat tumultuously as he laid a restraining hand on Maria’s
-arm to prevent her from rising up from the floor of the gallery. The
-instant the girl’s indignant, vibrating voice was heard an uncanny
-silence fell upon the masked men. Each looked fearfully at the other.
-Every man mistrusted his neighbor. The girl’s heavy breathing sounded
-ominously loud in the lad’s ears, and he was dumb with apprehension
-that she would sacrifice them all by a second outburst of passionate
-denial. They dared not move. There was naught to do but wait. If the
-society determined upon a search then their one chance was to make
-a dash for the passageway, and hold the angry men at bay with their
-revolvers. O’Neil and his five men were near the entrance, and Phil
-felt sure that their cause was not altogether desperate.
-
-After an interval that seemed hours the leader’s voice broke the heavy
-silence.
-
-“Who dared deny that Rodriguez has betrayed his people?” he cried.
-
-Phil’s strong fingers pressed firmly the girl’s arm and his eyes begged
-obedience.
-
-The masked men sat as if turned to stone. No sound broke the stillness.
-
-A loud knock on the door behind the speaker brought the assemblage to
-their feet in sudden fear. Phil saw that many had drawn their bolos,
-while others stood ready to extinguish the long rows of candles.
-
-A challenge was called and answered, and the next second the door was
-opened from within and a native entered. Phil beheld in admiration
-the air of grace and fearlessness while he advanced boldly toward the
-startled leader.
-
-A smothered exclamation from Maria caused the lad’s eyes to travel
-quickly to her face. She was staring, a horrible dread stamped on her
-face, while she murmured in a trembling voice: “Mi Padre!”
-
-So this was Juan Rodriguez, who had been denounced but a moment since
-by the terrible Katipunan society, come to answer in person to the
-charge!
-
-Another native followed him closely; neither were masked, and Phil
-recognized, in startled wonder, Colonel Martinez.
-
-“Fellow countrymen,” Rodriguez exclaimed in a loud, commanding voice,
-“I have obeyed your summons, but I shall not join the society. I
-shall never take sides in this war until I feel in my heart that to
-do so will better my countrymen. You who are deceiving the Americans,
-pretending that you are loyal and yet aiding your countrymen to kill
-them, doubtless believe that you are doing your country a service, but
-I know that in the end you will bring terrible suffering on our people.
-Take the field and fight openly and honorably, and you will be treated
-by your enemy as a brave antagonist, but fight with a knife, stabbing
-your enemy in the back, under the guise of friendship, and the end is
-surely the gallows tree.”
-
-A murmur of harsh voices filled the room as Rodriguez stopped speaking.
-
-All eyes were turned to this striking figure, as the light from many
-candles revealed the finely moulded face, flashing eyes and firmly
-chiseled lips and chin.
-
-As Phil watched, his eyes opened wider in dread. The leader had edged,
-during the long speech, nearer and yet nearer to Rodriguez. Martinez
-was standing silently on the other side. Phil’s anxious gaze caught
-the flash of brightly polished steel in the hands of this masked
-native, now but a few feet from his intended victim. Maria saw, but her
-voice was frozen within her. Phil gauged the distance to the would-be
-murderer, for his intention was only too evident. It was not over fifty
-paces. Surely it was possible; he had often practiced at that distance.
-His revolver was now pointing at the Katipunan leader, whose hand could
-be seen to be stealthily rising. Phil steadied one shaking hand with
-the other and pulled the trigger. The loud report of the discharge
-was deafening, and below in an instant all was the wildest confusion.
-Swiftly all lights were extinguished and the room was plunged into inky
-darkness.
-
-“Come,” Phil urged excitedly, “we must get O’Neil and save Juan
-Rodriguez.”
-
-Blindly they felt for the stairs and quickly descended; then hand in
-hand they ran along the dark, slippery tunnel. Reaching the street Phil
-gave a low whistle, which soon brought O’Neil and his men.
-
-“Did you fire a shot?” the sailor asked anxiously. “We thought we heard
-one, but it seemed a long ways off.”
-
-“Yes,” Phil replied, “but follow us; there’s work to be done; the
-señorita’s father is in danger.”
-
-Led by the native, Lopez, each sailor with his revolver drawn sped
-down the narrow street. At the corner they saw a small band of men
-approaching. Phil halted his party and waited ready to attack if they
-turned out to be enemies. The next moment Maria had thrown herself
-into her father’s arms, and was sobbing hysterically, while his native
-followers withdrew to some distance and stood on guard in respectful
-silence.
-
-Phil and Sydney wrung the hand of their former captor Martinez.
-
-“What would Captain Blynn say now?” Phil exclaimed laughingly as O’Neil
-too squeezed the colonel’s hand until the latter winced. “He’d shoot us
-for traitors sure.”
-
-Sydney smiled. “It would be rather difficult to explain the situation,”
-he replied, the drollness of the meeting suddenly striking him.
-
-“You saved my life, señor,” Rodriguez exclaimed suddenly, as Maria led
-him to the Americans. “My daughter has told me all. I do not know how
-she could have gone where she did, or how she found out that I had been
-summoned, but bringing you there has shown that often one’s greatest
-enemy lives in one’s house and eats his bread. I came this evening
-bringing with me my own men, for I know these blackguards too well to
-trust myself alone. As all were masked I recognized no one, but I have
-suspicions as to many and especially he who you probably have killed,
-for he fell limply at my feet just before the lights were extinguished.”
-
-A sudden pang of remorse came into Phil’s thoughts.
-
-“Colonel Martinez came with me as my friend and protector,” said
-Rodriguez, “and although he is an enemy within your lines I ask that he
-be allowed to withdraw in safety. You see,” he added with a smile, “we
-had no idea of meeting those who would recognize him.”
-
-Phil as the leader of the Americans gave a ready assent. He well knew
-that a strict interpretation of his duty required that he arrest
-Colonel Martinez on the spot and take him prisoner before the general,
-but intuitively he realized that to do so would hurt the American
-cause. He felt that Rodriguez had reached a crisis in his avowed
-intention of neutrality. By arresting Martinez after this appeal Phil
-might lose the government a valuable friend, now wavering between his
-loyalty to his own people and the more earnest duty of fighting against
-them to protect them from the domination of this treacherous band of
-murderers.
-
-“Good-bye, señores,” Maria cried eagerly, as her father signified his
-intention to depart. “I can never thank you enough for what you have
-done to-night. If your bullet,” she added earnestly, “has silenced
-forever that terrible leader of the Katipunan society, my father will
-be in no further danger.”
-
-“Can you pass through the lines?” Sydney asked, “or shall we vouch for
-you?”
-
-“If it is not too much trouble,” Rodriguez replied gratefully. “My
-carriage is just there, and we are then near the last patrol. The
-general has allowed me free conduct always, but this disturbance may
-have aroused suspicion, so I shall be grateful for your services.”
-
-The mixed party of sailors and natives walked briskly through the
-silent streets. The carriage drawn by two fast horses was reached, and
-Maria, her father, and Martinez entered, while Lopez mounted the box
-and drove slowly forward followed by the Americans on foot.
-
-A loud American challenge suddenly brought the horses on their haunches.
-
-“Halt! Who comes there?”
-
-“Officer,” answered Phil.
-
-“Advance one, and be recognized,” the sentry called.
-
-Phil walked slowly forward until he was within ten paces of the alert
-soldier.
-
-“Halt.”
-
-Phil stopped in his tracks.
-
-“I guess you’re a naval officer,” the soldier said in a puzzled voice.
-“You’re too young to be a brigadier-general, although you’ve got a star
-there on your shoulder-strap.”
-
-Phil smiled.
-
-“Yes, sentry, I am Captain Perry of the gunboat.”
-
-“Sure, sir, you can pass me, any time,” the soldier exclaimed gladly.
-“That was certainly great work you done in Binalbagan. All the boys is
-talking about you two officers and Jack O’Neil. I’d like to meet him;
-he must be a corker.” The sentry had grounded his rifle and now stood
-at ease talking sociably, very much at home with the young midshipman.
-
-“He is here,” Phil replied. “If I may pass my party, I’ll call him.”
-
-“Certainly, captain, anything you say goes with me,” the sentry
-returned enthusiastically.
-
-The carriage, followed by the band of a dozen natives, drove down the
-street away from the city. Phil caught a wave of a hand from the window
-as he turned and started for the gunboat and his bunk, for it was near
-midnight.
-
-O’Neil had stopped to shake hands with the admiring sentry and he soon
-overtook them.
-
-In silence they marched to the ship. So much had happened, crowded
-into such a short space of time, that the lads wanted a chance to think.
-
-The next morning while Phil and Sydney were at breakfast on the small
-quarter-deck of the “Mindinao” Captain Blynn crossed the gangway from
-the dock. He walked to where the lads had risen from their chairs
-to greet him. Refusing their offer of breakfast with an impatient
-movement of his hand he sat down in the proffered seat held for him by
-the attentive Chinese steward. Both lads saw in his grave face that
-something unpleasant had happened to account for this early morning
-visit. The army man did not keep them long in suspense, and had his say
-with his usual directness.
-
-“Lieutenant Tillotson, the officer of the guard yesterday, is missing.
-His bed shows that he did not sleep in it at all last night. I have
-investigated the case as far as I have been able, and I find that no
-one passed through the sentries except a closed carriage and a squad of
-Filipinos. This sentry says that you and Mr. Monroe vouched for them.
-Tillotson was last seen an hour before this time by a sentry at the
-bridge whom he visited. As soon as I heard of the carriage episode I
-cautioned the sentry to say nothing. I wanted to see you and clear up
-that part before I investigated further.”
-
-Phil sat speechless in his seat while the judge-advocate general
-talked on earnestly. Tillotson had disappeared! How could he have been
-forcibly carried past the numerous guards stationed at every outlet of
-the garrisoned city? He must surely still be within the town.
-
-“Do you suspect foul play?” Phil questioned. “Would the enemy have
-the daring to make way with him inside the town? Why should he alone
-be molested? And, besides, he carried his revolver, and could not be
-struck down without being able to fire a warning shot.”
-
-“One sentry,” the captain replied quickly, “reported having heard
-a shot from the part of town near the sea, but he said it was very
-indistinct, and after all he was not sure.”
-
-Phil and Sydney exchanged glances and the captain looked up sharply, a
-faint suspicion entering his thoughts.
-
-“What I’d like to know,” he added coldly, “is who was in that closed
-carriage; the sentry says there were four people.”
-
-Phil flushed as he read the insinuation in the captain’s voice.
-
-“Juan Rodriguez, his daughter and a Filipino overseer by the name
-of Lopez,” he answered promptly, but he lowered his eyes before the
-direct, searching gaze of the judge-advocate general. The presence of
-Colonel Martinez need not be told. It would but complicate the case and
-not aid in the search for Tillotson; but the army officer knew human
-nature too accurately, and Phil was too poor a hand at telling less
-than the truth.
-
-“There was besides a Filipino with the driver?” he questioned pointedly.
-
-Phil shook his head in the negative.
-
-“Was this Lopez within the carriage with Señor Rodriguez and his
-daughter?” the captain asked curtly, and Phil felt as if he were on the
-witness stand having the whole truth dragged from him. He might just as
-well make a clean breast of it. Before those piercing black eyes, he
-found that he was not good at dissembling.
-
-“Lopez was driving,” Phil said blushing furiously in mortification at
-being so easily tripped in his testimony. “The other occupant of the
-carriage was Colonel Martinez!”
-
-If a bombshell had exploded at Captain Blynn’s feet he could not have
-appeared more astounded.
-
-“And you passed this insurgent officer out of our lines?” he asked
-incredulously.
-
-Phil nodded, his throat dry and his mind stunned with a sudden fear.
-
-“This is certainly a queer proceeding!” the army man exclaimed. “I
-cannot fathom it. Do you realize what you have done? Can you not see
-that Lieutenant Tillotson’s disappearance will be laid at your door?
-But surely,” he added, “there is some explanation which you can make?
-You could hardly be so foolish as to plot against the life or even the
-liberty of a brother officer.”
-
-Phil gave a sudden exclamation of surprised indignation, and with
-flashing eyes he turned angrily on his accuser.
-
-“I didn’t see your meaning at first,” he said in a low, intense voice
-but one that carried distinctly over the ship. “How dare you to
-insinuate this to my face and on board my ship?--Captain Blynn, there’s
-the gangway!” he cried sternly, his face now deathly pale but his jaw
-set firmly.
-
-Captain Blynn rose hurriedly from his chair, his dark face swollen
-with passion; his black eyes flashed, while his strong hands clutched
-his chair nervously. He was about to speak, but Phil cut him short,
-pointing his finger toward the exit to the deck.
-
-“I hope, Captain Blynn,” he said quietly though his lips were
-trembling, “that you will see the uselessness of further talk and will
-go ashore as I have bid you.”
-
-“You confounded little whipper-snapper!” the captain exploded
-wrathfully. The stern judge-advocate was unused to such treatment; he
-had always bullied those under him and in a measure by the very force
-of his will, many of those senior to him in rank. But angry as he was
-he realized that the midshipman was quite within his rights. He was on
-board his own ship, and there he was supreme.
-
-“Captain Blynn, I hope it will not be necessary for me to have you
-escorted across the gangway,” Phil reiterated, his voice showing
-perfect control of temper. The lad glanced forward meaningly to where
-many of the crew had collected, intently listening to the heated
-colloquy between their young captain and this big, blustering army
-officer.
-
-Then a voice from the dock made both the combatants turn suddenly and
-gaze in surprise at the general, who, unobserved, had stopped abreast
-them and had been an amused spectator of the discomfiture of his
-judge-advocate.
-
-“I’ll tear up that telegram as soon as I get to the office,” he
-exclaimed chuckling gleefully; “and, Blynn, you’d better come ashore
-here before Captain Perry pitches you over the gangway.”
-
-Captain Blynn had but one great fault and that was his inability to
-consider that anything mattered outside of his beloved work. Ruthlessly
-he would trample over those in the way of success. Once he was on the
-trail of a wrong-doer, he would follow it fearlessly until the culprit
-was behind bars.
-
-Doubtless if Captain Blynn had stopped for just a moment and considered
-the young officer before him, he would not have cut him to the quick
-by an insinuation so cruel. To do the brusque captain justice, he
-had regretted his words immediately he had spoken and seen the look
-of injured innocence and anger in Phil’s face, but the masterful way
-in which Phil had turned the tables on him was too much for the army
-man’s temper and hence the invective. In his heart he did not really
-believe that Phil was guilty of plotting against Tillotson. Without
-the interruption from the dock he might even have apologized to the
-spirited young navy man, but the general’s words injected a salutary
-humor into this dramatic situation and made him see how untenable and
-cruel was the attitude he had assumed. His face softened and an apology
-of a smile struggled for place on his sun-tanned countenance. “You’re
-dead game, youngster,” he exclaimed impetuously. “I believe you’re on
-the level, only you’re a bit too reticent; anyway, here’s my hand, and
-from now on we’ll work together instead of at cross purposes.” He took
-the surprised midshipman’s hand and shook it heartily.
-
-“Come up to the office at ten o’clock,” he added as he walked toward
-the gangway, the smile having disappeared and the alert business
-expression taking its place on his face.
-
-The midshipmen watched him cross the gangway and join the general, who
-had been taking his usual morning exercise before going to his office,
-and as the two walked along apparently deep in conversation an orderly
-stopped them, handing a telegram to the general. The lads saw him open
-it and read and then pass it to Captain Blynn. Both turned as if by
-a mutual impulse and glanced toward the gunboat, then changing their
-minds apparently, they again turned and walked briskly toward the
-headquarters building.
-
-“Something in the telegram concerns us in some way,” exclaimed the
-analytical Sydney. “I wonder what it said?” But Phil’s mind was too
-much occupied in thinking of the chameleon character of his new friend
-to give more than a passing thought to the contents of the telegram.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI
-
-A TRAITOR UNMASKED
-
-
-“How dared he accuse me of knowing about Tillotson’s disappearance?”
-Phil exclaimed as he sought unsuccessfully a solution to the mystery.
-
-“I don’t believe he really suspected us,” Sydney replied deprecatingly,
-“but it must have struck him as odd to say the least that you should
-pass an insurgent officer through the guards. You didn’t tell him why
-you did it or even give him any of the circumstances. I think it was
-natural that he should act as he did.”
-
-“I didn’t realize,” Phil said half laughing, “how queer it must have
-seemed to him. Well, I’m going up and make a clean breast of it.
-
-“Have you any suspicion as to the identity of the man I shot?” Phil
-suddenly asked.
-
-“I thought at once of Espinosa,” Sydney answered, “but I’m not sure;
-he talked in a voice that was not familiar, but that may have been
-feigned. Think of it,” he exclaimed, “those masked men are all in the
-employ of our government. They have taken the oath of allegiance and
-yet they are plotting to massacre our soldiers.”
-
-“It seems queer,” Phil exclaimed in a puzzled voice, “that the meeting
-and Tillotson’s disappearance should happen the same evening. Do you
-suppose it was only a coincidence?”
-
-Sydney shook his head.
-
-“Let’s get Captain Blynn to unravel that,” he answered. “He’s not half
-as clever as some believe, not to have discovered in six months what we
-have in less than two days. But remember, we promised Señorita Maria to
-say nothing of her share in the work.”
-
-An hour later the lads had laid their startling discoveries before the
-judge-advocate.
-
-“How many of these men did you count?” he asked excitedly, after he
-had listened with rising indignation to the account of the Katipunan
-meeting and the accusation against Rodriguez.
-
-“About forty, I should say,” Phil answered.
-
-“I don’t understand,” the captain exclaimed aloud, “why Espinosa has
-not told me of the existence of this society. Of course I knew it was
-active elsewhere, but I had no idea they would dare plot against us
-within our lines.”
-
-“Have you never suspected Espinosa?” Phil asked quietly.
-
-“Yes, once,” the captain answered, after a moment’s hesitation, “but
-I found I was mistaken. He would not have led us against this fellow
-Martinez if he had been a traitor. I have the note here which I took
-from Espinosa that gives the information. It is in Visayan but I have
-translated it.” He handed the scrap of paper to Phil, who read it and
-passed it back.
-
- “Colonel Martinez and two hundred men encamp to-night at Barotoc Hill
- near Banate en route to join Diocno.”
-
-Phil pondered over the words of the message. Then he remembered the
-terrible personal attack of Espinosa against Martinez. Was this a clue
-to his betrayal? Were Martinez and Espinosa personal enemies?
-
-“No,” the captain continued assuredly. “Espinosa has aided us in every
-way. It was through him that we sent Captain Gordon to the north to
-prevent more of these deserters from Aguinaldo’s army landing. He has
-kept us well posted on the movements of our enemy.”
-
-“But still,” Phil insisted, “there have been no big fights and we’ve
-lost a number of men cut up through surprise.”
-
-“That’s due in a great measure to the country and the inexperience of
-our volunteer officers,” the captain explained readily.
-
-“Are you so sure of the honesty of Rodriguez?” he asked suddenly. “I
-have heard it insinuated that he aspires to the leadership if Diocno
-were removed.”
-
-Phil was about to cry out his assured belief that Rodriguez was
-sincere, but with the words on his lips he hesitated. He had seen
-Rodriguez but once, and to be convinced of his honesty after such a
-short acquaintance would sound ridiculous. He saw that Maria’s part
-would have to be told if Captain Blynn was to be convinced.
-
-“I have every reason to believe in his sincerity,” Phil said instead.
-“I can understand Spanish and I heard the leader denounce him as a
-traitor to the natives. Then I heard Rodriguez’s eloquent appeal to the
-men against their two-faced dealings. He surely had the courage of his
-convictions, for every hand there was against him.”
-
-“Yes, the general had him down here the other day,” the captain said,
-“and he was impressed the same way. He’s a power among the lower
-classes, although he has many enemies among the educated ones.”
-
-Captain Blynn had been holding a telegram in his hand while the above
-conversation was taking place and now he passed it over in silence for
-Phil to read.
-
- “Colonel Martinez is not the name of insurgent officer that left
- Manila about the time of sailing of steamer ‘Negros.’ Our secret
- service men are sure that he is the noted outlaw ‘Remundo.’”
-
-“So you see,” the captain said not unkindly, “you have twice allowed
-this desperado to escape.
-
-“But now,” the captain continued, “what we’ve got to do is to break up
-this secret society and find poor Tillotson if he is still alive. I can
-hardly believe that they have been able to carry him away unless it was
-by water. However, Espinosa should know of this. I will send for him to
-come here at once.”
-
-The captain rang his bell and sent the orderly who answered for the
-Filipino.
-
-The midshipmen sat silently waiting while the judge-advocate returned
-to his interrupted office work.
-
-The orderly soon returned, reporting that Señor Espinosa was not at his
-house, and that his servant reported that he had not been home since
-the evening before.
-
-The midshipmen exchanged knowing glances. Was Espinosa then the leader
-whom Phil had shot?
-
-“Come!” Captain Blynn exclaimed, starting up from his chair. He led the
-lads down to his carriage at the door and motioned them to enter. Then
-giving an address to the driver they went whirling through the narrow
-streets.
-
-After a ten minutes’ drive the carriage stopped in front of a large
-Filipino house. Without knocking the army man pushed open the door
-intruding his great bulk into the room.
-
-A half dozen natives arose from the floor, sudden fear in their faces
-as they saw the officers.
-
-“Señor Cardero,” the captain said in a quiet voice, “where has Señor
-Espinosa gone?”
-
-“I do not know,” the native replied sullenly.
-
-The captain glared fiercely at the small brown man before him; then he
-reached out a strong hand and caught the native fiercely by the neck,
-shaking him as a dog would a rat. The little man turned a sickly color
-and his teeth chattered, but the bullying American held him closely
-while his eyes flashed angrily as he questioned him. “Tell me, where is
-Señor Espinosa?”
-
-“He is hurt, señor commandante,” the native cried out finally in a
-terrified voice after he had regained his breath. “It was an accident.
-I do not now know where he is, but he is not in the city.”
-
-The midshipmen were overjoyed at this news. So Espinosa was
-the Katipunan leader and spy. Phil glanced at the surprised
-judge-advocate, a light of triumph in his eyes.
-
-“Captain Perry,” the captain ordered hurriedly, “you and Mr. Monroe
-stay here and guard these rats; I am going to have every native of
-prominence in the town arrested at once. Thanks to you, we have at last
-found the leak.”
-
-Throwing the cringing native from him, he strode out of the door, and
-the lads heard the rumble of his carriage wheels as he drove rapidly
-away.
-
-After the captain’s menacing presence had been removed the half dozen
-captive Filipinos showed signs of restlessness, and once or twice
-Phil surprised a covert glance toward a dark corner of the large
-living-room. Both lads felt the responsibility of their position. They
-knew that they were outside of the line of sentries, almost beyond the
-sound of firearms. It seemed to Phil that the captain was over-reckless
-in coming with only themselves into the haunts of a probable enemy.
-Both lads were armed, their revolvers were held ready in hand and
-their prisoners knew full well that Americans were dangerous shots.
-
-The inside of the room was but dimly lighted by a single oil wick,
-and the darkness became blacker toward that part of the house where
-no windows had been cut. Phil had heard the captain give instructions
-to his orderly as he left headquarters to have a guard follow the
-carriage. But would the guard be sent here to aid them, or would
-Captain Blynn send them elsewhere to make arrests?
-
-“Let’s get out of this trap,” Phil whispered anxiously to Sydney at his
-side, his idea being to order the men at the point of his revolver to
-pass out to the street.
-
-Suiting the action implied in his words, Phil opened the door leading
-from the living-room. He saw by the aid of the additional light from
-outside that the five men had cautiously and stealthily moved backward
-toward the wall nearest them, and were apparently supporting their
-weights upon it. Suddenly he felt a jar and read in the eyes of the
-Filipino nearest him revenge battling with fear. Then the floor shook,
-and grasping Sydney by the shoulder Phil threw himself bodily through
-the open door as the floor of the building crashed down twenty feet
-into the cellar below. The natives, he could see, were hung on the wall
-like so many old coats, while through the bamboo floor on which he
-and Sydney had just stood numberless bamboo spears bared their sharp,
-venomous points. The lad shuddered as he realized the murderous trick
-which had failed. If they had fallen with the floor, heavily weighted
-as it was with stones at the side, and resting on supports, which
-had been dislodged by a rope in the hands of one of the villains now
-hanging on the wall of the room, they would at this moment be lying
-pierced through and perhaps dying before the eyes of their cruel enemy.
-
-He raised his revolver and covered the nearest cringing native, a
-terrible anger in his eyes. In another second he would have pulled
-the trigger, but Sydney’s hand closed firmly over his wrist, forcing
-his revolver upward and the ball sped harmlessly over the terrified
-native’s head.
-
-“They are more valuable alive,” Sydney exclaimed to Phil’s angry cry
-of protest. “Come, let’s get outside before more of this hinged floor
-is loosened. We can better prevent their escape in that way.”
-
-Phil followed his companion down the bamboo stairs and into the
-street, where a crowd of curious natives had gathered on hearing the
-startling shot. The lads moved their weapons menacingly, not knowing
-or trusting the temper of the crowd which backed away cringingly from
-the Americans. A glance down the street brought a glad cry from the
-midshipmen as they saw a squad of soldiers advancing from the direction
-of headquarters. A loud voice in the Visayan tongue from the building
-they had just left was answered by many excited voices in the gathered
-crowd, and then several women advanced slowly, holding up their
-hands in sign of peace, their bodies close together as if for mutual
-protection. The lads scarcely noticed the approach of the women, so
-occupied were they in watching the building in which were imprisoned
-five of the traitors who had been biting the hand of the master
-that fed them. A swift glance over his shoulder showed Phil that
-the advancing women were scarce ten paces away from Sydney, who was
-guarding one corner of the house, while he was some thirty feet away,
-guarding the other three sides. The soldiers were not over a block away
-and hastening toward him; he could hear the rattle of their gun slings,
-and the thud of their heavy shoes on the hard road-bed. Then again as
-he cast an uneasy glance at this line of women his heart froze within
-him while his voice failed, for he had caught a fleeting glimpse of a
-savage face peering over their shoulders.
-
-“Look out for yourself,” Phil cried, directing his revolver at the line
-of women and firing blindly. In that second his disgust and wrath were
-so great at the dastardly strategy under the guise of friendship that
-he would not have felt a qualm of conscience if one of these unnatural
-women had fallen before his bullet.
-
-The women halted, sudden fear on their faces, while from between them
-dashed a half dozen savage natives armed with bolos. As they charged
-on the surprised midshipmen they cried out lustily in their guttural
-language the war-cry of the bolo-man who has received the charm of the
-Anting-Anting which to his superstitious mind makes him invulnerable
-against the Americans’ bullets. They came boldly on while Sydney jumped
-backward quickly to Phil’s side and the two lads emptied the contents
-of their revolvers into the mass of naked brown men flourishing their
-keen blades above their heads in an endeavor to close with their hated
-foe. The women had run screaming with terror back to the safety of the
-crowd, taking refuge within the densely packed houses.
-
-With their revolvers empty and but three of their half dozen assailants
-writhing in the road, the plucky midshipmen faced the onrush of the
-fanatics. Converting their revolvers into clubs, they awaited what
-seemed to them certain death. Their one hope for safety lay in running
-away from the charging bolo-men and toward the soldiers now scarce two
-hundred yards away, but turn their backs on an enemy they could not.
-
-Within ten feet of the midshipmen the fanatics suddenly stopped and a
-fear crept into their superstitious faces. The next second, to the
-lads’ astonishment, their sharp swords dropped from nerveless fingers,
-and the three natives prostrated themselves in the dust of the road.
-
-The lads gazed in startled wonder, scarcely believing their eyes.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII
-
-THE MIDSHIPMEN RECONNOITRE
-
-
-The midshipmen were so utterly astonished at the actions of their
-fanatical enemies that they could only gasp out their surprise in one
-heartfelt word of relief. Then a familiar voice at their elbow awoke
-them from their stupefied inactivity. It was in Visayan and they turned
-to gaze into the impassive face of Rodriguez.
-
-“I have ordered them to escape,” he added in Spanish, casting a quick
-glance toward the squad of soldiers. “Poor fellows, it would be a pity
-to kill them, for they are but acting under orders.”
-
-The lads were too grateful to their rescuer for saving their lives to
-make useless inquiries as to why his influence could be exerted over
-the acts of their enemy. Phil’s first thought was for the men whom the
-captain had left them to guard.
-
-“Surround this house,” he commanded, and the sergeant in charge gave a
-short command and led the way himself to the rear of the large native
-building.
-
-“It is too late, señor commandante,” Rodriguez said shaking his head;
-“they have all escaped through the rear door and are by now safely
-away.”
-
-The midshipmen ran quickly up the steps and gazed disappointedly into
-the gloom beyond. The floor still lay at the bottom of the cellar, the
-bamboo spears sticking half-way through, but the natives had gone. The
-back door stood open and to the ground was a jump of twenty feet. They
-had safely escaped while the lads were engaged defending themselves
-against the attack of the bolo-men.
-
-“I am on my way to see General Wilson,” Rodriguez announced after a
-search had failed to disclose any signs of the fugitives, “and offer my
-services.”
-
-“Do you mean that you will fight with us against the insurgents?” Phil
-asked in glad surprise.
-
-“Yes, from now on I shall aid the Americans to restore order in the
-island of Kapay,” Rodriguez replied, pleased at the cordial reception
-given him by the two midshipmen.
-
-Together the party made their way back to headquarters in search of
-Captain Blynn.
-
-“It was providential that I happened along,” Rodriguez said after they
-had passed through the sentries; “those bolo-men knew me and obeyed my
-sign. I see,” he added smilingly, “that you are already arresting the
-traitors.”
-
-“We were not very successful with Señor Cardero and his friends
-yonder,” Sydney exclaimed ruefully, “but I suppose we should be
-thankful to have gotten off so easily.”
-
-“Cardero is one of the craftiest of our outlaws,” Rodriguez returned.
-“It is a marvel to me how he could have remained unmasked so long. Of
-course,” he added, “I have known of this intrigue for some months, but
-until they deliberately plotted against my life I could not betray
-them.”
-
-“Have you discovered who is the Katipunan leader who tried to murder
-you last night?” Sydney asked excitedly.
-
-“Yes,” Rodriguez replied. “You have doubtless guessed that he was
-Espinosa. I know it now for sure. He has gone to Matiginao, where
-there is a strong fort, and is in command of all the insurgent forces
-there. The bullet only crippled him last night, and I hear he is
-rapidly recovering. General Diocno was murdered last night in his bed
-and no doubt I should have shared the same fate.”
-
-They were by this time at the headquarters building, and were glad to
-find that Captain Blynn had returned. The midshipmen informed the army
-man of their luckless adventure and stood in silence expecting to hear
-his harsh rebuke for allowing such important prisoners to escape, but
-he only grasped their hands and congratulated them upon their rare good
-fortune.
-
-“By George,” he exclaimed excitedly, “we’ve been contentedly living
-over an active volcano. It’s a marvel we haven’t all been massacred
-long ago.
-
-“Every native of any consequence in the town has departed,” he added
-sadly.
-
-“Rodriguez with you, and wishes to aid us?” he cried gladly, as Phil
-told of the intention of the wealthy native. “Well, that certainly is
-cheering news.”
-
-Rodriguez came into the office and stood with dignified bearing before
-the big judge-advocate.
-
-“So you are tired of being neutral?” the army officer said pointedly in
-Spanish. “Do you wish to occupy the position just vacated by our mutual
-friend Espinosa?”
-
-Rodriguez drew himself up proudly while the midshipmen gasped at this
-harsh arraignment.
-
-“I do not blame you, señor,” the native answered, no evidence of
-anger on his placid face. “I know that you can have but little reason
-to trust the honesty of the men of my race. But I do not desire a
-position. I am now ready to take the field with my men, heretofore
-neutral. I have three hundred rifles.”
-
-“You are ready then to take the oath of allegiance?” Captain Blynn
-asked in official tones.
-
-“Yes, señor, and keep it,” Rodriguez returned, his eyes unflinching.
-
-“Have you any news that will lead to our knowing the whereabouts of
-Lieutenant Tillotson?” Blynn asked.
-
-“Ah, I have,” the native answered eagerly. “I was about to ask you--my
-spies report a captive with Espinosa.”
-
-The Americans gave sighs of relief. At least Tillotson was alive.
-
-General Wilson received Señor Rodriguez with marked courtesy and
-appointed him on the spot a colonel in command of his own men whom he
-offered to enlist as native troops, rationing and feeding them from
-army funds, but Rodriguez declined the latter, agreeing to defray all
-expenses.
-
-The midshipmen insisted that their new ally should go down to the dock
-and inspect the gunboat, so after explaining to General Wilson that
-they would like to be absent for a few days on reconnaissance work, the
-three strolled leisurely down the street.
-
-“Where is Colonel Martinez?” Phil asked after they had arrived on board
-and the Chinese servant had brought refreshments.
-
-Rodriguez shrugged his shoulders and pointed toward the interior of the
-island.
-
-“Will he serve under Espinosa as leader?” Sydney asked incredulously.
-
-“Who knows?” Rodriguez answered evasively.
-
-The lads saw that their friend had reasons for being non-committal and
-tactfully ceased their interrogation, yet inwardly they were consumed
-with curiosity. Espinosa had attempted to kill Colonel Martinez on the
-morning of Blynn’s attack, and now would they serve amicably side by
-side against a common enemy?
-
-The hour for lunch arrived, and as Rodriguez was not leaving for
-several hours to return to his home up the river he gladly accepted the
-midshipmen’s pressing invitation to eat with them.
-
-Phil had made up his mind to explore the river, though this idea was
-unformed in his mind when he left headquarters.
-
-During the meal the midshipmen questioned their guest about Espinosa’s
-impregnable stronghold and of its approach by water.
-
-“There is a trail from my ranch to the foot of the mountain,” Rodriguez
-replied thoughtfully, “but it will be filled with traps, and will be
-dangerous if Espinosa hears an attack is to be attempted. The river
-flows through a narrow gorge at Matiginao, and from the cliffs huge
-boulders can be dropped into the river many hundred feet below.
-
-“The gunboat!” he exclaimed in amazement, after Phil had questioned
-in regard to the depth of water. “If it were possible!” Rodriguez
-glanced admiringly at the heavy cannon mounted near him. “Yes, with
-this gunboat in the river the tops of the cliffs could be swept, and
-soldiers could scale the difficult trail unopposed, and once through
-the narrows the trail leading from the stronghold could be commanded by
-the cannon to cut off the retreat of the insurgents. It is wonderful!
-But the bridge, Señor Perry,” he ended, his voice betraying his sudden
-disappointment; “it is strongly built and a gunboat cannot pass.”
-
-“If I find there’s water enough to float the ‘Mindinao,’” Phil replied
-assuredly, “the bridge will not stand in the way long.
-
-“Does your daughter know the country?” Phil asked earnestly.
-
-Rodriguez gazed a full minute at his questioner before he answered.
-
-“Every foot of it,” he added; “she was born near the stronghold. But
-what is your intention, señor? This is no work for a woman.”
-
-Phil would willingly have bitten off his tongue for having led him
-into such an embarrassing situation. He could not tell Rodriguez that
-he wanted Maria because she alone would he trust as a guide on the
-perilous mission which he had made up his mind to make.
-
-Major Marble fortunately arrived at this moment and saved the lad from
-becoming more deeply involved. He gave them the latest news.
-
-“Tillotson’s father is keeping the wires hot,” he told them. “We are
-ordered to spare nothing to recapture him, but of course we shall do
-that anyway. The general has wired back the good news the señor has
-brought, that Tillotson is believed to be a prisoner and alive.”
-
-Before the party dispersed, Phil confided to his hearers his plan to
-explore the river and his intention to start that very night.
-
-“Then you will visit me on my ranch?” Rodriguez exclaimed gladly.
-“Everything I have is at your service,” he added with the grandiloquent
-air of a Spanish gentleman.
-
-Phil nodded gratefully, realizing that unlike the Spaniard, whose form
-of address the native copied, Rodriguez made no empty offer.
-
-“I believe,” the lad continued, a spark of enthusiasm in his voice,
-“that a gunboat of the tonnage of this vessel is capable of reaching
-the insurgent stronghold.”
-
-“If you can accomplish that,” Major Marble exclaimed excitedly, “you
-and your ‘Mindinao’ will make an enviable name for yourselves, for once
-that stronghold is taken we shall have many surrenders throughout the
-island.”
-
-“Why not force the insurgents to concentrate on Matiginao,” Phil asked
-earnestly, “and attack them there?”
-
-“The general has already sent out orders,” Major Marble told them,
-smiling at the lad’s eagerness, “to attack the insurgents wherever
-they can be located and for all the troops to concentrate on Palilo,
-leaving small garrisons in the towns to guard the peaceful natives. He
-is working up a big plan to attack this stronghold with a large force,
-and will undoubtedly take the field in person. He is determined to
-rescue Tillotson, and will give Espinosa no rest until he is captured
-or killed.”
-
-The midshipmen listened in delight to this plan, which fitted in so
-well with their own ideas.
-
-The major soon departed, promising short work in destroying the bridge
-if the lads discovered the river to be navigable above the house of
-Rodriguez.
-
-O’Neil was ordered to have a boat’s crew of four men ready to leave the
-gunboat at one o’clock at night. The distance to Rodriguez’s ranch was
-somewhat over fifteen miles and the lads did not desire to be seen, so
-they would pass at night and be safely within friendly land by sunrise.
-Rodriguez left them soon after to return by land and promised a hearty
-welcome on their arrival up the river.
-
-Promptly at one o’clock the expedition started. O’Neil had provided the
-usual gear for surveyors; a compass, a lead line, and also a rifle for
-each man and a revolver for himself.
-
-Silently they shoved off and rowed with muffled oars up the river, and
-under the bridge, built substantially in the days of the Spaniards. “A
-few charges of dynamite would settle it,” Phil thought.
-
-Already O’Neil had uncoiled his lead line and was sounding in the
-channel of the river.
-
-“It’ll be a cinch, sir,” the boatswain’s mate exclaimed after several
-soundings had given him no less than four fathoms of water. “Seven feet
-is all we need and we can carry that for miles until the mountains
-commence to go up steep; then there’ll be rocks to look out for.”
-
-Mile after mile was pulled in silence except for the light dip of the
-oars and the dull, almost soundless splash of the lead as it was heaved
-a short distance forward of the boat.
-
-The midshipmen gazed with apprehension at the forbidding banks of the
-river. The rank tropical foliage would conceal an army. Riflemen might
-lie concealed and fire without the slightest fear of discovery.
-
-Gradually the river narrowed, but the depth of water did not grow less.
-
-It was just before dawn when the boat arrived at the bend behind
-which, by the description given them, would be the landing pier of the
-Rodriguez ranch.
-
-In a half hour the boat was being cared for by one of the many willing
-attendants and the sailors were escorted to the palatial residence of
-Señor Rodriguez.
-
-It was the señorita who came first to meet her old friends.
-
-“Now we are fighting together,” she exclaimed gladly, “and I would like
-to go out as a man and help.”
-
-Phil thought that nothing so far had deterred her. She had seen as much
-fighting as most men and had withstood it bravely, and he said so to
-her.
-
-“You might be valuable, señorita, to put courage in men’s hearts,”
-Sydney added smiling, “but you would not be very formidable as a
-soldier.”
-
-Maria bit her lips vexedly.
-
-“I can shoot as well as a man,” she cried half angrily, “and I can ride
-a horse and paddle a canoe. What more is needed?”
-
-“Something which is not in your makeup,” Phil answered admiringly. “You
-are not vindictive and are not cruel. But you can do us a favor, if you
-will. We want to explore the country between here and Matiginao.”
-
-Maria clapped her hands with joy.
-
-“I know every foot of the country,” she cried eagerly. “You couldn’t
-have better guides than my little brother and I. But,” she added, her
-voice becoming lower and a fear in her eyes, “my father is now an enemy
-to the ladrones and insurgents, and it is unsafe to wander away on the
-lonely trails.”
-
-Phil and Sydney exchanged glances as much as to say, “There is your
-woman’s argument. One moment she wants to fight and the next she speaks
-of danger.”
-
-Señor Rodriguez welcomed the midshipmen, and together all sat down to a
-large table where a delicious breakfast was served.
-
-Phil saw his men were provided for, as he intended leaving them behind,
-and after breakfast Maria led the party out where five finely bred
-horses were held by native grooms.
-
-Maria and Juan, who sat his pony as gracefully as if he were a part of
-the animal, led the way across the open fields surrounding the ranch
-houses. Then they plunged into a path cleaving the giant trees of the
-tropical jungle. Limbs of trees brushed their faces and great care was
-necessary to prevent themselves from being unhorsed.
-
-Phil’s idea was for the boat to wait until dark, and then row up the
-river as far as possible and return by morning, in order that the
-general could be informed of the feasibility of the plan and the work
-of destroying the bridge started. His party, meanwhile, were bent
-on following this trail toward Matiginao, to reach the ranch before
-the boat and wait for it. He realized that they were running a great
-risk, but he believed the necessity for the information was worth the
-risk run. The trail led mostly within sight of the snake-like river.
-They passed many dwellings, most of them deserted of all save hungry
-mongrels and starving pigs.
-
-“This seems to be a fine trail,” Sydney said surprisedly, as they
-walked their horses two abreast.
-
-“It leads but five miles further,” Maria replied, “and from where it
-ends, all other trails are those made by animals, and followed seldom
-by men.”
-
-At a brisk trot Maria started ahead. The jungle bent away from the
-road, leaving a high arched canopy over the heads of the travelers,
-through which the tropical sun shone with sullen impotence.
-
-“There is a small bungalow up here,” the girl announced in pleasurable
-anticipation. “We shall have our lunch there. Before the big house was
-built we lived there.”
-
-“How long has it been since you were there?” Sydney asked in sudden
-anxiety, the fear entering his mind that it might now have other
-occupants.
-
-“Not for years, señor,” the girl replied in a low voice. “It is very
-lonesome, besides there are many pulijanes[3] in the mountains.”
-
-The house soon appeared through the thick grove of cocoanut palms with
-its unkept lawn sloping gently to the river. The grass in front of the
-house was overhead high, and everything had grown wild and in luxuriant
-profusion. The house itself was in ruins.
-
-While Maria and little Juan had taken charge of the horses and tethered
-them amid a good repast of alfalfa, the two lads strolled down to the
-river.
-
-“Hello, here are some canoes!” Phil exclaimed; “and they’ve been
-tied here recently,” he added anxiously, as he saw clearly the fresh
-footprints and the grass trodden down near the landing.
-
-[Illustration: “_HELLO, HERE ARE SOME CANOES_!”]
-
-The lads’ intention had been to investigate the depth of the water in
-the river, but their startling discovery made them forget all else
-save the visible evidence that a small body of men had recently landed
-at this very spot and had taken the almost obliterated trail to the
-abandoned house. Maria and her brother might even now be prisoners
-among their enemy. The two midshipmen gazed at each other through eyes
-wide with apprehension. What was to be done?
-
-“We can’t desert the girl,” Sydney declared, gazing at the trodden
-grass. “Otherwise we might reach the horses and escape before they
-discover us.”
-
-“Come,” Phil exclaimed, “there are not many of them, and maybe,” he
-added reassuringly, “they are not all armed.”
-
-The two lads walked noiselessly toward the house along the dim trail.
-
-The building was now in plain sight. The wide porch with its profusion
-of clinging vines was deserted. The long flight of bamboo steps was
-half in ruins. To the right not a hundred yards distant their horses
-were standing, their noses deep in the rich grass.
-
-At the foot of the steps the midshipmen halted. There was a mysterious
-silence in the air about them and they imagined that from the deserted
-building unfriendly eyes were peering down upon them.
-
-Phil gave a sigh of relief as he saw Maria, leading little Juan, come
-slowly through the tall grass toward them from the neighborhood of the
-horses. He made up his mind quickly. Nothing further could be gained
-here, and the evidence that others had been on this spot very recently
-was too strong not to take the warning. He caught Sydney’s arm and
-wheeled him away from the house. The lads had not taken a half dozen
-steps before a shrill cry from Maria riveted them in their tracks. Over
-their shoulders they saw that now the porch was filled with natives who
-were pointing their rifles at them menacingly.
-
-“Come on, we might as well face them,” Phil whispered, his teeth
-tightly clenched and with his hand on his pistol.
-
-Turning, Phil led the way back to the steps, and there he halted,
-glancing inquiringly at the unfriendly guns covering him.
-
-A native, apparently an officer, dressed in a dull gray cotton uniform,
-walked slowly toward him down the rickety steps.
-
-“How dare you insult me and my friends on my own door-step?” Maria’s
-voice was high pitched in anger. “These gentlemen are my guests. By
-what right are you here?”
-
-The Filipino officer had stopped half-way on the steps in surprise,
-his revolver held in front of him. Unconsciously he dropped its muzzle
-toward the ground and regarded the girl in unfeigned admiration.
-
-“Pardon, señorita,” he said apologetically, using the Spanish of the
-higher classes of Filipinos. “You, then, are Señorita Rodriguez, and
-I ask your forgiveness for my rudeness. I thought these señores,”
-indicating the two midshipmen with a nod of his head, “were Americans
-and my enemies.”
-
-Phil’s ears were startled by a loud peal of laughter, and he gazed in
-almost horror at the girl, believing that she had become hysterical.
-But a glance at her smiling face showed that her nerves were well in
-hand. An angry flush suffused his face as it crossed his mind that this
-was a trap of her own laying. But he blamed himself instantly for even
-entertaining such a thought. What would she say? She must acknowledge
-that he and Sydney were Americans, naval officers, though they were not
-in uniform, having on khaki riding suits. Phil’s hand slowly drew out
-his revolver from its holster, while his eyes were turned now on the
-averted face of the native officer.
-
-“From what part of the island have you come?” Maria asked quickly, the
-smile of superiority still on her face and Phil saw that to the native
-the smile was disconcerting.
-
-“I am just from Matiginao,” he replied. “I came for fresh meat. To
-forage on your father’s land.”
-
-The smile died on Maria’s face, but luckily the native had withdrawn
-his eyes and was regarding closely the young men before him.
-
-Maria felt that the Filipino officer must know of her father’s enmity
-to his new leader, Espinosa. Then as the native’s eyes again traveled
-to her face the smile reappeared.
-
-“I see all white men are to you Americans. These señores are my guests.
-I vouch for them,” she told him in a confiding voice. “It was a natural
-mistake for you to make, Señor----” she stopped questioningly, and he
-supplied the name. “Salas, colonel in the Filipino army, señorita, at
-your service,” he said bowing gallantly.
-
-Maria had not guessed at the officer’s identity although she knew most
-of the important leaders, having known them as a girl at her father’s
-house before the war had begun. Now the mention of his name almost made
-her heart stop beating. This frail creature, with the face and figure
-of a boy, was feared by all who had fallen under his control. He had
-won the unenviable reputation of being the most cruel of the insurgent
-leaders, first in Luzon under Aguinaldo and then on the island of
-Kapay. He was scarcely older than Phil, and yet he held the rank of
-colonel.
-
-“Your name, señor,” she smiled, “is one well known throughout Kapay.
-In appearance you are not the ogre that you are painted.”
-
-Colonel Salas’ white, even teeth gleamed between his thin lips. He
-felt himself the master of the situation. Here was the proud daughter
-of Rodriguez complimenting him. His small soul was nourished by the
-thought that he was feared by all.
-
-“Then, señorita,” he said, “if you do not consider me an ogre, will you
-and your English friends accept the offer of a share in my frugal meal?
-It is now ready inside.”
-
-The midshipmen had watched with beating hearts this plucky girl’s brave
-fence with the subtle native and as he pronounced the word English he
-glanced at the silent lads. Phil thought he saw a gleam of joy in his
-cruel eyes.
-
-“They do not speak Spanish?” he asked, shrugging his shoulder
-expressively as much as to answer the question himself in the negative.
-It was better so; one could play the game better than two and the lads
-now knew that Maria was an adept in diplomacy, and could be depended
-upon to make a better and intelligent fight for their lives. That
-their lives were in danger was but too evident to the lads. The native
-soldiers still covered them with their rifles, and Colonel Salas had
-moved to Maria’s side as they had talked, leaving the line of fire
-quite clear. A word from him and a score of bullets would be tearing
-through their bodies. Did the officer believe that they were English?
-Had he already seen through the deception, and made up his mind to
-maneuver so as to kill them at the least risk to himself and men? Phil
-gauged the distance between himself and the insolent face of this young
-colonel and resolved that the word of command to his men to fire should
-be a dear one for the smiling colonel.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIII
-
-UNWELCOME COMPANIONS
-
-
-The lads indeed found themselves in an awkward predicament. Just the
-faintest thread really bound them to life, for they saw in the cruel
-expression in the eyes of the Filipino officer that nothing would
-delight him so much as to have these white men shot. Phil very much
-feared that in spite of his cordial words this boyish native had before
-now guessed the truth. However there was nothing to do but remain
-silent and inactive. Phil had a great desire to speak to Sydney in
-English, but he feared this dapper little Filipino might have learned
-enough of that language to understand what he might say.
-
-With his cold eye on the midshipmen the native officer gave a gruff
-command to his men behind him on the porch. Phil’s hand moved a hair’s
-breadth, and the revolver muzzle on his hip pointed squarely at the
-body of Colonel Salas, while his finger pressed ever so slightly the
-trigger. For the fraction of a second their eyes met. Then the lad saw
-with relief that the soldiers had lowered their guns and were filing
-through the door into the house. With a deft motion he allowed his
-revolver to slip noiselessly back into its holster.
-
-Colonel Salas had already turned and was leading the way up the steps,
-Maria and her brother following, and the midshipmen bringing up the
-rear.
-
-“Do you think he suspects us?” Sydney whispered.
-
-“He must,” Phil answered hurriedly. “Be careful, Syd,” he added
-anxiously. “We’ve got to fight our way out. There seems no other way.
-There are twenty of them against us two.”
-
-At the top of the steps Salas turned and looked questioningly at the
-midshipmen. Phil dared not meet his eye for fear that the little native
-would see the anxiety which he strove to hide.
-
-On the floor of the big room a cloth had been spread and a repast set
-out.
-
-With a graceful wave of his thin hands Colonel Salas made a sign for
-all to be seated and took, himself, the place beside Maria. Phil sat
-on the other side of Maria, while Sydney and little Juan were placed
-opposite.
-
-Their brisk ride had given them all an appetite, but the terrible
-predicament in which they now found themselves had quite taken away
-their relish for food. The lads did their best to appear undisturbed,
-but any one with half an eye could have seen the restlessness behind
-their forced tranquillity.
-
-It is not the Filipino custom to talk while eating, and it was not
-until his dish was emptied that Colonel Salas broke the awkward silence.
-
-“Your English friends are very fond of adventure,” he said suddenly.
-“Our camp is only a league up the river, and would be well worth a
-visit. I did not intend to return so soon, but I shall be glad to take
-you there. You can return to-day or remain until to-morrow morning.
-It is the strongest fortified camp in the islands, and has never been
-successfully attacked. You can see where three Spanish regiments were
-annihilated by having rocks rolled down upon them.”
-
-Phil’s heart beat faster. Here was the very opportunity he had wished
-for. If they could only see this camp with their own eyes; photograph
-the surroundings in their minds; test the depth of the water and the
-width of the channel, would it not be worth the fearful risk they
-would run? Then the thought of Espinosa drove the possibility of such
-a hazardous undertaking from his mind. They would then surely be
-recognized even if they had not been already, and he shuddered to think
-of the penalty. What was his astonishment when Maria agreed gladly to
-the plan.
-
-“That would be fun, wouldn’t it?” she cried in English, appealing to
-the utterly bewildered lads.
-
-“Bueno! We can ride to ‘El Salto de Diablo’ (the devil’s leap), and
-there I shall have ‘bankas’ ready to take us to the foot of the trail,”
-Salas returned delightedly as he left them to instruct his men sleeping
-on the shady porch at the back of the house.
-
-“Do you realize what you are doing?” Phil muttered excitedly. “At any
-moment he may discover who we really are. Suppose word should come
-to him from the city? We must not accept his invitation,” he ended
-hurriedly.
-
-“I fear,” Maria whispered, “that he already suspects who you are, and
-for that reason I have accepted. If I refused we are already in his
-hands, and what can we do against his twenty rifles?
-
-“We must act it out, and, if opportunity offers, escape. Above all,
-don’t show by sign or word that you suspect him and don’t show how much
-Spanish you know,” she ended fearfully, as she saw Salas approaching
-with several of his men.
-
-Phil’s heart beat like a trip-hammer at this disquieting belief of
-Maria. She was certainly keen. By what system of argument had she
-arrived at such a conclusion? To Phil Salas had appeared to believe the
-story told by the girl. Sydney and Juan had listened attentively to her
-words.
-
-In a short time the party were in motion. A horse had been captured
-from the herd of those that had run wild during the absence of their
-owner, and Salas sat it well. Phil thought he had never seen such a
-graceful horseman. The wild horse reared and plunged in its efforts to
-unseat the rider, but he could not be disturbed. The native followers
-formed about them, and the party moved slowly along the uneven road.
-
-After a half hour’s ride, Salas ordered a halt at the base of a bluff
-several hundred feet high. The midshipmen gazed with inward emotion at
-the towering cliffs ahead of them, through which ran like a torrent the
-muddy Tubig River.
-
-“From here we must go by banka,” the outlaw explained. “My men will
-go on foot, for they are accustomed to the rough trail; but for the
-señorita it would be impossible.”
-
-One of the natives approached his chief timidly, and spoke a few short
-sentences in a frightened voice.
-
-On hearing the man’s words, Salas’ face darkened in anger and he struck
-him brutally with his heavy whip. The startled native recoiled in
-terror from his incensed master.
-
-“He tells me that there is but one banka ready,” he explained
-apologetically; “the other bankas are at the foot of the trail two
-miles up the river. The ones we used this morning I left at the ranch.
-I am sorry, but as only five can go in this boat some of the party
-must walk. Who shall it be?” he asked abruptly.
-
-“There are just five of us,” Maria suggested enthusiastically. “My
-brother and I are at home with a paddle and surely the señor colonel
-has often propelled his own boat.”
-
-Salas glanced keenly at the girl’s face. He saw nothing there save
-youthful eagerness for adventure.
-
-“As you wish,” he replied carelessly. “It’s a tedious journey: two
-miles against the swift current. My men are used to it.”
-
-But Maria’s mind was set upon their going together. Phil pondered upon
-what her plan might be. The river was now narrow and the colonel’s men
-would always be within hail.
-
-“What shall we do with our horses?” Phil questioned. “Are we to return
-here?”
-
-“I shall leave some men here with them,” the Filipino leader assured
-him. “We shall either return by the way we came or else over the trail.
-
-“Vamos,” he concluded, waving his hand toward the large canoe which two
-of the natives were holding close up to the steep river bank.
-
-Maria took her place in the bow while the others distributed themselves
-evenly upon the frail low seats, grasping their paddles ready to
-balance the boat when it was cast adrift in the swift current.
-
-Salas stood undecided upon the bank; his men had gone over the trail
-leading through the almost impenetrable jungle between them and the
-high palisade upon which was the outlaw’s stronghold.
-
-“Leave the horses here,” he said finally to his two men, “and go back
-to the palm grove and bring up one of the canoes we left there this
-morning.”
-
-Phil from his seat in the stern of the banka caught a significant look
-flung to him out of the eyes of the girl who was seated in the bow, her
-head bent gracefully backward regarding the Filipino leader. In the
-rear of Maria was little Juan, his small hands grasping a paddle, much
-too large for his strength.
-
-“Give the señor your paddle, Juan,” the girl ordered, then turning
-to Salas she added persuasively, “Sit behind Juan, señor. I’m afraid
-he might fall overboard and I don’t know what my father would do if
-anything should happen to him.”
-
-The outlaw smiled and took the empty seat, taking from the boy’s
-unwilling hands the large paddle.
-
-“Bueno,” he exclaimed, while the two men released the boat, pushing it
-gently away out into the stream.
-
-Under the strong strokes of four paddles, for the midshipmen were both
-expert, having owned canoes at the Naval Academy, the native boat swept
-swiftly through the water. To avoid the strength of the current the
-canoe was steered close in to the steep bank under the protecting shade
-of the overhanging trees. Great crocodiles basking on the muddy banks
-were passed, the animals slinking away as the boat approached, their
-long tails lashing furiously in their haste. Monkeys filled the trees,
-whistling and jabbering fearlessly as the boat passed under them.
-
-While Phil exerted himself manfully at his paddle, his thoughts busily
-sought a plan to escape the enforced hospitality of Salas. A great fear
-filled his mind as he dwelt upon the horrors of imprisonment among
-these lawless men. To Sydney and him it would eventually mean death,
-and to Maria and her little brother a long and dangerous imprisonment
-and harsh treatment. But why had not Salas made them prisoners at once
-if he suspected their real identity? Phil did not guess that the outlaw
-had read defiance and action in the midshipmen’s eyes, and alert as the
-outlaw’s faculties had become to scent danger even though carefully
-concealed, he had detected the stealthy motion of Phil’s hand when he
-had been confronted by his men. Salas was not a coward, but he had
-realized instantly that if he ordered his men to open fire, unless the
-first shots killed the Americans, he himself would fall the victim of
-their vengeance. So he was biding the time when he would have them safe
-without danger to himself.
-
-The boat had now covered nearly half the distance. Phil wondered what
-he could do. The slight figure of the outlaw, seated upon the low
-thwart just in front of him, was so temptingly close and apparently
-so unconscious of any threatening danger. The native’s revolver lay
-in its holster just within reach of the lad’s hand, the flap securely
-buttoned upon its polished handle. Phil realized that when Salas
-expected treachery his first act would be to capsize the canoe. Being
-a strong swimmer the native doubtless believed he could reach the
-bank first and have at his mercy those still struggling in the water.
-To attempt to unbutton the flap of the holster and take the revolver
-without the owner’s knowledge was impossible. Phil needed both of his
-hands to wield the heavy paddle and if he stopped paddling Salas would
-at once suspect treachery. His heart rose in his throat and his pulses
-throbbed painfully as a bold plan flashed suddenly into his thoughts.
-It seemed the one chance of escape. At the rate the boat was going it
-would soon be at the foot of the trail to the stronghold where Salas’
-men would be waiting in force to escort them up the steep incline to
-the top of the mountain. A huge crocodile lay asleep about a hundred
-yards ahead and this sight had awakened the plan to action in Phil’s
-mind.
-
-“Go slowly,” he whispered loud enough to be heard by all in the boat.
-“Let’s see if we can’t get a shot at that big crocodile over there.”
-
-Salas slowly drew in his paddle, laying it across his knees, while his
-hand went back to the holster strap.
-
-“You keep paddling slowly, Syd, and the señorita can prevent us from
-capsizing when we fire,” the lad continued eagerly. His own revolver
-still rested in its holster, while his eyes were bent upon the outlaw’s
-hand fumbling with the buttoned flap. Mentally he measured the slight
-figure before him and then the frail boat in which they were seated.
-The terrible risk he was running came to him almost overpoweringly.
-Overboard in this river full of hungry crocodiles was unnerving enough
-to those who could swim, but Maria had said that her small brother
-could not, and for him death in this swift current would be assured.
-With his own paddle resting on his knees he braced his feet cautiously
-but firmly on the round of the bilge so as to put an equal pressure
-on each side. The outlaw, with his eyes on the crocodile as yet
-undisturbed in his doze, had succeeded in releasing the flap; his thumb
-and forefinger grasped lightly the revolver handle, drawing it slowly,
-thoughtfully, from its cover. Phil’s hand was partly raised, as if he
-held his revolver ready to shoot at the formidable animal. He muttered
-a silent prayer that the crocodile would not awake before his plan had
-succeeded. He felt that out of the corner of his eye the outlaw was
-watching him, but Phil’s hope was that his act would be so swift and
-unexpected that Salas would have no time to avoid it and jeopardize the
-lives of those in the boat.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIV
-
-CLEVERLY OUTWITTED
-
-
-As Salas’ hand slowly drew his revolver from its holster, Phil’s right
-hand with the speed of a mongoos seizing its prey clutched the slender
-wrist of the outlaw; the lad’s left hand had moved deftly to the slack
-of the native’s strong khaki trousers, and the next second he had
-raised the surprised Filipino from off his seat and held him for an
-instant balanced in the air.
-
-“Turn her down-stream,” the midshipman ordered in a hoarse voice, as he
-flung the struggling man into the water clear of the rocking boat.
-
-Maria by a well-timed stroke had instantly spun the canoe about, and
-all four bent desperately to their paddles. Phil saw the broad-brimmed
-sombrero of their enemy floating on the surface and a fear instantly
-filled his thoughts that Salas might not swim. The next second he was
-reassured; the head of the native covered with thick black hair could
-be plainly seen swimming toward the far shore; the menacing presence of
-the crocodile had deterred him from attempting to reach the land but
-a few strokes away. Every second the lad expected to hear a loud call
-for help from the outraged officer. Phil, over his shoulder, measured
-the distance yet to be gained by the struggling native. Why had he not
-cried out a warning to his men? Surely they were within hearing; the
-trail over which they had gone must be but a short distance from the
-river.
-
-Under the straining muscles of the midshipmen, helped by the swiftness
-of the current, the canoe sped toward the grassy slope where their
-horses were waiting. A bend in the river, and the swimmer disappeared
-from sight.
-
-“Why hasn’t he given the alarm?” Phil demanded nervously. “What does it
-mean?”
-
-“He will as soon as he reaches shore,” Maria gasped breathlessly. “The
-monkeys when they fall in the water always scream, so Salas knows
-better than to signal to all the crocodiles within hearing.”
-
-Little Juan, try as he would, could not keep up with the furious pace
-set him by his companions, and he lay quietly balancing himself in the
-boat and gazing about him with frightened eyes.
-
-The skiff was run full speed against the steep bank of the river, and
-the midshipmen clutched eagerly the loose earth until Maria and her
-brother had gained the shore. Then to their expectant ears there came a
-loud halloo! from up the river.
-
-“There’s no time to be lost,” Phil urged excitedly as he darted ahead
-to where their horses had been tied. A sickening fear took possession
-of him until he had climbed to the top of the slope.
-
-“They’re here!” he cried joyfully, as he saw the five horses grazing
-contentedly.
-
-The midshipmen lifted Maria and her brother upon the backs of their
-horses, cutting loose the hempen lariats with which they had been
-tethered.
-
-“Lead the way, señorita,” he cried hurriedly; “we must not spare
-ourselves.”
-
-For one second Phil lingered. The fifth horse, if he left it there,
-would afford the means of catching other horses to pursue them; for he
-knew that a single outlaw would not dare attempt to follow. With a few
-swift strokes of his knife he severed the bridle and then with his open
-hand struck the restless animal across the flanks. As he swung himself
-into his saddle he saw it plunge eagerly away into the dense jungle,
-happy to be again free of its domestic yoke.
-
-As the lad dashed ahead after his companions, he heard the low moaning
-note of the concha (a shell bugle), a signal of warning used by the
-ladrones of the mountains. The sound was insidious. It seemed to come
-from a long way off. Yet Phil knew the operator could not be a mile
-away. The low tones were known to travel many miles, even farther than
-the high notes of a bugle. To those whose ears had not been trained to
-listen to the warning note, the sound might be mistaken for the coo
-of a wood pigeon. The lad’s heart leaped as he foresaw that the two
-men who had gone to bring the missing canoe were between them and the
-only avenue of escape and their trained ears had already heard the
-warning sound. If they had started back in the boat when they heard
-the warning, they would remain concealed until the fugitives had drawn
-within close range and then would open fire upon them. Even though the
-persons of the party might escape the hastily aimed shots, the great
-bulk of a horse could never escape and the crippling of one animal
-would mean at the least their recapture, and probably death to all four.
-
-With the energy of despair he drove his horse forward to join those in
-the lead. Breathlessly, trembling with his terrible anxiety, he reached
-Maria’s side.
-
-“Do you know of any other road?” he gasped. “There!” he exclaimed
-hopelessly, as a low coo came from the direction of the bungalow, “they
-have answered.”
-
-“I know of a road,” the girl returned breathlessly, “but it is across
-the river, and is very narrow and uneven.”
-
-Phil gazed frantically at the swift current as it appeared
-intermittently through vistas in the trees while they sped along. Once
-across undiscovered they would be safe.
-
-“But Juan, he cannot swim; he will be afraid,” he cried hoarsely.
-
-“Never fear for him. It was necessary Colonel Salas should think so
-in order to persuade him to sit in front of you. He fell into my trap
-very obligingly,” she returned, a half smile curving the corners of her
-mouth.
-
-“The river then is our only chance,” Phil declared decidedly. “It will
-be death for us all to attempt to pass the two armed outlaws.”
-
-“These horses are all good swimmers,” Maria answered hurriedly. “Just
-hold on to the saddle and give them their heads. I know where we can
-land, so follow me. Look out for Juan,” she ended in sisterly fear.
-
-As Maria, followed by the midshipmen and Juan, forced her horse to
-enter the forbidding river, a fusillade of rifle-shots sounded from a
-point in the river some thousand yards above them, and the smack of
-bullets struck the water close to the horses’ forefeet. A new danger
-now confronted the fugitives. Those above them had discovered their
-intention to cross the river. Fortunately as yet they were beyond the
-effective range of rifles, but if the two men at the ranch should
-discover the move they were making to put the river between them and
-their enemies, they could quickly cross in their canoe and locate
-themselves in the path of escape.
-
-The horses drew back at first, erecting their ears and neighing
-timidly, doubtless scenting the huge crocodiles hidden in the rank
-growth upon the banks.
-
-Phil heaved a relieved sigh as he saw Maria’s horse emerge from the
-water on the far side, and scramble up the steep bank, the dripping
-girl clutching securely the saddle.
-
-Little Juan behaved like a veteran, guiding his horse with a gentle
-hand across the current until the animal’s feet took the bottom on the
-other side and when the horse’s back emerged, he was sitting again
-securely in the saddle.
-
-Just as Phil, the last to reach the shore, gained the steep ascent,
-a sharp crack of a rifle, followed by a loud smack as the bullet dug
-itself into the muddy soil, announced that those at the ranch had also
-discovered their presence. As Phil drew himself into the saddle shaking
-free his reins, a single swift glance down the river showed him the
-two natives running toward the palm grove where the canoe was tied. A
-few swift strokes and they would again bar the way.
-
-“Come, Syd, we must ride ahead,” Phil cried in a fever of dread, as he
-dashed by Maria and her brother. “Never mind what happens, señorita,
-you ride on as fast as you can go,” he continued earnestly as Sydney
-spurred ahead to join him. “We’ve got to turn those fellows back,” he
-explained breathlessly. “If they succeed in getting across they will be
-able to stop us completely.”
-
-As the midshipmen galloped madly down the rough trail toward a clearing
-in the trees from which they could get a clear view of their enemy,
-both drew their revolvers and held them in readiness.
-
-“Look out for your horse, Syd,” Phil continued; “he’ll probably balk
-when we fire and to be unseated now would mean the end.”
-
-As the two horsemen came into view of the boat the two natives,
-half-way across the river, suddenly dropped their paddles. Two flashes
-of flame and a light, filmy smoke told that their bullets had been
-sent speeding in the midshipmen’s direction. But fortunately the
-rocking canoe had spoiled their aim. The missiles sang harmlessly above
-the lads’ heads.
-
-On a mad gallop the two midshipmen rushed out upon the clearing,
-revolvers in hand. As if on drill, the two horses were drawn back upon
-their haunches and the Americans’ weapons spoke furiously--shot after
-shot struck about the panic-stricken natives. They first attempted to
-paddle away, but the close hiss of the bullets became more than their
-waning courage could stand. Forgetting their rifles in their mad fear,
-they jumped overboard and dived below the surface of the water, while
-the empty canoe, in the grasp of the current, went sailing swiftly
-down-stream, forever beyond their reach.
-
-With wild exultation the midshipmen turned and raced after their
-fleeing friends.
-
-Darkness overtook them long before they could again recross the river
-and take the wide trail on which it was possible to ride with greater
-speed.
-
-It was after midnight before the great house of Señor Rodriguez loomed
-up ahead, and after they had been stopped a number of times by the
-vigilant sentries they gained the hospitable roof.
-
-After a hearty supper, which Maria insisted upon their eating, Phil
-declared his wish to return to Palilo.
-
-“But your boat has not returned,” Maria insisted. “You must sleep here
-to-night, then you can return in the morning.”
-
-Phil knew that O’Neil would not return until he had reached a depth of
-water in the river too shallow for the gunboat to pass. How far would
-he have to go? Maybe to the cañon beneath the insurgent stronghold.
-In that case he could scarcely expect them before morning. A slight
-uneasiness filled his thoughts, but he tried to put it aside, for
-O’Neil’s ready resourcefulness could get them out of almost any
-difficulty.
-
-“It is important, señorita,” Phil declared firmly, “that I should
-return to-night. I will leave a message for my men to follow down on
-their return. May I have a boat or a couple of horses?” he asked.
-
-Maria spoke a few words to an attendant.
-
-“Lopez will guide you,” she answered. “I am sorry you will not stay,
-but you, of course, know best.”
-
-Señor Rodriguez, after he had been told of the miraculous escape of
-the explorers, shook the lads warmly by the hand, and thanked them for
-taking care of his two children.
-
-“It was the other way around,” Sydney cried in admiration. “Your
-daughter really saved us and herself, too. If it had not been for her
-we should have blundered into a fight with the ladrones and been killed
-for our pains.”
-
-The old man shook his head thoughtfully.
-
-“Salas, eh? So he is with Espinosa. The two blackest rogues we have in
-the islands. You are lucky to be free of them.”
-
-“How many men have you guarding your plantation?” Phil inquired, his
-mind bent upon the possibility of an attack.
-
-“I have five hundred men, but only three hundred rifles,” Rodriguez
-replied. “Captain Blynn will send sufficient guns to arm all the men
-by to-morrow. I do not fear an attack until after Espinosa is more
-recovered. My spies report that he is still suffering from his wound.
-I suppose I must expect an attack eventually,” he added sadly, gazing
-lovingly at his daughter and little son.
-
-Within the hour, Lopez appeared and reported all was ready for the trip
-to Palilo.
-
-“If you want more men,” Phil suggested, “I can speak to Major Marble,
-the adjutant-general. But I, myself, hope soon to be anchored off your
-house in the ‘Mindinao.’”
-
-Lopez’s old eyes opened wide. “A gunboat has not been for many years up
-this river,” he said gravely. “The Spaniards built the bridge after the
-bloody fight at Matiginao over thirty years ago. It is said that many
-rocks were placed in the channel by the natives at that time, and after
-the Spaniards found the river was blocked for their gunboats they built
-that bridge to endure. It is all of stone and iron. A steam-launch can
-barely pass through the archway.”
-
-Phil’s heart sank. The channel blocked with rock! If this was true only
-a careful survey could assure safety for the gunboat. The lead might
-easily miss the shallow places while the gunboat would discover the
-obstruction for the first time with its frail bottom.
-
-The lad shook hands with the dignified old man. They regarded him
-almost with reverence. Had they not seen him stand bravely before a
-score of his countrymen, who he knew would like nothing better than
-to murder him, and tell them boldly that he was for the right even if
-to be so would cause him to be called a traitor! Now he had declared
-for the American cause and almost every influential native’s hand was
-against him.
-
-Maria went with them to where the grooms held their horses.
-
-“Señorita, we can never thank you enough,” Phil declared gladly. “You
-are forever putting us in your debt.”
-
-“Ah, you have forgotten the night you saved Colonel Martinez,” she said
-softly, and Phil imagined in the moonlight that her eyes shone brighter.
-
-“By Jove, Phil!” Sydney exclaimed eagerly a moment later, after they
-and Lopez had swung themselves into their saddles and were trotting
-down the broad roadway, “I didn’t believe it was in any girl to have
-such grit, least of all one of her race. How on earth did you come to
-think of such a trick as you played on that dapper little colonel?”
-
-Phil smiled deliciously.
-
-“That was planned telepathically between the señorita and me,” he
-replied. “She purposely sat in front of Salas and I was placed behind
-him; reason one. She knew that I knew if Salas remained in that
-canoe we would all be made prisoners, and as Espinosa would be our
-jailer--well! The crocodile was sent by a kind Providence, but if not
-one way it would have been another. The idea occurred to me and I
-firmly believe that she divined what I was about to do, for did you see
-her spin the canoe about so as to get out of the colonel’s reach when
-he was sent floundering in the water? She first induced him against
-his caution and better judgment to trust himself alone with us in one
-canoe.”
-
-“But why didn’t he disarm us?” Sydney questioned perplexedly.
-
-“I dare say he wonders why he didn’t too, by now,” Phil laughed. “Maria
-threw him quite off the scent, apparently. These brown fellows are
-very keen on dramatic scenes, and he doubtless thought it would be a
-fine situation to spring the fact that we were prisoners when we had
-arrived in Espinosa’s presence.”
-
-The guide Lopez rode silently at their side. The lads were too much
-occupied to give him more than a passing thought until the road emerged
-from the woods of the valley and wound gradually around a hill which
-was half-way between Rodriguez’s ranch and Palilo. Their conversation
-had flagged; for the first time they realized that they needed sleep.
-After their hard ride they felt tired and stiff. By mutual consent they
-stopped on the crest of the hill. Phil took out his watch and held it
-up to the moon’s rays.
-
-“Two o’clock!” he exclaimed. “Not much sleep for us to-night.” Then a
-look in Lopez’s face caused him alarm. He saw the native, eyes intent
-on the horizon from which they had come and his hands pressing forward
-his ears, apparently trying to intercept a sound which he had either
-heard or imagined.
-
-Phil was about to ask an eager question but before he could speak he
-was answered by a distant rumble from the direction of the ranch. Again
-and again the slight sound trembled on the still night. Like statues
-silhouetted against the sky, for a second or more the three men sat
-transfixed with apprehension. Then as one man they whirled their
-horses about and galloped madly back over the road in the direction
-from which they had come. That far-distant sound could have but one
-interpretation;--the Rodriguez ranch was being attacked, and they might
-be needed.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XV
-
-A NIGHT OF ALARM
-
-
-After the midshipmen had ridden away Maria returned to the large
-living-room to bid her father good-night. A new pleasure had come
-into her life, and what was more natural than that she should wish to
-share it with him? These frank, young Americans had proved themselves
-to be of a quality which she had not thought existed outside of the
-story-books of her childhood. She believed that in their friendship
-her father’s difficulties would melt away. Juan Rodriguez, interested
-as he had always been in the political trials of his country together
-with the management of his vast estates, from which he had reaped great
-riches, like most Filipinos of the upper class, had treated his only
-daughter more as a heaven-sent treasure rather than as a daughter to
-confide in and in whom to seek womanly sympathy in his perplexities.
-Her principal care had been for her brother, Juan, the pride of the
-old man’s life. Upon this seven-year-old boy the greater part of his
-affection was centred. Maria was not at all sleepy, and, seeing a light
-in her father’s bedroom, she slipped in quietly to pour out her heart
-to the stern but kindly parent.
-
-On the threshold she stopped in startled amazement. Her slippered feet
-had made no sound and the door as she pushed it open caused him to
-glance up in annoyed surprise. She saw her father on his knees in the
-corner before several heavy iron-bound chests, and their opened covers
-displayed to her anxious eyes a great wealth of gold and silver coins.
-More money than her young imagination had ever dreamed of.
-
-As Rodriguez’s eyes encountered the startled look in his daughter’s
-face, an expression of stern annoyance came into his own as he snapped
-the huge lids shut and rose to his feet.
-
-“Why do you keep all that money here?” she asked anxiously.
-
-Her father looked worried at the question.
-
-“All the money I have is in those chests, daughter,” he answered in a
-low voice. “It has been buried, but when Garcia deserted me, Lopez
-and I dug it up and brought it in here. I fear these native banks, and
-if I should be robbed by the insurgents I would leave you and Juan
-penniless. My lands are valuable, but these,” pointing to the chests,
-“contain the most of my wealth. My ambition is to take my children
-abroad, away from this turmoil and strife where they can see the world
-and be educated in a way befitting the blood in their veins.”
-
-Maria put her arms about the old man’s neck and kissed him fondly.
-“Father,” she began, her eyes smiling with happiness, “I came in to
-speak to you of the two young men who have just left us. Tell them of
-your troubles and I know they will be able to solve the difficulty.”
-
-Rodriguez smiled sadly.
-
-“Your knights, child, I see have already been endowed with magic
-powers,” he answered lovingly, patting her smooth black hair, “but we
-have a cruel and unscrupulous enemy against us, and I am sure by now
-he knows of the existence of this treasure. Garcia and I were the only
-ones who knew where it was buried, and I trusted him as a brother but
-he has deserted and betrayed me. Lopez is from the people, but his
-honesty and loyalty are beyond doubt. Captain Blynn knows that this
-money is here and has promised to send a company of soldiers to take it
-to safety in the government vaults at Palilo. I had hoped he would be
-here before now,” he ended in a worried tone.
-
-“Why bury it?” Maria exclaimed. “Our American friends would gladly take
-it on the gunboat, where it will be perfectly safe.”
-
-Rodriguez’s face lighted up.
-
-“I will ask them to-morrow,” she added as she kissed her father in
-parting, “and now don’t lose any sleep over your troublesome gold.” She
-turned, a happy smile on her face, and glided noiselessly to the door,
-to enter her own room; she stopped and the smile froze on her face and
-the fear within her made her faint; she clutched reeling at the door
-and steadied herself. The face of a man had been pressed against the
-dark glass of the window in her room, and she knew instantly that he
-had seen through the opened door the three coveted chests of treasure.
-She passed her hands across her face in horror, hoping that it was but
-a trick of the imagination, conjured up by her anxiety. But no, the
-face had been too vividly distinct. As she had entered the darkness
-of her room, for an instant the light from her father’s lamp had been
-reflected on the intruder’s face, and in that terrible moment she had
-recognized her father’s former confidant, but now his enemy, Garcia.
-She stood panic-stricken, at a loss how to act. To give the alarm might
-insure her father’s death. Perhaps the enemy had made their way within
-and were at that very moment concealed in the great vacant rooms, lying
-hidden in the darkness waiting until the household were all asleep,
-and then murder and robbery would be their aim. If she told her father
-now, she knew that he would fearlessly and at once give the alarm and
-call for his armed men to protect him. Then a thought made the blood
-freeze in her veins, as her active mind sought for the means Garcia
-had employed to pass her father’s sentries. There could be but one
-solution. Garcia had sowed dissension among her father’s retainers. How
-many of his men could now be trusted? While she stood in terrified
-silence, a loud knock on the outside door caused her young body to
-tremble in mortal terror. What could it mean? Who would come at this
-hour in the morning? She saw her father make ready to answer, for the
-servants all slept in a house adjoining.
-
-“I’ll open it,” she cried, trying to disguise the tremble in her voice,
-and with shaking limbs she crept down the stairs. Holding her breath,
-she listened. Then she drew back the bolts in trembling haste and threw
-wide the door.
-
-O’Neil and his tired companions, the boat’s crew, stood in open-eyed
-wonder as this wild-eyed but now joyous girl dragged them inside and
-again barred the door.
-
-“What’s the trouble, señorita?” O’Neil asked in calm surprise.
-
-She put her finger to her lips and led them into the dining-room, where
-the remnants of the midshipmen’s supper still remained. The five men
-fell upon the food ravenously while Maria stood by, fear and hope in
-turns showing in her dark eyes.
-
-She told them of the trip up the river and the escape from the ladrone
-leader, then of the valuable treasure in her father’s room and the
-face she had seen at the window. After she had finished she watched
-O’Neil’s face as if it were an oracle and she a petitioner before it.
-The boatswain’s mate ate for several minutes in silence.
-
-“Where are your men posted?” he asked suddenly.
-
-“They are divided into four companies, one at each of the outposts,”
-she answered.
-
-“Does any one except your father and Colonel Martinez know of Garcia’s
-treachery?” he asked.
-
-“Yes, two, Lopez and Lukban,” she replied, “and they are both away from
-the ranch. Lopez has just gone to Palilo with our friends.”
-
-“That’s bad,” the sailor exclaimed, a cloud on his otherwise
-expressionless face. “Then your men believe that Garcia is still their
-friend? He has, of course, accomplices among them and his object surely
-must be the treasure. He has discovered that it has been dug up, and
-now knows it is in your father’s room. I do not believe there is any
-immediate danger unless at the same time the insurgents are to make an
-attack in force.”
-
-The girl listened eagerly, nodding her head in agreement with the
-wise words of this cool and calm American. O’Neil’s companions,
-understanding no Spanish, had finished their meal and were dozing
-contentedly in their chairs.
-
-“Have you a servant you can trust?” O’Neil asked after a moment’s
-thought.
-
-“My maid, Inez,” she answered.
-
-“All right; give her a revolver and tell her to go to each company and
-quietly wake the men and tell them to get ready immediately to repel an
-attack. If she is in danger of being captured by a lurking enemy tell
-her to use the revolver. I’ll leave two men with you and your father,
-while I’ll take two to try to bag this Garcia.”
-
-Maria listened eagerly, hope rising as the sailor clearly outlined his
-plan of action. She was sure Inez could be depended upon. Quietly she
-flew up the stairs. As she passed her father’s room she saw that he had
-retired, but had left the light burning for her. She stopped a second,
-listening to his easy breathing. He was asleep. Then she went through
-her own room, a chill passing through her as her eyes turned in fear
-toward the window.
-
-She took hold of Inez’s arm and shook her into wakefulness. The old
-woman, who had nursed Maria as a baby, sat up rubbing the sleep out of
-her eyes.
-
-“Keep quiet,” Maria whispered in a commanding voice. “We are all in
-danger of being murdered. I want you to take this revolver and go to
-each outpost, tell the officer on guard that it is Señor Rodriguez’s
-order to form his men to repel an attack at once. If you fail fire the
-revolver as a signal to us.”
-
-The old woman rose to her feet trembling violently. She counted her
-beads, murmuring her prayers, but there was never a word of fear or
-hesitancy.
-
-“Good, Inez,” Maria whispered, kissing the old wrinkled face. The girl
-saw it was set determinedly, yet a great and unknown terror looked out
-of her appealing eyes. But the girl knew that she would be the safest
-messenger. No one else could be depended upon like Inez, and she would
-sacrifice her old life willingly to help her beloved master.
-
-When Maria again entered the dining-room O’Neil had turned out the lamp
-and was ready to carry out his daring plan.
-
-“Two of my men will remain here with you, señorita,” he told Maria as
-she held open the door. “We’ll soon bag this fellow Garcia, if he’s
-still hanging about.”
-
-O’Neil, followed cautiously by his two men, walked slowly about the
-great house. As noiselessly as Indians they crept within its shadow,
-straining their eyes toward the portico and covered porches above their
-heads. There still remained the light in the room above where the girl
-and her two protectors were doubtless now guarding her father and his
-treasure. While O’Neil stood listening eagerly, a shadow crossed the
-windows; it moved slowly inch by inch. The house was silent. Off to his
-left O’Neil could hear a babble of excited voices and the rattle of
-military accoutrements. Inez’s warning had been given and the native
-soldiers were hastening to their stations to repel an enemy. The
-shadow slowly crossed and disappeared and then the light was suddenly
-extinguished. O’Neil was about to seek further when a noise from above
-arrested his attention. He recognized at once that a sash was being
-opened slowly. Then as he watched a dark figure appeared and dropped
-noiselessly to the porch roof a few feet below the window. Quietly it
-lowered itself to the edge of the roof and then with the agility of an
-acrobat or a sailor climbed down the post near which the boatswain’s
-mate and his men were standing. The next moment two powerful arms
-enfolded it and a cry of fear was promptly stifled.
-
-Then from the dark shadow of the woods to the northward came a volley
-of musketry, followed by the war-cry of the bolo-man.
-
-Hastily binding their prisoner with their neckerchiefs, the sailors
-flung him on to the porch and rushed to join the defenders scarcely
-four hundred yards away. Rodriguez had carefully laid out his plan of
-defense, and before the attacking enemy could come to a hand to hand
-fight, over three hundred yards of cleared land must be traversed.
-As O’Neil and his men reached the trenches where the native soldiers
-were excitedly firing blindly into the night, he could see a bobbing
-line of men rapidly running across this open space, firing as they
-advanced. Hastily surveying his surroundings, he saw that on one flank
-was the river defended by a company of men and on the flank away from
-the river was still another company. The excited native officers were
-shouting orders to their men, the purport of which O’Neil could but
-guess. The bobbing figures seemed in vast numbers and they advanced
-rapidly in spite of the fire from the trenches. Suddenly the company
-from the river bank left its post and came at double time to the middle
-of the line of defense. O’Neil and his men had seized a rifle each
-from lifeless hands and were elbow to elbow--vociferously haranguing
-the men, cautioning them to aim at the constantly moving enemy. Before
-they could realize its significance, a line of men arose suddenly from
-the short grass, only a few score of yards in front of the trenches,
-to which point they had crawled unobserved, while the defenders had
-been firing at the visible enemy. The next second this avalanche of
-naked humanity had cleared the intervening yards and were hacking at
-the surprised defenders with their sharp bolos. Their friends in their
-rear still kept up a brisk fire and many of the bolo-men suffered by
-it. O’Neil suddenly found himself occupied by three fanatics bent upon
-his destruction, while his companions near him were in as perilous
-a position. Throwing away his empty rifle he drew his revolver and
-fired unerringly at the nearest native. Then seizing the fallen man’s
-bolo he rushed upon his other two assailants. So fierce had been the
-onslaught of the bolo-men that they had surged into and even beyond the
-rifle-pits, leaving a trail of destruction in their path.
-
-The bolo-men, now at close quarters with those in the trenches, made
-good use of their keen-bladed knives, but Rodriguez’s men, familiar
-with the method of attack of these fanatics, appeared to flee, and then
-turning shot their would-be pursuers down by the score. O’Neil and his
-companions were in these few exciting minutes many times in peril of
-their lives but soon the last of the attacking horde lay gasping on the
-grass behind the intrenchment and the sailors and their dusky allies
-were again in comparative security awaiting grimly the final attack of
-the bobbing figures some hundreds of yards in their front, from whose
-direction a hail of bullets whistled incessantly. O’Neil felt himself
-all over hardly believing that he had escaped unscathed. The sailor
-during his many years of service had never seen a fight more desperate.
-He had frequently heard of the insurgent method of employing bolo-men;
-using their riflemen as a screen, the practically unarmed horde, who
-believed that their “Anting-Anting” charms rendered them invulnerable,
-crawling snake-like, unobserved beyond their firing line until they
-reached the rifle-pits of their enemy. Now he felt sure the attack on
-the ranch would fail. Rodriguez’s natives had successfully weathered
-the bolo rush, which they had learned to fear most. He did not know the
-numbers of the attackers, but if they could be held off until morning
-the soldiers who had been promised from Palilo to guard Rodriguez’s
-treasure would surely be there to turn the tide in their favor. By the
-fire from the trenches surrounding the ranch house on all sides except
-that covered by the river, beyond which was an impenetrable swamp,
-he knew that their line had not been broken. With a lighter heart
-he counseled the natives near him to be careful of their ammunition,
-setting them an example by firing deliberately only when a target
-native exposed himself in the clearing in front of them. So much
-occupied were those in the trenches that they failed to see several
-great canoes land near the pier, and their occupants in single file
-noiselessly steal toward the ranch house.
-
-Again and again the insurgents made their onslaught, but each time were
-received unflinchingly and driven back in confusion across the cleared
-ground, many being left dead or dying on the field.
-
-A disheveled, terrified figure came running from the house toward the
-trenches; it glanced about wildly seeking some one and then threw
-itself at O’Neil’s feet, clasping his legs tightly, almost upsetting
-him among the stiffening bodies of the dead on the floor of the trench.
-In the dim light he recognized the woman Inez who had courageously
-spread the alarm among the native soldiers and her incoherent words
-filled the sailor’s heart with dire forebodings.
-
-“Oh, señor, save my master,” she cried; “he is in mortal danger.”
-
-O’Neil bent down and unclasped the woman’s hands and lifted her to her
-feet, but her body crumpled and the American saw with a sob of horror
-that Inez had done her last service to the Rodriguez family; a bolo
-cut on her old body had claimed her among the victims slain in this
-unnecessary war.
-
-The boatswain’s mate laid the woman’s body aside and with a score
-of willing men started on a run for the house. Half-way there they
-stopped precipitously, hardly believing their eyes, a great fear in
-their hearts, for from the river there came a noiseless band of men,
-dim shadows under the gloom of the trees. O’Neil counted them as their
-silhouettes crossed a vista in the trees, and his hopes died within
-him. Here was a new enemy, striking from the rear. The men in the
-trenches could not leave their positions; to do so would allow many
-hundreds of the insurgents to sweep the ranch.
-
-“Forward!” he cried; “we must reach the ranch house first.”
-
-He saw that this was their only hope to save the inmates.
-
-Then a cry of joy leaped from his lips as tongues of flame leaped from
-the vicinity of the house, directed upon the advancing men from the
-river. He heard an order given sharply in the English tongue and a
-volley shattered the darkness asunder.
-
-“American soldiers!” he cried jubilantly.
-
-O’Neil and his men had meanwhile circled away from the river in hopes
-of making a rush for an entrance; now with sudden consternation O’Neil
-saw that the appearance of the soldiers from the river would place
-him in the line of retreat of those now surrounding the ranch house.
-Selecting the protection of a tree trunk he called upon his men to do
-likewise. He heard the order “Charge” given in the silvery peals of a
-bugle and the next moment the terrified natives were fleeing directly
-toward him, the hindmost slashing with their bolos those in front of
-them in their mad haste to seek safety. Then the drumming of hoof-beats
-was heard and three horsemen appeared suddenly from the night,
-emptying their revolvers as they came into the fleeing savages.
-
-A woman’s scream pierced the night and the figure of a man silently
-dropped from the roof and disappeared in the darkness.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVI
-
-A FILIPINO MARTYR
-
-
-Phil and Sydney were hard pushed to keep up with the native as he
-spurred his horse forward over the dark road.
-
-“The ranch is being attacked!” Lopez cried in a voice of fear. “My poor
-master will surely be killed!”
-
-Phil’s thoughts were only for the frail girl whom he had begun to look
-upon as his own especial charge. He knew the cruelty of the Filipinos
-when once their anger was aroused and he believed that her part in
-Espinosa’s betrayal must now be known to that treacherous leader.
-Probably Colonel Salas himself formed a part of the attacking force,
-and the lad thought fearfully of the vengeance he would take upon the
-helpless girl if she fell into his hands. As they approached the ranch,
-the volume of fire increased alarmingly.
-
-“They are in force!” Phil exclaimed, his heart sinking within him as
-he urged his tired mount forward.
-
-The ranch with its surrounding orchard of fruit trees now lay just
-below them and the white road winding down the hill glistened in the
-dim moonlight. Tongues of flame darted here and there from the shadows
-of trees and shrub, even close to the house itself, while further in
-the background toward the river a line of flame resembling fireflies
-on a summer evening told him the soldiers of Rodriguez were stubbornly
-resisting the main attack from their solidly built trenches. As they
-plunged madly down the hill road, his alert eyes tried to disentangle
-the situation. He saw many moving figures flitting through the trees,
-the moonlight glinting on their bright bladed bolos, while toward
-the river a long line of flashing rifles told of a rescue party
-approaching, from whom the flitting figures were fleeing.
-
-Three white figures appeared suddenly from behind a tree close to the
-retreating bolo-men and the lad’s heart gave a great leap of joy as he
-recognized even in the dim light the stalwart figure of O’Neil.
-
-Then as he charged forward with his companions close beside him,
-Maria’s cry made his heart sink and at the same instant he saw
-the figure of a man emerge from the house and dart away after the
-retreating bolo-men.
-
-“Where are we needed?” a familiar voice shouted from the company which
-had now halted at the house, and the anxious lads, after firing their
-revolvers in vain at the fleeing figure, were shaking Captain Blynn’s
-hand.
-
-“In the trenches, sir,” O’Neil volunteered eagerly. “They are hard
-pushed, sir.”
-
-Captain Blynn gave a hurried order and his company of American soldiers
-rushed eagerly toward the thick of the firing, followed by O’Neil and
-his men. All were eager to again try conclusions with the elusive foe.
-
-Phil and Sydney followed the anxious Lopez to the house. As they
-entered the hall they were horrified to find everything in confusion.
-The furniture was wrecked in many places, and there were blood-stains
-on floor and wall, showing there had been a terrible struggle. A light
-was burning dimly in an alcove. In the corner lay the white form of
-an American sailor mutilated and dead. Further up the stairs they saw
-the other poor sailor breathing his last. Clearing the body with a
-bound the lads gazed with sinking heart upon the dead face of Señor
-Rodriguez, lying on the floor of his bedroom, while all about him was
-confusion and ruin.
-
-“Where is the girl?” Sydney asked in a faint, fearful voice.
-
-“Señorita!” Phil called hopelessly.
-
-A faint sob came to their ears from an inner room. Rushing in they
-found the girl on the floor, her hands and feet securely bound. About
-her mouth a gag had been placed, but it had fallen, leaving the mouth
-free.
-
-They quickly released her and placed her tenderly on the bed.
-
-“She managed to get off the gag and scream,” Phil whispered with
-admiration, “before she fainted. Bring that light, Syd, she may be
-hurt.”
-
-The light was soon brought, and the lads were relieved to find that she
-was unharmed.
-
-Lopez meanwhile had stayed at the bedside of his dead master, moaning
-piteously. The noise caught the girl’s ear as she awaked from her
-stupor under the administration of the midshipmen.
-
-“It was Espinosa himself,” she exclaimed in an anguish of sorrow.
-“They forced the door and killed the brave sailors. My father defended
-himself but he is no match for five men. Espinosa struck him down from
-behind. I ran to guard little Juan, but they caught me and bound me.”
-
-“The money is gone too,” groaned Lopez. This to him seemed as great a
-sorrow as the death of his master.
-
-“They lowered it out the window,” Maria said. She entered her father’s
-room, walking unsteadily between the two midshipmen, and knelt in
-prayer before her father’s couch.
-
-Phil’s eyes fell before those of the girl as she arose dry-eyed and
-calm. He saw the anguish in her face, however, and vowed that he would
-lighten her task wherever it lay in his power.
-
-“Is Juan safe?” Lopez asked suddenly, his mind at last grasping the
-horrible calamity which had fallen on his master’s house and realizing
-that his first duty was with the living.
-
-The girl nodded.
-
-“Inez brought the alarm that the house was surrounded. She hid the
-boy and herself. Espinosa searched for him and his intention was to
-carry us both away as his prisoners.” Then a sudden fear came into her
-voice and her eyes flashed with excited terror. “He said that Colonel
-Martinez had been killed. Is it so?”
-
-The lads shook their heads.
-
-“We have no news, Maria,” Phil said kindly. “No, it cannot be so. It
-was but prompted by this cruel man to taunt you.”
-
-She sighed hopefully.
-
-“If he had known of this attack and was alive he would have prevented
-it,” she exclaimed suddenly, her hope turning to dejection.
-
-While they were talking the fusillade slowly diminished and soon ceased
-altogether and in a short time Captain Blynn’s voice was heard in the
-hall below.
-
-In the large living-room the army and navy men sat, until the daylight
-sifted in through the shell windows, talking of the perplexing
-situation, while Maria was made to go to bed and sleep. The doctor who
-accompanied the captain regarded her with eyes of grave concern.
-
-“She must not be overexcited. She is outwardly calm but her heart acts
-queerly. It may snap at any moment,” he had told the lads.
-
-“I have received a long letter from your friend, Colonel Martinez,” the
-captain exclaimed to the midshipmen after disposing of a steaming cup
-of coffee. “He said he would willingly surrender to General Wilson if
-the price on his head were removed, and he sent me papers and documents
-which I have already sent to the governor-general in Manila which prove
-Martinez’s innocence of certain crimes committed in Luzon and implicate
-a Filipino now high in the good graces of the government.”
-
-Phil thoughtfully sent Lopez to Maria to tell her of Captain Blynn’s
-news and then gave Captain Blynn the story of the recent tragedy on the
-floor above.
-
-“Poor Rodriguez,” the captain murmured. “If he had taken the other
-side he would now be alive. The money,” he added, his face troubled--“I
-am too late. I promised him I would come, but I was delayed by
-important matters with the general.”
-
-“A search at once,” Phil exclaimed rising hastily from his chair; “they
-can’t have gone far with those heavy chests.”
-
-Lopez smiled grimly.
-
-“Señor, it would be impossible to follow them. By now the treasure is
-either carefully hidden or else in a banka hurrying up the river to
-Espinosa’s stronghold. We must capture Espinosa; where he is the money
-will be also.”
-
-“Quite right, Lopez,” Captain Blynn agreed. “It’s not pleasant to hike
-in this country at night either, young man,” he added to Phil, whose
-sudden show of excitement in the prospect of another fight had died
-down; “every trail is trapped, and I don’t relish a green bamboo spear
-through me even for all old Rodriguez’s money. Espinosa undoubtedly has
-planned this attack carefully and in the darkness we would simply be
-wasting our time and be losing sleep.
-
-“Some of our friend Espinosa’s plotting, in the light of this affair,
-is now quite plain. Rodriguez was in his way, and so is Martinez, but
-I don’t exactly see why; and this attack was made easy through his
-winning of Garcia, the trusted friend of Rodriguez. But how did he
-learn of this money?”
-
-“Why,” Phil exclaimed, a scowl on his face, “Lopez tells me that Garcia
-alone knew of its existence and coveted it, and readily persuaded
-Espinosa to help him obtain it and share it. With that amount of money
-they can make this war very difficult for us or they can escape with
-their booty to Hongkong.”
-
-“Well,” said the captain yawning outright, “I must get some sleep. The
-bridge is clear; I’ll wait here until you bring up the gunboat. The
-general is coming himself to look over the ground. We’ve had reports
-that the rebel army is massing at Matiginao, where supplies for a year
-have been collected.
-
-“We’re going to have the biggest fight in the history of the war,” he
-added in a sleepy voice as he lay full length on the wicker lounge. “By
-the way, old man Tillotson promises all kinds of rewards to any one
-who will rescue his son. He’s coming down himself--sailed from Manila
-the day after he got the news.”
-
-Although the midshipmen and their men would have liked nothing better
-than to follow Captain Blynn’s example for a few hours’ nap, they felt
-that the startling news that the entire rebel army was collecting
-upon Matiginao made it imperative for them to leave the situation at
-the Rodriguez ranch in the hands of Captain Blynn and return to their
-gunboat. So far their work had not been crowned with success. True,
-they had exposed a traitor, but in doing so the American soldiers had
-acquired a new and sagacious enemy in Espinosa. The remaining members
-of the Katipunan society had taken flight, and had fled before the
-vengeance of Captain Blynn whom they all hated and feared. Rodriguez
-had been killed, and enough gold to continue the war indefinitely had
-been taken almost before their eyes, and they had been powerless to
-prevent it. This was not a pleasant retrospective dream in which to
-indulge as they watched in silence the even breathing of the complacent
-army man.
-
-“We seem so powerless against them,” Sydney complained. “Our enemies
-are everywhere. One moment the natives about us seem friendly, and the
-next they are sticking us in the back with knives. When we start on an
-expedition the enemy know just how many men we have and where we are
-going, so there can be no surprise, while they always take us unawares.”
-
-“But now, it’s different since Espinosa and the Katipunans have been
-forced to leave Palilo,” Phil exclaimed. “In the last few days Captain
-Blynn says our soldiers in the provinces have surprised several bands
-of insurgents. So you see they have ceased to be kept posted by spies
-at headquarters.
-
-“Espinosa is collecting all his men in Matiginao with the idea of
-safety and a hope of being able to capture Palilo before the two extra
-regiments arrive, but General Wilson will checkmate him by withdrawing
-half his men to surround him in his mountain stronghold. Now we have
-some chance; before, they simply knew when we were coming, and if they
-couldn’t meet us with three times our number they kept out of the way.
-But come,” he added suddenly jumping to his feet, “we are wasting
-time.”
-
-The Americans returned down the river in their cutter, this time the
-midshipmen taking turns at the oars, and it was nearly eight o’clock
-before they stood once more on the deck of the “Mindinao.” The bodies
-of the dead sailors were sent at once to the army hospital for burial.
-
-“Major Marble has been here twice to see you, sir,” the quartermaster
-informed Phil; “he said he’d return again in an hour.”
-
-“Breakfast first,” Phil shouted to the Chinese steward, who came aft,
-smiling blandly at the return of his officers, steaming coffee in hand.
-
-While they were still at table Major Marble arrived, and was told all
-the news of the river.
-
-“The audacity of those beggars,” he exclaimed, “attacking in force
-within ten miles of headquarters. It’s a shame, the few men we are
-allowed to cover this entire country. The general sees now that what
-is needed is concentration, but if we withdraw our entire garrisons
-from the towns it will mean that the innocent people there who have
-befriended us will suffer.”
-
-“I suppose you are right, major,” Phil said thoughtfully, “but in war
-it seems to me that one can’t stop to consider the feelings of innocent
-people where the success of the cause is concerned. Espinosa has twice
-as many troops as the general, and they are fighting on their home
-soil. They know every footpath. Some are not armed with a rifle but
-are far more dangerous to us with their bolos and fanatical bravery.
-We did not see his stronghold, I am glad to say,” he smiled grimly at
-the words, “but we know that one thousand men held it successfully
-against five times that number of Spaniards a generation ago. From what
-I have seen I say concentrate every available man and crush this fellow
-Espinosa before he gets any stronger.”
-
-Major Marble nodded his head in agreement with the views of the young
-navy man.
-
-“If we could always do what our military training dictates,” he
-answered sadly, “this war might not have begun.”
-
-“I shall go up the river in an hour,” Phil announced, “and if the
-general wishes I shall be honored to have him on board.”
-
-“The general is waiting anxiously to know that,” the major replied
-promptly; “that was my mission here, but your exploits so interested me
-I had nearly forgotten my mission.”
-
-Within the hour the “Mindinao,” flying the blue flag with one white
-star at her main truck in honor of her distinguished passenger, General
-Wilson, cast off from the dock and steamed up the river.
-
-“That was a fine piece of work,” Phil exclaimed in admiration, as
-he examined the cleverly constructed drawbridge built within the
-twenty-four hours by the army engineers. Its width was just sufficient
-to admit the “Mindinao.”
-
-Phil stood on the bridge beside the man at the wheel, piloting the
-gunboat through the ever-changing shoals, while O’Neil in person heaved
-the lead in the chains, calling out the depth in feet.
-
-After leaving the town the river ran through several miles of nipa
-swamp land, the home of the carnivorous land crab, the crocodile and
-the bandit Filipino. The gunboat continued cautiously, Phil keeping
-the sharp bow within the deep water, sometimes so close to the thickly
-wooded shore that he could have reached out and touched with his hand
-the overhanging trees.
-
-Before noon the “Mindinao” had anchored off Rodriguez’s ranch and
-the general and party were landed to view the scene of the recent
-fight. The shore was lined with curious and excited natives, those of
-Rodriguez’s men, who had been spared from the fierce attack. To them
-the presence of the gunboat so far up the river was almost a miracle.
-They pointed knowingly at the big guns and clapped their hands in
-savage joy at the thought of what they could do against the enemy.
-
-Captain Blynn had taken the situation in hand and had distributed the
-soldiers of his company to reinforce the native companies. A feeling of
-relief was now manifested by all. They were confident that no attack
-would be attempted while the gunboat’s guns frowned menacingly out
-there in the river.
-
-“That’s worth a regiment,” Captain Blynn exclaimed as he saluted the
-general and helped him from the “Mindinao’s” cutter to the bamboo
-pier, pointing to the graceful white ship, standing sharply against the
-dark background of jungle grass and banana trees. As they walked toward
-the house Captain Blynn dropped behind and took Phil’s arm confidingly.
-
-“After you had gone my men found a native tied up in all sorts of
-sailor knots with silk neckerchiefs, just under Rodriguez’s window.
-Señorita Rodriguez recognized him at once as a former friend of her
-father who she said had betrayed him. He was pretty well frightened
-and to save his skin, for he believes we are going to kill him, he has
-offered to show us the trail to Espinosa’s stronghold.”
-
-Phil shook his head in mystery.
-
-“I don’t know how he got there, unless----” He turned and called O’Neil
-from the boat. “O’Neil, do you know anything about a native securely
-bound with sailor neckerchiefs?”
-
-“Sure, sir. It was the one that crawled out of the window,” he
-explained hastily; “the young lady saw his face spying on her father.
-His name is Garcia.”
-
-“Do you know,” the captain said knowingly, “that he is the only
-prisoner captured? There wasn’t a single wounded man in sight this
-morning. It isn’t the custom of the country, you see.”
-
-Phil involuntarily shuddered. “How callous one becomes,” he thought,
-“in war time. Think of maybe a hundred wounded men cruelly butchered by
-brother natives.”
-
-Before they reached the house the party was startled by a rifle-shot
-from behind them. Glancing about quickly they saw a large canoe manned
-by natives appear from behind the trees and paddle directly for the
-gunboat; a large white flag flew prominently from the bow of the boat.
-Phil and Captain Blynn walked quickly back and sent O’Neil and his
-cutter out to learn the meaning of the flag of truce. The general and
-the rest of the party halted and waited, eager to see what this strange
-move might mean.
-
-The boat came quickly back and Phil took a letter from a native’s hand
-scanning it with beating heart. “For the general,” he said.
-
-All watched the general break the seal and fumble with his glasses.
-It seemed ages before he finished the few short lines and handed the
-letter to Captain Blynn.
-
- “Lieutenant Tillotson is my prisoner. I will surrender him safely in
- exchange for the deserter Colonel Martinez. If you attack me I shall
- have him shot.
-
- “ESPINOSA.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVII
-
-A DARING PLAN
-
-
-Phil stood silently by, his mind occupied over the details of a daring
-plan.
-
-The exchange proposed by Espinosa was out of the question, even if
-Colonel Martinez had surrendered, which he had not done up to the
-present time; and until his sins in Luzon were forgiven Phil knew that
-he preferred his liberty. But this threat against Tillotson’s life
-worried Phil. Espinosa was sufficiently cruel to carry it out, he was
-sure.
-
-Leaving the group of officers, who were still pondering over the
-contents of Espinosa’s communication, Phil went in search of Maria.
-There were points in his plan which she could throw light upon.
-
-He found her in the house, heavy-eyed with sorrow and loss of sleep,
-but she greeted him with a smile and waited patiently until the room
-was empty before signing him to speak, for she saw that he had
-something of importance to communicate.
-
-“How much dependence can we put upon Garcia as a guide?” he asked
-eagerly. “I have a plan, and all depends upon whether he can be trusted
-to lead us against Espinosa, if not willingly, then under intimidation.”
-
-“Before they killed my father and carried away the treasure,” the girl
-answered, a spark of excitement entering her dull eyes, “Espinosa and
-Salas got the information necessary for their work from Garcia, bound
-and helpless where your sailors had left him. They refused to liberate
-him and hoped he would be killed by the Americans. You can be sure,”
-she added, “that he will take keen pleasure in running his enemies to
-earth.”
-
-“And now for my favor from you,” the lad continued in a lower tone; “as
-Garcia will take Lopez’s place as guide for the soldiers to the trail
-up the mountain, I want twenty-five of your men whom you would trust
-to the death, under the command of Lopez, to take O’Neil and me as
-prisoners to Espinosa’s camp.”
-
-The girl gave a low exclamation of surprised horror, regarding Phil
-fixedly, half believing the lad was out of his mind.
-
-“I mean it,” he exclaimed earnestly. “It’s the only chance we have
-of saving Tillotson’s life. Your men must pretend to have deserted
-after the death of their master,” he dropped his voice as he saw the
-look of pain in Maria’s eyes at the mention of her father’s sad fate.
-“Lopez will claim to have taken us prisoners and then deserted to the
-insurgents. It’s a good plan,” he cried enthusiastically, “and is sure
-to be successful.”
-
-Maria paled at the mere thought of such rashness, but seeing Phil could
-not be moved from his avowed intention, she gave her consent grudgingly.
-
-The general was not so easily convinced. His natural and inherent
-cautiousness could not be changed even under the combined persuasion
-of the midshipman and his staff officers, Major Marble and Captain
-Blynn, who were both enthusiastic over the conception of such a daring
-strategy.
-
-“The very impertinence of it will make it successful,” Major Marble
-exclaimed. “They will not believe that one could be so rash as to
-willingly place his life in danger.”
-
-“You’ll have to stay with the gunboat,” Phil explained to Sydney, who
-was visibly put out that he too could not be allowed to go. “I shall
-take only O’Neil. The general has ordered that all the soldiers who can
-be spared from the garrisons throughout the island be despatched to
-rendezvous here and will need the ‘Mindinao’ to carry troops and shell
-the stronghold from the river. If you find it possible take her through
-the cañon; there is a trail on the other side from the westward. If you
-are successful we shall have them between our two parties.”
-
-That evening Maria and her small brother followed their father’s body
-to his grave in the family cemetery. The general himself read the
-solemn burial service and a company of American infantry fired three
-volleys over the grave of the murdered patriot.
-
-General Wilson established his field headquarters in the house of
-mourning and before three o’clock of the next day the first of the
-detachments of soldiers arrived and went into camp on the river slope.
-
-“We shall have about one thousand rifles for the attack,” Captain
-Blynn told the midshipmen, after Phil had unfolded to him and Major
-Marble the details of his plan to rescue Lieutenant Tillotson, “and by
-to-morrow afternoon they should all be assembled here. The general,”
-he added, “is very much worked up over Espinosa’s threat, and realizes
-that it is not an empty one, but he still refuses to allow you to take
-this terrible chance.”
-
-Within a short time Phil was summoned to the general’s room.
-
-“I cannot allow you to take this risk,” he said kindly, a light of
-admiration in his eyes. “Why should two American lives be jeopardized
-to save one? And perhaps some will say that Lieutenant Tillotson does
-not deserve such a sacrifice at your hands.”
-
-“That makes me more anxious to take the risk,” Phil urged. “We did not
-part friends, and I can’t help feeling that our quarrel has had some
-part in his misfortune.”
-
-Under the confiding influence of the general’s manner, Phil told of his
-affair with Tillotson, doing his best to make a good case for his one
-time enemy.
-
-The general shook his head thoughtfully.
-
-“It is very hard for me to allow you to undertake such a rash
-adventure,” he answered, putting his hand affectionately on the
-midshipman’s shoulder, “but war is war, and if pluck will bring
-success, Tillotson’s life will be saved. Tell me now,” he added,
-seating himself and motioning Phil to a chair, “how far you have worked
-out the details of your plan, for every point must be covered; there
-must be no loophole for failure. Can you expect that each of your
-twenty-five men will keep the secret after they have mixed with the
-enemy?”
-
-Phil outlined each step as he had thought it out during the last
-anxious twenty-four hours, while the general listened, his face grave
-and thoughtful.
-
-They would start after nightfall, and by sending men ahead to announce
-their coming would be received by the insurgents with acclamation. They
-would spend the next day at the camp and Lopez would endeavor to keep
-his men from mixing with the enemy, and the next night the gunboat
-and as many troops as the general could muster would lay siege to the
-stronghold. The remainder Phil had not thought out. Chance alone
-must decide the outcome, but he hoped to save Lieutenant Tillotson’s
-life and their own, and maybe by Lopez and his men commanding the top
-of the trail they could aid the American troops in their fight for
-the stronghold. When the attack was made he would use Lopez’s men to
-prevent Espinosa from carrying out his threat against Tillotson’s
-life. The gunboat must use its fire against the fortifications, but be
-careful to direct its shell to the left of the stronghold, for he hoped
-that his own men would be at the right near the trail leading down the
-precipice.
-
-“There are a great many chances for failure,” the general said
-thoughtfully as Phil finished, “but with your energy and perseverance I
-believe you will win.” He shook the lad’s hand warmly in parting.
-
-“I wish I could go with you,” Maria said sadly as Phil bade her
-good-bye; “but you can put your full trust in Lopez. It was he who
-betrayed the Katipunan society to me to save my father’s life. How he
-got the information I do not know, but if his act were known his life
-would be forfeited.”
-
-Without ceremony Phil and O’Neil, their hands tied securely with ropes
-made fast to their bodies and held in the hands of the make-believe
-deserting natives, filed along the narrow trail leading parallel to the
-fast flowing river. Two messengers had been sent ahead to notify the
-insurgent leader of the joyful tidings of the important captures. Their
-progress was rapid, and inside of three hours the house which had been
-the scene of Phil’s and Maria’s strategy was reached. There the party
-waited.
-
-After what seemed an interminable time to the anxious prisoners, a
-challenge suddenly broke the stillness of the dismal woods and Phil’s
-old enemy, Colonel Salas, stood before him. A great joy shone from his
-dark vengeful eyes as he beheld the bound prisoners.
-
-“My chief will be delighted to receive such distinguished visitors,”
-he laughed, kicking Phil viciously as he lay helpless upon the ground.
-“That is for your cleverness of yesterday,” he snarled. “We’ll see you
-are kindly treated. We shall give you all the refined initiations that
-we can think of to make your stay with us pleasant and then----” He
-stopped with a significant gesture.
-
-“O’Neil,” Phil whispered after Colonel Salas had left him to join
-Lopez, who had assembled his men ready to advance, “I am afraid we are
-in for a pretty bad time of it. But if I ever get the opportunity I’ll
-make that little brown piece of pomposity pay for that kick he gave me.”
-
-“Well, sir,” O’Neil replied evasively, “I may have been in worse
-situations--no doubt I have--but this one seems rather more
-complicated. I think we’ll have many kicks and worse to pay back before
-we can call our bodies our own and not footballs for these little brown
-brothers to score with.”
-
-After a rapid parley the party were again in motion. Phil and O’Neil
-were roughly seized by two natives and forced ahead up the trail. Two
-or three times Phil’s foot slipped into yawning holes at either side of
-the trail, but each time he was dragged back to safety by the natives
-behind him.
-
-“This whole place is trapped,” O’Neil whispered, pointing to where his
-foot had uncovered the top of a square hole some six feet deep, the
-lantern carried by a man in front betraying to view the green bamboo
-spears at the bottom.
-
-Phil shivered as he gazed down on the pointed sticks as sharp as a
-needle, and poisoned, he knew, with a deadly vegetable sap that would
-kill within the hour.
-
-“Be careful, Mr. Perry,” O’Neil cautioned in a low, anxious voice.
-“These men know where the traps are, and will try to catch you if you
-make a misstep--but they might fail,” he added with a shudder.
-
-A halt was called suddenly as they moved through a densely wooded
-section of the level trail, while several of Colonel Salas’ men moved
-cautiously ahead and appeared to work quietly in the jungle. After a
-few minutes they reappeared and signaled for the column to proceed.
-
-“Spring traps,” O’Neil informed the midshipman. “They’ve detached them
-from their springs. If we hadn’t known they were there one of us would
-have caught his foot in a piece of innocent looking vine which would
-have pulled a trigger and sent twenty or more spears across the trail
-with force sufficient to penetrate a pine board.”
-
-Phil half wished that he had not volunteered for this nerve-racking
-ordeal. After all what did he owe Tillotson? Had not the army man tried
-to injure him in every way? Yet the lad knew for that very reason he
-had asked to be allowed to risk his own life to rescue him. Then he
-thought suddenly of O’Neil. His stalwart form was just ahead of him,
-dimly outlined in the darkness. Had he acted generously to this brave
-and willing sailor?
-
-“O’Neil, I am mighty sorry I brought you along,” he exclaimed suddenly.
-
-O’Neil stopped in his tracks so suddenly that the two brown men bumped
-their heads with some force against his back and cried out with
-surprise.
-
-“Why, sir!” he answered in an aggrieved tone. “Have I done anything to
-displease you, sir?”
-
-Phil laughed outright, only to be prodded by the sharp bayonets of his
-captors for his incautiousness.
-
-“If that’s the way you feel about it,” he said, “I am glad you are
-here.”
-
-Inside of ten minutes, conversation was impossible, for they needed
-all their breath for the precipitous climb up the face of the cliff
-leading to the top of the mountain. The natives on each side of the
-prisoners pulled and pushed them up the jagged and rocky trail until
-their bodies were bruised and their skin torn in many places by the
-cruel cactus and “Spanish bayonet,” which seemed to have been planted
-by nature as a further difficulty for those who dared to ascend the
-secret trail to the insurgent stronghold.
-
-After many rests, out of breath, footsore, bleeding and tired, the top
-was reached and with scant courtesy O’Neil and Phil were thrown into a
-nipa shack, where they fell unceremoniously on top of a sleeping human
-being who awakened with a cry of alarm and fear, striking at them with
-his manacled hands.
-
-“It’s Lieutenant Tillotson,” O’Neil exclaimed gladly, as he rolled away
-to the farthest side of the small hut, to put himself out of reach of
-the startled prisoner.
-
-“Who are you?” came from the figure, in a weak voice. “Yes, I am
-Lieutenant Tillotson. Tell me I’m not dreaming. Didn’t I hear a white
-man’s voice?”
-
-[Illustration: _UP THE FACE OF THE CLIFF_]
-
-Phil could see him dimly by the light of the camp-fire outside. The man
-had been completely cowed. What terrible torture had been inflicted to
-cause him to become such an abject figure, groveling before them, his
-voice hollow, and in his eyes a light of unreasonable fear?
-
-“It is Midshipman Perry and O’Neil from the gunboat, Tillotson,” the
-lad whispered. “We hope to save you if you will keep quiet and do just
-what we tell you.” Phil could have wept in pity at the sight of the
-physical wreck before him. He was shocked at the sight. Tillotson’s
-eyes were dull and the face empty of hope.
-
-“You don’t know what you are saying,” he answered in a monotonous
-voice. “No one can be saved who is brought to this place. Death is the
-one avenue of escape. Oh! No one knows of the tortures I have endured
-from that fiend’s hands.” Then his face lit up for a second as he
-raised himself from the ground and stared at Phil, who had approached
-and stood looking down pityingly upon him. “How can you save me? Oh,
-tell me the truth. Are you not prisoners also?”
-
-Phil seated himself by the side of the unnerved man and begged him to
-be calm and reserve his strength. After a few moments he told him of
-the plan and his hopes for success.
-
-“Let us pray for success,” the captive cried weakly. “I had determined
-to throw myself off the cliff rather than undergo another day’s
-torture.”
-
-Tillotson talked for an hour, gruesomely dwelling on the details of his
-horrible treatment by Espinosa. He told of his mission to the spy, with
-the letter which Phil had taken from the dead messenger at Binalbagan.
-The message was in Espinosa’s own handwriting, and warned the attackers
-of the gunboat’s approach.
-
-“I see now that I have been repaid for my stupidity,” he moaned. “I
-believed that I could unmask him and earn the thanks of the general,
-but first I wished to get from him a full confession and implicate
-his accomplices. I showed him the letter and told him I would call at
-his house after visiting the sentries.” The overwrought officer broke
-down and sobbed for several minutes before continuing. “I was a child
-in his hands; I did not know his power. His followers trapped me and
-carried me away by water, bringing me to this awful place. Every day
-some new torture is devised for me. To-day I was suspended by my neck
-with only my toes on the ground. That was the worst so far. I don’t
-know what it will be to-morrow,” he ended with a shudder.
-
-Phil tried to console him as best he could, but a great fear had
-entered his thoughts. If this terrible punishment had been meted out
-to Tillotson, what would the treacherous and cruel Espinosa devise for
-him? Surely something many, many times more horrible.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVIII
-
-A RIVER EXPEDITION
-
-
-After Phil and his party had gone on their hazardous mission, Sydney
-went aboard the gunboat to make ready for the work which had been left
-in his hands. He felt it keenly that he could not share this dangerous
-expedition, but there was some consolation in the knowledge that O’Neil
-was with Phil.
-
-Another detachment, footsore and tired from its forced march from a
-distant post, had arrived at the ranch, and the two staff officers were
-untiringly arranging all the details for the attack in force.
-
-Sydney, upon his arrival on the gunboat, gave orders that all
-obstructions be cleared away from the guns, and directed the placing of
-iron sheeting to protect the officers and men who would be, with him,
-exposed on the gunboat’s bridge.
-
-The plan of attack was to divide the force of soldiers; the gunboat to
-carry as many of the men as her limited deck space would accommodate,
-and the remainder were to go by trail, guided by Garcia. A sufficient
-force would remain to guard the ranch, to which point supplies were on
-their way up the river from Palilo.
-
-General Wilson would command the expedition in person from on board the
-gunboat.
-
-At sunrise Sydney was awake, and already the camp ashore was alive
-and the lad saw the companies drawn up, their rifles stacked, eating
-their morning meal. Hurriedly dressing he was rowed ashore, but before
-leaving he had ordered all his boats to be lowered for transporting the
-soldiers to the gunboat.
-
-“Major Lukban, one of Rodriguez’s officers, will go with you as a
-guide,” Captain Blynn informed the lad as he stepped ashore. “He
-was wounded in the attack on the ranch, but he is well enough to go
-on the gunboat, and he knows the navigation of the river. He is now
-questioning an insurgent officer who was brought in by one of our
-companies; they captured him in a village several miles from here.
-
-“Lukban is like a wild beast; they have just told him of Rodriguez’s
-murder by Espinosa and Salas, so I suppose we had best keep an eye on
-this unfortunate prisoner.”
-
-Captain Blynn led Sydney down to the basement of the ranch house. The
-midshipman, when his eyes became accustomed to the gloom, gave an
-exclamation of surprised horror as he saw a half-strangled native on
-the floor with several others astride his heaving chest. Sydney noticed
-the wounded major in a chair, looking down upon his victim, a savage
-smile on his face.
-
-“It’s not strictly orthodox,” Captain Blynn whispered as he saw the
-horror in Sydney’s eyes, “but it’s effective.”
-
-“A little more,” Major Lukban ordered in a cold voice, after nodding a
-welcome to the newcomers.
-
-Sydney saw the native at the prisoner’s head slowly pour the water
-which he held in a bamboo cup between the prisoner’s teeth. The
-unfortunate man choked, while the veins in his neck stood out like
-whip-cords. His eyes turned glassy and staring, while his colorless
-face became a sickly blue.
-
-“You’ll kill him,” Sydney cried aghast. “It shouldn’t be allowed,
-captain,” he appealed, turning to the army man.
-
-“Don’t you worry, Monroe,” the captain answered calmly, “he knows
-within a few drops of how much the man can stand--watch!” he added
-quietly, as the natives raised the prone captive to a sitting position
-and struck him smartly on the back with their open hands. The native
-coughed and sputtered; gradually his color returned and he drew great
-gasping breaths.
-
-After the prisoner had returned to a comparatively normal condition,
-the inquisitor reached out his hand and struck him smartly across the
-cheek. Where his hand had fallen, a white imprint was left, dying out
-gradually, as the sluggish blood flowed back again.
-
-“This is the ‘water cure,’” Captain Blynn observed as Major Lukban
-fired question after question at the thoroughly cowed and now
-tractable prisoner. “He will exact a confession from him which will
-give us all the information we need. If you or I did this we would
-be court-martialed and maybe dismissed but----” He ended with an
-expressive shrug.
-
-Sydney turned sick at the sight of a human being tortured beyond
-endurance and a fear rose in his mind as he thought of poor Phil in
-Espinosa’s hands. As he watched, the native appeared to hesitate
-in answering a question, but a wave of Lukban’s hand, bringing the
-attending natives and the water cup nearer, caused him to answer the
-question immediately. Once the native refused to answer and then
-despite his cries of fear and struggles almost superhuman, he was
-forced back upon his back, and his jaws pried rudely open with a stick,
-while the bamboo cup was poised menacingly above his open mouth.
-
-The next moment the cup was sent spinning from the native’s hand and
-Sydney had jerked the captive to his feet, and stood flushed with anger
-and excitement between him and his torturer.
-
-“I shan’t stand by and see any more of this torture,” he exclaimed
-forcefully. “It’s a disgrace for us to allow it.”
-
-Captain Blynn shrugged his shoulders, while Lukban glared angrily at
-the indignant champion.
-
-“But, señor, I must have that question answered,” he declared. “It
-will not injure him, and it may save us many lives.”
-
-“What was the question?” Captain Blynn asked.
-
-“Whether there is a third trail from the stronghold and how it may be
-reached,” he answered. “You see, captain, if there is we must guard it,
-for otherwise all will escape us.”
-
-Captain Blynn nodded, glancing amusedly at Sydney’s excited face.
-
-“I am afraid, major, that question must remain unanswered,” he said in
-a level tone, turning and leading the way out.
-
-Sydney turned the half-drowned prisoner over to one of Captain
-Blynn’s soldiers with orders to guard him carefully and to allow no
-interference by their native allies.
-
-By nine o’clock two hundred men had been embarked on the gunboat and
-five hundred more had started under the command of Captain Blynn along
-the trail leading up the river; Garcia as leader was at their head.
-
-In the party on the gunboat were General Wilson, Major Marble and
-Major Lukban; the latter, still sullen and angry with Sydney for his
-unwarranted presumption in making him discontinue his torture, stood
-with his former victim on the bridge of the “Mindinao.”
-
-Sydney headed the vessel into the narrow channel, cautiously picking
-his way through the numerous shoals; one minute the gunboat clung
-closely to the steep river bank on one side and the next it was
-scraping the overhanging trees on the other side.
-
-From the masthead the lookout kept the soldiers on shore in sight,
-and Sydney regulated his speed to just keep pace with them. He
-thought often and with grave concern of Phil. What luck had he had?
-His heartbeats quickened as he vaguely wondered if he were alive! He
-realized the terrible cruelty of the Filipino leader, and Espinosa had
-reason to hate the young naval man!
-
-The small house, where the midshipmen had unexpectedly met Colonel
-Salas, flashed into view as they rounded a bend in the river, and from
-the bridge Sydney could discern with his glasses far in the distance
-the enemy’s stronghold, Matiginao, “the impregnable.”
-
-As the gunboat swept slowly by close inshore the soldiers waved their
-campaign hats in silent salute to their formidable navy ally.
-
-“This, from here on, is unknown river, sir,” Sydney reported to the
-general, sitting calmly talking with his adjutant-general.
-
-The general nodded and answered with a smile.
-
-“All right, admiral, I am entirely satisfied to rely upon your
-judgment.”
-
-Major Lukban had during the gunboat’s progress up the river stood by
-Sydney’s side, showing his appreciation of the lad’s navigation at
-intervals by a silent nod, while at the same time he kept one guarding
-eye upon his captive, whose crafty, sullen eyes roved incessantly along
-the wooded slopes of the narrowing river.
-
-“This is not new to you then, major?” Sydney asked suddenly, as he
-directed the ship’s head toward a large dead tree which stood out a
-lone sentinel on a rocky point ahead.
-
-“As a boy I was brought up on this river,” the native replied sadly.
-“Then many thousand of my people lived in plenty and happiness along
-its banks.”
-
-“Where have they all gone?” the lad inquired interestedly, his eyes
-gazing about for the signs of a deserted population.
-
-Lukban pointed to the tall mountains ahead of them.
-
-“Time and again the Spaniards have endeavored to drive out the outlaws
-from yonder stronghold, and the poor people who made their living
-on the river were mercilessly preyed upon by the war parties of the
-contending factions, until none were left. Juan Rodriguez alone has
-managed to remain, but only by his fearless courage and the devotion of
-his followers. Neither side cared to provoke him in his security until
-Espinosa coveted his lands and his money and, who can say, maybe his
-beautiful daughter.”
-
-“Maria!” Sydney exclaimed.
-
-The native lowered his voice to a whisper.
-
-“Espinosa has had but one ambition all his life; to marry the daughter
-of Rodriguez; but she scorned him, and to save her from his persistent
-attention, Señorita Maria was sent away to Manila to school. Now he has
-robbed her of her father and stolen the treasure which had been hoarded
-for her. For many years Espinosa has been the head of the outlaws of
-Kapay. Holding positions of trust under Spanish rule, he directed
-the rebel movements and prevented their annihilation by the Spanish
-columns. This identical work he has attempted under the American rule,
-but his treachery has at last been exposed. Until he openly threatened
-the life of Rodriguez, none of us dared to thwart him. His murderers
-are everywhere, and his society of the Katipunan is far-reaching.
-Nowhere in the archipelago is one safe from their vengeance. Maria,
-woman as she is, has been marked for the assassin’s knife if she
-continues to refuse to become the wife of its leader. Garcia,
-Rodriguez’s trusted friend and overseer, was lured by terrible threats
-of vengeance and hopes of reward to betray his benefactor. He had been
-chosen by the society to commit the repulsive crime of murdering his
-friend. He came to the Rodriguez house intending to kill the father and
-carry away the daughter into captivity, which would have been for her a
-living death. Through the administering of the water and the voluntary
-confessions of Garcia, I have found out every motive which has actuated
-both Espinosa and Garcia. The would-be murderer entered the room of
-his victim, but in the light of the lamp could not bring himself to
-murder his lifelong friend. He at least had remaining some of the
-kindlier feelings in his heart. Turning out the light he was about to
-despatch him with a swift dagger thrust as he lay innocently sleeping;
-then hearing a noise on the stairs he withdrew into the darkness of an
-adjoining room. It was Señorita Maria and the two Americans who had
-remained to protect her. Seeing that to stay would mean discovery,
-he escaped by a window, intending to meet Espinosa and his men as
-they stole through the uproar of the bolo attack and tell him of the
-locality of the treasure. Espinosa is a leader of no mean order. His
-attack on the ranch was masterfully executed. Even though wounded, he
-came unhindered through the thick of the attack, with his body-guard
-of twenty faithful men. These were the ones who entered the house and
-carried away the treasure chests.
-
-“When Garcia, escaping, reached the ground, your trusty boatswain’s
-mate, O’Neil, was on the spot.”
-
-Major Lukban’s eyes were on his restive captive as he talked in low
-tones to Sydney.
-
-“We must keep an eye on him,” he continued. “He has given me so much
-information that he would be killed if he fell into Espinosa’s hands.
-Knowing the danger he runs, acting as our guide, he may attempt to
-escape.”
-
-The “Mindinao” was now where the dapper little colonel had taken his
-involuntary bath. The river had become sensibly narrower and the shores
-more treacherously rocky.
-
-The captive suddenly turned and excitedly spoke to Major Lukban in the
-native language, his gaze meanwhile roving over the cliffs just visible
-ahead.
-
-Lukban gave Sydney the man’s words in Spanish:
-
-“He says the gunboat can pass through the cañon, but you must keep
-close to the left hand shore to avoid the huge rocks which the
-insurgents will hurl from the top of the stronghold.”
-
-Sydney’s heart beat faster. They had not as yet come in sight of the
-whirling maelstrom of water as it hurled itself through the narrow
-gorge, but the top of the cañon was in plain sight. One huge boulder
-dislodged from the heights, striking the deck of the “Mindinao,” could
-easily pierce her frail steel shell.
-
-“Will you go through on the gunboat, sir?” Sydney asked the general
-eagerly as the “Mindinao” rounded a bend in the river, and the muddy
-racing water loomed ahead straight as if nature had laid a ruler along
-its path. About a mile away the other end of the cañon appeared, a
-white streak of light between the sombre rocks.
-
-The general regarded him in surprise.
-
-“How would you expect me to go?” he asked, a twinkle appearing in his
-eyes for a fraction of a second.
-
-“I was thinking of the danger, sir,” the lad added hurriedly in
-apology. “They’ll probably throw rocks down on us.”
-
-“The commanding general cannot always be three miles in the rear,” the
-veteran replied, now smiling broadly.
-
-Sydney had sent word to the engine room that he desired all speed
-possible and despite the current against them, the wooded shores were
-passed quickly.
-
-“To your guns,” he called in a clear voice without a note of
-excitement. “Major,” he added turning to the adjutant-general, “some of
-your best shots might take station to pick off the enemy on the cliffs.
-Those on this end I hope will be Phil and his friendly natives.” He
-turned suddenly pale as the possibility occurred to him of shelling his
-own people.
-
-The gunboat sped swiftly toward the cañon. Through glasses the jagged
-rocks at the top could be seen covered with a curious crowd of natives.
-Several sharp reports came muffled to his ears. The soft coo of
-the alarm concha vibrated above the stillness. He called his three
-gun-pointers up on the bridge and cautioned them with painstaking care
-of their important duty. “Shoot at the middle and the left; Captain
-Perry is on that mountain and I hope at this end. All three will fire
-together and I will control from here.”
-
-The men listened gravely and returned to their guns.
-
-“Load,” Sydney ordered harshly. The breech-blocks clicked shut and the
-crew stood expectantly alert. The soldiers, unaccustomed to artillery,
-unconsciously edged away from the three bow guns.
-
-“Set your sights at 1,500 yards,” Sydney directed, at the same time
-giving a signal to the helmsman to hold the ship steady on her course.
-
-“Fire when you’re on, aim at the edge of the rock,” he said in a tense
-voice.
-
-The three guns roared almost in unison and three black dots winged
-swiftly out toward the frowning cliffs ahead of the gunboat. Three dull
-brown splashes suddenly appeared just under the edge of the cliff and
-the reverberations died out slowly to an unearthly wail.
-
-“Seventeen hundred,” the lad cried out sharply, for the shots had
-fallen short of the mark.
-
-The sight-setters corrected their sights by a swift movement of the
-wheel under their hand and the air was again rent by the discharges.
-
-“Fine shots,” the general exclaimed excitedly as he leveled his glass
-at the top of the mountain where the three shells had exploded,
-scattering the rock and dirt in all directions and causing the
-inquisitive insurgents to hurriedly seek shelter.
-
-“Rapid fire,” Sydney ordered calmly and his voice had scarcely died
-away when a puff of white smoke belched from the stronghold.
-
-The lad’s heart almost stopped beating. Artillery he did not fear, if
-he could return the fire. He was confident that he could take care of
-himself with those three unerring guns, but this gun of the enemy was
-mounted just where Phil had warned him not to shoot. He sickened at the
-thought of disobeying the order, yet there was the menacing screech of
-the shell in his ears, as it struck the water only a few hundred yards
-ahead of his approaching gunboat.
-
-What else could he do? The gun must be silenced before the “Mindinao”
-could proceed, and the gorge was only a thousand yards ahead.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIX
-
-A WILLING CAPTIVE
-
-
-The sun was high the next morning before Phil awakened from his sound
-sleep. He had tossed on his hard bed listening to the half morbid
-ravings of poor Tillotson. Ever before him was the fear that after all
-he would be unable to save him. He knew only too well the difficulties
-that must be overcome before a rescue were possible. He recalled the
-difficult trails over which he and O’Neil had been led. At every point
-they had been under the eyes of unseen men on top of the mountain and
-within the range of modern rifles. There was not a tree nor rock large
-enough to offer cover to the men who on the morrow would assault the
-stronghold. His heart ever beat faster as he pictured the fight in his
-imagination: The natives behind intrenchments, cornered, no retreat
-open to them, fighting with the courage of despair; and the American
-soldiers, fearlessly charging upward, giving no heed to the danger at
-the top. On the summit, the lad knew, it would be a fight to the death.
-The part he was to play had seemed only too simple in the light of day,
-but now in the silence of the night, bound as he was hand and foot, and
-guarded by cruel enemies who would gladly shoot him down at the first
-show of force, all seemed different. O’Neil’s healthy body had long
-since been wrapped in slumber and when Phil’s feverish eyes opened he
-was up and seated calmly by the lad’s side.
-
-“There are over a thousand of these gugus here in the camp,” he
-exclaimed as Phil with difficulty arose and endeavored to stretch his
-cramped limbs. “I have been spying from the door there, and I see Lopez
-has encamped his men right at the top of the trail, and the men who
-were there have been sent somewhere else. The natives who are guarding
-us are our own men, and one of ’em tried to stick his bayonet in me
-when I asked him for some water to wash in. I wish they were not so
-careful of appearances,” he added with a grim smile.
-
-This was certainly cheering news. Lopez then had won his first point
-with the insurgent leader. Espinosa had believed his story.
-
-Lieutenant Tillotson still lay like a log, completely overcome from
-exhaustion, caused by his torture of yesterday. Phil looked with
-compassion on the weak, boyish face; he was breathing evenly, but his
-skin was of an unhealthy pallor.
-
-“He looks ill, sir,” O’Neil declared as Phil turned away with a sigh.
-“A few more days will do for him. He’s got too sensitive a nature for
-soldiering.”
-
-The doorway was darkened by the entrance of two natives. Phil regarded
-them coldly as they advanced, and led him not ungently by the arm out
-into the sunshine. There they cut his binding cords and gave both him
-and O’Neil a bucket of water to wash in. They had been on the point of
-arousing Tillotson by a cruel kick, but through Phil’s insistence, they
-left the shack without disturbing the sleeping man.
-
-After eating and enjoying a scanty breakfast, the two Americans
-surveyed with great interest the scenes about them.
-
-“Do you see that gun there, sir?” O’Neil exclaimed, suddenly nodding
-his head toward a Spanish howitzer mounted on the cliff just to the
-right of the trail. “It’s manned by Espinosa’s men!”
-
-“That’s bad,” Phil replied anxiously; “and you notice, it commands the
-river.”
-
-“Good-morning,” in Spanish from behind them caused Phil to swing about
-quickly and gaze into the amused but wicked eyes of Colonel Salas. “So
-we are to have the pleasure of your company as our guest, after all?”
-the Filipino continued tauntingly. “General Espinosa is making great
-preparations for your reception. It is needless for me to tell you how
-delighted he is that you have changed your mind. He was very angry at
-me for not insisting on your coming with me the other day.”
-
-Phil regarded the little native, a fine scorn in his eyes. He would
-have liked nothing better than to have answered him in the same
-ironical vein, but he realized that to do so and anger him would only
-make more difficult their position.
-
-“He will be here to pay his respects shortly,” Salas continued
-ironically. “Ah! here he comes now.”
-
-With his heart beating fast and the muscles in his throat tightening,
-Phil saw Espinosa sauntering toward them. He was dressed in the uniform
-of a Filipino general, made in the Spanish fashion, of a mouse-colored
-duck with a rolling collar, on which a silver star glistened. He came
-slowly forward, a wicked smile on his face.
-
-“Señor Perry! So! I have you now in my power?” he said in a low, hard
-voice. “I knew that my time would come. Your cleverness caused me
-some inconvenience. Colonel Martinez is still to be accounted for.
-But”--and he shrugged his shoulders--“that is but a matter of days.
-You can see that I am now master of the situation. I shall annihilate
-your untried, inefficient volunteers with as much ease as I can kill
-flies on the wall of a butcher shop. Your general dare not call in his
-men from the garrisons in the north. After I have worn out and killed
-those sent against me, then I shall attack Palilo itself. Then when I
-have the city in my hands and your general has withdrawn or surrenders,
-I shall wire to Manila my willingness to accept civil government. I
-shall go through the form of surrendering to the vanquished Americans,
-and shall be made the governor of Kapay. I shall then carry on my
-authority under your own flag. Is it not a very clever plan? Ah, there
-is one point that I have forgotten, a governor of an island as rich as
-Kapay must have a suitable dwelling. Very well. Señor Rodriguez is no
-more; his house is vacant and adequate for the worthy purpose; and the
-señorita--how well the title of wife to the governor of Kapay would
-become her!
-
-“So you see, señor, after all, Espinosa has lost nothing,” he ended
-with mock politeness.
-
-Phil glared angrily at this vain, boastful Malay half-breed. How dare
-he even think of marrying a girl like Maria Rodriguez? Phil knew that
-she would rather die first.
-
-“Every man in the American army will fight you to the last fence,” Phil
-exclaimed savagely. “Your villainy and treachery are too well known
-among even your own people, who serve you only through fear. You will
-never be made a governor under the civil government. That won’t aid you
-to carry out your vengeful purposes upon those whom you might choose
-to call your enemies.”
-
-Espinosa’s face paled slightly, and his eyes kindled in anger.
-
-“I am sorry that I cannot allow you to remain alive to see my prophecy
-come true,” he replied with a cruel shrug. “And before I am found out,
-as you Americans say, and displaced, I shall have enough money put
-aside in banks outside of the Philippines to live in ease and luxury
-for the remainder of my life.
-
-“These thoughts,” he added, “may cheer your last hours. It should be a
-pleasure to you to know that you haven’t done me as much harm as you
-supposed.”
-
-Phil glared at his tormentor, a bitter hatred in his eyes. How cleverly
-had this half-breed played upon the credulity of the Americans! For
-months this despicable native had ruled over both the warring parties;
-on one hand controlling the native bands of insurgents, telling them
-how, when and where to attack their enemy and then by his plausible
-words and treacherous cunning had exerted sufficient influence
-over General Wilson and his aides to enable him to so dispose the
-scattered American troops as to make them impotent, helpless against
-the insurgent ambushes and attacks. The lad noticed with a certain
-satisfaction that the native wore his left arm in a sling. Was that
-then the effect of his shot the night of the meeting of the Katipunan
-society? How he blamed himself for not having taken a more careful aim;
-he remembered with disappointment that when he had pulled the trigger
-of his revolver, his aim had been to the left of Espinosa’s body.
-Phil’s gaze was not lost on the half-breed. With a snarl he glanced
-down at his almost helpless arm.
-
-“For this I took Rodriguez’s life with my own hands, although Garcia
-had been chosen for the deed,” he exclaimed darkly, “and for this I
-shall force his daughter to become the wife of Manuel Espinosa.”
-
-Phil gasped, a flood of angry blood mounting to his temples.
-
-“It was I who fired the shot,” the lad cried exultantly, “and the next
-time you won’t get off so easily.”
-
-Espinosa in sullen rage regarded the angry midshipman through his
-slit-like eyes.
-
-“You?” he cried in unfeigned surprise. “How did you get there?”
-
-“I was there,” Phil replied quickly, a keen satisfaction entering his
-thoughts at being able to beard the lion in his den, “and afterward
-exposed you to the general--but,” he asked suddenly, “why did you
-desert? If you hadn’t we would have had a pleasant little hanging party
-in the Plaza the next morning.”
-
-Espinosa was evidently enraged at the lad’s daring words.
-
-“You are brave,” he said suddenly, a spark of suspicion coming into his
-mind, “to speak this way before me knowing that I can have you hung, or
-tortured, by simply giving the order.”
-
-“I know your yellow soul too well,” Phil declared in answer, “to
-believe that anything I might say now would influence the plan for
-revenge which you have already made. But I am curious to know why you
-left Palilo so suddenly. Did you believe that Rodriguez would betray
-you?”
-
-The outlaw glared at the midshipman, his hands twitching longingly to
-take forcible hold on his tormentor.
-
-“Because of that shot,” Espinosa answered finally, “I feared there
-might have been an enemy at the meeting and I feared Captain Blynn’s
-hand,--I would give a box of old Rodriguez’s gold to have him here a
-prisoner,” he added, a flash of terror in his eyes.
-
-“He may be here any moment now,” Phil said quietly. Then he would have
-bitten off his tongue as he saw the sudden gleam of suspicion in his
-enemy’s eyes.
-
-Espinosa gave the lad a searching look. “What do you mean?” he asked
-casting a glance of fear about him.
-
-“Oh, nothing,” the lad answered carelessly, “only he knows you killed
-Rodriguez, stole his money and tried to carry off his daughter; also
-by this time he will know that I’m a prisoner in your hands. And if
-for no other reason, you hold Lieutenant Tillotson, and his father is
-overturning the war department to rescue him. You made a bad fist of it
-there.”
-
-Phil had been watching the native leader’s anxious face, as he glanced
-about him as if half fearing the big American to appear suddenly from
-the ground. He now saw it light up with keen enjoyment as his eyes
-encountered something which amused him. Looking up quickly the lad
-uttered an exclamation of horror as he realized with overwhelming
-force the true position in which he had placed himself and his trusted
-boatswain’s mate.
-
-O’Neil, bound hand and foot, had been triced up, his toes just resting
-on the ground, and his strong bronzed face swollen and blue from a
-strangling rope knotted about his neck, the end thrown over a framework
-apparently built for this diabolical torture.
-
-Phil turned his face away. He saw as through a red mist the throngs
-of curious natives who had quickly gathered to see their enemy slowly
-murdered before their eyes.
-
-Espinosa gave a guttural order and immediately Phil was seized and
-forced to gaze at the revolting torture of his companion.
-
-“We shall not kill him yet,” Espinosa said, while he smiled in keen
-delight at the discomfited midshipman. “I have promised my men a field
-day. We have many amusing ways of treating our guests,--but,” he added,
-“before your turn comes I wish some information which I know you can
-give.
-
-“Where is General Wilson?” he asked anxiously, “and is it true that
-your gunboat is in the river?”
-
-“Where are your scouts?” Phil exclaimed haughtily. “Ask them, not your
-prisoner.”
-
-“I choose to ask my prisoner,” the native retorted with a meaning
-glance at those who held Phil’s head turned so that he must see out of
-the tail of his eyes the cruel suffering of O’Neil.
-
-“Your prisoner does not choose to answer,” the lad declared stoutly.
-
-The next second Phil was jerked suddenly upon his back, and his hands
-and feet hauled out, spread eagle fashion to stakes driven in the solid
-ground. He was quite helpless, and the pain in his arms and legs was
-excruciating. He opened his mouth to cry out when quickly a wedge of
-hard wood was inserted, holding his jaws wide apart.
-
-He closed his eyes and stiffened his muscle in a supreme endeavor to
-withstand the pain and prevent himself showing his suffering to the
-delighted natives.
-
-“Now maybe you will consider your answer--Colonel Salas, a little water
-may loosen his tongue,” he heard the cruel voice of Espinosa say.
-
-A horrible fear overcame the lad. The water cure was to be given
-him. He was to be half drowned. To be made to feel all the torturing
-sensations of a drowning man; not once but many times, until his
-spirit was broken and he would answer questions which would make him
-traitorously injure his own cause. His eyes opened, and he saw dimly
-Espinosa’s mocking face above him. The sun had flamed forth from under
-a cloud and burned down unmercifully on his staring eyes. He noted
-vaguely that it had passed the meridian. Then a terrible fear came into
-his mind. Where were the gunboat and the soldiers? Surely by this time
-they would have made their presence known. Had the gunboat run aground
-and the expedition been delayed? Would a delay mean death to him and
-O’Neil or only one more awful day of diabolical torture?
-
-“If you will cease torturing my man,” Phil said with difficulty through
-his wedged jaws, “I will answer your questions.”
-
-Espinosa laughed cruelly.
-
-“So you would dictate your own terms,” he cackled. “Colonel Salas, just
-a few cupfuls. Captain Perry seems thirsty.”
-
-Phil swallowed the water as it was poured down his throat, holding his
-breath long intervals at a time. It seemed to him that the water was
-never ending; he had swallowed quarts and yet he drank. Finally he
-could swallow no longer and yet the cruel hand above him poured the
-liquid without ceasing into his wide open mouth. The water splashed
-and ran out. He managed yet to breathe by contracting the muscles of
-his throat and then taking a slow breath but even then he felt the
-irritation of a few drops of water in his lungs and he knew if he
-coughed, as he must in a second, that all the water in his throat and
-mouth would enter his windpipe and fairly choke him. A feeling of
-suffocation oppressed him, as if a heavy weight lay pressing on his
-chest. He knew as yet he had not suffered, that this was but a taste of
-what was to come. Once more, this time as if from a great distance, he
-heard the cold, sinister voice of the half-breed.
-
-“Before it is too late,” he said, “will you answer my questions?”
-
-Phil opened his eyes and gazed at his tormentors. Then he closed them
-and steeled himself to what was to come.
-
-He felt his nose held securely by muscular fingers and his head thrown
-back, making a reservoir of his mouth, which was kept full of water.
-
-Just before he closed his eyes Phil had taken a full breath and now
-with his lungs full of air he knew that the agony was less than two
-minutes away. Strong swimmer as he was, he knew that was the limit of
-his endurance, and then afterward would come the sickening sensation
-of water agonizingly breathed into his lungs. Congestion would follow
-and if there was any trouble with his heart it would stop. If not,
-the cruel Colonel Salas who, with a delighted smile, was pouring the
-water, would stop and free the lad’s mouth of water, permitting him to
-regain his breath, working over him as if he were a half-drowned man,
-and after he had been brought to by artificial respiration, the cruel
-torture would be begun again and carried out until he agreed to do his
-enemy’s bidding.
-
-Those two minutes were the longest in the lad’s life. His entire past
-flashed before his eyes and he shed tears of disappointment at the
-thought that this might be his death. He wondered how much time had
-passed. Then he began to count the seconds, but soon stopped in horror;
-it was too much like self-destruction. He held his breath now tightly,
-allowing just a little air at a time to escape through his throat. He
-opened his eyes once or twice, but he could see nothing but a fiery
-sun overhead. He had the sensation that his entire body was swelling.
-Every vein seemed to have hardened. The sweat poured from his forehead,
-stinging his eyes.
-
-He could hold his breath no longer. His blood throbbed painfully in his
-temples. An awful nausea overcame him, and he gasped for air.
-
-Then a sharp sound as of the discharge of a cannon sounded in his ears
-and he fought and struggled with the strength of a score of men for the
-precious air.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XX
-
-THE STRUGGLE FOR THE STRONGHOLD
-
-
-While Phil and O’Neil were being tortured by Espinosa, Lopez had kept
-watch from his station, guarding the trail leading up the precipitous
-mountain from the valley below. His eyes fascinatedly held upon the
-scene in front of him had nevertheless guardedly turned backward,
-scanning anxiously the wooded foothills below him and the vista of
-the river as it entered the cañon. As yet no signs of the rescuers
-were visible. He trembled when he saw that Espinosa had determined to
-give the midshipman the water torture. But few white men had survived
-its harshness. Lopez’s face wore an increasingly anxious look as the
-minutes dragged into hours. The sun had passed the meridian and was
-dipping slowly in the western sky. His own men had not left their
-posts; each understood his duty; Rodriguez’s faithful followers alone
-had been selected to guard this southern bastion of the stronghold.
-The faithful native could see a handful of Espinosa’s men at the
-howitzer mounted to command the approach by water and farther along
-the edge of the precipice small knots of men squatting under shelters
-of bamboo. These latter he knew were to dislodge great boulders,
-which had been delicately balanced ready to be thrown downward, five
-hundred or more feet, into the racing river. Those who dared to enter
-the treacherous waters of the cañon must run the gauntlet of these
-huge rocks, but Lopez knew that the Americans would take any risk to
-reach the trail leading away from the stronghold and further into the
-mountain fastness, over which the trapped insurgents would endeavor to
-escape.
-
-Several hundred natives, their weapons in hand, had gathered about
-their cruel leader. Every eye was turned in rapt enjoyment toward the
-delighting spectacle of the torture of a despised American. None save
-Lopez and his faithful guards had observed the glint of steel far down
-in the valley below. None save he discerned two small white poles
-creeping along above the high trees on the river bank. He glanced
-uneasily toward the torture. Phil was on his back securely bound, while
-Colonel Salas held above his head a long bamboo cane filled with water.
-
-Lopez whispered an order to a native sergeant and the latter
-noiselessly edged his way in the direction of the sailor, now
-apparently senseless, deserted by those who had been torturing him, now
-that they were being indulged in a more interesting spectacle.
-
-Lopez, his heart beating and his bronze face set determinedly, watched
-the two topmasts of the gunboat as they traveled toward the bend in
-the river. The next second the “Mindinao’s” white bow came slowly,
-majestically from behind the land and turned gracefully up the river
-toward the cañon. At the foot of the trail khaki-clad figures suddenly
-appeared and mounted slowly up the narrow path. He could see the guides
-in front clearing and uncovering the treacherous man traps. His men
-had now seen the approaching deliverers and their black eyes snapped
-excitedly. Any one with half an eye would have known that something
-out of the ordinary was going forward. The eager brown soldiers of
-Rodriguez moved about restlessly, glancing excitedly down into the
-valley below them. Fortunately the leader and his followers were too
-absorbed in watching the suffering of poor Phil to take heed of the
-strange behavior of the deserters from Rodriguez.
-
-Lopez saw the little gunboat stop suddenly in the river and he observed
-plainly groups of men at the bow guns. Then came a flash of flame from
-her white hull and a reverberation which shook the mountain stronghold
-to its foundation.
-
-The tortured and half-dead Americans were forgotten; their captors had
-rushed away to see the meaning of this interruption. It was but the
-work of an instant for the watchful Lopez to sever with a few swift
-strokes of his bolo the cords that bound his white chief. O’Neil was
-likewise cut down, and the two nearly lifeless men were dragged to the
-safety of that part of the stronghold guarded by Lopez and his small
-band.
-
-Shell after shell came speeding up from the gunboat, and meanwhile the
-khaki-clad soldiers, unobserved, toiled onward up the slope.
-
-“To your posts,” Espinosa cried out in alarm. “Open fire with that
-gun.” The surprised and terrified leader raved like a madman, taking
-all to task for their stupidity. Phil had been released so promptly,
-while all was uproar and confusion, that as yet the insurgents had
-not realized that Lopez and his men were against them. Espinosa, in
-a fever of excitement, himself ran to the howitzer and with his own
-hands pointed and fired the first shot. But that was the last shot the
-gun would ever fire, for Lopez with a number of his men pushed quietly
-forward, cutting its binding ropes and shoved it over the edge of the
-cliff from which it crashed downward to the river below.
-
-Espinosa turned aghast and met the cold, defiant eye of Lopez. In them
-he read his doom. Lopez’s sharp bolo was already circling about his
-head. But the next second it had flashed harmlessly by and rattled on
-the rocky ground. Fearful of his life Espinosa had dodged the blow
-aimed at him and had taken flight, screaming as he ran for his men to
-open fire on the traitors. The shells of the gunboat seemed to fall in
-every part of the stronghold and the havoc of their explosions was
-terrible to witness; but the small band under Lopez remained unharmed.
-
-Mad with fear, the natives who had been witnessing Phil’s torture, upon
-hearing the terrifying words of their leader and seeing the awful havoc
-behind them caused by the bursting shell, charged boldly on the natives
-in their front, believing that in that direction lay their one avenue
-of escape, but a well directed volley from Lopez’s men made them recoil
-in disorder.
-
-Like one who is chained, powerless in the grip of an unnerving
-nightmare, Phil felt rather than saw the wild scenes about him. He
-heard the sharp rattle of musket fire and the sonorous discharge of
-cannon, the wild, vibrant cries of the natives as they dashed now
-forward and again retreating from the clash of contact and the avenging
-strokes of bayonet and bolo. By a mighty effort he struggled to his
-feet and leaned heavily for support upon the bamboo frame of his
-prison. His lungs seemed on fire and a red mist was still in his eyes.
-The riot of forms about him confused his brain and made him dizzy.
-Then his eyes fell upon the body of O’Neil lying on the ground where
-the natives had dragged him; the cruel marks of the rope stood out in
-blue welts on his muscular neck. His eyes were closed, but the lad saw
-with joy that he was alive. He knelt by the sailor’s side ministering
-to him as tenderly as if he were a child. Then in great anxiety he saw
-that Lopez’s men were slowly giving ground. Stubbornly they fought, but
-the overwhelming ranks of the enemy, now alive to the actual conditions
-and spurred forward by their leaders, came frantically forward across
-the open ground.
-
-Phil dragged the senseless body of the sailor back until they were on
-the very edge of the hill and then a sight which made him mad with joy
-caused him to stand upright and swing his hat jubilantly, unheeding the
-leaden missiles on all sides. There scarcely a hundred yards below him
-struggling forward and upward was Captain Blynn and his five hundred
-soldiers. Dropping the sailor’s head he rushed madly into the company
-of loyal natives.
-
-“Charge them,” he cried, beside himself with eagerness, for he saw
-that if the enemy, one thousand strong, should obtain possession of the
-top of the trail the struggling men below would never reach the top
-alive, and their retreat could mean but one thing--a rout and massacre.
-
-The natives did not understand the lad’s words, but his meaning was
-only too plain as he snatched a rifle from the ground and led the
-remnant of that plucky band.
-
-The next moment he was in the midst of the shrieking horde. In
-his nostrils was the reek of the Malay, almost sickening in its
-overpowering pungency. Blow after blow at his body he warded off with
-the barrel of his rifle.
-
-Now the savage horde had given way and his men had quickly closed in,
-warily protecting their flanks, knowing full well the cunning of their
-enemy. To his left the lad saw hundreds of natives hurling rocks into
-the river below them, and he cut a lane toward them, yelling to the
-loyal natives to prevent what he feared would be the destruction of his
-ship. From below the ominous rattle of a Colt gun gladdened his heart
-and he saw with delight the men on the cliffs flee in terror, leaving
-great boulders balanced menacingly on the very edge of the abyss. An
-American cheer rang out from behind him and he became dizzy with joy
-at the good news it brought. He read in the natives’ eyes a look of
-terror at the sudden appearance of an unlooked for enemy, and at the
-same instant he realized that if he and his loyal natives were to be
-saved he must extricate them from this dangerous position between the
-fire of the two opposing forces. He looked wildly about him for Lopez,
-but he was nowhere in sight, and already the soldiers had begun to
-open a withering fire in their direction. Mad with their exertions,
-brought suddenly face to face with the enemy, the soldiers would have
-no discretion; friend and foe alike were mixed in one writhing mass of
-brown.
-
-Then a sinister face showed itself on his right hand and all thoughts
-of safety were thrown to the winds. Espinosa, the tyrant and murderer,
-was within his reach. With a score of men as a body-guard he was
-hurrying away, deserting the field of battle. The midshipman pressed
-against the enemy to his right, fighting his way even through the
-remnant of the loyal natives, crying out to them to follow, while
-behind him he could hear the heavy footfalls of the soldiers.
-
-[Illustration: _HE GAZED DOWN INTO THE STILL FACE_]
-
-A body brushed him nearly off his feet and he turned toward it, his
-rifle raised as if to ward off an expected blow and then as his eyes
-fell upon the disheveled figure, he gave a cry of delight.
-
-“O’Neil,” he shouted above the noise of the fighting, as he put his arm
-about the great figure to steady himself from the force of the impact
-from the khaki-clad soldiers pressing eagerly upon them.
-
-“There’s that devil,” the sailor cried in smothered rage, and Phil saw
-with astonishment that O’Neil had naught but his bare hands though
-the lust of battle was in his eyes. The horror of his recent torture
-pressed heavily on his mind and he was bending every exertion to reach
-the retreating insurgent leader.
-
-So closely did the Americans press their foes that the lifeless body of
-Lieutenant Tillotson was abandoned, and Phil stopped, kneeling at his
-side and gazed down into the still face. There was a deep wound in the
-neck. Phil saw that the troubled spirit had been released. Ahead the
-pursuers had stopped and were firing fiercely in the direction of the
-retreating enemy.
-
-“We can’t allow Espinosa to escape,” the lad cried, aghast as he
-regained his men and saw with horror that many lay moaning on the
-ground.
-
-“They’re intrenched there, sir,” a sergeant exclaimed. “It would be
-suicide to charge them;” but Phil had gone too far and had suffered too
-much to be stopped by any thoughts of discretion or danger.
-
-“Charge, I say,” he cried; “that murderer Espinosa must not escape.”
-
-The sergeant from his security on the ground gazed up at the lad,
-believing quite properly that he had lost his mind, but before he could
-be stopped, Phil was beyond reach, charging blindly forward, while from
-the intrenchments came a volume of fire which it seemed folly to face.
-
-The seasoned old sergeant shook his head knowingly, but when an officer
-orders a charge there is but one thing to do.
-
-As one man the line arose from its shelter and raced madly after the
-midshipman.
-
-Hand to hand they battled--the natives with a courage born of
-desperation, for their backs were almost at the sheer edge of a
-precipice. Slowly they gave way before the onslaught of the Americans.
-
-Phil and O’Neil fought shoulder to shoulder and the lad in his weakened
-condition, bleeding profusely from a score of wounds, never more sorely
-needed the help that the brave sailorman could give.
-
-“He’s getting away,” O’Neil cried out in an agonized voice as the
-stubborn defenders fell one by one before the avenging bayonets.
-
-The natives died bravely, in fanatical fervor, fighting to the last
-man, not wishing nor asking for quarter. O’Neil and Phil at last stood
-upon the brink of a yawning chasm while they saw, far below them, and
-just disappearing within the shadow of the woods, a small band of
-natives, while there dangled from the rocks at their feet the severed
-end of a rope--the leader’s road to safety.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXI
-
-THE GUNBOAT TAKES A HAND
-
-
-Sydney gazed in consternation at the black speck clinging to the top of
-the cliff. His hands trembled excitedly as he held his glasses to his
-eyes focusing upon this spiteful piece of artillery.
-
-“We’ve got to silence that gun,” he said in a hoarse voice to Major
-Marble at his side, as he rang the engine room telegraphs for full
-speed astern. “They can’t miss us, and one shell would sink us. Yet
-Phil and O’Neil are probably there.”
-
-“There are our men, general,” Major Marble reported, pointing to a
-creeping point of color just emerging from the jungle and showing
-itself against the neutral tints of the treeless mountainside.
-
-“Make up your mind quickly, Mr. Monroe,” the general exclaimed
-anxiously. “Shell it, or else let’s try to get by; we can’t afford to
-leave the neck of the sack open for Espinosa and his cutthroats to
-escape.”
-
-Sydney saw there was no way out of the situation, save to silence
-the battery:--one shot through the boiler of the “Mindinao,” and the
-gunboat with all on board would be killed by the explosion or else
-drowned in the madly racing current of the river.
-
-“Take a few shots at that gun,” he ordered hoarsely. The gun-pointers
-when they heard the spiteful hiss of the enemy’s shell had, as though
-by an order, ceased their fire and waited obediently for the command
-which they felt sure the midshipman would give. They did not relish
-being fired upon and not allowed to return the fire.
-
-Sydney’s glasses were upon the cliff: he saw a group of struggling
-figures about the cannon, and then to his surprise and joy the black
-object detached itself and dropped swiftly to the water six hundred
-feet below.
-
-“Don’t fire,” he cried out quickly, but the gun-pointers through their
-sight telescopes had also been watching the struggle about their target
-and had waited.
-
-The lad rang up full speed ahead and again the gunboat sped toward the
-cañon.
-
-“Open fire on the left flank of the hill,” Sydney ordered.
-
-The three-pounders barked, and shell after shell was sent against the
-gathering crowds forming to attack the mere handful on the right, where
-the trail ended. The soldiers under Captain Blynn could now be plainly
-seen plodding upward.
-
-Sydney’s boyish nerves were at the highest pitch of excitement. He
-realized that he was to perform one of the most difficult feats of his
-life, and he had the life of a general of the army in his keeping. An
-error of judgment on his part would send them all to their deaths. He
-glanced searchingly at the frowning cliff, now scarcely a thousand
-yards away. He could plainly see that at the top a fierce fight was
-raging. The narrow gorge ahead seemed barely wide enough to permit the
-gunboat to pass, and above it, he knew only too well great boulders
-were standing ready to be dropped like meteors on the frail deck of the
-“Mindinao.”
-
-“Are you ready there with the Colt gun?” he called loudly to the
-sailors in the foretop, where the gun was mounted.
-
-There was no answer; a glance aloft showed him the crew of the gun
-grouped anxiously about it.
-
-“Jammed again, I suppose,” he exclaimed.
-
-Closer and closer loomed the cañon.
-
-“Look out for the prisoner,” Sydney cried out as he saw the native,
-his hands on the rail, about to leap overboard. Major Marble was
-near enough to grasp him and the next minute ready hands had bound
-him securely to the rail and from there he gazed up in terror at the
-rapidly approaching cliffs.
-
-“There goes the first one,” Sydney exclaimed excitedly as a great
-boulder swayed unsteadily and then rolled slowly over the edge of the
-chasm and descended with the speed of a shooting star. Every man on the
-gunboat was on his feet; above them now was the camp of the outlaws,
-and several hundred such boulders were there ready to be dropped upon
-their defenseless heads. The firing of the “Mindinao’s” guns had long
-since stopped as the elevation was much too great.
-
-With a terrific splash which hurled the water completely over the bow
-of the gunboat, the first rock took the water; but another and another
-followed it in rapid succession, and so close did they fall that
-Sydney felt the rushes of air caused by their passage. General Wilson
-stood calmly by as unconcerned as though he were only a spectator at
-a display of fireworks. Major Marble paced rapidly across the bridge,
-his hands nervously clutching a rifle which every few seconds he would
-discharge at the frowning cliffs above him.
-
-To add to the danger there now came the song of enemy’s bullets while
-the water near the gunboat became disturbed as if from the fall of
-hail. Occasionally there was heard a commotion forward and a man sorely
-hit would be carried below decks to be attended by the hospital corps
-located in the men’s quarters.
-
-Many of the soldiers and sailors had now opened fire with their
-rifles, but the falling rocks disconcerted them. Suddenly the Colt gun
-commenced its sharp drumming discharge. Sydney glanced aloft. He could
-see his crew directing the stream of lead slowly covering every point
-of the cliff ahead.
-
-A cry of delight rose from the Americans, and a cheer broke out from
-the anxious but relieved men as they noted the immediate effect of the
-leaden stream. As it swept along the cliffs, those who stood ready to
-project the balanced rocks upon the heads of their enemy had taken
-fright, and instead of waiting until the gunboat was immediately
-beneath them, had in their impatience let go their rocks, and they were
-falling harmlessly in the water ahead of the gunboat. Sydney steered as
-near the opposite shore as he dared, fearing that a boulder might have
-closed the channel. On top of the cliff the sound of strife could still
-be heard.
-
-Major Marble and Major Lukban anxiously questioned the prisoner. He
-alone knew the whereabouts of the trail which Espinosa and his men
-relied upon to furnish an avenue of escape in case the stronghold
-was successfully attacked. The Filipino officer held his revolver
-threateningly before the frightened native’s eyes.
-
-“If you allow us to pass it, I’ll have no mercy,” he exclaimed.
-
-The “Mindinao” had now emerged from the dangerous cañon and the sound
-of firing above became less distinct.
-
-General Wilson was becoming impatient. He had held himself well in
-hand to steady the officers and men under him during the trial through
-which they had passed so successfully. Now his anxiety was more than he
-could keep to himself. He rushed up to the cringing native, taking him
-roughly by the shoulders and crying out to him in English, a language
-unintelligible to the terrified prisoner.
-
-But the general’s act was crowned with success. The insurgent soldier
-had steeled himself against the threats of Major Lukban, even
-reinforced as they were with the deadly revolver held to his head, but
-the wildly gesticulating general had put a terrible fear into his soul.
-Like all orientals he reverenced and feared rank, and this taciturn
-American general had so suddenly turned upon him that he was too
-frightened to do aught else but tell the truth.
-
-“Back there is the place,” the native cried in his own language, and
-Major Lukban in feverish haste translated the man’s words, while
-Sydney swung the gunboat about, reversing his engines at full speed to
-keep from grounding on the rocky shores, and giving small thought to
-the dangers of the madly racing current.
-
-Within ten minutes, which seemed ages to the eager Americans, the
-“Mindinao” was anchored in the river and the troops were landed.
-
-Major Lukban with the guide, whose hands were securely bound to prevent
-his escape, led the party through the tangled underbrush over the
-secret trail which without the aid of one who had been there before
-would have been impossible. Tediously the distance was covered, the
-sounds of battle ever becoming more distinct. General Wilson’s age was
-no handicap to him as he eagerly pressed forward behind the native
-guides.
-
-The enemy, by the volume of rifle fire which came down to the ears
-of the anxious column of soldiers, were making a desperate stand to
-recover the advantage lost by the suddenness of the surprise, and
-so absorbed were they with Captain Blynn’s men that those under the
-general’s command stood on the level plateau of the mountain before
-their presence was discovered. The sight of this unexpected force
-turned the tide for the Americans and the terrified insurgents threw
-away their arms and huddled together, expecting to be executed by their
-enemy without mercy.
-
-General Wilson quietly controlled his eager soldiers, bent upon
-annihilating these treacherous brown men now within their power. The
-soldier mind knew but one style of warfare with a savage foe. No
-quarter had been the insurgent watchword. Kill! kill! had frequently
-rung in their ears as the fanatical hordes had charged down upon them
-on many a battle-field.
-
-“Cease firing!” General Wilson’s commanding voice rang out above the
-discharges of musketry, and the bugles signaled the order across the
-battle-field. “Major Lukban, tell them no harm will come to them if
-they submit without further resistance,” he cried to the native officer
-at his elbow, pointing toward the panic-stricken hundreds.
-
-The Filipino major calmly walked forward, his hands held above his head
-in sign of peace, and raised his voice in his native language. A hush
-fell upon the babbling throngs, while the terror in their eyes slowly
-died out and they dropped on their knees, giving thanks for their
-miraculous deliverance.
-
-Major Marble and the native officer went fearlessly among the natives,
-leading them to a point near the river, and placed guards over them
-to prevent their escape and then, seeing that a struggle was still
-going forward on the eastern side of the mountain, gathered a force of
-soldiers about him and hastened to aid those still in the throes of
-combat.
-
-Almost out of breath the reinforcing column arrived in time to greet
-Phil and O’Neil standing on the brink of the precipice and hear their
-exclamations of disappointment at the escape of the coveted insurgent
-leader.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXII
-
-THE ESCAPED OUTLAW
-
-
-Lukban was the first to recover from the stunning news that Espinosa
-had, by a miracle, escaped out of the Americans’ hands when all outlets
-were supposed to have been covered.
-
-“He doesn’t dare stay in Kapay,” the native exclaimed after Phil had
-explained to the general the manner of his escape. “The natives fear
-him, but without his followers and with the incumbrance of Rodriguez’s
-treasure, the dangers he must face will make him do his utmost to leave
-the island.”
-
-General Wilson listened intently, his eyes wandering over the
-victorious battle-field behind him where Captain Blynn’s men were
-quietly disarming the now docile natives.
-
-“I fear we cannot stop him now,” General Wilson said disappointedly,
-“but I suppose we should be satisfied with our victory. This means the
-end of the war on Kapay.”
-
-Lukban had turned and was earnestly engaged in conversation with Lopez,
-and then he asked several eager questions of Garcia, who had joined the
-group. Finally he turned to General Wilson, his black eyes snapping
-with renewed eagerness.
-
-“Lopez wishes to follow him,” he exclaimed excitedly. “He will take his
-hundred men, who are only too anxious to see him captured and punished
-for his many crimes, and especially for the murder of Señor Rodriguez.
-If he is pressed closely he will make for the nearest point of escape
-which by the trail is Banate. This Garcia assures me was his intention
-if he was defeated. Garcia wishes to go with Lopez, and he can arrange
-a signal by fires on the hill behind the swamps to be seen by the
-gunboat at sea. The gunboat must go down the river at once and at sea
-await the signal. Espinosa must attempt his escape by proa to Megras.
-It is only fifty miles away and if he reaches there he will be safe for
-the time among his friends living on that island.”
-
-Phil’s face suddenly beamed in smiles as Lukban’s plan slowly unfolded
-before him. Highly delighted, he shook hands enthusiastically with the
-speaker, until the latter cried out in pain from the well meant but
-rough show of appreciation.
-
-“Major Marble and I will return with you at once,” General Wilson added
-quietly to Phil after he had in but a few words approved the proposed
-plan. “Blynn can settle the question of prisoners. I’d like to have
-Espinosa behind bars before I wire to Manila giving them this news.”
-
-Phil solemnly told of the sad fate of Lieutenant Tillotson and the
-general shook his head mournfully.
-
-“Maybe it is better so,” he whispered half to himself, but to Phil,
-standing close by, these words from the old soldier’s heart came
-distinctly.
-
-A detail of men carried the body of the dead officer across the
-battle-field, and as they passed solemnly through the joyful troops who
-had collected to cheer the white-haired veteran, the soldiers became
-suddenly silent as their eyes fell upon the stretcher and were told the
-identity of that figure underneath the flag. None had reverenced the
-officer in life, but in death all were anxious to render respect.
-
-Phil told the general of the pitiful plight of Lieutenant Tillotson,
-and of the cruel manner of his death, and generously praised the
-doubtful courage of the army man.
-
-“It’s a glorious end for a soldier,” General Wilson murmured. “I have
-always felt that I could welcome it, and now,” he added disappointedly,
-“I shall probably die in my bed like an ordinary citizen. My career is
-almost over; in another year I shall have left active service behind.”
-
-While the general and his party climbed down the difficult trail to
-reach the gunboat at anchor in the river below them, Lopez and Garcia
-with their trusty company had nimbly descended the almost precipitous
-side of the mountain and were eagerly following the trail of the
-fleeing insurgent and his ill-gotten spoils.
-
-The “Mindinao” steamed fearlessly down the river, her flag at half-mast
-in honor of those whose mortal remains lay covered on the quarter-deck;
-the soldiers who had given their lives in the attack on the most
-formidable of insurgent strongholds. Phil and O’Neil were given
-prompt attention by the surgeon and several ugly wounds were carefully
-dressed. Phil was glad to relinquish his command to Sydney and remained
-luxuriously in his cot.
-
-At Rodriguez’s ranch the gunboat stopped and reverently landed the dead
-heroes, to be buried in the cemetery, and here General Wilson and his
-adjutant-general disembarked to return to Palilo by road.
-
-Just as the “Mindinao” started ahead, after landing her passengers,
-on its way to the mouth of the river, a native canoe paddled rapidly
-from the landing, and ran up alongside of the gunboat. An excited hail
-came from its occupant, answered by an angry cry from Major Lukban
-who turned, his face deathly pale, and his hands trembling, to the
-midshipmen at his side.
-
-“Señorita Maria is missing,” he gasped.
-
-The midshipmen were stunned at the suddenness of this unexpected and
-disquieting news. Maria captured! What did it mean?
-
-Lukban declared that his first duty was to his young mistress and the
-lads heartily approved of his desire to be landed to attempt to trail
-the lost girl and her brother.
-
-The excited native was brought on board from his canoe and told the
-eager men the meagre details of her loss.
-
-She and Juan had gone out to the cemetery in the morning, and had not
-returned. A search had been made in the afternoon and the footprints
-of men had been discovered, showing that the girl had fallen into the
-hands of a party of natives.
-
-The midshipmen bade good-bye to their native friend who entered the
-canoe and paddled shoreward, and then Phil rang for full speed ahead on
-the engines.
-
-“The loyalty of these natives to the Rodriguez family is touching,”
-Sydney exclaimed in admiration. “Garcia alone betrayed his friend; but
-he did it through superstitious fear of the Katipunan society. Lopez is
-as staunch as a rock, and Lukban, you can see, would lay down his life
-willingly for his young mistress.”
-
-Two hours later the “Mindinao” had steamed through the harbor of Palilo
-and turned her bow northward.
-
-During the night Sydney and O’Neil took turns with Phil in standing
-watch on the gunboat’s bridge, carefully searching the shore for the
-signal agreed upon with Lopez. Would he succeed in coming up with the
-fleeing outlaw?
-
-The night wore slowly along and morning dawned clear, finding all three
-of the Americans up and on the bridge of the rapidly moving vessel.
-
-No sails were in sight. A wide expanse of water was before them, while
-on the port hand the low swamp land of Banate was in plain sight.
-
-Phil steered his ship in toward the bamboo town nestling in the hollow
-of two small hills in the midst of the swampy mouth of the Mani River.
-As they approached, the Americans could discover naught but the usual
-listless life of a Filipino village.
-
-“I’ll patrol here,” Phil said, as he steered further offshore.
-
-All day long the gunboat steamed backward and forward over fifteen
-miles of coast line. An occasional sail was sighted and overhauled,
-only to find in it a handful of frightened fishermen.
-
-As night approached the gunboat was brought to a stop in the centre
-of the line of patrol in order that it might be at an equal distance
-from all possible points of departure, in case Espinosa had eluded his
-pursuers.
-
-“If he has a proa in waiting, hidden in the swamps of one of these
-estuaries, he will choose night for his escape,” Phil declared as he
-studied his inaccurate chart, “and at night he can easily elude us, for
-it is too dark to see a half mile. Our only hope is that there will be
-no wind, and if the air is sufficiently calm we can hear the dip of
-oars for miles.”
-
-Phil stationed his sailors as lookouts everywhere, with orders to
-listen alertly and make known to him if they heard the slightest sound.
-
-The night drew on. The others had gone below for their broken night’s
-sleep, and Sydney was alone on the bridge. A half dozen lookouts were
-alert, peering into the night, their energies bent on catching the
-faintest sound from the distant shore.
-
-Suddenly Sydney’s ears caught a dull sound which seemed to come from
-the direction of the land. He listened intently, his breath held
-tight. The dawn wind brought to his nostrils the sweet damp smell of
-earth mingled with the pungent odor of smoke from the early morning
-fires of the villagers.
-
-All lights were extinguished on the “Mindinao” and the midshipman knew
-that the vessel was, even at a short distance, invisible.
-
-Now the sound came distinctly to his ears. It was the steady dip of
-oars and their rattle in the locks. He could hear the low muffled swish
-as the blades shook themselves clear of the water.
-
-Several of the lookouts reported in whispers the presence of the
-strange craft.
-
-Gradually the sound approached, the boat invisible, while slowly the
-gray streak of dawn spread in the east. The sound was now located ahead
-and the boat appeared to be traveling fast, doubtless propelled by both
-oars and sail. Was it only a fisherman going out early to spread his
-nets? Or was it the outlaw Espinosa attempting escape, and carrying off
-Rodriguez’s gold and the more precious treasures, Maria and Juan?
-
-Sydney sent one of the men to call Phil to the bridge immediately.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIII
-
-COLONEL MARTINEZ
-
-
-Maria watched with a heavy heart her young friend Phil Perry go
-cheerfully away to put himself in the hands of the cruel native leader
-in his endeavor to save the life of a brother officer.
-
-“I never expect to see him alive again,” she whispered sorrowfully to
-her small brother as he stood with big round eyes of wonder gazing at
-the military preparations for the attack on the insurgent stronghold.
-
-The next day she and Juan gazed wistfully after the long column of
-khaki-clad American soldiers as they filed silently past the ranch
-house, taking the trail over which she and her American friends had
-ridden so merrily but a few days before.
-
-The guard left at the ranch, consisting of two companies of soldiers,
-quietly stationed its sentries and took up the monotonous routine of
-guarding the many supplies which were arriving by boats from Palilo.
-
-For several long hours the girl brooded over the situation, wondering
-how she could aid the friends for whom she had learned to hold a high
-regard. Bemoaning the fate that had made her a helpless woman, she
-took Juan by the hand and strolled away up the wooded slope toward the
-family burying grounds where the body of her father peacefully rested.
-Reaching the newly made mound she placed upon his grave the handful of
-flowers which she had gathered. In her heart was a great bitterness.
-Juan, too young to appreciate the magnitude of his loss, chased
-gleefully the monkeys which chattered in the trees about him, leaping
-almost into his arms as they eluded his embrace. Following her brother
-Maria listlessly strolled farther into the gloom of the forest.
-
-Suddenly a low whistle from deeper in the woods attracted her
-attention. With startled eyes she stopped, her head erect and her bosom
-heaving in sudden fright.
-
-[Illustration: _A MAN STEPPED SILENTLY FROM BEHIND A TREE_]
-
-A man stepped silently from behind a tree and walked toward her. With a
-glad cry she ran to him. It was the officer known to the Americans
-as Colonel Martinez.
-
-“I have heard,” he said sorrowfully as the girl incoherently sobbed
-the sad news of her father’s death. “I would have come sooner, but I
-believed the Americans would have been strong enough to prevent it.”
-
-“His last words were for you, Gregorio,” Maria whispered as he patted
-caressingly her straight black hair. “He hoped that you would follow
-his example and surrender to General Wilson. Why do you not take your
-own name again?”
-
-“Sister,” the insurgent officer answered earnestly, “when my father
-disowned me for fighting under Aguinaldo in the north, I took the name
-of Remundo, and because I would not surrender after most of my men had
-been killed or captured I have been declared by the government of the
-islands an outlaw, and a price was put on my head. I am accused of many
-crimes of which I am not guilty. I have an enemy, who now stands high
-in government favor. It was he who harried the country using my name
-falsely, and for his deeds I am blamed. Captain Blynn has my written
-proofs. So you see I could not comply with our father’s wish before,
-but now I am willing to lay down my life in order that Juan Rodriguez’s
-soul may rest in peace, which it cannot do until his murderer has
-received his just punishment.”
-
-While they talked Gregorio Rodriguez had taken the small hand of Juan
-in his own, leading his sister along a tiny trail away from the river.
-
-“I have a few trusty followers awaiting me a short distance beyond,”
-he added, “and I wish you both to come with me. Your lives are too
-precious to allow you to be out of my sight.”
-
-Maria smiled happily and pressed her brother’s hand.
-
-After a quarter of an hour’s walk the forest opened and they found
-themselves in the midst of a company of native soldiers. The men arose
-from the ground as their leader passed, doffing their hats to the woman
-walking so proudly with their officer. Gregorio stood silently in their
-midst, holding up his hand to demand attention.
-
-In a few short lines he told his men of his real identity and of the
-horrible murder of his father by Espinosa; of the expedition which he
-had watched start out to attack the stronghold. To serve their best
-interests, he told them he should surrender with his force to the
-Americans, who would give them all fair and honorable treatment. Then
-he raised his voice and excitedly cried:
-
-“Those who still desire to fight against their own interests under a
-traitor and a murderer may go forth unmolested. At once!” he cried,
-pointing to the trail leading inland, while his black eyes flashed.
-
-Not a man gave ground; all looked trustfully up to their leader.
-
-“Viva los Americanos,” one shouted and the woods rang with their lusty
-cheers.
-
-“Will you come to the ranch with me and surrender there to the
-Americans?” Maria asked, after the cheering had died away.
-
-Gregorio shook his head.
-
-“My first quest is Espinosa,” he replied earnestly. “At once we shall
-march toward the stronghold. If he is captured or killed in the battle
-I shall seek General Wilson and surrender myself and men. If Espinosa
-escapes I shall follow him to the death.”
-
-Maria knew the native spirit too well to attempt to urge her brother to
-give up this perilous quest of their father’s murderer, so she bowed
-her head submissively.
-
-An hour saw the band on the march, with Maria and Juan mounted on two
-ponies; quietly the native soldiers led by Gregorio Rodriguez circled
-the Americans encamped at the ranch and struck the trail taken in the
-morning by Captain Blynn and his five hundred soldiers.
-
-Long before they came in sight of the stronghold the distant rumble of
-musketry and the thunder of artillery told them of the struggle at the
-top of the mountain.
-
-Despairing of reaching the battle-field by the treacherous trail
-already covered by the Americans, Gregorio led his party to high ground
-across the valley from Matiginao. They arrived breathlessly at the
-summit and viewed the distant figures of men fighting in a hand-to-hand
-struggle.
-
-Maria gasped in fear as she comprehended the awful sight of the
-struggle.
-
-“The Americans are victorious,” Gregorio exclaimed excitedly as he
-saw the wave of khaki sweep from two sides across the broad plateau.
-He saw the native insurgents huddled together in the centre of the
-American soldiers. But his eager eyes followed a small band of
-Americans and natives on the right of the mountain; he saw the natives
-in front of them give way slowly, contesting the battle-field foot by
-foot, while behind them he saw several score more of natives reach the
-edge of the plateau and rapidly disappear down the sheer side of the
-cliff.
-
-“They are escaping,” he cried in sudden alarm. “See, they are holding
-the Americans back to give those fleeing time to escape. It’s
-Espinosa,” he shouted hoarsely, beside himself with apprehension.
-
-Between him and the valley at the foot of the precipice, Gregorio knew
-were many miles of impenetrable jungle, through which there was no
-trail. Yet he must push through this formidable barrier in an effort to
-cut off his enemy’s escape. Calling up one of his trusty lieutenants he
-gave Maria and Juan in his charge.
-
-“Take the trail and join the Americans,” he ordered his sister.
-“Come,” he commanded, selecting a score of men by a motion of his
-hand. In another minute Gregorio, followed obediently by his selected
-followers, had plunged through the dense woods straight down the
-mountainside toward the avenue of escape over which Espinosa would soon
-be traveling, while Maria and her guard left their place of vantage and
-headed for the distant mountain top now in the hands of Captain Blynn
-and his victorious men.
-
-Laboriously, but spurred forward by the eagerness of their leader,
-Gregorio and his small band toiled through the dense jungle. The
-distance was slowly covered and, almost exhausted, they were finally
-rewarded by reaching the trail leading from the stronghold to the
-northward.
-
-Gregorio uttered an exclamation of surprise as his knowledge of
-woodcraft told him that a large force of men had recently passed over
-this road. Surely he had seen but a few score escape from the plateau.
-
-Nothing daunted, in the lead, he urged his men forward. He would
-attack, no matter what were the odds against him. Espinosa should not
-escape!
-
-After several hours of strenuous marching a straggler was found on the
-side of the trail and after a hasty interview gave the anxious native
-the good tidings that Lopez was ahead on the same quest as himself.
-
-Hurrying forward, most of the time on a run, he overtook his father’s
-faithful servant just before darkness arrived, and together,
-unsparingly, they urged onward their tired men.
-
-Gregorio’s keen eyes were ever on the trail; in his heart was a
-desperate resolve. The thought of escape of Espinosa maddened him
-beyond endurance. The newly made grave in the family burying grounds
-spurred him on to almost superhuman exertions. Lopez, hardened as he
-was to toil in the fields, kept pace with his untiring young master,
-but many of the pursuing natives were left far behind.
-
-“We are nearly to Banate,” Lopez said intensely as they saw the high
-jungle slowly merge into nipa swamp. The cocoanut palms were becoming
-more and more infrequent and the mud of the trail clung to their tired
-feet.
-
-So silently had they approached the little settlement at the foot of
-the hills rising from the delta of the river that the sudden barking
-of a dog caused them to stop in consternation.
-
-With eyes open wide with anxiety and apprehension, Gregorio and Lopez
-pressed onward through the narrow street. They saw the natives were not
-as yet awake, the houses were closed and no human being was visible. On
-the ocean beach they saw many native boats hauled high above the tide.
-Anxiously they visited each in turn, but all were abandoned.
-
-The sandy soil gave them no news of their quarry. Many footmarks
-were evident, but the tracks were so crossed and recrossed that even
-Gregorio gave up all hope of learning from them the direction taken by
-Espinosa and his men.
-
-Gregorio stood in deepest dejection at the edge of the beach; his eyes
-sorrowfully scanned the dark waters. Had Espinosa turned off into
-the jungle, allowing him to go by, chuckling in his sleeve at the
-cleverness of his ruse? or had he embarked, and was he now sailing
-rapidly away toward freedom and wealth? Many of the straggling natives
-had now gathered about their chief and waited for his orders. They had
-ruthlessly entered the huts of the sleeping villagers and had dragged
-several of them trembling before their leaders.
-
-“But a half hour ago a large proa was launched from down the beach,” a
-native villager spoke up. “It had been waiting, and we were commanded
-to keep indoors on penalty of being shot. Through my bamboo shutter I
-saw it start.”
-
-Gregorio waited for no further words. Hastily turning to Lopez and
-Garcia he cried eagerly:
-
-“Light three fires on the top of the hill, the signal to the gunboat.”
-Then without spoken orders a half score of men helped the anxious
-Gregorio launch one of the small fishing boats lying high on the beach.
-As Lopez and his men hurried away, the native boat, with Gregorio at
-the helm, hoisted its bamboo sail to catch the light morning breeze and
-disappeared into the night.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIV
-
-THE GUNBOAT ON GUARD
-
-
-“There’s a fire ashore there, sir,” a lookout called in an eager voice
-as Phil accompanied by O’Neil stepped on deck, and the midshipman’s joy
-was unbounded as he saw three points of light gradually grow into three
-unmistakable fires.
-
-“The signal,” he exclaimed. “We’ve got him. He can’t escape us now.”
-
-Eagerly he listened to the sweet music of those hollow sounds caused
-as he knew by the play of the oars in their rowlocks. Scarcely a half
-mile away was Espinosa, blissfully unconscious of the presence of his
-sentinel gunboat. Then a great fear came into his mind as he thought of
-the cargo the approaching boat might be carrying. Were Maria and her
-brother captives of this cruel villain?
-
-The anxious midshipman rang the engine bell for full speed ahead and
-the little gunboat quickly leaped to life. Espinosa was as good as
-captured. Inside of an hour day would break.
-
-“Keep a sharp lookout,” he shouted. The gunboat’s bow had turned
-directly for the sound of the passing boat and he did not know at what
-moment it would appear suddenly from out of the darkness ahead.
-
-Sydney and O’Neil stood beside Phil as the gunboat rushed forward.
-
-“That’s Espinosa, all right,” O’Neil exclaimed joyfully as he went
-below, after taking a look about him, to get the forward three-pounder
-ready.
-
-The two midshipmen strained their ears in vain into the night, but no
-sound of their quarry was evident.
-
-The gunboat was again stopped and the word passed for silence. A
-stillness crept over the gunboat. The sailors stood alert, silent in
-strained attitudes of listening, but no sound could be heard to cheer
-the now depressed Americans.
-
-“They’ve stopped rowing,” Sydney exclaimed, “and with this breeze they
-must be going away from us fast.” The midshipmen gazed at each other in
-consternation. What should be done? Should they steam ahead blindly,
-awaiting the day? Might not the proa have discovered the presence of
-the gunboat and changed its course? Both knew that ten miles to the
-eastward treacherous coral reefs covered the sea, through which the
-gunboat must navigate cautiously, even if it were possible to go at
-all. Was the outlaw again to escape? Then their attention was attracted
-by a new sound as the chug of oars came to their ears, but this time
-from a direction opposite to that taken by the first boat.
-
-“It’s a second boat,” Phil exclaimed in a troubled voice. “What can it
-mean?” The noise of the approaching boat came closer and closer and
-then suddenly out of the night a great sail appeared, while a Spanish
-hail drifted across the waters:
-
-“Espinosa is in a proa ahead of us. This is Colonel Martinez.”
-
-Both lads recognized their friend’s voice, even before he declared his
-identity, and now with his mind made up that he must act quickly, Phil
-called back:
-
-“I shall steam directly ahead for the reefs; stand by to take a line.”
-
-The active natives caught the tow-line heaved to them from the stern
-of the gunboat, and the “Mindinao” at full speed raced toward the gray
-in the eastern sky, while the proa astern lowered her sail and leaped
-joyfully in tow of the steamer.
-
-O’Neil stood like a statue at the bow’s gun, his eyes endeavoring to
-pierce the gloom ahead. His eager eyes were conscious of the growing
-light. Farther and farther his range of vision grew; now a mile of
-sea on either bow was in sight, but barren of sail. Then from out the
-dissolving mist, the sailor saw a dim shadow and knew that the quarry
-at last was found and in easy range.
-
-“I see her, sir,” he hailed joyfully. “Can I give her a polite
-invitation to heave to?”
-
-“Don’t hit her, O’Neil,” Phil answered excitedly; “put a shell as close
-as you can. She’s nearly up to the reefs.”
-
-A roar and a blinding flash was O’Neil’s answer to his captain’s words.
-
-Shell after shell was hurled after the fleeing boat but the Americans
-could see no inclination to obey the order of the challenge. Now
-silhouetted against the eastern sky, with a great spread of sail,
-Espinosa was straining everything to escape. From out the sea ahead a
-fiery sun arose, throwing its brilliant light into the eyes of those on
-the gunboat.
-
-“Be careful, O’Neil,” Phil urged earnestly. “Señorita Rodriguez may be
-in that boat.”
-
-“She’s safe with our soldiers,” Sydney called from the deck below, at
-hearing his friend’s caution. “I’ve just talked with Martinez astern.”
-
-“Put a shot in that boat,” Phil cried, and the roar of the
-three-pounder echoed his words.
-
-Then suddenly a gentle tremble of the “Mindinao” made her young captain
-turn pale, as he rang for full speed astern.
-
-“We’re on the reef,” he cried in anguish. “What shall we do? Hit her,
-O’Neil,” he called beside himself; “he must not escape.”
-
-Sydney had rushed aft with several sailors close at his heels and
-taking the tow-line of the native boat astern, they hauled it up clear
-of the backing screws until the outrigger was alongside the gangway.
-
-“Make room for ten of our sailors,” he shouted to Martinez. “We want
-men who know how to shoot.”
-
-While the water boiled above the swiftly revolving propellers slowly
-hauling the gunboat backward from its perilous position on a coral
-reef, all but two of the natives in the fishing boat climbed nimbly
-aboard and ten eager sailors, their rifles in hand, scrambled in.
-
-The sharp detonations of the three-pounder added to the confusion of
-the scene.
-
-As he saw the “Mindinao” was again afloat, Phil turned his eyes to the
-fleeing enemy. The boat, still untouched, was sailing swiftly away with
-an ever-increasing breeze behind it. Then his eyes opened in surprise
-and joy as he saw what Sydney had been doing.
-
-“Come on, O’Neil, she’s nearly out of range,” he called excitedly. The
-sailor turned, took in the situation at a glance and seizing a rifle
-from a sailor near him followed his captain.
-
-“She’s dropped her sail,” he cried, as a swift look over his shoulder
-to mark the effect of the last shot revealed but a small black speck on
-the water.
-
-“I am sorry, Syd, but I must leave you to look out for the ship,” Phil
-said as he leaped for the side of the native boat and grasped Colonel
-Martinez’s hands. “Keep us in sight and see if you can work her through
-the reefs.”
-
-Sydney drew a long face, but he appreciated that Phil’s greatest desire
-was to be in at the death, when Espinosa was captured.
-
-The boat shoved off and the bamboo sail, far bigger in proportion than
-the sails carried by American boats, was quickly hoisted. The boat
-appeared to skim over the surface of the water. The gunboat slowly
-dropped astern, but now the proa had again hoisted its sail and the
-distance between the two boats seemed to be ever the same.
-
-“We’ll catch him if we have to chase him the whole fifty miles of water
-and then some,” O’Neil cried angrily. “I don’t see how I could have
-missed him.”
-
-Phil smiled feebly. “You were beginning to get pretty close,” he said.
-“They lowered their sail so as to offer a smaller target for you to aim
-at.”
-
-“I thought I’d done it with a shell,” the boatswain’s mate replied
-disappointedly. “Well, if we get within the range of this little piece
-of iron,” patting his rifle, “I’ll take great pleasure in writing my
-initials on that Espinosa’s yellow carcass.”
-
-The midshipman did not take this soft-hearted sailorman seriously. In
-a fight, he knew he was as brave as twenty men, but with a vanquished
-enemy he was as gentle as a woman.
-
-“If we can catch him alive, I don’t wish to kill him,” Phil answered
-now, in Spanish, to include Rodriguez, who had not understood the
-declarations of the disappointed sailor.
-
-“I claim the privilege of doing that, Señor Perry,” the colonel replied.
-
-Phil regarded him sternly. The native looked into the midshipman’s eyes
-unwaveringly.
-
-“Why should you?” the lad asked.
-
-“Ah, señor, I had forgotten,” the native said earnestly, taking
-his revolver from its holster and holding it butt forward to the
-midshipman. “Colonel Remundo in Luzon, Colonel Martinez in Kapay, and
-now Gregorio Rodriguez, surrenders to you as a prisoner of war.”
-
-Phil looked aghast, while O’Neil mumbled inarticulate nautical phrases
-of surprise.
-
-“Are you then Maria’s brother?” the lad asked.
-
-Gregorio nodded his head slowly, still holding his revolver for Phil to
-take.
-
-“Put your revolver back,” the midshipman ordered peremptorily. “You
-and I never have been enemies--except for a very short time,” he added
-as the remembrance of those two anxious days after his capture on the
-“Negros” came into his mind. “Anyway, we have now the same objective,
-that murderer yonder, but,” and he lowered his voice to a cold, hard
-tone, “you shall not kill him if we can capture him alive. I forbid it.”
-
-Gregorio’s black eyes blazed, and despite the avowed friendship of the
-native, O’Neil reached hastily for his revolver. Then as suddenly the
-native mastered himself and with a shrug turned away his telltale eyes.
-
-“I know how you feel, colonel,” Phil declared conscious of the passion
-in the native’s soul, “but I’d rather have it done regularly. We’ll try
-him by a military commission for treason and hang him in the Plaza in
-Palilo as a warning to all traitors.”
-
-Slowly the fishing boat overhauled the bigger craft. Now the distance
-was but five hundred yards. The sun had risen and shone down on the
-green opalescent water. A report of a rifle-shot startled the Americans
-who had settled themselves for a long and monotonous chase.
-
-“So they are going to offer resistance,” Phil exclaimed.
-
-“Yes; let him have it, O’Neil,” he added as the sailor threw the muzzle
-of his piece forward and looked questioningly at the midshipman.
-
-O’Neil’s rifle cracked and a figure standing on the rail near the mast
-doubled up and fell forward in the boat.
-
-A fusillade of shots followed from the fleeing boat, the bullets
-hissing in the water dangerously near the dozen huddled Americans.
-
-“We can’t allow this,” Phil exclaimed uneasily; “they can’t miss us if
-we get any closer.
-
-“Open fire!” he ordered suddenly.
-
-Ten rifles were discharged almost as one, and as quickly fired again
-and again. The sharp rattle of the breech-blocks was continuous.
-
-By this time the Americans had approached abreast the enemy, but
-above its rail no human being was visible. Had all been killed by the
-unerring shooting of Phil’s men?
-
-Scarcely twenty yards separated the two boats. The larger craft, with
-sheets slacked, sailed silently onward. The helm swung idle; the hand
-that had steered it probably now lay limp in the bottom of the proa.
-Phil rose cautiously, his hand grasping the sail; he placed his foot
-on the high gunwale in an endeavor to discover the state of the enemy
-concealed in the bottom of the boat. As he drew himself up above his
-companions, the two boats slid noiselessly nearer and to the lad’s
-horror he suddenly found himself looking squarely into the black muzzle
-of a pistol. Behind it burned the cruel eyes of Espinosa, while on the
-latter’s face was a leer of triumph.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXV
-
-CONCLUSION
-
-
-Scarcely a second elapsed between the time Espinosa had leaped to
-the proa’s deck and the discharge of his revolver, but in that
-second Phil had seen the awful havoc among the traitor’s followers.
-Espinosa himself, sorely wounded as he was, could hardly have helped
-hitting his mark. Phil was conscious of a shot from his own boat
-almost simultaneously with a sharp pain in his left shoulder, and saw
-the would-be slayer pitch forward into the sea. In that second the
-outriggers of the two boats came together and Gregorio and his two
-natives quickly jumped on board to lower the captured vessel’s sails,
-while O’Neil put the helm of his own craft over to bring the wind ahead
-and stop their progress.
-
-Phil balanced himself on the sail of the boat, his eyes following
-the bubbles which closed over the body of the wounded man. Then a
-trembling seized him as a great black fin protruded from the water and
-the sun’s rays reflected deep red against the green of the reef.
-
-“Sharks,” he cried hoarsely, balancing himself with a great effort, for
-he had been about to plunge overboard to rescue his enemy.
-
-O’Neil as if by intuition had seized the lad by the foot and forcibly
-hauled him back into the boat.
-
-The two boats were soon secured together and the Americans, putting
-aside their weapons of destruction, looked down pityingly upon the
-terrified natives huddled together in the bottom of the proa. Many were
-wounded by the Krag bullets and several had died not knowing pain, so
-swiftly had death come. Far astern a black curl of smoke marked the
-gunboat.
-
-All hands turned to willingly and administered to the stricken enemy
-and soon all the wounded were made as comfortable as possible, their
-bleeding stanched, while the two boats were being steered toward the
-west. The treasure was found hidden under the footboards of the proa
-and this treasure had sealed the traitor’s doom, for in carrying it he
-had delayed his flight, allowing Gregorio and Lopez to all but overtake
-him.
-
-Inside of two hours the “Mindinao,” steaming cautiously between the
-numberless shoals, took the Americans and their captives on board and
-was steaming joyfully back to Palilo with her glad tidings.
-
-The wound in Phil’s shoulder turned out happily to be but a glancing
-blow and under Sydney’s administration he suffered only the
-inconvenience of carrying his arm in a black silk sling about his neck.
-
-As Phil brought his gunboat for the last time to her berth, there on
-the dock stood General Wilson and his aides, and before the gangway had
-been down a moment they came on board to praise the work of the navy
-men, and hear the thrilling story of the end of Espinosa.
-
-A sad-eyed stranger in civilian’s clothes stood silently by as Phil
-modestly told how the outlaw had died. Then he grasped the lad’s hand
-while the general murmured a name which made the young man blush as if
-with shame. He stood in the presence of Lieutenant Tillotson’s father.
-
-“My boy,” the bereaved man said in a low voice, “you have a father’s
-blessing. The general has told me of your unselfish and reckless act in
-a vain endeavor to save my son.”
-
-Phil turned away to hide his emotion.
-
-Mr. Tillotson, taking the body of his son, sailed the following day for
-Manila.
-
-For ten days the “Mindinao” remained quietly at her dock, while from
-all over the island there came to Palilo to surrender to the general
-small bands of insurgent soldiers. Gregorio Rodriguez, the acknowledged
-leader after Espinosa’s death, had sent word to all his captains to
-stop fighting, and their obedience was instant.
-
-One evening somewhat over a week later, on board the “Mindinao” a
-dinner party was in progress. The happy general, a weight of care
-lifted from his shoulders, sat on Phil’s right, while about the board
-were the well-known faces of his friends. O’Neil, barred by naval
-etiquette from partaking at his captain’s table, in the shadow of the
-night, stood near, hanging on every word spoken. The Chinese servants
-with smiling faces flitted between the galley and the quarter-deck.
-
-Maria sat between the two midshipmen, and the sadness in her eyes still
-lingered, but a look of admiration would kindle as she talked to each
-of her two friends in turn.
-
-General Wilson held in his hand two unopened telegrams which had just
-been handed him by an orderly.
-
-The general tore one of the yellow envelopes and ran his eye hurriedly
-over the contents.
-
-“My congratulations, governor,” he exclaimed, as he passed the paper to
-Gregorio Rodriguez.
-
-The native could hardly believe his eyes, for these were the words he
-read:
-
-“Gregorio Rodriguez appointed civil governor of the Island of Kapay
-to-day by the governor-general.”
-
-Rodriguez rose to his feet and strode quietly to the general’s side.
-
-“General Wilson,” he said reverently, “this fulfils my father’s dearest
-wish. I would that he could know.” Then he dropped on one knee and,
-much to the surprise of the gray-haired prosaic veteran, raised the
-blue-veined hand to his lips. Maria remained seated, but her dark eyes
-beamed lovingly on her brother.
-
-Then the other telegram was opened and a smile appeared on the
-warrior’s face.
-
-The lads were consumed with impatience, for by the look in the
-general’s eyes they realized it concerned them. He read the message.
-
- “I am appointed ambassador to Japan. Have selected Blynn as military
- attaché and Midshipmen Perry and Monroe naval attachés to our
- embassy. Wire their answers.
-
- “TILLOTSON.”
-
-The midshipmen’s hearts beat fast and they were about to cry out their
-delight, when the tearful face of Maria caught their eye; and instead
-Phil answered soberly, “I doubt if we have sufficient rank to accept.”
-
-O’Neil had heard enough, and as he moved forward toward his hammock
-slung on the forecastle he murmured gruffly:
-
-“I can’t let ’em go alone. They need me to look out for them.” And Phil
-and Sydney, had they heard, would have said he was right.
-
-
-Other books in this same series are:
-
- A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN AFLOAT
- A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN CHINA
- A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN JAPAN
- A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN THE SOUTH SEAS
-
-
-
-
-FOOTNOTES:
-
-[1] A lorcha is a Filipino schooner; its sails are usually made of
-a rough canvas, yellow in color, manufactured from a native fibre,
-usually hemp.
-
-[2] “Friend, a letter.”
-
-[3] Pulijanes--ladrones, outlaw
-
-
-
-
-TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES:
-
-
- Italicized text is surrounded by underscores: _italics_.
-
- Obvious typographical errors have been corrected.
-
- Inconsistencies in hyphenation have been standardized.
-
- Archaic or alternate spelling has been retained from the original.
-
-*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN
-THE PHILIPPINES ***
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the
-United States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
-the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
-of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
-copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
-easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
-of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
-Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
-do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
-by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
-license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country other than the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where
- you are located before using this eBook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm website
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that:
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
-the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
-forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
-Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
-to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's website
-and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without
-widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This website includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/old/67438-0.zip b/old/67438-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 6781db1..0000000
--- a/old/67438-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h.zip b/old/67438-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 55bfe5d..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/67438-h.htm b/old/67438-h/67438-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index ecc8054..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/67438-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12045 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- A United States Midshipman in the Philippines, by Yates Stirling, Jr.&mdash;A Project Gutenberg eBook
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {
- margin-left: 10%;
- margin-right: 10%;
-}
-
- h1,h2 {
- text-align: center;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-p {
- margin-top: .51em;
- text-align: justify;
- margin-bottom: .49em;
-}
-
-div.titlepage {text-align: center; page-break-before: always; page-break-after: always;}
-div.titlepage p {text-align: center; font-weight: bold; line-height: 1.5; margin-top: 2em;}
-
-hr {
- width: 33%;
- margin-top: 2em;
- margin-bottom: 2em;
- margin-left: 33.5%;
- margin-right: 33.5%;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-
-hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
-@media print { hr.chap {display: none; visibility: hidden;} }
-
-.ph1 {text-align: center; font-size: large; font-weight: bold;}
-.ph2 {text-align: center; font-size: xx-large; font-weight: bold;}
-
-.poetry-container {text-align: center;}
-.poetry {display: inline-block; text-align: left;}
-
-div.chapter {page-break-before: always;}
-h2.nobreak {page-break-before: avoid;}
-
-table {
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;
-}
-
-.tdr {text-align: right;}
-
-
-.pagenum {
- position: absolute;
- left: 92%;
- font-size: smaller;
- text-align: right;
- font-style: normal;
- font-weight: normal;
- font-variant: normal;
-}
-
-
-.blockquot {
- margin-left: 5%;
- margin-right: 10%;
-}
-
-.large {font-size: 125%;}
-.small {font-size: 60%;}
-
-.center {text-align: center;}
-
-.right {text-align: right;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-
-p.drop-cap {
- margin-left: 36%;
- text-indent: -0.35em;
-}
-p.drop-cap2 {
- margin-left: 36%;
- text-indent: 0em;
-}
-p.drop-cap:first-letter, p.drop-cap2:first-letter
-{
- float: left;
- margin: 0em 0.15em 0em 0em;
- font-size: 250%;
- line-height:0.85em;
- text-indent: 0em;
-}
-.x-ebookmaker p.drop-cap, .x-ebookmaker p.drop-cap2 {
- text-indent: 0em;
- margin-left: 5em;
-}
-.x-ebookmaker p.drop-cap:first-letter, .x-ebookmaker p.drop-cap2:first-letter
-{
- float: none;
- margin: 0;
- font-size: 100%;
-}
-
-.figcenter {
- margin: auto;
- text-align: center;
- page-break-inside: avoid;
- max-width: 100%;
-}
-
-.footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 0.9em;}
-
-.footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right;}
-
-.fnanchor {
- vertical-align: super;
- font-size: .8em;
- text-decoration:
- none;
-}
-
-.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA;
- color: black;
- font-size:smaller;
- margin-left: 17.5%;
- margin-right: 17.5%;
- padding: 1em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- font-family:sans-serif, serif; }
-
- </style>
- </head>
-<body>
-<p style='text-align:center; font-size:1.2em; font-weight:bold'>The Project Gutenberg eBook of A United States Midshipman in the Philippines, by Yates Stirling, Jr.</p>
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
-most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
-of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
-at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
-are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws of the
-country where you are located before using this eBook.
-</div>
-
-<p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Title: A United States Midshipman in the Philippines</p>
-<p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Author: Yates Stirling, Jr.</p>
-<p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Illustrator: Ralph L. Boyer</p>
-<p style='display:block; text-indent:0; margin:1em 0'>Release Date: February 18, 2022 [eBook #67438]</p>
-<p style='display:block; text-indent:0; margin:1em 0'>Language: English</p>
- <p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em; text-align:left'>Produced by: D A Alexander, David E. Brown, University of Michigan for the original scans and the color image of the cover, and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This file was produced from images generously made available by the Library of Congress.)</p>
-<div style='margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:4em'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN THE PHILIPPINES ***</div>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/cover.jpg" width="40%" alt="" /></div>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_0"></span></p>
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_frontispiece.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap"><i>SOME ONE TURNED ON THE<br />
-CURRENT</i></p>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_title.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="titlepage">
-
-<h1>A<br />
-UNITED STATES<br />
-MIDSHIPMAN<br />
-<span class="small">IN THE</span><br />
-PHILIPPINES</h1>
-
-<p><i>by</i><br />
-
-<span class="large">Lt. Com. Yates Stirling Jr. U.S.N.</span><br />
-
-Author of<br />
-
-&#8220;A U.S. Midshipman Afloat&#8221;<br />
-&#8220;A U.S. Midshipman in China&#8221;<br />
-&#8220;A U.S. Midshipman in Japan&#8221;<br />
-&#8220;A U.S. Midshipman in the South Seas&#8221;</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_titlelogo.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-
-<p>Illustrated <i>by</i> Ralph L. Boyer</p>
-
-<p><span class="large">THE PENN PUBLISHING<br />
-COMPANY PHILADELPHIA<br />
-MCMXIII</span></p>
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p class="center">
-COPYRIGHT<br />
-1910 BY<br />
-THE PENN<br />
-PUBLISHING<br />
-COMPANY</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_logo.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_3">[3]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">Introduction</h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> writer has attempted to describe in this
-volume the life of two young midshipmen of
-the United States Navy, serving in a small
-gunboat in Philippine waters.</p>
-
-<p>The fighting between the United States
-troops and the lawless bands of Filipino
-bandits (for they were bandits, more or less,
-after Aguinaldo&#8217;s army had been dispersed)
-was in most cases &#8220;hand to hand&#8221; and to the
-death. The navy had but small share in this
-war, but in some instances the helpful co&ouml;peration
-of their web-footed brothers saved
-the soldiers from embarrassing situations.</p>
-
-<p>Midshipman Philip Perry and his classmate
-at Annapolis, Sydney Monroe, first made their
-appearance in &#8220;A United States Midshipman
-Afloat.&#8221; They had a part in stirring adventures
-during one of the frequent South American
-revolutions. Here they became involved
-in diplomatic intrigue, and had some success;
-but unfortunately diplomatic successes cannot
-always be proclaimed to the world.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_4">[4]</span>&#8220;A United States Midshipman in China&#8221;
-told of the adventures of the same boys
-in China during a threatened uprising of
-fanatical Chinese against the foreigners.
-Here again diplomacy counseled silence, and
-their reward for saving the day was a mild rebuke
-from their admiral. One of the principal
-characters in all three books is Jack O&#8217;Neil, a
-typical modern man-of-war&#8217;s man.</p>
-
-<p>These books are written in an endeavor to
-portray the life led by young officers in the
-naval service. The writer&#8217;s own experiences
-warrant the belief that the incidents are not
-unusual. The midshipmen are not merely
-automatons. To one of Napoleon&#8217;s pawns an
-order was an order, to be obeyed, right or
-wrong. But the doctrine, &#8220;their&#8217;s not to
-reason why&#8221; when &#8220;some one has blundered&#8221;
-is no longer accepted as an excuse for poor results.
-In these days of progress we court-martial
-an officer who stubbornly obeys an
-order, when he knows that to do so will injure
-the cause he has sworn to uphold.</p>
-
-<p>Further account of the boys&#8217; stirring adventures
-will be found in &#8220;A U. S. Midshipman in
-Japan&#8221; and &#8220;A U. S. Midshipman in the South
-Seas.&#8221;</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_5">[5]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">Contents</h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<table border="0" cellpadding="2" cellspacing="2" summary="table">
-
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">I.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Start for Palilo</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_9"> 9</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">II.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Polite Captor</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_25"> 25</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">III.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Leak of Military Information</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_41"> 41</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">IV.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Landed in Captivity</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_54"> 54</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">V.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Captain Blynn Marches</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_71"> 71</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">VI.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The &#8220;Mindinao&#8221;</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_83"> 83</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">VII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Gunboat Co&ouml;perates</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_101"> 101</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">VIII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Privileges of Rank</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_119"> 119</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">IX.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Katipunan Society</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_138"> 138</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">X.</td><td> <span class="smcap">In the Shadow of a Suspicion</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158"> 158</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XI.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Traitor Unmasked</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_175"> 175</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Midshipmen Reconnoitre</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_189"> 189</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XIII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Unwelcome Companions</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_212"> 212</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XIV.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Cleverly Outwitted</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_225"> 225</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XV.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Night of Alarm</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_241"> 241</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XVI.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Filipino Martyr</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_259"> 259</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XVII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Daring Plan</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_277"> 277</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XVIII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A River Expedition</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_292"> 292</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XIX.</td><td> <span class="smcap">A Willing Captive</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_308"> 308</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XX.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Struggle for the Stronghold</span> &nbsp; &nbsp; </td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_324"> 324</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XXI.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Gunboat Takes a Hand</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_336"> 336</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XXII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Escaped Outlaw</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_346"> 346</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XXIII.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Colonel Martinez</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_355"> 355</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XXIV.</td><td> <span class="smcap">The Gunboat on Guard</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_366"> 366</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdr">XXV.</td><td> <span class="smcap">Conclusion</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_377"> 377</a></td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_6">[6]</span></p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_7">[7]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">Illustrations</h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<table border="0" cellpadding="2" cellspacing="2" summary="table">
-
-<tr><td class="tdr" colspan="2"><small>PAGE</small></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td><span class="smcap">Some One Turned On the Current</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_0"> <i>Frontispiece</i></a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td><span class="smcap">Here was Freedom Within His Grasp</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_69"> 69</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td>&#8220;<span class="smcap">I Am In Command Here!</span>&#8221;</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_126"> 126</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td>&#8220;<span class="smcap">Hello, Here Are Some Canoes!</span>&#8221;</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205"> 205</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td><span class="smcap">Up the Face of the Cliff</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_288"> 288</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td><span class="smcap">He Gazed Down Into the Still Face</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_333"> 333</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td><span class="smcap">A Man Stepped Silently From Behind a Tree</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_356"> 356</a></td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_8">[8]</span></p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_9">[9]</span>
-
-<p class="ph2">A United States Midshipman<br />
-In the Philippines</p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER I<br />
-
-
-<small>THE START FOR PALILO</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> &#8220;Isla de Negros,&#8221; a small inter-island
-steamer, lay moored alongside the dock in the
-turbulent waters of the Pasig River, the commercial
-artery of the city of Manila. As the
-last of its cargo was noisily carried on board
-by a swarm of half-naked stevedores, the
-slender lines which held the steamer to the
-stone quay were cast off, and with many shrill
-screeches from its high treble whistle the
-steamer swung its blunt bow out into the
-strength of the current.</p>
-
-<p>On the upper deck of the vessel, clad in
-white naval uniforms, two United States midshipmen
-stood in silent contemplation of the
-activity about them. They watched with undisguised
-interest the hundreds of toiling<span class="pagenum" id="Page_10">[10]</span>
-orientals; resembling many ant swarms,
-traveling and retraveling incessantly between
-the countless hulls of steamers and lorchas and
-the long rows of hastily constructed storehouses
-facing the river frontage. Here and
-there stood a khaki-clad sentry, rifle in hand
-and belt filled with ball cartridges, America&#8217;s
-guardian of the precious stores now being
-idly collected. Into these spacious storehouses
-the sinews of war for the army of occupation
-were being hoarded to be afterward
-redistributed among the small steamers plying
-between the metropolis, Manila, and the outlying
-islands of the archipelago.</p>
-
-<p>The American army in the Philippines, always
-too small for the stupendous task before
-it, was at last, owing to the added disaffection
-of the tribes in the Southern islands, receiving
-the attention from home which had long been
-withheld, and its numbers were being increased
-by the arrival of every transport from the far-away
-homeland.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We are here at last, Syd,&#8221; Midshipman
-Philip Perry exclaimed, a ring of triumph in
-his voice as he turned toward his fellow midshipman,
-Sydney Monroe. Friends of long<span class="pagenum" id="Page_11">[11]</span>
-standing were these two; for four years at the
-Naval Academy at Annapolis they had been
-companions and classmates, and during the
-past year they had together witnessed stirring
-service in South America and in China.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;ve missed nearly six months of the
-war,&#8221; Sydney replied querulously; &#8220;from the
-last accounts, Aguinaldo is on the run.
-Why,&#8221; he ended mirthlessly, &#8220;the war may
-be over before we even see the &#8216;Mindinao.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Pessimistic as usual,&#8221; Phil laughingly
-retorted; &#8220;where we are going, in the words
-of the immortal John Paul Jones, they
-&#8216;haven&#8217;t begun to fight.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The steamer had now swung her bow down
-river, and the chug of the engines told the
-lads that they were fairly started on their
-voyage to Palilo, the capital of the island of
-Kapay, where the gunboat &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; was
-awaiting them.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Hello, what&#8217;s this?&#8221; Phil exclaimed,
-while the engine bell rang with throaty
-clanks, and the chugging of the engines
-ceased. The two lads leaning inquiringly
-over the rail, saw a small navy launch steam
-alongside the moving steamer; then a tightly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_12">[12]</span>
-lashed bag and hammock were thrown on
-deck, and finally from the depths of the white
-canopied awning there appeared the familiar
-form of a sailor, who sprang nimbly on board,
-waving a parting good-bye to his mates, while
-the launch swung away; and again the &#8220;Negros&#8217;&#8221;
-engines chugged noisily.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Jack O&#8217;Neil!&#8221; the two lads cried, their
-faces beaming with surprised pleasure as they
-grasped the newcomer&#8217;s hand.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s me, sir,&#8221; the sailor declared ungrammatically
-though heartily, highly delighted
-at his enthusiastic reception. &#8220;Telegraphic
-orders from the admiral to report to Midshipman
-Perry, commanding the gunboat
-&#8216;Mindinao.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But where&#8217;s your old ship, the &#8216;Monadnock&#8217;?&#8221;
-Sydney questioned blankly. &#8220;We
-looked for her this morning as we came in on
-the cattle boat from Hongkong. Is she in
-the bay?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sure, sir, she is,&#8221; returned O&#8217;Neil, &#8220;over
-there at Paranaque keeping the ladrones out
-of the navy-yard with her ten-inch guns.
-They made a rush for it once, about six
-months ago, then the gugus had an army<span class="pagenum" id="Page_13">[13]</span>
-and we were kept guessing; but a few brace
-of hot ten-inch birds, exploding near them
-from our coffee kettle of a monitor soon
-made &#8217;em change their minds. They decided
-they hadn&#8217;t lost nothing at the navy-yard
-after all. But,&#8221; he ended, the enthusiasm
-dying out of his voice, &#8220;that, I said, was six
-months ago; we&#8217;ve been bailing out there
-ever since, awnings furled, guns loaded, expecting
-to be boarded every night.&#8221; He made
-a gesture of utter disgust as he stopped.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They don&#8217;t know anything, these gugus,&#8221;
-he began again, seeing that his friends didn&#8217;t
-understand his disjointed explanation; &#8220;they
-won&#8217;t try to board a man-of-war. They&#8217;ll
-attack you on shore; but as for paddling out
-in their canoes to capture a steel monitor,
-it&#8217;s too absurd. Yet we stood watch on and
-watch off every night waiting for &#8217;em to
-board. Do you blame me, sir, for feeling
-happy when I got these orders?&#8221; tapping his
-telegram against an awning stanchion. &#8220;This
-means life again; like we had in the dago
-country and up with them pigtailed chinks.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen slapped the loquacious
-sailor joyfully on the back.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_14">[14]</span>&#8220;You&#8217;re not half as glad to be with us as
-we are to have you,&#8221; Phil exclaimed frankly.
-&#8220;We&#8217;re just aching for something worth while&mdash;we&#8217;ve
-been roasting up on the Yangtse River
-since you left us, doing nothing except watch
-the grass burn up and the water in the river
-fall. I never felt such heat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While the Americans were talking the
-little steamer slipped noisily down the busy
-river and out on the bay made famous by Admiral
-Dewey on that memorable May morning.</p>
-
-<p>Corregidor Island lifted itself slowly out
-of a molten sea to the westward. The
-&#8220;Negros&#8217;&#8221; bow was pointed out through the
-southern channel, passing close to the precipitous
-island, standing like an unbending
-sentinel on guard between the wide portals of
-the Bay of Manila.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A few guns over there on Corregidor
-would soon stop this talk of our waking up
-some morning and finding Manila at the
-mercy of an enemy,&#8221; Phil declared after
-studying the landscape earnestly. &#8220;But
-these islands are too far away for our people
-at home to take much interest. Half of
-them would be glad to see another nation<span class="pagenum" id="Page_15">[15]</span>
-wrest them from us.&mdash;Hello! there&#8217;s one of
-those native lorchas,&#8221;<a id="FNanchor_1" href="#Footnote_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a> he added as his keen
-eye discovered a sail some miles away almost
-ahead of their steamer; &#8220;we passed one coming
-in this morning on the &#8216;Rubi.&#8217; I looked
-at her through the captain&#8217;s spy-glass; her
-crew were the ugliest looking cutthroats I&#8217;ve
-ever seen. They reminded me of that picture
-&#8216;Revenge.&#8217; Do you know it?&#8221; he asked suddenly
-turning to Sydney, and then describing
-the picture in mock tragic tones: &#8220;A half
-score of scowling Malays, in the bow of their
-&#8216;Vinta&#8217;; their curved swords in their mouths
-and their evil faces lustful with passion and
-hope of blood, approaching their defenseless
-victims. I hope the captain gives them a
-wide berth, for I haven&#8217;t even a revolver.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans had so far discovered but
-few people on board the steamer; the captain
-and pilot were on the bridge while on the
-lower decks there were scarcely a dozen lazy
-natives, listlessly cleaning the soiled decks
-and coiling up the confused roping.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_16">[16]</span>&#8220;Do you think we are the only passengers?&#8221;
-Sydney asked as they entered their
-stateroom to make ready for the evening meal.</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;No, there must be others, for I heard a
-woman&#8217;s voice in a cabin near ours.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As they again emerged on deck and walked
-aft to where their steamer chairs had been
-placed, a young Filipino girl rose from her
-seat and bowed courteously to the two young
-officers. Phil noticed as he saluted that she
-was a remarkably pretty girl of the higher
-class dressed in becoming native costume, and
-from her dark eyes there shone intelligence
-and knowledge.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have I one of the se&ntilde;or&#8217;s chairs?&#8221; she
-asked in excellent Spanish. &#8220;It was very
-stupid of me to have forgotten mine.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Both lads remarked at once the air of good
-breeding and the pleasing voice; the guttural
-lisp so common in the Malay was lacking.
-She could not have appeared more at
-her ease and yet they saw by her dark skin
-and straight black hair that no other blood
-than the native flowed in her veins.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is my small brother,&#8221; she explained<span class="pagenum" id="Page_17">[17]</span>
-as a slight lad of about seven came toward
-them from behind a small boat, resting on the
-skids of the upper deck. &#8220;He is my only
-companion,&#8221; she added half shyly.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen were at a loss how to talk
-to this girl of an alien race. If her skin had
-been fair they would have welcomed her
-gladly, seeing before them a pleasant two
-days of companionship before they would arrive
-at their destination; but she belonged to
-a race whose color they had been taught to
-believe placed her on a social footing far beneath
-their own.</p>
-
-<p>The girl seemed to divine the hesitancy in
-the midshipmen&#8217;s manner, and for a second a
-slight flush spread over her dark cheeks.</p>
-
-<p>Phil was the first to recover and break the
-embarrassing silence, heartily ashamed of
-himself for his boorish manner.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We are glad, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he commenced
-haltingly in Spanish which had become rusty
-through lack of practice, &#8220;to have you use
-our chairs, and also,&#8221; he ended lamely, &#8220;to
-have you with us. I fear we are the only
-passengers.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A few moments later a servant announced<span class="pagenum" id="Page_18">[18]</span>
-dinner, and the four took their seats at a table
-spread on the upper deck after the custom of
-the tropics.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The captain will not be with us,&#8221; the girl
-explained as Phil&#8217;s eyes rested inquiringly on
-the seat at the head of the table; &#8220;he begs that
-we will excuse him, for he is navigating the
-ship through the entrance to the bay.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>They sat down in silence; Phil&#8217;s seat was
-next to this remarkable girl.</p>
-
-<p>In a few moments both lads had quite forgotten
-that her skin was dark, so skilfully did
-she preside over the plentiful board, attentive
-to their wants with the natural grace of one
-accustomed to dispense hospitality.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Juan and I are on our way to Palilo to
-join our father,&#8221; she explained after the meal
-had fairly started. &#8220;I am very much concerned
-over the bad news I have heard. Oh! I hope
-we shall not have war in our beautiful island,&#8221;
-she added appealingly, &#8220;but the Filipinos are
-so ignorant; they will follow blindly where
-they are led, and so many of our educated
-men are at heart bad.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There has been some fighting there already?&#8221;
-Phil questioned.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_19">[19]</span>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; she answered, &#8220;but it has been only
-guerilla warfare so far. My father fears that
-reinforcements may come from the north.
-The natives in Luzon are of the Tagalo race,
-and if they come after being driven from their
-island by the American troops, we shall have
-the horrors of war on Kapay.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen&#8217;s eyes sparkled; they were
-just about to express their delight at this possibility
-when they suddenly realized that she
-was of the same blood as those they were wishing
-to fight.</p>
-
-<p>Phil was the first to see the reproving look
-in the girl&#8217;s eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You must not blame us, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he
-hastened to say apologetically. &#8220;You see fighting
-is our business; we look for it the same
-as a merchant looks for trade or a fisherman
-for fish.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I think your ideas are wrong, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; she replied
-quickly, but in a caressing tone, to soften
-the sting. &#8220;Your duty is not necessarily to
-fight, but to prevent fighting. The sisters in the
-convent taught us that a soldier&#8217;s duty was to
-uphold the honor of his country. If fighting
-only will accomplish this duty, then it is just<span class="pagenum" id="Page_20">[20]</span>
-to fight, but in this case no honor is at stake.
-How can our people hurt the honor of a great
-nation like yours?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil blushed half angrily, half in shame.
-This girl of a dark race had the temerity to
-tell him what was his duty, and he was defenseless,
-for she was in the right.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is true, se&ntilde;orita, what you say,&#8221; Sydney
-came to the rescue, &#8220;but peace for us is very
-monotonous, always the same eternal grind.
-War is exciting; it stirs the blood and makes
-men of us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; the girl answered in a low,
-hard voice, &#8220;and it arouses all the evil passions
-in us. We forget all our training, all
-our ideals, all our instincts for good, and give
-way to the instincts of the beasts. My people
-in war are not men, se&ntilde;or, they are demons.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While the girl was talking the steamer had
-drawn closer to the lorcha which Phil had
-sighted earlier in the afternoon. The night
-was not bright; a crescent moon cast a dim
-light on the hull scarcely a hundred yards on
-the weather bow. The breeze had freshened,
-and with wind free the lorcha&#8217;s sails bellied<span class="pagenum" id="Page_21">[21]</span>
-out, giving it a speed almost equal to that of
-the steamer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why doesn&#8217;t he give that sail a wider
-berth?&#8221; Phil exclaimed suddenly as the
-girl&#8217;s voice died away. &#8220;If she should yaw
-now, she&#8217;d be into us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Look out!&#8221; Sydney cried in alarm as the
-lorcha suddenly sheered to leeward and the
-great mass of tautening canvas careened toward
-the unsuspecting steamer.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen were on their feet in an
-instant, while O&#8217;Neil came running up from
-the deck below.</p>
-
-<p>The Spanish captain, calling loudly to all
-his saints to witness that it was not his fault,
-jammed the helm to starboard, throwing the
-steamer&#8217;s bow away from the rapidly approaching
-lorcha. The engine bell clanked
-riotously, as the excited Spanish captain
-rang for more speed. Then the Americans&#8217;
-blood froze in their veins, for the chugging of
-the noisy engines had ceased in a wheezy
-wail, and the &#8220;Negros&#8221; lay helpless, almost
-motionless in the path of the strange sail to
-windward.</p>
-
-<p>The lads looked at each other in consternation.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_22">[22]</span>
-The suddenness of the emergency had
-rendered them powerless to act.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Was it only a stupid blunder? Or was it
-by design that the silent lorcha had shifted
-its helm and stood down upon the demoralized
-steamer?&#8221; were the questions that came into
-their minds.</p>
-
-<p>A guttural hail from the lorcha accompanied
-by a fusillade of rifle-shots put an end
-to all doubt.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Pirates!&#8221; O&#8217;Neil gasped as he dislodged
-an iron crowbar from a boat skid. &#8220;And
-there isn&#8217;t a gun among us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A bright glare suddenly darted from the
-bridge of the steamer as some one turned on
-the current for the search-light, and the
-Americans saw in the bright beam a motley
-crew of natives lining the lorcha&#8217;s rail, their
-eager bodies crouched ready to spring upon the
-deck of their helpless victim.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Tagalos,&#8221; the girl cried out in sudden
-alarm as she instinctively put her small
-brother behind her, shielding him from the
-flying bullets.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t do it, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil commanded
-hoarsely as Phil started precipitously forward.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_23">[23]</span>
-&#8220;We can&#8217;t stand them off, we&#8217;re too few.
-Here we can make a stand if they attack us.
-We can&#8217;t save the ship.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lads saw at once the wisdom in O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s
-advice. No power could save the ship from
-the terrible onslaught of that savage horde.
-The two vessels came together with a mighty
-crash, and the air was rent with harsh cries
-of triumph as the captors leaped on board, firing
-their guns and slashing with their sharp
-bolos. The cries for mercy from the cringing
-crew were soon swallowed up in the shrieks
-of pain and anger as the vengeful victors
-satisfied their inherent love for blood.</p>
-
-<p>The triumphant natives scaled the bridge
-deck, and in the bright glow from the search-light,
-the Americans were horrified to see
-those on the bridge, in spite of their hands
-held aloft in supplication, cruelly butchered
-where they stood.</p>
-
-<p>The Americans in mortal dread pressed
-their bodies close within the deep shadow of
-the boats. The blinding glare from the
-search-light aided them in their attempt to
-hide from the searching eyes of their assailants.
-Phil and Sydney had manfully lifted<span class="pagenum" id="Page_24">[24]</span>
-the native girl and her brother into the boat
-behind them and stood their ground ready to
-protect them with their lives. So this was to
-be the end of their hopes for adventure?&mdash;to be
-butchered, unarmed and in cold blood by a
-band of lawless murderers.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_25">[25]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER II<br />
-
-
-<small>A POLITE CAPTOR</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> Americans were not kept long in
-suspense, although to the anxious boys,
-huddled helplessly in the shadow of the boat,
-the time seemed hours until the victorious
-and jubilant natives moved aft, bent on annihilating
-those whom they believed were hiding
-from their search.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil grasped his weapon firmly, while
-the lads made a mental resolve to seize the
-arms of the first natives within reach and
-sacrifice their own lives as dearly as possible.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly the beam of the search-light
-swung directly aft, revealing to the pirates
-the defenseless band of spectators to the
-recent tragedy.</p>
-
-<p>The helpless passengers were confident now
-that all was over. As if in broad daylight,
-they were visible to the outlaws. A volley
-from their rifles would send them all to death.</p>
-
-<p>Blinded by the bright light, they could but<span class="pagenum" id="Page_26">[26]</span>
-speculate as to the movement of their
-enemies, but they well knew that they must
-surely be advancing slowly, only awaiting
-the word to throw themselves on their helpless
-victims.</p>
-
-<p>What could be done? Phil realized only
-too vividly that something must be done and
-quickly. A false move would condemn them
-all. Once those wild men, steeped in the
-blood of the innocent, had commenced, even
-the power of their leader could not stop
-them.</p>
-
-<p>Then a girl&#8217;s voice, clear and commanding
-from behind them, made the Americans gasp
-in wonder. O&#8217;Neil with his great club raised
-to strike the misty figures just beyond his
-reach stiffened. The girl&#8217;s words were unintelligible
-to the Americans, but to the advancing
-natives they were like a flash of lightning
-from out of a clear sky. They stopped short,
-and for a few seconds a deep silence reigned.
-The girl was speaking in her native tongue.
-Phil cast a swift glance behind him; she
-stood boldly upright in the bow of the
-boat, like a beautiful bronze statue. The
-light threw her face in high relief against the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_27">[27]</span>
-black background of sky. He saw the flashing
-eyes, the quivering straight nostrils, and
-the scornful curve of her mouth. She
-finished speaking, and still the silence was
-unbroken. From the gathered crowd the
-leader advanced, his hand held above his
-head in mute sign of peace. Phil could
-scarcely believe his eyes, but the girl&#8217;s low
-voice in his ear caused his heart to beat
-tumultuously.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He has accepted your surrender.&#8221; She
-spoke in Spanish. Then, with her hands
-placed lightly on Phil&#8217;s shoulder she jumped
-down to the deck and advanced to meet
-the native leader. At a few paces from
-her he halted, and the Americans held their
-breath in wonder to see the bandit bow low
-before her, raising her hand to his lips.
-Then he turned and gave several harsh commands
-to his followers, who quietly dispersed.</p>
-
-<p>Inside of but a few minutes the lorcha had
-disappeared in the night and the &#8220;Negros&#8221;
-resumed its journey, the noisy engines chugging
-away just as faithfully under their new
-masters.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_28">[28]</span>The Americans, as they gathered about the
-table to finish the meal long forgotten in the
-excitement of the attack, marveled at the
-outcome of the affair.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Who can she be?&#8221; Sydney whispered.
-&#8220;Why, she orders the ladrone leader around
-as if she were a princess.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil was about to reply when the girl herself
-appeared from the shadows, followed by
-the native chief.</p>
-
-<p>The lads regarded him with a mixture of
-feelings, admiration for his soldierly bearing
-and disgust at the thought of the wilful
-butchery they had seen him permit on the
-bridge of the steamer.</p>
-
-<p>They recognized at once that these two were
-of the highest caste among their people. The
-man&#8217;s face, almost perfect in contour, except
-in the cruel lines of the mouth, beamed hospitably
-upon them.</p>
-
-<p>The girl spoke quickly, breathlessly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Martinez wishes to meet the brave
-Americans who would have fought unarmed
-against overwhelming odds and who had no
-thoughts of asking for quarter.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans bowed, but the Filipino advanced,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_29">[29]</span>
-his hand outstretched. Phil took it
-with almost a shudder. Why had this hand
-been withheld while the Spanish captain and
-his officers were asking for mercy scarcely five
-minutes before? Yet he knew that he had
-no choice but to take the proffered fingers; he
-and his companions were in the power of this
-man, the lines of whose mouth told what
-might happen if the native leader&#8217;s pride was
-offended.</p>
-
-<p>After shaking hands, Colonel Martinez went
-straight to the point. &#8220;You belong to the
-country of our enemy, and being such you
-must remain prisoners of war. We shall land
-at Dumaguete to-morrow, and if you will give
-me your solemn parole not to bear arms
-against us, I shall send you with an escort and
-safe conduct to Palilo. If not, I must send
-you to the headquarters of my superior,
-General Diocno.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil as spokesman bowed.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We shall not give you our parole, colonel,&#8221;
-he said emphatically. &#8220;We prefer to remain
-prisoners of war.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;As you will,&#8221; the insurgent answered
-coldly, but his swarthy face betrayed his admiration.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_30">[30]</span>
-&#8220;I shall assure you of my good
-offices with our general. And now, I shall
-leave you, but I warn you that your lives will
-be in danger if you leave this deck, or if you
-make the slightest attempt to thwart my
-plans. I shall have your belongings brought
-back here. You see I can take no chances,
-and I appreciate that you three Americans are
-no mean antagonists.&#8221; He cast a look of admiration
-at O&#8217;Neil, who had been listening in
-silence, his muscular fingers still clasping the
-stout crowbar with which he would like to
-have brained this pompous little Filipino.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Beggars can&#8217;t be choosers, Mr. Perry,&#8221;
-O&#8217;Neil exclaimed with a wry smile after the
-officer had departed, &#8220;and I guess it was a
-good thing the girl knew how to get the ear
-of that there little bantam rooster. In another
-minute, I&#8217;d have brained one of them, and
-then those words she spoke would have had
-as much chance to be heard as the chairman&#8217;s
-voice in a state convention.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans&#8217; belongings were brought to
-them from their cabin by several evil-looking
-natives, and very soon all were comfortable
-under the awning, protected from the wind by<span class="pagenum" id="Page_31">[31]</span>
-the boat against which an hour ago they had
-been about to make their last stand.</p>
-
-<p>The sun awakened the Americans at an early
-hour the next morning. While they were
-sipping their morning coffee, the lads gazed
-in admiration at the beautiful scenery about
-them. The little steamer had during the night
-wound its way past myriads of small islands,
-now but black smudges astern. The high
-mountains of Kapay Island rose boldly from
-the sea on their starboard hand. Ahead, becoming
-more distinct, was the shore line
-toward which the steamer was now traveling
-at an increased speed as told by the more rapid
-chugging of her engines.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Hello,&#8221; Phil exclaimed as he cast a
-glance toward the bridge, &#8220;something&#8217;s happening.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney and O&#8217;Neil followed his gaze.
-There on the bridge were Martinez and the
-native pilot, who had apparently been spared
-in the attack of the night before. Martinez
-was walking up and down excitedly, casting
-an anxious glance ever and again off on the
-port quarter.</p>
-
-<p>It was O&#8217;Neil who was the first to discover<span class="pagenum" id="Page_32">[32]</span>
-the reason for the evident excitement of their
-captors.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Smoke,&#8221; he exclaimed laconically, characteristically
-jerking his thumb toward the
-islands astern fast being swallowed up in the
-glassy sea. &#8220;They ain&#8217;t taking no chances.
-That stretch of shore yonder,&#8221; he added, his
-gaze on the shore line ahead, &#8220;must be the
-mouth of the Davao River.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lads gazed eagerly at the faint curl of
-smoke astern, but it gave them but scant encouragement,
-for it was only too evident that
-before the stranger, if it were one of the many
-small gunboats patrolling the islands, could
-hope to get within gunshot of the &#8220;Negros,&#8221;
-the steamer would have crossed the shallow
-bar of the Davao River and be safe from the
-pursuit of the deeper vessel.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If we could only stop her,&#8221; Phil lamented.
-&#8220;Smash those rickety engines or haul fires in
-the boiler.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil in answer cast a comprehensive glance
-at the sentries on guard on the upper deck.
-The evil-looking natives were squatted in
-plain sight, their loaded rifles held tightly in
-their brown fingers.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_33">[33]</span>&#8220;Oh! for three good Krag rifles,&#8221; Sydney
-cried petulantly; &#8220;we could clear this deck
-and then jam the steering gear there, and
-by the time they could overpower us the
-gunboat, if it is one, would make them
-heave to.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>In a short time the girl and her brother
-joined them, and the native guards arose and
-moved farther away.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is one of your gunboats,&#8221; she announced
-smiling mischievously at the evident pleasure
-of the midshipmen; &#8220;Colonel Martinez has
-recognized her through his telescope. She is
-giving chase, but Dumaguete is now scarcely
-twenty-five miles ahead, so I fear there will not
-be a rescue.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil calculated quickly. If Martinez could
-see the gunboat with his glass to recognize her
-she could not be over ten to twelve miles
-astern. The &#8220;Negros&#8217;&#8221; best speed was ten
-knots, which meant two and a half hours before
-she could reach the river bar. He knew
-that several of the gunboats were good for fifteen
-knots. If this were one of the fast ones,
-which he earnestly prayed it was, in two hours
-and a half the gunboat would be up to the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_34">[34]</span>
-&#8220;Negros.&#8221; His face brightened as these figures
-awakened his hopes.</p>
-
-<p>While the Americans went through the
-pretense of breakfast the &#8220;Negros&#8221; steamed
-swiftly toward the shore, and they saw with
-rising hopes the white hull of a large vessel
-raise itself slowly out of the deep blue of the
-tropical sea.</p>
-
-<p>Phil eyed the Filipino girl questioningly.
-He could tell nothing from her sphynx-like
-face. Would she be glad to be rescued from
-this band of outlaws or was she at home and
-safe among them? The respect shown her by
-the leader and his men seemed to point to the
-conclusion that she was of importance among
-her people. He knew not what were those
-crisp words spoken the night before to prevent
-the fierce onslaught of the natives, but they
-had calmed the storm. She had saved their
-lives, that much was certain; and for that,
-even though she was at heart in sympathy with
-this band of pirates, he owed her his gratitude.</p>
-
-<p>His whole heart rebelled against the thought
-of captivity among the insurgents. He knew
-it would be a living death. Poorly nourished
-and without the necessities of life; exposed to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_35">[35]</span>
-the savage temper of a people whose spirits
-fluctuated more rapidly than a tropical barometer,
-there seemed but little to live for. Perhaps
-death would be happier! His thoughts
-dwelt upon the stories he had heard of the
-atrocities committed by this same Diocno
-upon American soldiers who had been captured.
-Some of them he had buried alive in an
-ant-hill all but their heads, with their mouths
-propped open and a train of sugar leading to
-their swollen tongues. A cold shiver ran down
-his spine as his imagination pictured the agony
-of these men as they slowly died.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s the &#8216;Albany,&#8217;&#8221; O&#8217;Neil cried joyfully a
-minute later, &#8220;and do you see the bone in
-her teeth? She&#8217;s making nearly twenty knots.
-Why, it&#8217;s all over but the shouting. These
-little yellow runts will look well when they are
-lined up against the wall at Cavite and shot
-for piracy.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil held up his hand to demand silence
-from the excited sailor. He did not know
-how much English the girl might know, and
-the ladrone leader might learn the dire wish
-of the sailorman for him and his followers.
-Then if the &#8220;Negros&#8221; escaped, his anger could<span class="pagenum" id="Page_36">[36]</span>
-be vented upon the Americans. But the girl&#8217;s
-face did not betray that she had understood the
-meaning of O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s words. The &#8220;Albany&#8221;
-was fast approaching, but Phil knew that
-O&#8217;Neil must be overestimating the cruiser&#8217;s
-speed; the most she could make, without
-special preparation, would be fifteen knots,
-but, and his joy welled up into his eyes,&mdash;her
-six-inch guns! He had seen them fired with
-accuracy at four miles.</p>
-
-<p>The shore line ahead had now become distinct.
-The deep cut in the surrounding hills
-betrayed the presence of the Davao River as
-it flowed through them to the sea. Groves of
-high-topped palm trees appeared, a deeper
-green against the emerald background, while
-the water stretching toward them from the
-land polluted the sea with a dull brown
-stain&mdash;the muddy water of the river. The
-town of Dumaguete could not be seen, but
-from the curls of rising smoke, Phil knew it
-must be beyond the first bend of the river
-and screened from view by the spur-like hill
-stretching its length from the mountains behind
-to the water&#8217;s edge.</p>
-
-<p>The girl sat between the two midshipmen,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_37">[37]</span>
-her small brother innocently unconscious
-of the tragedy being enacted about him, playing
-joyfully about the decks. Phil watched
-the child as a relief to his overanxious mind.
-He had dislodged a wedge-shaped block of
-wood from under the quarter boat, and was
-using it to frighten a large monkey which
-was eying him grotesquely from on top of
-the tattered awning. The monkey apparently
-did not enjoy the game, for he suddenly flew
-screeching at the boy, his mouth opened
-viciously. The boy in his haste to escape
-dropped the block of wood almost on Phil&#8217;s
-foot and the midshipman determinedly placed
-his foot upon it. In that instant an idea had
-occurred to him. His pulse beat faster, as
-the thought flashed into his mind. He
-would use it as a last resort, even though it
-would bring the howling mob of natives
-vengefully about their heads.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Now she&#8217;s talking,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil exclaimed
-grimly, as a flash and a puff of brownish smoke
-belched from the bow of the distant cruiser.
-The Americans arose to their feet, their eyes
-held fascinatingly on the cruiser. They
-knew that a hundred-pound shell was speeding<span class="pagenum" id="Page_38">[38]</span>
-toward them at a speed of a mile in three
-seconds. The Filipino girl sat unconcernedly
-sipping her coffee. She was as yet ignorant
-of the meaning of that flash from a
-vessel nearly five miles away.</p>
-
-<p>Far astern a column of water arose in the
-air and the distant shock of the discharge
-came to their expectant ears.</p>
-
-<p>Phil saw with sinking heart that the
-&#8220;Negros&#8221; had entered the discolored water
-from the river. Ahead less than two miles
-the ever-present bamboo fish weirs showed
-the commencement of the shallows of the
-Davao River. His hopes died within him.
-The cruiser was not making the speed he had
-hoped. She would hardly be in range before
-the &#8220;Negros&#8221; had put the high spur of land
-between her and the enemy. The cruiser,
-apparently seeing the quarry was about to
-escape, opened a rapid fire in hopes of intimidating
-or crippling its prey; but the
-range was too great. The shells hissed close
-to the stern of the fleeing vessel; the boasted
-accuracy of American gunners was lacking.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If she was only a thousand yards closer,&#8221;
-O&#8217;Neil cried in bitter disappointment. &#8220;It&#8217;s<span class="pagenum" id="Page_39">[39]</span>
-only a matter of luck at this distance. Look
-out,&#8221; he yelled as a shell struck the water
-with the noise of an express train, within
-fifty feet of the fleeing &#8220;Negros.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Filipino girl&#8217;s face blanched, while the
-boy ran cowering to his sister&#8217;s side. The
-danger to them seemed almost supernatural.
-The girl&#8217;s lips moved, and Phil saw that she
-was praying. For a moment a fear seized
-him. The thought of their danger was certainly
-unnerving. A single shell exploding
-near them would send them all to eternity.
-The fish weirs were now abreast the ship and
-the &#8220;Negros&#8217;&#8221; bow was being guided into the
-narrow, tortuous channel of the delta. The
-Filipino pilot on the bridge spun his steering
-wheel from side to side, following the twisting
-channel. The quadrant with its rusty chain,
-connecting the wheel and the rudder, clanked
-loudly at Phil&#8217;s feet. Now was the time to
-put his daring plan in operation. He saw that
-the four guards had taken refuge behind the
-boats, from which they peered out with frightened
-eyes at the oncoming cruiser, dodging
-out of sight at each screech of a shell. They
-had apparently forgotten the prisoners whom<span class="pagenum" id="Page_40">[40]</span>
-they were guarding, for their rifles and belts
-were resting on the hatch several yards away.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;When I give the word, you jump for
-those rifles and belts,&#8221; Phil said in a low,
-intense voice, glancing covertly at the terrified
-girl at his side. &#8220;I am going to jam the
-steering quadrant. When you get the guns,&#8221;
-he continued, &#8220;take cover behind the boats.
-It may cost us our lives, but anything is better
-than imprisonment among these people.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil and Sydney breathed a gasping assent
-to the bold plan. Phil watched carefully
-the quadrant; he saw it move slowly over
-until it was hard astarboard. He reached
-down, grasping the boy&#8217;s block of wood under
-his foot, then slid it slowly, amid the terrific
-noise of a passing shell, toward the quadrant.
-He knew the wedge would hold the rudder
-over and the &#8220;Negros,&#8221; unable to steer, would
-ground on the edge of the channel, thus leaving
-her helpless to be captured by the cruiser.
-He opened his mouth to give the signal for
-his companions to act, when a shrill warning
-cry sounded in his ears and he was roughly
-drawn back into his chair and the wedge
-dropped from his hands a foot from its goal.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_41">[41]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER III<br />
-
-
-<small>A LEAK OF MILITARY INFORMATION</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Brigadier-General Wilson</span> sat at his desk
-in the headquarters building at Palilo. In
-the spacious corridors outside orderlies hurried
-to and fro, carrying messages from the
-several officers of the staff whose offices joined
-that of the general.</p>
-
-<p>Before him was a chart of his military district,
-and while he pondered he juggled a
-score or more of different colored pins with
-little tags attached to them. Those pins with
-blue heads represented soldiers of his command
-in the field against the enemy while
-the ones with the green heads were the ladrones
-or insurrectos, whom he had been
-fighting without success for nearly six
-months.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They jump about as if they were mounted
-in balloons,&#8221; he exclaimed testily as he drew
-out several green-headed pins and replaced
-them in accordance with recent information<span class="pagenum" id="Page_42">[42]</span>
-in other localities on the map. The big headquarters
-clock ticked away in silence, while
-the gray-haired veteran again lapsed into
-thought over his problem.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Here are two regiments in the field,&#8221; he
-complained querulously; &#8220;Gordon with two
-companies at San Juan, Baker with a company
-at Binalbagan, Anderson and a battalion
-at Barotoc, Huse and a company at Estancia,
-Pollard with two companies at Kapiz,
-Shanks with three companies at Carles,
-Stewart with his rough-riders at Dumangas
-and Bane with his two battalions as a flying
-column. That ought to give us some results,
-and yet what have we to show for it?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The general raised his thoughtful eyes, as
-his orderly&#8217;s step sounded on the soft matting
-at his side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A telegram,&#8221; he exclaimed with a show
-of interest. &#8220;Tell Major Marble I wish to see
-him,&#8221; he added, tearing open the yellow envelope.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Whew!&#8221; he whistled in sudden consternation
-as he read the unwelcome message.
-&#8220;They not only avoided Gordon but attacked
-San Juan in his absence, cutting up ten of his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_43">[43]</span>
-men left to guard the town. This thing has
-got to be stopped. There is a leak somewhere
-and I am going to put my hand on it before
-I send out another expedition.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>He pushed the chart back on his desk and
-rose suddenly to his feet.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Major,&#8221; he cried as the adjutant-general&#8217;s
-active figure entered the office, &#8220;we are all a
-set of ninnies. Don&#8217;t start and look indignant,
-sir,&#8221; he added in mock severity. &#8220;You
-are as bad as the rest, but Blynn there is the
-worst of us all, for he can&#8217;t do what he&#8217;s employed
-to do&mdash;you and I are only plain, blunt
-soldiers, while he is supposed,&#8221; with fine
-scorn, &#8220;to be in addition lawyer and detective;
-a regular secret service sleuth and all
-that.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Here, read that,&#8221; he ended throwing the
-telegram on the desk. &#8220;You see it&#8217;s the
-same old story, and ten more men butchered
-through our stupidity.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The general paced up and down his office
-with quick, energetic steps.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ve a good mind to go out in the field
-myself,&#8221; he exclaimed, half to himself. &#8220;I
-am tired of these silly, costly blunders.&#8221; Then<span class="pagenum" id="Page_44">[44]</span>
-he glanced through the open door into the
-next office to his own. &#8220;Come here, Blynn!&#8221;
-he hailed.</p>
-
-<p>A stout, dark-visaged officer arose from a
-desk littered with countless papers and came
-energetically toward him.</p>
-
-<p>The older officer&#8217;s eyes roamed searchingly
-over his judge-advocate general&#8217;s strong, massive
-frame; he gazed with kindling eyes at
-the bronzed cheeks, the unbending directness
-of his black eyes, the firm set to the bulldog
-jaws. Here surely was no weakling. He
-waved his hand toward the adjutant-general,
-standing in stunned silence, the telegram
-crumpled in his hand.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That may interest you,&#8221; the general exclaimed
-as he turned away.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The information was first hand, sir,&#8221; Captain
-Blynn&#8217;s bass voice insisted after he had
-straightened the paper and read the unwelcome
-message. &#8220;There&#8217;s been a leak.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Of course there&#8217;s been a leak,&#8221; the general
-announced hotly, &#8220;any idiot would see that,
-but where? Where? that&#8217;s the question!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn returned to his desk and
-drew out a bundle of papers from a locked<span class="pagenum" id="Page_45">[45]</span>
-drawer. He glanced over them hurriedly.
-Every word was familiar to him. Could he
-have made a mistake? Every witness whom
-he had examined had given the same information.
-These natives had not been coerced;
-they had come to him of their own volition.
-Espinosa had vouched for each. Then he
-stopped, the papers fell from his hand to the
-desk. No! it could not be possible! Espinosa
-was surely loyal. That much was sure.
-For the space of a minute he was lost in
-thought. &#8220;I shall test him,&#8221; he muttered,
-while he pressed a bell at his side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Tell Se&ntilde;or Espinosa over the telephone
-that I shall call on him in an hour on important
-business,&#8221; he instructed the orderly who
-answered his summons.</p>
-
-<p>An hour later Captain Blynn mounted the
-high stairs of the wealthy Filipino&#8217;s dwelling.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Buenos Dias, El Capitan,&#8221; Se&ntilde;or Manuel
-Espinosa cried delightedly as he pushed a chair
-forward for his visitor. But the smile died
-quickly on the native&#8217;s face as Captain Blynn
-waved away the chair impatiently, almost
-rudely, and in his typical way jumped into the
-very midst of the matter in hand.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_46">[46]</span>&#8220;Se&ntilde;or,&#8221; he exclaimed angrily, &#8220;I&#8217;ve been
-betrayed! Do you understand?&#8221; he cried menacingly,
-his flashing eyes fixed on the crafty
-face opposite him, while he shook his big,
-strong fist before the eyes of the startled Presidente
-of Palilo. &#8220;Betrayed, that&#8217;s the word,
-and if I can lay my hand on the hound, I&#8217;ll
-swing him to the eaves of his own house-top.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Se&ntilde;or Espinosa was silent, his crafty, bead-like
-eyes regarding closely the angry, excited
-face of the judge-advocate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Gordon went on a wild-goose
-chase, and when he returned he found the insurgents
-had been in San Juan in his absence.
-Ten soldiers, American men, were caught,
-trapped, and butchered. The natives who
-brought me the information were vouched for
-by you and now you&#8217;ve got to prove to me that
-you&#8217;re not a sneaking traitor!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The captain&#8217;s words tumbled one after another
-so fast that the little Filipino could grasp
-only half their meaning, but the last could not
-be misunderstood. His brown face turned a
-sickly yellow, while his frightened eyes sought
-instinctively for some weapon of defense from<span class="pagenum" id="Page_47">[47]</span>
-this terrible American, who was strong enough
-to tear his frail body limb from limb.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Ah, se&ntilde;or capitan, is this your much-boasted
-American justice?&#8221; he gasped in a
-weak voice. &#8220;Am I then judged guilty without
-hearing my defense?&#8221; His voice became
-stronger as he proceeded. &#8220;Let us look over
-this calmly,&#8221; he begged. &#8220;I, myself, have been
-betrayed. In embracing the American cause,
-I have made many enemies among my people.
-I live constantly in fear of assassination.&#8221;
-He stopped abruptly, his voice choking and
-his eyes filled with tears of self-pity.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn had dealt with many different
-classes of men in his twenty odd years of
-service. He had been a terror to the ruffians
-on the Western frontier where he had been
-stationed during the several Indian wars.
-The &#8220;bad men&#8221; had said when they had
-found Blynn against them, &#8220;We might as
-well own up&mdash;we can&#8217;t fool Blynn.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>But here was a case that baffled him. In
-the hour before going to this house he had
-after deep thought believed that after all
-Espinosa was a traitor, and he had avowedly
-intended to force him to confess his treason; but<span class="pagenum" id="Page_48">[48]</span>
-now in spite of these resolves, the captain was
-weakening. After all might not the Filipino
-be innocent? At all events he would listen to
-his defense.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn dropped his muscular hands,
-which had been creeping menacingly toward
-the thin yellow throat of the Presidente, and
-sat down suddenly in the chair which the
-native had previously offered him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Go on!&#8221; he ordered harshly. &#8220;I&#8217;ll
-suspend judgment, but remember, if you
-can&#8217;t prove your innocence, I&#8217;ll give you
-water. Do you understand, water! I&#8217;ve never
-given it, and I don&#8217;t believe in it, but if you
-can&#8217;t show me how these men were butchered,
-I&#8217;ll fill you up to the neck with it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa wetted his lips with his tongue
-and swallowed hard, but the captain by taking
-the proffered chair had removed the
-native from the terrifying influence of those
-powerful twitching fingers which he had seen
-ready to throttle him, and he, in proportion
-to the distance away of the cause of his fear,
-grew bolder.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The se&ntilde;or capitan must know of my
-sincerity,&#8221; he pleaded in a weak voice.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_49">[49]</span>
-&#8220;Have I not taken the oath of allegiance to
-the United States? Do I not know the
-punishment for breaking that oath?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn nodded his head. &#8220;Go
-ahead,&#8221; he commanded impatiently; &#8220;cut
-that out, give me the unvarnished story.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The information which I gave you and
-which was sworn to by three witnesses came
-from Juan Rodriguez,&#8221; Espinosa continued,
-dropping his voice to a whisper and approaching
-closer to the American. Then he stopped
-and glanced covertly at his listener&#8217;s startled
-face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Juan Rodriguez!&#8221; the judge-advocate
-general exclaimed half rising in his excitement.
-&#8220;Then you believe that he has deliberately
-furnished false information of the insurgents&#8217;
-movements?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While the two were talking a servant
-brought refreshments, which the army man
-waved impatiently aside. Espinosa helped
-himself and as he did so he followed his servant&#8217;s
-eye to a tightly rolled piece of paper
-inside the salva. He drew it out hastily, unrolling
-it in silence, feeling rather than seeing
-the captain&#8217;s eyes upon him, then he read the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_50">[50]</span>
-few lines written therein. Here was a chance
-to redeem his good name or at least save himself
-for this time from the fierce American.
-He asked a question in the native language
-and received a monosyllabic answer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is very important,&#8221; he exclaimed
-suddenly turning to the American officer.
-His voice was now joyful, full of confidence.
-&#8220;Two hundred riflemen have landed at
-Dumaguete from Luzon. To-night they will
-be encamped on a hill near Banate. You can
-attack them there before they can join Diocno.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn jumped to his feet, reaching
-out for the paper; he took it, scrutinizing it
-closely&mdash;then stuck it quietly into his pocket.
-Espinosa held out a trembling hand, bent
-upon regaining the note, but Captain Blynn
-had turned away, picking up his hat and
-whip from the table behind him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shall myself go in command of this
-expedition,&#8221; he announced gruffly as he
-moved toward the stairs, &#8220;and I shall expect
-you to accompany me, se&ntilde;or. We shall start
-at sunset.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Se&ntilde;or Espinosa feebly murmured his willingness,
-and after waiting to see the burly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_51">[51]</span>
-figure of his visitor pass out through the
-wide entrance, he turned and called for his
-servant.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Tell the messenger I will speak to him,&#8221;
-he said as the muchacho noiselessly entered.</p>
-
-<p>A moment later a ragged native stood
-tremblingly before him, twisting his dirty
-head-covering in his nervous hands.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa seated himself luxuriously in the
-chair recently vacated by Captain Blynn.
-He had now regained his old confidence and
-cruel arrogance, while he fired question after
-question at the uncomfortable native.</p>
-
-<p>The Presidente sat motionless in his chair
-long after his messenger had gone. His servant
-came noiselessly into the room several
-times but tiptoed away, believing his master
-was asleep. But Espinosa was far from sleep,
-his brain was actively at work. How could
-he hold his position and yet remain undiscovered
-to this terrible Captain Blynn? He
-shuddered as he remembered those big hands
-as they worked longingly to grasp his slender
-neck. He was not a fighting man; the inheritance
-of his father&#8217;s Chinese blood mixed
-with the cruelty in the native strain qualified<span class="pagenum" id="Page_52">[52]</span>
-him only for plotting. Others could do the
-fighting. His brain and cunning would furnish
-them the means and opportunity. But
-Rodriguez&mdash;he was too honest, and knew too
-much; he stood a menacing figure in his path
-as the leader of his people. He had, however,
-set the train of powder on fire, and now he
-would watch it burn. Once Rodriguez was
-removed there were no others strong enough
-to thwart him. Even Diocno bowed to his
-superior sagacity. Then he could cast off this
-halter that he felt tightening about his neck.
-With Diocno and Rodriguez out of the way,
-he could make terms with these childlike
-Americans, and then with his fortune made
-shake the dust of the islands forever from his
-feet.</p>
-
-<p>An hour before sunset he arose and dressed
-himself for his ride, ordering his servant to
-have his horse ready. The messenger had
-three hours&#8217; start; that would insure the escape
-of the Tagalos. Captain Blynn would
-find that his information was true. He could
-not blame him if the enemy had taken alarm
-and fled. As for the other matter, if the
-Americans would only arrest Rodriguez he<span class="pagenum" id="Page_53">[53]</span>
-would see that he did not interfere with his
-cherished plans for power. As he buckled on
-his English made leggings, he whistled gaily
-an old Spanish air, one he had heard in Spain;
-in his mind he saw the brightly lighted theatre,
-the richly dressed people in the boxes. Some
-day he would be rich and he would then be
-able to recline in a gilded box and cast disdainful
-glances at an admiring crowd.</p>
-
-<p>His joy would have been indeed short-lived
-and his castles in Spain would have fallen as
-flat as the surface of the sea on a calm day if
-he could have known that at that moment his
-messenger was lying dead in the trail but half-way
-to his destination, suddenly overcome by
-the terrible scourge of the camp, cholera.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_54">[54]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER IV<br />
-
-
-<small>LANDED IN CAPTIVITY</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Phil</span> was too angry and humiliated to do
-more than glare at the girl who had so cleverly
-thwarted him in his daring plan to strand the
-steamer. His companions had started to
-spring toward the coveted rifles of their enemy,
-but now they sank back into their seats and
-hopelessly looked into the menacing muzzles
-of these same rifles in the hands of the four
-aroused sentries. The girl had risen to her
-feet, her face flushed with excitement; she
-raised her hand to the natives, motioning
-them to put up their weapons.</p>
-
-<p>Phil scrambled to his feet and sheepishly
-dropped again into his chair. His breathing
-was quick and his eyes dilated with suppressed
-rage and mortification. At that moment he
-could have quite forgotten his natural instinct
-of gallantry and would have taken pleasure
-in throttling this slight girl who had come
-between them and freedom.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_55">[55]</span>&#8220;They would have all been shot,&#8221; she said
-in quick accents of excitement. &#8220;You see I
-can understand a little English. I could not
-be a traitor to my own blood as long as I had
-power to prevent it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>For answer Phil gave her a look of loathing.</p>
-
-<p>The girl recoiled under his menacing glance.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am sorry for you,&#8221; she hastened to add,
-&#8220;for now Colonel Martinez will have to keep
-you closer prisoners, unless you give me your
-word that you will not again try to prevent
-the escape of the steamer.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head savagely, his eyes on
-the steering quadrant within easy reach of his
-hand. The girl waited breathlessly for an answer,
-then finding none was forthcoming she
-gave a sharp command in her own language
-and immediately the four sentries closed in
-around the Americans, their rifles pointed toward
-their prisoners.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;For goodness&#8217; sake, Phil,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed
-in an agony of doubt, &#8220;don&#8217;t be foolhardy.
-We are absolutely in their power.
-See,&#8221; he cried desperately, &#8220;the &#8216;Albany&#8217; has
-stopped and sheered away. She has given up
-the chase.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_56">[56]</span>Phil realized that Sydney was right&mdash;nothing
-could be gained by giving in to his rash
-anger. He saw that O&#8217;Neil had dropped the
-crowbar and had been led away by two of the
-natives, going as peacefully as a lamb. However
-his pride stood in the way of an outward
-surrender, and instead of agreeing to make no
-attempts to disable the steamer he arose and
-moved away from the tempting steering quadrant.</p>
-
-<p>The &#8220;Negros&#8221; had meanwhile threaded her
-way among the dangerous shoals and was now
-in the river; the cruiser had disappeared behind
-the land.</p>
-
-<p>A great crowd of natives ashore had witnessed
-the escape of the steamer from the war-ship
-and these lined the banks of the river
-shouting joyfully as the &#8220;Negros&#8221; steamed
-quietly to the bamboo pier in front of the
-village.</p>
-
-<p>As soon as the dock had been reached, the
-girl dismissed the guards and the Americans
-once more gathered about the breakfast table.</p>
-
-<p>A few moments later Colonel Martinez, his
-face wreathed in smiles, left the bridge and
-joined them.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_57">[57]</span>&#8220;You are to be given the freedom of the
-town,&#8221; he said as he took a cup of coffee from
-the servant&#8217;s hands and sipped it gratefully,
-&#8220;but I warn you if you attempt to escape you
-will be shot, and even if you escaped, without
-guides you would be lost in the jungle and be
-killed by ladrones.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil bowed his head in sign of submission.
-They were certainly prisoners, without hope of
-rescue.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;To-morrow morning,&#8221; Colonel Martinez
-added, &#8220;we shall leave the village and
-march inland. I have already sent to notify
-our leader that I have successfully arrived. I
-think for your own good it would be wiser
-for you to remain on board here until we
-start. I do not trust the temper of the
-people. Americans are not just now in
-favor.&#8221; He finished with an amused smile
-on his face.</p>
-
-<p>After their captors had left them, the three
-terribly disappointed men sat bemoaning their
-fate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We might just as well make the best of
-it,&#8221; Sydney philosophically assured the
-others. &#8220;There certainly isn&#8217;t any way to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_58">[58]</span>
-escape that I can see. After all, we&#8217;ve been in
-just as tight places and have come out of
-them; we don&#8217;t make matters any better by
-crying over spilled milk.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If that girl hadn&#8217;t betrayed us,&#8221; Phil
-moaned, &#8220;we would have been on board the
-&#8216;Albany&#8217; this minute.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Mr. Perry,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil broke in apologetically,
-&#8220;it ain&#8217;t like you to be unfair to anybody,
-most of all a woman. These are her own people&mdash;Colonel
-Martinez must be a friend of
-hers, or otherwise we wouldn&#8217;t have been living
-to see the &#8216;Albany.&#8217; If she had only been
-an ordinary native girl, these ladrones wouldn&#8217;t
-have stopped and bowed and scraped and
-then given us the freedom of the after deck of
-the ship. No, sir, she&#8217;s a person of consequence.
-She saved our lives and then afterward
-she saved the lives of Colonel Martinez
-and his band of cutthroats, for if they had
-fallen into the hands of the crew of the
-&#8216;Albany&#8217; they would have all been shot or
-swung at her yard-arm. Seizing this merchant
-ship and killing her captain is piracy.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I think O&#8217;Neil is right,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed
-patting the sailor on the back enthusiastically.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_59">[59]</span>
-&#8220;The girl&#8217;s all right&mdash;I&#8217;ll take my
-hat off to her every time.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It was my own stupidity, I suppose,&#8221;
-Phil declared, his face sobering slightly. &#8220;I
-thought she was too frightened to know what
-was happening; in fact I really didn&#8217;t believe
-she would understand what I intended doing.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Who do you suppose she is?&#8221; Sydney
-asked eagerly. &#8220;Isn&#8217;t it queer she has never
-told us her name?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It probably wouldn&#8217;t aid us if she had,&#8221;
-Phil replied; &#8220;she&#8217;s probably the daughter of
-some rich Filipino, who holds a fat position
-under our civil government. By the way she
-talked when we first met her I thought she
-was dead against war, yet she appears to know
-and welcome these cutthroat Tagalos with
-open arms.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There you go, Phil,&#8221; Sydney admonished,
-&#8220;unfair again. She has so far shown herself
-willing to help both sides. In your heart,
-when you&#8217;ve recovered from your disappointment
-and humiliation at being handled so
-roughly by a girl, you&#8217;ll see that she acted in a
-way that was just to both the insurgents and
-ourselves.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_60">[60]</span>The next morning at daylight the Americans
-were up and dressed, ready for the march
-with their captors.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Martinez has secured enough
-horses for you and your companions to ride,&#8221;
-the girl told them as a half dozen small
-Filipino ponies were led down to the end of
-the wharf. &#8220;Your belongings will be carried
-by natives whom he has secured, so I hope
-you will not be put to too great hardships.
-The soldiers are used to marching, but for
-those unaccustomed to the country it is very
-tedious.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil thanked her not ungraciously. He
-had during many hours of a sleepless night
-brooded over the situation and had awakened
-with much kindlier thoughts for this girl
-than he had held the night before.</p>
-
-<p>The Americans, with Colonel Martinez, the
-girl and her brother rode at the head of the
-long file of armed insurgent soldiers. As the
-procession passed through the streets of the
-town the natives gathered and gave excited
-and enthusiastic yells of pleasure. Great
-curiosity was shown as to the white captives,
-but Colonel Martinez took precautions that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_61">[61]</span>
-they should not be disturbed by the evident
-dislike of the people. Phil read hatred in
-many eyes as they wended their way through
-the curious crowds, and he quite believed the
-insurgent colonel&#8217;s words that they would
-not be safe among them.</p>
-
-<p>The trail which they were following led
-steadily inland, and constantly climbed above
-the level of the sea. After a few miles had
-been covered all signs of habitation disappeared,
-the country was bleak and barren of
-cultivation. At first they had passed through
-groves of cocoanut, banana and many varieties
-of tropical fruit trees and afterward the velvety
-green of rice fields lay on either hand,
-but now the earth was scorched and brown,
-the high jungle bush lay thick on either side
-of the trail. The Americans realized the
-hardships of a campaign in such a country
-against a wild and determined foe. They
-had marched for about four hours without a
-rest when a signal of warning was given from
-scouts in front. The leader stopped, giving a
-low order to a soldier at his elbow.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; Phil breathed, forcing his
-pony forward eagerly.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_62">[62]</span>&#8220;They&#8217;ve seen something,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil whispered;
-&#8220;probably a company of our soldiers
-on a &#8216;hike.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans were ordered to dismount,
-and a dozen riflemen quietly surrounded
-them. Colonel Martinez spurred ahead while
-the entire band dissolved in the jungle, leaving
-the trail clear. Scarcely twenty feet
-from the trail the Americans were roughly
-seized, their hands secured tightly behind
-their backs and gags were forced into their
-mouths. They submitted peaceably. Suddenly,
-scarcely fifty yards away, a column of
-khaki-clad soldiers appeared marching down
-the trail. Phil caught a glimpse through a
-vista in the dense brush of these men, swinging
-lightly along, ignorant of the presence,
-so near them, of over two hundred armed
-enemies. His pulse beat fast and his heart
-seemed ready to burst within him. Were
-these Americans walking innocently into an
-ambush? He tried to scream a warning, but
-he emitted no sound save a faint gurgle,
-which his guards heard, and for his pains
-struck him down with their knees until he
-lay with his face pressed close to the prickly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_63">[63]</span>
-earth. He could hear the tramp of shod feet
-and an occasional snatch of a song. Once he
-heard a sharp command in English and at
-another time a jest which called forth local
-laughter. It seemed an age since he had
-seen the head of this column appear, and yet
-the earth trembled under the tread of a multitude
-of feet. Finally the sounds died away.
-The soldiers had passed, and no attack had
-been made. After a long hour of waiting
-their guards brought out the Americans and
-unbound their hands, taking out the cruel
-gags from their mouths. Colonel Martinez appeared,
-still mounted upon his small gray pony.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am very sorry,&#8221; he said politely, &#8220;but I
-could not run the risk of detection. That
-was Colonel Bane with two battalions of the
-Seventy-eighth Infantry. I had been warned
-that he was in the neighborhood. I was not
-strong enough to attack him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil could have cried aloud at the utter
-uselessness of this warfare. Their movements
-heralded far and wide whenever a column
-moved, in a country well-nigh impenetrable,
-how were the Americans ever to put down
-this ugly rebellion?</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_64">[64]</span>At sunset the band halted and went into
-camp. Phil saw that the site selected was a
-strong one and one that could be easily defended
-from attack if the attackers came by
-trail, and there seemed no other way through
-the impenetrable brush.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We shall remain here until my messenger
-returns,&#8221; Phil overheard Colonel Martinez
-say to the girl. &#8220;Will you wait until your
-father sends for you, or will you accept an
-escort from me?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shall remain here,&#8221; she said; &#8220;the morning
-should bring my own people.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Shortly afterward the girl took her brother&#8217;s
-hand and led him away to the part of the camp
-that had been set aside for her own use, and
-Colonel Martinez joined the disconsolate
-Americans.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he said as he sat down on
-the ground near Phil, &#8220;has told me of the
-brave conduct of my prisoners, and I wish it
-were in my power to set you free. I have
-known many American navy men before this
-war began and my treatment by them has always
-been courteous and considerate. I have
-the power to take your parole, and knowing<span class="pagenum" id="Page_65">[65]</span>
-the hardships which you must undergo as
-prisoners among our soldiers I advise you to
-give it. To-morrow morning you can be on
-your way to Palilo.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>It was certainly a grave temptation, but the
-midshipmen knew that in giving their parole
-all hopes of taking part in the war would
-vanish; and then, the insurgents not being recognized
-as belligerents, the Navy Department
-might even see fit to order them to break their
-parole.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Thank you, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; Phil finally replied.
-&#8220;We shall take our chances as your prisoners.
-We shall always remember your considerate
-treatment of us, and if by the chances of war
-the situation is reversed you can count on us
-to repay our obligations to a chivalrous
-enemy.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you and your companions were to remain
-in my keeping,&#8221; the Filipino answered,
-a pleased smile on his face at Phil&#8217;s subtle
-compliment, &#8220;I should have no concern, but
-I must give you over to the mercies of General
-Diocno; he is a Tagalo, and has known
-nothing but war since his youth; he would
-never surrender to the Spaniards, and for years<span class="pagenum" id="Page_66">[66]</span>
-a price has been upon his head; he is said to
-be cruel to those who fall into his hands.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil shuddered at the frank words of his
-captor. He saw in the earnestness of his face
-that this gruesome information was being
-given for the Americans&#8217; own good.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your friends,&#8221; the colonel continued,
-&#8220;will doubtless attempt a rescue, and that will
-only add to your danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After Colonel Martinez had said good-night
-Phil told his companions of the unpleasant
-and disquieting reports concerning their future
-captor, but nothing could shake O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s good
-spirits.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s all in the game, Mr. Perry,&#8221; he said
-philosophically. &#8220;They can&#8217;t do more than
-kill us, and as we&#8217;ve got to die some day, it
-might just as well be in Kapay as any other
-place. But as long as we&#8217;ve got our senses
-and our strong arms, there are going to be some
-little brown men hurt before I give up my
-mess number.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What I&#8217;ve been trying to study out,&#8221; the
-sailor continued, seeing the two lads still
-silent, &#8220;is how all those American soldiers
-could pass along that trail and not find out<span class="pagenum" id="Page_67">[67]</span>
-that this band of natives had just left it.
-Where are all the old Indian fighters we used
-to have in the army?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney both raised their heads, a
-look of surprise in their faces.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I hadn&#8217;t thought of that,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed.
-&#8220;Our trail must have been there;
-the native soldiers all go barefooted and leave
-but indistinct tracks on this hard soil, but our
-pony tracks must have been in plain sight.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The solution is,&#8221; Phil broke in sadly,
-&#8220;those men were volunteers, the Seventy-eighth
-Infantry, the colonel said; there probably
-wasn&#8217;t an old soldier among them. They
-fight like demons when they see the enemy,
-but are as helpless as children against a savage
-foe skilled in woodcraft. If that had been a
-battalion of regulars there&#8217;d have been a fight
-and we would now be free, or,&#8221; he added with
-an unconscious shiver, &#8220;dead there in the
-jungle, for the native guarding me would
-have been only too happy to stick his bolo
-into me.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil had already rolled himself in his
-blanket, apparently resigned to the tricks of
-fate, and the midshipmen, realizing, after their<span class="pagenum" id="Page_68">[68]</span>
-long day&#8217;s ride in spite of their troubled minds,
-that they were in need of rest, were soon comfortably
-settled on the bundles of dry grass
-given them to lie upon. As Phil dropped
-into a troubled sleep, he was conscious of the
-four native guards, pacing to and fro just
-outside of ear-shot. These four men were all
-that stood between them and liberty; for once
-they had escaped, he felt confident that O&#8217;Neil
-could be depended upon to follow the track of
-those half a thousand soldiers who had
-marched past so carelessly only a few hours
-before.</p>
-
-<p>After what seemed an incredibly short time,
-although he had slept for hours, he awakened
-with a start; sitting bolt upright, he gazed
-quickly about him. A faint streak of light in
-the eastern sky told him the night had nearly
-passed. His brain, keenly alive, grasped for
-a reason; what had stirred him to wakefulness?
-All was quiet about the camp. The
-guards were no longer on their feet, but he
-could see their shadowy forms squatting on
-the ground, their rifles in their hands. With
-a disappointed sigh, for what he did not know,
-he dropped back upon his bundle of straw,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_69">[69]</span>
-but he soon found he was too wide awake for
-more sleep. He finally arose, stretching himself
-as though just awakened, and by an impulse
-which he was powerless to disobey,
-walked slowly toward the guards. As he advanced
-he saw with surprise that they did not
-move. Stealthily he went on until he stood
-over the nearest one, squatting naturally, the
-butt of his rifle between his bare feet. The
-guard was sound asleep. Farther on he saw
-in the dim mysterious light of early dawn that
-the other three were also silently sleeping,
-their bodies propped up against the trunks of
-the dwarf pine-trees. Phil&#8217;s heart beat fast.
-Here was freedom within his grasp. He leaned
-forward, seizing the rifle barrel of an unconscious
-guard, drawing it slowly from his relaxed
-fingers. The butt still rested between
-his feet and as he slowly, steadily drew the
-rifle toward him, the sleeping native&#8217;s body
-settled itself inch by inch upon the ground.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_068.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap"><i>HERE WAS FREEDOM WITHIN<br />
-HIS GRASP</i></p>
-
-<p>A twig snapped close by, sending the blood
-coursing through his veins while his hand
-shook from the sudden start. Terrified he cast
-his startled eyes into the jungle behind him.
-The dim shadow of a man stood scarcely a<span class="pagenum" id="Page_70">[70]</span>
-hundred yards away, silently watching him.
-In the dim light the figure seemed of heroic
-size. He retreated toward it and back to his
-sleeping companions, the rifle clasped in his
-hand. Then suddenly the silence was broken
-by a volley of rifle-shots and the hiss of bullets
-sounded everywhere about him. Stunned,
-unable to explain the meaning of this, he
-dropped to the ground and lay silent, his face
-in the straw of his bed. The next second a
-line of shouting, excited khaki-clad men
-streamed past, firing their rifles as they charged
-upon their hidden native foes.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_71">[71]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER V<br />
-
-
-<small>CAPTAIN BLYNN MARCHES</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">As</span> night fell, Captain Blynn led his battalion
-of regulars from their barracks, across the
-bridge and on to the trail leading to the northward
-of Palilo. The American officer rode in
-the lead, the Filipino Presidente at his side.
-The soldiers behind him, eight full companies,
-each under its own officer, swung along with
-the long, untiring step of the American soldier.
-They each knew that before the night
-was over and the sun had lifted its fiery head
-above the misty mountains to the eastward
-twenty miles of rough trail must be covered,
-and then they had been promised to be
-brought face to face with an enemy whose
-shadows they had chased during these many
-long, tiresome months.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa, as he rode in silence by the side
-of the big American, chuckled inwardly at the
-fruitlessness of this expedition. &#8220;These childlike<span class="pagenum" id="Page_72">[72]</span>
-American dogs,&#8221; he thought, &#8220;they will
-arrive in time to see the smouldering fires
-where our men have cooked their morning
-rice, while they will be high in the hills, looking
-down on them derisively, and possibly
-will fire a few shots at long range to show their
-contempt.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn&#8217;s restless gaze contemplated
-his companion from time to time as the native
-signaled the right trail. They were now in a
-narrow defile between two hills that rose precipitously
-to a height of over a thousand feet.
-Captain Blynn, as he contemplated his surroundings
-with a soldier&#8217;s eyes, drew his revolver
-from its holster and laid it gently across
-the pommel of his saddle.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A nice place for an ambush,&#8221; he said in a
-low, insinuating voice. &#8220;I suppose, se&ntilde;or,
-you are prepared to stand before your Maker.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The native shuddered. He saw only too
-clearly the accusation and threat in this terrible
-American&#8217;s words. If there was to be an
-ambush, he knew nothing of it, but if a single
-hostile shot was fired, he would pay the penalty
-with his life.</p>
-
-<p>The Filipino forced an uneasy laugh. &#8220;As<span class="pagenum" id="Page_73">[73]</span>
-far as I know, se&ntilde;or capitan, there are no insurgents
-this side of Banate.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;For your sake, I hope you are right,&#8221; the
-American replied. &#8220;As you see, I am taking
-no chances. You are our guide; if you get
-us into trouble, you pay, that&#8217;s all.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn ordered a halt and called a
-lieutenant from the leading company.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Take ten men, Simpson,&#8221; he said, &#8220;and
-act as the point. If you are attacked, retreat
-and fall back on the main body.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Simpson picked his men quickly
-and disappeared quietly down the trail. Captain
-Blynn watched them until swallowed up
-in the darkness, and then set the long line in
-motion again. Every soldier took, instinctively,
-a tighter grip upon his musket, and
-loosened the sharp sword bayonet from its
-scabbard. Each knew that when &#8220;Black
-Jack&#8221; Blynn took precautions there was reason
-to scent trouble.</p>
-
-<p>Half-way through the defile a guarded
-whistle of warning came to Blynn&#8217;s ears from
-the point. As one man the long column
-halted; the soldiers&#8217; heavy breathing was distinctly
-audible above the tremor of the metallic<span class="pagenum" id="Page_74">[74]</span>
-rattling of accoutrements. Each soldier
-sought his neighbor&#8217;s face for a key to the
-solution of the problem. Blynn, motioning
-Espinosa to follow, rode silently forward. In
-the trail a hundred paces ahead he saw Lieutenant
-Simpson bending over a dark object.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; Blynn asked in a harsh
-whisper.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A dead native,&#8221; Simpson answered shortly.
-Espinosa was off his horse instantly; bending
-down quickly he struck a match, illuminating
-the native&#8217;s dead face. He started, turning
-a sickly yellow. His heart stopped beating,
-and his knees shook under him, but
-Captain Blynn was too much occupied with
-the silent figure to notice the peculiar behavior
-of his guide. They turned the dead
-man over, revealing the terrible havoc accomplished
-in but a few hours by the tropical
-scourge.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Poor chap!&#8221; Blynn exclaimed. &#8220;Only
-a common &#8216;Tao&#8217; stricken by cholera and dead
-before he knew what had hit him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>They moved the body off the trail, and
-again the command was set in motion.</p>
-
-<p>In the flash of the match Espinosa had<span class="pagenum" id="Page_75">[75]</span>
-recognized his messenger although his face
-was horribly disfigured by his last mortal suffering.
-He shuddered at the consequences of
-this man&#8217;s death&mdash;Martinez would not get his
-warning message and would fall into the trap
-set for him. He, Espinosa, could never explain
-his actions. He would doubtless pay
-for this treachery with his life. But his cruel
-mind was instantly made up as to his future
-actions. He feared this American too thoroughly
-not to take them to the place where
-the Tagalos under Martinez were encamped;
-above all else Captain Blynn must be made to
-believe that he was sincere; all depended upon
-that. Everything must be sacrificed for his
-final great ambition. Martinez would not be
-taken alive. That was a necessity, he would
-see to that. Once he was killed his part in the
-night&#8217;s expedition must remain a secret
-among the Americans.</p>
-
-<p>Casting from him his first fears he straightened
-his slight frame and rode boldly, with
-head erect, beside the American leader.</p>
-
-<p>One hour before sunrise Captain Blynn
-disposed his command in a single circular
-line about the base of a high hill; its sides<span class="pagenum" id="Page_76">[76]</span>
-were covered with a dense jungle while a
-single trail led to the top.</p>
-
-<p>Under the guardianship of Espinosa the
-command moved forward, straight up through
-the high clutching brush; the men were so
-close to each other that their neighbors on
-each side were always in sight. Captain
-Blynn and one company marched fearlessly
-up the trail. A few feet from where the
-round top hill had been cleared he halted
-and waited for the remainder of his men to
-join him. His enemy&#8217;s camp was silent, but
-his keen eyes could discern shadowy forms
-lying prone on the ground. He searched for
-a sentry, but no movement could be seen.
-Were they all asleep, believing themselves
-secure in their surroundings? No! there
-directly in front of him he saw a white figure
-standing upright beside a dark form on the
-ground. This must be an officer, for the
-native soldiers do not wear white&mdash;something
-familiar in the pose and cut of the uniform
-struck him. Could it be possible, was it a
-navy uniform? At that instant the soldiers
-on both sides reached the edge of the clearing.
-As yet the enemy were unaware of their<span class="pagenum" id="Page_77">[77]</span>
-presence. Not a moment must be lost; they
-must attack at once. Firing his revolver,
-Captain Blynn plunged forward, straight toward
-the white-clad figure. Several of his
-men passed him while he stopped to find
-why the figure had thrown itself face downward
-in the grass at the discharge of his
-revolver.</p>
-
-<p>The next moment he was shaking hands
-with three almost tearfully joyful fellow
-countrymen.</p>
-
-<p>As soon as Phil realized that they were
-again free his thoughts were for the Filipino
-girl and her little brother. Was she in
-danger? With the rifle he had taken from
-the sentry in his hands, he rushed anxiously
-in the direction that he believed she might
-be found. He recognized some of her belongings
-on the ground at his feet, but the girl
-had vanished. Fearful at the thought of
-finding them killed by his own people, he
-sought her everywhere, repeatedly risking his
-life as the terrified natives, finding themselves
-trapped, flung at him with their long,
-sharp knives or discharged their weapons almost
-in his face. He gave them but little<span class="pagenum" id="Page_78">[78]</span>
-heed, not giving a thought to the reason why
-he had not been killed, although a faithful
-sailor at his elbow was the only tangible
-cause. A score of times O&#8217;Neil had saved his
-young officer at the risk of his own life.</p>
-
-<p>A small group of struggling men on the
-right near the edge of the jungle suddenly
-caught his restless eye and desperately he
-plunged downward toward them. On the
-ground two men struggled in a death embrace,
-while the girl and her brother stood
-wild-eyed with fright, unwilling spectators to
-the fierce duel. Phil gave a gasp of relief as
-he stood beside the girl. The two combatants
-uttered no sound save their sharp gasps for
-breath while they struggled for supremacy.
-Phil saw with wonder that the men were
-both natives and then for the first time
-realized that they were alone; no soldier was
-within a hundred yards of them. Behind
-them the soldiers were relentlessly, stubbornly
-herding the natives into a mass of
-flashing, frenzied humanity at the top of the
-hill.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is Colonel Martinez,&#8221; the girl gasped
-seizing Phil&#8217;s arm. &#8220;Oh, save him, se&ntilde;or,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_79">[79]</span>
-he will be murdered.&#8221; Phil saw the other
-native, by an effort almost superhuman, free
-his right arm, and in it a bright blade flashed
-in the dim light. The girl&#8217;s appealing face
-looked into his for an instant, and the next
-moment the lad had thrown himself between
-the two men; seizing the hand with the
-knife he bent it slowly backward, finally
-wrenching it from its firm grasp. O&#8217;Neil
-was beside him. The sailor caught the two
-natives as if they had been fighting dogs and
-held them for a second in his powerful arms
-clear of the ground. Espinosa fell limply as
-the sailor released his hold, and lay breathing
-heavily, too exhausted for speech. Colonel
-Martinez quickly regained his revolver, and
-was immediately the man of action. He gazed
-boldly at the Americans, his revolver held
-menacingly, and the while edging slowly
-away from his captors. Phil turned his eyes
-to the figure on the ground and the angry
-glare he received disconcerted him; the next
-second as he looked about him he saw that
-Colonel Martinez had gone; from the gloom
-of the jungle he heard the rustle of brush
-and caught a glimpse of misty forms. He<span class="pagenum" id="Page_80">[80]</span>
-raised his rifle half-way and then lowered it.
-In his heart he rejoiced that he had not
-taken him prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>In the next second Espinosa leaped toward
-him. Phil was stunned by a stinging blow;
-but before it could be repeated O&#8217;Neil interposed
-and Espinosa had measured his length
-on the ground.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where did Colonel Martinez go?&#8221; Phil
-asked quietly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I didn&#8217;t see,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil answered, his face as
-solemn as that of a judge.</p>
-
-<p>Phil smiled and put out his hand. The two
-men exchanged clasps. &#8220;I believe he would
-have done as much for us,&#8221; Phil said.</p>
-
-<p>Before the sun had risen above the sea to
-the eastward, the fight was over. But few of
-the enemy had escaped. Asking no quarter,
-fighting to the last man, they had died as they
-had lived. Two hundred rifles were the
-spoils of the fight.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn and the midshipmen were
-seated after their victory on the bloody battle-field,
-while the lads gave a hurried account of
-their capture.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly from the grass a horribly disfigured<span class="pagenum" id="Page_81">[81]</span>
-face confronted them. It was Espinosa.
-His cunning gave him counsel that he must
-control his ungovernable temper. He could
-gain nothing by accusing these Americans of
-wilfully aiding Martinez in his escape. &#8220;I
-am sorry to inform you, se&ntilde;or captain, that
-Colonel Martinez escaped. These gentlemen
-can tell you the details. I was about to kill
-him. They doubtless had good reasons for
-permitting him to escape.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn turned quickly to the midshipmen,
-a surprised look on his face at the
-words of his guide.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Is this true?&#8221; he asked angrily.</p>
-
-<p>Phil felt as he had before the court-martial
-that had tried him for disobeying orders.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I alone am to blame, captain,&#8221; the lad
-replied quietly, after an effort. &#8220;I saw these
-two men on the ground and separated them,
-seeing they were both natives. This man attacked
-me afterward, so of course he was
-knocked down.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But it was Colonel Martinez! His capture
-is worth far more than all these men and
-rifles,&#8221; the captain exclaimed angrily, pointing
-to the heaps of slain being laid side<span class="pagenum" id="Page_82">[82]</span>
-by side in the narrow trench dug by the
-soldiers.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He escaped,&#8221; Phil said, his throat dry,
-but his eyes looking fearlessly into those of
-the enraged officer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You will have to explain this, sir,&#8221; Captain
-Blynn cried hoarsely, cutting short any
-explanation. &#8220;You are under my command
-here. If you have deliberately allowed this
-man to escape, I shall prosecute you to the utmost
-of my power, and you know the articles
-of war sufficiently to understand the penalty
-for such an unauthorized act.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil was stunned; but his conscience had
-acquitted him of all guilt.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_83">[83]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VI<br />
-
-
-<small>THE &#8220;MINDINAO&#8221;</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Captain Blynn</span> rested his tired soldiers
-until the cool of the evening and then the
-march was begun back to Palilo, carrying
-with them the spoils of the fight.</p>
-
-<p>The judge-advocate general, in spite of the
-complete victory, was not friendly to the
-Americans whom he had rescued from a torturing
-captivity. The escape of the Filipino
-leader, Colonel Martinez, was indeed a severe
-blow to his pride. Both Sydney and O&#8217;Neil,
-while giving the officer their gratitude for
-their deliverance, were hurt at his stern attitude
-toward Phil.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why did you allow him to escape?&#8221;
-Sydney asked as they were riding side by side
-along the back trail which the soldiers had
-taken the night before.</p>
-
-<p>Phil looked at his friend, a hurt expression
-in his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He was armed,&#8221; Phil said quietly, a catch<span class="pagenum" id="Page_84">[84]</span>
-in his voice which he could not control, &#8220;and
-I knew he would not be taken alive. I
-couldn&#8217;t kill him,&#8221; he added, &#8220;before the
-girl&#8217;s eyes, and there seemed no other way.
-Something tells me that there is a strong
-blood tie between those two. I can&#8217;t explain,
-Syd,&#8221; he cried in confusion. &#8220;It may sound
-sentimental, but the look in the girl&#8217;s eyes
-when she realized what might happen made
-me lower the muzzle of the rifle to the
-ground.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney was silent. He believed implicitly
-in Phil and if opportunity had offered he was
-sure that he would have acted the same.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But why didn&#8217;t you give Captain Blynn
-your reasons for allowing this insurgent to
-escape? You must see how he now views the
-occurrence and a word from you would have
-set matters straight.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A sudden anger came into Phil&#8217;s face. &#8220;I
-would have told him all, but you saw how he
-cut off my explanation and arraigned me before
-that despicable spy Espinosa. After that a
-mule team couldn&#8217;t drag the story from me.
-I&#8217;ll tell it in good time, but not to Captain
-Blynn. Syd,&#8221; he added confidingly, &#8220;I<span class="pagenum" id="Page_85">[85]</span>
-don&#8217;t like that fellow Espinosa&#8217;s looks. He
-reminds me of a domesticated coyote. He
-will bite the hands that feed him some day.
-You see if he doesn&#8217;t!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I haven&#8217;t any use for these men who are
-traitors to their own countrymen,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil
-joined in as he rode up alongside of Phil, the
-trail having widened to allow three abreast.
-&#8220;The soldiers tell me he is the white-haired old
-boy with Captain Blynn. It was he that betrayed
-the Tagalos. How he gets his information
-no one seems to know. Did you notice,&#8221;
-he asked suddenly, &#8220;the expression on his face
-when I dragged him away from the insurgent
-colonel? He wanted that man&#8217;s life the worst
-kind, and the girl&#8217;s too, I guess. We&#8217;ve made
-an enemy, Mr. Perry,&#8221; the sailor added decidedly,
-&#8220;and one who won&#8217;t soon forget us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gave a mirthless laugh.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t mind making that sort of an enemy,&#8221;
-he said, &#8220;but we shall have to keep our eyes
-open hereafter, I suppose, for Se&ntilde;or Espinosa.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>It was broad daylight before the expedition
-arrived in Palilo and after a formal parting
-from the other Americans, which O&#8217;Neil described
-as &#8220;the frozen mit,&#8221; the naval men<span class="pagenum" id="Page_86">[86]</span>
-separated from the soldiers and took the street
-leading to the water-front. There in front of
-the quartermaster&#8217;s depot they saw the gunboat
-&#8220;Mindinao&#8221; moored snugly to the stone
-jetty.</p>
-
-<p>A wave of pride swept through Phil&#8217;s body
-as he took in the trim outlines of his command,
-one of which any lad would be proud
-to be captain.</p>
-
-<p>A score of curious faces peered at them from
-the gunboat as they drew rein at the gangway
-and dismounted.</p>
-
-<p>An exclamation of surprised inquiry met
-their ears from the quarter-deck of the vessel
-and a second later Ensign Marshall was
-wringing their hands warmly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well, if this isn&#8217;t luck,&#8221; he cried. &#8220;I am
-partly packed and there&#8217;s a steamer for Manila
-this afternoon. But,&#8221; and he stopped, precipitously
-gazing with frank astonishment at
-their soiled and mud-stained uniforms, &#8220;where
-did you come from? I expected you by boat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While the Chinese servants set before their
-hungry eyes a tempting breakfast, Phil and
-Sydney in turn gave Marshall the exciting incidents
-of their journey from Manila. O&#8217;Neil<span class="pagenum" id="Page_87">[87]</span>
-meanwhile had turned forward and was at
-once the centre of an admiring crowd of
-sailors; his big voice and hearty laugh sounded
-distinctly over the quiet water-front.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you aren&#8217;t the luckiest lambs I&#8217;ve ever
-seen,&#8221; Marshall laughed admiringly; &#8220;you&#8217;re
-a regular lodestone, the three of you. Everything
-you touch turns to excitement. Now
-I&#8217;ve been here for three months, most of the
-time cooling my heels at the dock with no one
-to talk to except a lot of hayseed volunteers
-who haven&#8217;t even been to sea, and now you
-come along and relieve me and I suppose,
-&#8216;presto,&#8217; there&#8217;ll be something doing at once.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I hope not until we can get a little sleep,&#8221;
-Phil exclaimed, smiling at Marshall&#8217;s sincerity.
-&#8220;I am sleepy enough to drop off standing up.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well,&#8221; Marshall said as he pushed back
-his chair and arose from the table, &#8220;I&#8217;ll be
-finished packing in an hour, and then you
-can read your orders and take command. I
-don&#8217;t want to miss that boat, for she makes
-easy connections with the transport for home.
-Think of it, Perry, home! Doesn&#8217;t it sound
-fine?&#8221; Then, seeing that the name had not
-stirred his listeners to a great degree of enthusiasm,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_88">[88]</span>
-he exclaimed, &#8220;Well, if you&#8217;d been living
-by yourself for nearly a year and hadn&#8217;t
-seen anything but these natives, home would
-sound good to you, too.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lads were soon asleep in steamer chairs
-under the quarter-deck awning, while Marshall
-busied himself with his packing. The Chinese
-servants moved about noiselessly and
-with deft hands quickly filled the two open
-trunks. Finally Marshall remade his toilet
-and appeared spick and span in a fresh and
-spotless white uniform.</p>
-
-<p>Refreshed by even this short nap the midshipmen
-opened their trunks, which had been
-carried over nearly sixty miles of rough country
-on the shoulders of stalwart native carriers,
-and in an incredibly short time appeared
-on deck as fresh in appearance as if they had
-both stepped from the proverbial band-box.</p>
-
-<p>A shrill whistle sounded on the gunboat
-followed by the call, &#8220;Lay aft, everybody.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The men filed aft on the miniature quarter-deck,
-lining themselves obediently on each
-side, and there waited.</p>
-
-<p>A smile stole irrepressibly to Phil&#8217;s face.
-Here on board this tiny ship, scarcely a hundred<span class="pagenum" id="Page_89">[89]</span>
-feet long and of a little over one hundred
-tons displacement, the far-reaching navy regulations
-were being carried out with as much
-form and punctiliousness as they would be on
-the biggest battle-ship.</p>
-
-<p>In a graceful speech Marshall bade farewell
-to his small crew and then he unfolded the
-paper in his hand signed by no less a personage
-than the admiral commanding the Asiatic
-fleet.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You are, upon the reporting of your relief,
-Midshipman Philip Perry, U. S. Navy, detached
-from the command of the U. S. S.
-&#8216;Mindinao&#8217; and will proceed immediately
-to Manila, reporting your arrival, for passage
-to your home, to the senior officer present.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As soon as Marshall&#8217;s voice died away, Phil
-began to read his own orders, which he had
-kept safely pinned to the inside of his breast-pocket
-during the last few exciting days.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You are hereby detached from the U. S. S.
-&#8216;Ph&#339;nix&#8217; and will proceed to Palilo, Island
-of Kapay, Philippine Islands, and upon your
-arrival assume command of the U. S. S.
-&#8216;Mindinao&#8217; as the relief of Ensign Charles
-Marshall, U. S. Navy.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_90">[90]</span>For a moment there was complete silence,
-broken in an instant by a hoarse voice.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Three cheers for Captain Marshall.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>From twenty-five strong chests the cheers
-were given, while the happy man honored
-blushed with pleasurable pride and manly
-tears welled to his eyes. And then Phil&#8217;s turn
-came to blush and look confused, and as he
-said afterward, foolish, when the same loud
-voice proposed, &#8220;Three cheers for Captain
-Perry.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Immediately the cheering was over the
-boatswain&#8217;s mate&#8217;s pipe sounded shrilly and
-the men, touching their caps respectfully, returned
-to their quarters forward.</p>
-
-<p>The lads saw Marshall sail away on a small
-island steamer similar to the one on which
-they had commenced their journey four days
-before and then returned to sit upon the quarter-deck
-of their gunboat and enjoy the intense
-gratification of being their own masters on
-their own ship.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Think of it, Syd. If I want to get under
-way all I have to do is to tell the machinist
-to get up steam and off we go. It&#8217;s like having
-your own yacht,&#8221; Phil exclaimed contentedly,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_91">[91]</span>
-leaning back luxuriantly in his chair
-and cocking his feet up comfortably on the
-rail. &#8220;Let me see,&#8221; he added banteringly,
-&#8220;I am the captain; you are the executive officer,
-navigator, ordnance officer, all the watch
-officers and the chief engineer. Don&#8217;t you feel
-heavy with all those titles?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney smiled happily. &#8220;Well, if the &#8216;old
-man&#8217; doesn&#8217;t expect too much of a poor midshipman,
-I&#8217;ll do my best to uphold the dignity
-of them all,&#8221; he replied.</p>
-
-<p>After they had settled themselves in their
-new homes and had inspected every foot of
-the clean, trim little craft, admired the powerful
-battery of six long three-pounder guns, with
-auxiliaries of two one-pounders and a much
-sinned-against Colt gun, they started over the
-gangway bent upon paying their respects to
-the general commanding the troops in the
-military district of Kapay.</p>
-
-<p>It was with a decided feeling of uneasiness
-that Phil sent his card by the orderly to the
-general. He knew that Captain Blynn had
-before this given his superior officer a full account
-of his expedition and he felt sure that
-the escape of Martinez with his consequent<span class="pagenum" id="Page_92">[92]</span>
-blame had not been forgotten in the telling.
-However, his high spirits could not be easily
-dampened by even these sinister thoughts.
-His greatest ambition had been achieved.
-Was he not the commander of an American
-man-of-war? He was not even under the
-command of that awe-inspiring figure he could
-see dimly at the desk, on whose shoulders the
-direction of an army rested.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of this feeling of independence the
-lad&#8217;s pulse beat faster as the orderly beckoned
-him to enter the general&#8217;s office.</p>
-
-<p>A short, sharp-featured officer, whose hair
-and beard were as white as his spotless clothes,
-arose from his chair and gave a welcoming
-hand to the visitors in turn, inviting them in
-silence to be seated.</p>
-
-<p>Phil fidgeted restlessly in his chair, while
-the general paced slowly toward the open
-window and back again to his desk. Phil
-was on the point of speaking several times,
-but each time he waited, seeing in the army
-man&#8217;s face that he was about to speak.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Blynn has made his report,&#8221; came
-in metallic tones from the old campaigner,
-&#8220;and I am deeply distressed to hear that you,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_93">[93]</span>
-Captain Perry, deliberately allowed a prisoner
-to escape; one whom above all I wished to lay
-my hands on. Blynn is for asking the admiral
-to court-martial you at once; but I am sure you
-must have some good reason for your action.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>He ended and glanced questioningly at the
-abashed Phil.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My reason was,&#8221; the lad blurted out, his
-feelings much hurt at the severe arraignment,
-&#8220;that in order to capture Colonel Martinez, I
-would have had to kill him in cold blood. I
-couldn&#8217;t bring myself to do it for he had behaved
-handsomely toward us while we were
-his prisoners.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But,&#8221; the general retorted, &#8220;Se&ntilde;or Espinosa
-would have saved you the trouble if you had
-not interfered.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s wrath blazed forth.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How did I know that the man who was
-about to murder Martinez was a traitor to his
-own people? I saw the two natives on the
-ground, one with a knife upraised to bury it in
-the body of a man lying helplessly beneath
-him, and then when I had separated them
-with the help of a sailor, I saw that Martinez
-was armed, and I knew by a glance at his face<span class="pagenum" id="Page_94">[94]</span>
-that he could not be taken alive.&#8221; The lad
-stopped suddenly, the girl&#8217;s face coming suddenly
-before his eye. Did the general know
-of her? He remembered that her presence at
-the scene had not been mentioned. Had
-Espinosa failed to discover her presence? If
-not, why had he failed to mention her in his
-report to Captain Blynn?</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson&#8217;s parchment-like face betrayed
-a suspicion of a smile while he listened
-patiently to the midshipman&#8217;s impetuous defense
-of his own actions.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Perry,&#8221; he said slowly, &#8220;after
-you have been fighting these natives longer
-your sensibilities will become more blunted.
-The excuse of allowing an enemy to escape
-simply because you did not wish to kill him
-would be laughed at by those who have been
-through these six months of fighting. But,&#8221; he
-added, &#8220;I respect the delicacy of the situation
-and shall tell Captain Blynn that I approve of
-your actions.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s gratitude was fully expressed in the
-look he gave the officer as he murmured his
-thanks.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I do not wish you to believe,&#8221; the general<span class="pagenum" id="Page_95">[95]</span>
-added hastily, &#8220;that I approve of useless bloodshed,
-but in a warfare such as has been forced
-upon us the higher instincts of generosity to a
-fallen foe have but small place. It is an eye
-for an eye with us now.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As the general finished speaking the adjutant-general,
-Major Marble, entered and
-greeted the newcomers warmly. Both the
-lads had known him in their Annapolis days.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Major Marble will give you the situation,&#8221;
-the general said as the midshipmen shook his
-hand in parting. &#8220;I suppose you are ready to
-get under way on summons.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil answered promptly in the affirmative.</p>
-
-<p>The major took the lads to his own comfortable
-quarters, facing the Plaza, and then told
-them briefly of the perplexing conditions
-under which the general was struggling.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The insurgents will only fight,&#8221; the major
-told them earnestly, &#8220;when they can surprise
-us, and with these untrained volunteers that
-has been very frequent of late.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen told him how the American
-troops had marched unsuspectingly past
-Colonel Martinez&#8217;s party the day before Captain
-Blynn attacked them.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_96">[96]</span>Major Marble shook his head sadly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Bane is not a soldier and never
-will be. He has blundered into more traps
-than any officer in the island.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A heavy footfall sounded on the stairs.
-Major Marble stopped talking suddenly, and
-walked quickly to the door as Captain Blynn&#8217;s
-stalwart figure emerged from the stairway.
-&#8220;Come here, Blynn,&#8221; he called.</p>
-
-<p>The judge-advocate general approached;
-upon his face was a good-natured smile which
-changed suddenly to an ugly frown as he
-caught sight of his brother officer&#8217;s guests.
-He would have turned sullenly away, but
-Major Marble put out a restraining hand.
-The lads had risen to their feet. Phil felt his
-own face suffuse with blood as he caught the
-glint of annoyance in Captain Blynn&#8217;s eyes.
-The midshipman turned his back quietly and
-looked out the window. A moment later he
-heard the captain&#8217;s heavy tread in the hall
-and a door slam loudly. When he turned
-Major Marble&#8217;s face was pale and his blue eyes
-flashed angrily.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Blynn&#8217;s a boor, sometimes,&#8221; he hastened
-to apologize. &#8220;I&#8217;ve heard the story. He&#8217;s<span class="pagenum" id="Page_97">[97]</span>
-so absorbed in his work that any one who
-thwarts him arouses his dislike. He cannot
-see the human side. He&#8217;s a veritable bull in
-a china shop. He and Espinosa are doing
-splendid service. All of our success so far
-has been through their secret service work.
-You&#8217;ll be friends after you&#8217;ve been here
-a while. Martinez&#8217;s escape hurts his pride just
-now. Martinez is something like the man
-with the iron mask. He comes from Luzon,
-but no one knows who he is. We have wired
-Manila and they answer that they know of
-no insurgent officer of that name. Yet he&#8217;s
-here, and from all accounts has been expected.
-Most of his party were destroyed by
-Blynn, but about seventy-five are believed to
-have escaped, and Espinosa says that his followers
-are landing every day in the neighborhood
-of Dumaguete. I think the general&#8217;s
-plan is to have you cruise off there in hopes
-of intercepting some of their war parties.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil had composed his ruffled feelings and
-listened eagerly while Major Marble was talking.
-His heart sank within him as there
-flashed through his mind thoughts as to
-whom Martinez might be. Maybe no less a<span class="pagenum" id="Page_98">[98]</span>
-personage than Aguinaldo himself, or General
-Rios, had been within his grasp. Small wonder
-that Captain Blynn was put out at his
-escape. Yet he could not have done otherwise
-with the girl&#8217;s beseeching, pleading eyes
-upon him.</p>
-
-<p>After leaving Major Marble&#8217;s quarters the
-lads took a turn around the small Spanish
-town, loitering before the many shops and
-gazing admiringly up at the great churches,
-gray with age. They finally hired a carramata,
-the native cab, and drove through the
-city and out on the military road, begun by
-the Spaniards years before but, as was the
-custom of the country, never finished. As
-they drove into the Plaza on their return
-they came face to face with Se&ntilde;or Espinosa,
-riding a blooded horse which was prancing
-and pawing the earth, and making vain attempts
-to unseat its rider. Espinosa drew
-rein and bowed pointedly and courteously to
-the Americans.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;ores,&#8221; he called eagerly, &#8220;may I have
-a word with you?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil ordered his cochero to stop, while
-Espinosa dismounted, throwing his reins to a<span class="pagenum" id="Page_99">[99]</span>
-small native gamin near by. The native advanced
-to the carriage hat in hand and with
-as much ceremony as if he were about to
-speak to some exalted personage.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am extremely mortified at my actions
-of yesterday,&#8221; he exclaimed in his fluent and
-grandiloquent Spanish. &#8220;I have just seen
-the general. I abjectly apologize for my
-rudeness. May I count upon the friendship
-of the se&ntilde;ores?&#8221; he asked in a suave, appealing
-voice.</p>
-
-<p>Phil flinched unconsciously. He felt as if
-some reptile was drawing him toward him
-against his will. Espinosa&#8217;s eyes were mild
-and his smile was urbane; yet he felt that
-treachery was hidden behind this mask of
-friendliness. Espinosa read the struggle in
-the lad&#8217;s eyes and for an instant the mildness
-died in his own and a savage gleam took its
-place, but Phil&#8217;s gaze had wandered, and this
-vision of the true man was lost.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t bear you any ill will for that,&#8221;
-Phil replied, his voice unconsciously accenting
-the last word. &#8220;I suppose you felt you
-had been cheated of your victory over Colonel
-Martinez.&#8221; Then the lad stopped suddenly,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_100">[100]</span>
-a question trembling on his lips. Why should
-he not ask it? Wherein was the harm?
-&#8220;Who was the girl with him?&#8221; Phil suddenly
-questioned.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa&#8217;s face paled and in his eyes fear
-crept. &#8220;The girl,&#8221; he gasped, &#8220;was there a
-girl?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil nodded. &#8220;Yes, and her small brother;
-they came on the steamer with us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;And escaped with Martinez,&#8221; Espinosa exclaimed
-excitedly. &#8220;I didn&#8217;t see her; it was
-too dark. While I was struggling I thought
-I heard a woman&#8217;s scream, but afterward I
-saw only Martinez.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil saw the native was unduly agitated.
-What did it mean? How and why had the
-presence of this woman so greatly excited
-him?</p>
-
-<p>As the midshipmen drove toward their
-ship this question was still in Phil&#8217;s thoughts.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Is Espinosa playing a double game?&#8221; he
-asked Sydney suddenly. &#8220;Does he fear detection
-by his own people? Does he believe that
-Martinez did not recognize him and that his
-identity as a traitor is safe?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney shook his head over the mystery.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_101">[101]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VII<br />
-
-
-<small>THE GUNBOAT CO&Ouml;PERATES</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">As</span> the two midshipmen stepped over the
-gangway of the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; a figure arose
-from a seat on the quarter-deck and hurried
-eagerly toward them.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ve been waiting an hour for you,&#8221; Major
-Marble exclaimed excitedly. &#8220;The general
-wants you to start as soon as possible for
-Binalbagan. Baker&#8217;s men have had a fight;
-we got some news, and then the wire was cut;
-our signal corps men have already gone out to
-find the break. Tillotson and fifty men will
-be on board inside of an hour.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen&#8217;s eyes opened wide with
-excitement.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;re getting up steam, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil
-volunteered. &#8220;I thought something was in
-the wind when I seen the major come aboard,
-so I asked him and he told me what we was to
-do.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_102">[102]</span>&#8220;Good for you,&#8221; Phil exclaimed, throwing
-an appreciative glance at the trusty boatswain&#8217;s
-mate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Baker is in the field and a sergeant and
-twenty men are holding the post,&#8221; Major
-Marble continued, &#8220;but if the natives are in
-great force such a handful cannot last long.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>An hour later, Lieutenant Tillotson, a thin,
-blonde-haired youngster, marched his khaki-clad
-men on board and joined the little group
-of officers about the table on the quarter-deck.</p>
-
-<p>Phil gave the young soldier a look of close
-scrutiny as he unbuckled the revolver from
-about his slim waist and laid it on the hatch
-top. There was nothing soldierly in the newcomer&#8217;s
-appearance, and Phil unconsciously
-gave a sigh of disappointment. On the officer&#8217;s
-collar between the crossed rifles was a
-single numeral.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;And a regular, too,&#8221; he thought.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Good luck,&#8221; Major Marble cried as he
-passed over the gangway on to the dock while
-the gunboat heaved up its anchor from the
-muddy bottom of the river and steamed swiftly
-for the outer harbor.</p>
-
-<p>Phil studied carefully the chart in his miniature<span class="pagenum" id="Page_103">[103]</span>
-wheel house forward. &#8220;Ninety miles,&#8221;
-he mused as he stepped off the distance to
-Binalbagan. &#8220;At this speed we&#8217;ll be in by
-daylight.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The three sat long over their dinner on the
-cool quarter-deck, while the gunboat sped
-rapidly along the coast of Kapay. Forward,
-the soldiers and sailors fraternized, speculating
-upon the morrow&#8217;s work.</p>
-
-<p>The naval men&#8217;s faces were keenly excited.
-The long-looked-for fun had commenced.
-They were almost willing to hope that Captain
-Baker&#8217;s men were having a stiff time of it, so
-that the guns of their boat could have a chance
-to speak their disapproval to the insurgents.
-Lieutenant Tillotson sat coolly contemplating
-his coffee cup. To him these expeditions
-meant but one thing: discomfort.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s the chance for a fight?&#8221; Sydney
-asked the army man.</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson shook his head. &#8220;None,&#8221; he
-replied, &#8220;unless we can catch them by surprise.
-This gunboat would scare off an army of insurgents.
-They don&#8217;t like them.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But we shall surprise them,&#8221; Phil cried
-enthusiastically. &#8220;We&#8217;ll get there before daylight,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_104">[104]</span>
-hit the enemy from behind and crumple
-him up. I dare say, though, the fight will be
-finished before we arrive.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson shook his head. He was non-committal.
-&#8220;News travels fast in this country,
-and it&#8217;s only twenty-five miles by road to
-Binalbagan,&#8221; he said.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you been there?&#8221; Phil asked, all interest.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; Tillotson replied carelessly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What is your plan?&#8221; Phil inquired
-quickly.</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson eyed the lad, his blue eyes wide
-with astonishment, while a superior smile
-curved the corners of his mouth.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Plan?&#8221; he asked. &#8220;Why, just to land,
-that&#8217;s all; isn&#8217;t that enough?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, but,&#8221; Phil urged, &#8220;it&#8217;ll be dark, and if
-fighting is going on, we may get between the
-two fires. I got myself in that fix once, and I
-know how it feels.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson&#8217;s eyes opened wider. He took a
-closer look at this young midshipman.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What does he know of being under fire?&#8221;
-he thought. Tillotson was a first lieutenant;
-he had served in Cuba and in the Philippines,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_105">[105]</span>
-but his active duty until his assignment to
-the regiment whose number he now wore on
-his collar had been only at a desk at headquarters.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What service have you seen?&#8221; he inquired
-of Phil in a patronizing voice. &#8220;Were you
-in the battle of Santiago, or Manila Bay, perhaps?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;No&mdash;not those,&#8221; Phil answered quickly,
-awe in his voice; &#8220;only a few skirmishes, that&#8217;s
-all,&#8221; he added sheepishly, &#8220;in South America
-and in China.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have we then had trouble in those places
-recently?&#8221; Tillotson inquired in mild surprise,
-and in a voice calculated to annoy his
-listeners.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Not very lately,&#8221; Phil answered; &#8220;the
-South American trouble was over a year ago
-and in China about six months ago. They
-were only small rumpuses. I dare say you
-didn&#8217;t hear about them.&#8221; Phil&#8217;s pride was
-touched, for he knew that many papers had
-given full and even exaggerated accounts of
-both fights, and his name and Sydney&#8217;s had
-been glowingly mentioned.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I suppose I must have been out in the field<span class="pagenum" id="Page_106">[106]</span>
-at the time,&#8221; Tillotson explained indifferently,
-&#8220;so I didn&#8217;t see the papers.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Hadn&#8217;t we best make up a plan of just
-how we&#8217;re going to do this thing?&#8221; Phil
-urged, returning to his point and being guided
-by his training at the Naval Academy, which
-had taught him to be methodical in all things.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson regarded the lad coldly.
-&#8220;You can plan for yourself,&#8221; he replied. &#8220;I&#8217;ve
-been fighting these insurgents for some months
-and my men know my plans by heart: they
-comprise just one word: &#8216;Forward.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After the lieutenant had gone to his cot and
-was sound asleep, the midshipmen adjourned
-to the brightly lighted chart house to discuss
-the situation.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This rank business is what is hurting the
-army and navy too,&#8221; Phil exclaimed testily.
-&#8220;Just because a man has one more stripe on
-his sleeve he thinks he knows more than
-every one below him, and considers a suggestion
-from a subordinate unpardonable insubordination,
-almost akin to mutiny. Well,
-Mr. Tillotson can keep his own plan, but, Syd,
-I am going to work out our end of it.&#8221; While
-Phil spoke he drew the chart toward him and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_107">[107]</span>
-glanced carefully at the land in the neighborhood
-of Binalbagan.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you see that marsh behind the town?&#8221;
-he exclaimed suddenly to Sydney whose eyes
-were upon the chart. &#8220;That&#8217;s probably mangrove,
-and they can&#8217;t get through that, so if
-they&#8217;re attacking, it&#8217;ll be from the side. If
-Tillotson lands his men to the northward and
-we take a position to the southward we ought
-to make a big haul. I told O&#8217;Neil to have the
-Colt gun ready and if it comes out as I hope
-it will, we&#8217;ll land it there,&#8221; pointing to a spot
-on the chart showing a low hill to the left of
-the town.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney agreed heartily with Phil&#8217;s plans,
-and berated soundly the attitude of the army
-man.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I suppose,&#8221; Phil said in apology for him
-as they parted, one to turn in, the other to
-keep watch until midnight, &#8220;that he&#8217;s had so
-much fighting he&#8217;s grown careless.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>At midnight Phil was awakened, and relieved
-Sydney on the bridge, while the latter
-went below to get a few hours&#8217; sleep before he
-would be needed in the work to be accomplished.
-Phil gazed through the darkness<span class="pagenum" id="Page_108">[108]</span>
-ahead of the gunboat; the dim outline of the
-land along which they were traveling could be
-seen on the port hand. The coast was bald
-and he knew he could without danger run as
-close as he desired to its precipitous cliffs.
-The more he thought of the scornful carelessness
-of the young lieutenant the angrier he
-became. What right had he to consider such
-an expedition one to require no plans? What
-if he landed in an ambush?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He should consider the lives of his men,&#8221;
-he exclaimed hotly.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipman already knew that a large
-part of the garrison were not at Binalbagan,
-having gone on an expedition to the north
-coast; a sergeant and twenty men had remained
-to guard the men&#8217;s barracks and supplies, to
-say nothing of the natives who had professed
-friendship to the Americans and lived close
-under their protection. These poor souls,
-Phil knew, were between two fires; if the soldiers
-were defeated they would be killed by
-their enraged countrymen, while if their countrymen
-claimed and received aid from them
-they would at once be put in prison by the
-Americans, and yet if they refused to subscribe<span class="pagenum" id="Page_109">[109]</span>
-to the cruel demands of the insurgents their
-lives would pay for their rashness as soon as
-they wandered outside of their village.</p>
-
-<p>He paced restlessly the silent bridge. His
-men he could see sleeping under the awning
-just below him. The man at the wheel, his
-eyes on the compass, and the lookout on the
-forecastle were alone awake and alert. The
-hours dragged by. A faint blush of dawn
-was visible on the eastern horizon when Phil
-through his powerful night-glass could recognize
-the chief landmark near the town of
-Binalbagan, a deep notch in the rugged coast
-hills through which the river in the season of
-rains flowed to the sea. It was as yet too
-dark to discover the town, and Phil knew
-that the hull of the gunboat could not be seen
-from shore until the sun had almost risen
-above the horizon. The last point of land
-was rounded, and the gunboat&#8217;s bow was directed
-toward the locality where he knew the
-town was even then in the throes of an attack
-from a savage enemy. His heart rose in his
-throat as his mind dwelt upon the gruesome
-possibilities if the handful of soldiers had been
-overpowered by their numerous foe. It was<span class="pagenum" id="Page_110">[110]</span>
-almost with a sigh of relief that, as the gunboat
-approached nearer the shore, he indistinctly
-recognized the faint flashes of flame
-from rifle fire. At least the soldiers, or some
-of them, were still alive.</p>
-
-<p>All hands had been called, and on the deck
-of the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; there was a scene of great
-activity. Boats were cast loose and supplied
-with the accessories of war. A grim Colt gun
-was mounted on its tripod ready to be carried
-ashore to hurl its five hundred shots a minute
-at the foe.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson, after a rapid inspection
-of his men, approached the two midshipmen
-on the bridge. Phil had slowed the
-gunboat. With a leadsman in the chains,
-calling out the depth of water, he was now
-steering directly for the small, serpent-like
-flashes showing distinctly against the dark
-background of the hills.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It looks like a big fight,&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-excitedly as the lieutenant reached his side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;These people make a lot of noise,&#8221; the
-latter replied nervously. &#8220;I am not afraid
-of their rifles; the bolo is their weapon. By
-Jove!&#8221; he exclaimed, after taking another<span class="pagenum" id="Page_111">[111]</span>
-long look at the scene. &#8220;It is a big fight.
-I&#8217;d no idea they had so many rifles on the island.
-My fifty men won&#8217;t be a drop in the
-bucket.&#8221; He turned upon Phil, alarm in his
-eyes. &#8220;I shan&#8217;t land under that fire. Our
-men are doubtless intrenched in the convent
-and can hold out till daylight, then when it
-gets light enough to see, you can easily drive
-the insurgents off with your guns.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gazed at the army man in undisguised
-surprise. What did he mean? Was this the
-same Tillotson whose only order was &#8220;forward&#8221;?
-Here they were, undiscovered, with
-fifty soldiers, a Colt gun and a gunboat. It
-was a chance a landing party seldom had to
-deal its enemy a severe blow.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There must be five hundred riflemen surrounding
-the town,&#8221; Tillotson continued, with
-more assurance, believing from Phil&#8217;s silence
-that he had agreed with his plan of attack.
-&#8220;It would be foolhardy to risk my men against
-such odds.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He does think of his men, then,&#8221; Phil
-thought contemptuously.</p>
-
-<p>The gunboat had now stopped and lay motionless
-on the quiet sea. Without orders<span class="pagenum" id="Page_112">[112]</span>
-four boats fully manned with ready sailormen
-were noiselessly lowered from the davits.
-Stalwart arms lifted the Colt gun and placed
-it in the bow of a cutter. Phil gave a last
-careful search through his glass at the shore
-line, scarce a thousand yards away. He
-could see the shadowy form of the big white
-cathedral from which tongues of flame darted
-incessantly. To the right the long, low
-convent building was silent. The soldiers
-had seized the church and inside its shelter
-they were making their last stand. Phil was
-assured that they would be safe until their
-ammunition was exhausted, and his experience
-had taught him that soldiers in such
-straits, unless there was an officer to control
-them, would use up their last cartridge before
-thinking of the dire consequences. To
-husband ammunition was not their concern.
-Even as the lad gazed the enemy&#8217;s flashes appeared
-closer to the cathedral. They were
-closing in; a final rush might land these
-savages under the very walls of the church.
-His hand shook violently and almost a sob
-escaped him as a bright flame suddenly appeared
-on the convent roof.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_113">[113]</span>&#8220;They have set the convent on fire,&#8221; Phil
-exclaimed in an awed whisper. Then he
-turned fiercely on the army man.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What are your plans now?&#8221; he asked
-almost roughly.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson drew himself up
-stiffly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;At sunrise all will be clear,&#8221; he angrily
-insisted. &#8220;It would be worse than murder
-to land now; as you said last night,&#8221; he
-added, seemingly grasping at a straw, &#8220;we
-would be between two fires.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gave him an impatient glance. &#8220;Come
-on, Syd!&#8221; he exclaimed eagerly, leading the
-way down from the bridge.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil had his four boats ready at the
-gangway; two for the soldiers and the others
-for the men of the gunboat who could be
-spared from the guns.</p>
-
-<p>The lads gripped each other&#8217;s hand in
-silence as Phil stepped on the gangway ladder
-leading to the boat. The soldiers by one accord
-had crowded aft, their rifles in hand
-and cartridge belts bulging with extra ammunition.
-Some had even filled the inside of their
-blue flannel shirt with more precious cartridges.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_114">[114]</span>&#8220;Aren&#8217;t we going, sir?&#8221; the sergeant
-asked, gazing through the darkness for his
-lieutenant.</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head. He was too angry to
-speak. Then suddenly without command the
-soldiers filed, at first hesitatingly, casting
-anxious glances behind them, into the awaiting
-boats.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Syd,&#8221; Phil said in a low, tense voice,
-&#8220;you know the plan. Keep those cordite
-shells away from our own men. Get as close
-in as you can; don&#8217;t hesitate to run her
-ashore if necessary. If I am not mistaken
-we&#8217;ve got these natives in the closest box
-they&#8217;ve ever been in.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The four boats waited in silence at the
-gangway. Phil had taken his place with
-O&#8217;Neil in the boat carrying the Colt gun.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Tell Lieutenant Tillotson we&#8217;re ready,&#8221;
-Phil said in his natural voice to Sydney on
-the gangway.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson strolled aft slowly,
-his eyes on the streak of dawn ever increasing
-in the eastern sky.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on, Tillotson,&#8221; Phil said harshly;
-&#8220;we&#8217;ve wasted too much time already.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_115">[115]</span>Lieutenant Tillotson stopped on the gangway
-and glared angrily at the composed midshipman
-below him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;d like to know,&#8221; he sneered, &#8220;what
-business a midshipman has to give orders to
-his superior officer.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ll give you one more chance, Tillotson,&#8221;
-Phil said in a stern, tense whisper; he did
-not wish the men to hear. He could see
-even in the dim light the surprised, incredulous
-look on the faces of his sailors.
-&#8220;Will you please get aboard?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lieutenant remained motionless, a dark
-scowl on his face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Shove off,&#8221; Phil ordered harshly.</p>
-
-<p>The boats cleared the gangway. The sailors
-dipped their oar blades, ready to follow the leading
-boat in which was Phil and the trusty Colt.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come back here,&#8221; the lieutenant cried,
-seeing he had gone too far. But Phil&#8217;s jaw
-was set and he turned to him a deaf ear.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s his own fault,&#8221; Phil confided to O&#8217;Neil
-at his side. &#8220;I didn&#8217;t order his men in the
-boats; they got in without orders, as any
-decent men would do. What is it, O&#8217;Neil,
-just pure cold feet?&#8221; he asked suddenly.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_116">[116]</span>&#8220;Partly that, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil answered, &#8220;but
-Lieutenant Tillotson is not a coward; he&#8217;s just
-overcautious and a bit of a braggart. He
-didn&#8217;t like attacking in the dark.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The four boats pulled with oars muffled in
-toward the dim shore. Phil steered his boat
-for a point behind the long fringe of flashes,
-where the insurgent firing line was established,
-creeping ever closer to the handful entrenched
-behind walls that would soon be too hot to
-hold them. He had abandoned his first plan
-and now was landing all of his mixed command
-to the left of the town. If he could
-land without discovery, the first the enemy
-would know of his presence would be the
-horrifying, crackling report of the machine
-gun.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There, steer for that,&#8221; Phil breathed as a
-mound-like hill took shape out of the darkness.</p>
-
-<p>With eyes straining and faculties alert for
-the first premonition of danger, Phil directed
-his boat forward. The gunboat had been
-swallowed up in the night astern. The shore
-grew more distinct. The church now stood
-out prominently, silhouetted against the background<span class="pagenum" id="Page_117">[117]</span>
-of flames from the burning convent.
-Even as he gazed the gun fire from the church
-seemed to slacken and against the bright glow
-he could see indistinctly natives swarming toward
-the burning building. Their number
-seemed myriad; surely those could not be all
-riflemen. Then he turned cold as he suddenly
-grasped the sinister meaning&mdash;they were bolo-men.
-For each rifleman, at least four natives
-armed with bolos are assigned. They are the
-guardians of the precious rifle. To obtain an
-insurgent gun, five men must be slain. These
-men, armed with weapons in the use of which
-every native is proficient, were advancing to
-rush upon the trapped men when the heat of
-the fire and the smoke had driven them from
-the shelter of the church&#8217;s protecting walls.</p>
-
-<p>So intent had Phil been that the boat, before
-he realized it, had grounded on the sandy
-beach and the men had jumped overboard into
-the shallow water. Once on the beach, he
-superintended the securing of the boats and
-then led the way toward the point he had
-selected for the first position to be occupied.
-The enemy were only a few hundred yards
-away, but so intent were they on the accomplishment<span class="pagenum" id="Page_118">[118]</span>
-of their cruel purposes, that the
-shadowy forms of the men from the sea, stealing
-quietly through the short grass and
-against a background of darkness, were not
-discovered.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s quick eyes suddenly discovered some
-one approaching from a direction away from
-the enemy. He gripped his revolver firmly,
-not knowing how many more men might be
-behind the figure discovered. As the Americans
-approached the newcomer, a native suddenly
-raised his hand and called loudly:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Amigo, hua carta.&#8221;<a id="FNanchor_2" href="#Footnote_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a></p>
-
-<p>A blow from O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s revolver butt was the
-answer, while Phil grasped the letter which
-had been held in the stricken man&#8217;s hand,
-placing it carefully in his breast-pocket. Then
-a warning cry rang out, followed by a rifle-shot,
-the hot blast of which almost burned
-Phil&#8217;s cheek, while a wiry form struck boldly
-right and left with his keen blade in the very
-midst of the startled Americans.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_119">[119]</span>
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VIII<br />
-
-
-<small>THE PRIVILEGES OF RANK</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p>&#8220;<span class="smcap">There</span> was two of &#8217;em, captain,&#8221; the infantry
-sergeant exclaimed, in that purely
-official calm voice for which the army non-commissioned
-officers are noted even under
-the most trying and hazardous circumstances,
-while he pushed away the body from beneath
-his feet, after making sure the native was not
-shamming. &#8220;They was messengers, telling
-the gugus of the coming of the gunboat, I
-reckon.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The small band of soldiers and sailors
-moved cautiously through the rank grass and
-sparse cocoanut palms. The enemy before
-the town had been too much occupied to discover
-the disturbance in their rear.</p>
-
-<p>Phil saw that the fire had grown apace and
-now the conflagration threatened the entire
-town, but the greatest danger was to the
-church, for the dawn breeze was carrying the
-hot, stifling smoke and flame high on the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_120">[120]</span>
-church walls. It would be but a matter of
-minutes before the church itself would be on
-fire. The sun was slowly approaching the
-horizon; Phil saw the broad white band of
-light stretching across the eastern sky. Out
-on the water to the right of the town the lofty
-spars and smoke-stack of the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; were
-indistinctly visible; Sydney was ready to begin
-his allotted work when the day had broken
-so that he could recognize friend from foe.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If that fellow Tillotson hadn&#8217;t funked,&#8221;
-the midshipman whispered fiercely, his teeth
-set firmly, &#8220;and we could have had his men
-to the right of the town, we could have flayed
-&#8217;em alive. Now they&#8217;ll all escape past the
-gunboat&mdash;unless we let the gunboat open the
-ball and drive them all this way.&mdash;I&#8217;ll do it,&#8221;
-he cried determinedly.</p>
-
-<p>They had now reached the grassy-topped
-mound, the Colt gun placed in battery, and
-the first string of cartridges fed into its steel
-maw.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sergeant,&#8221; Phil commanded tersely, &#8220;deploy
-your men to the right and left, and take
-shelter. Don&#8217;t fire without orders.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant saluted and gave a quick,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_121">[121]</span>
-sharp command. The soldiers melted from
-sight. This was a new experience for them.
-Six months in the islands and the only real
-fights they had seen were included in a few
-shots at the disappearing brown men after they
-had fired their volley from ambush, killing
-and wounding several of their comrades. Now
-here were over five hundred yelling natives
-worked up to the wildest pitch of savage
-triumph before their eyes, within range of
-their trusty guns, and as yet no orders to fire.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Stop your grumbling,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil overheard
-the sergeant tell one of his soldiers in language
-more forceful than polite. &#8220;This is something
-that your thick skulls can&#8217;t savvy. It&#8217;s
-naval strategy. Wait till the ball opens and
-every mother&#8217;s son of you can prove his claim
-to a sharpshooter&#8217;s medal.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>When all was ready, Phil could only wait
-patiently for the sun to give Sydney enough
-light for his gunners to see to shoot, but meanwhile
-he saw with ever-increasing impatience
-that the enemy was gradually closing in about
-the church and convent. If the dawn were
-too long coming! If the terrible, irresistible
-rush came before Sydney had opened fire, then<span class="pagenum" id="Page_122">[122]</span>
-their attack would have failed, for the loss of
-twenty American soldiers could not be repaid
-by the death or capture of the whole insurgent
-army. It seemed to the awaiting midshipman
-that hours must have passed since his men
-had entrenched themselves on this small hillock.
-Surely the sun had stopped in its
-movement around the earth! The flames in
-the town became higher and the smoke arose
-in greater volume while the crackling of burning
-bamboo added its sinister sound to the discharges
-of the rifles, ever drawing nearer the
-besieged garrison. With heart beating rapidly
-and youthful indecision stamped on his face,
-he gazed anxiously at the &#8220;Mindinao.&#8221; He
-breathed a sigh of partial relief as he saw she
-was close inshore and was clearly visible.
-Surely it was light enough to see, or if not yet
-the enemy must soon discover the presence of the
-unwelcome and much-feared visitor. When
-they fled, their retreat would be toward where
-he and his machine-gun and sixty-five American
-rifles were awaiting them.</p>
-
-<p>Moisture stood out on the youngster&#8217;s forehead
-in great beads and his tongue lay like
-cotton against the roof of his mouth.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_123">[123]</span>&#8220;I couldn&#8217;t have stood it another second,&#8221;
-he breathed, as a jet of flame shot out from the
-gunboat&#8217;s bow and a sharp report followed by
-thunderous reverberations awakened for the
-first time an unknown terror in the hearts of
-the savage attackers, and brought courage and
-joy to the hopeless men inside the stifling
-walls of the church.</p>
-
-<p>The little gunboat belched flame from her
-three-pounders and the eager and delighted
-watchers on the mound of earth, clustered
-about the Colt gun, gazed with admiration and
-awe as the high explosive shells tore great
-gaps in the earth, scattering the demoralized
-natives in all directions. The avenue of
-escape to the right was closed; the enemy
-dared not approach nearer that death-dealing
-war-ship, and with one accord, an uncontrolled,
-terrified mob of human beings, without
-method or leaders, they turned and retreated
-directly toward the mound on which Phil
-and his men were impatiently awaiting them.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil had taken his place at the Colt gun.
-Seated in the bicycle saddle, he squinted
-carefully down the massive rifle barrel, while
-the seething mass of brown came ever closer.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_124">[124]</span>
-When the insurgents had arrived at a distance
-of two hundred yards, Phil gave the
-order &#8220;Open fire,&#8221; in a voice scarcely recognizable
-as his own, it trembled so with excitement.</p>
-
-<p>Bang&mdash;bang&mdash;bang, faster than one could
-count, resembling the explosions in the
-cylinders of a high power touring car, only
-infinitely louder and more sonorous, the Colt
-gun hurled a solid leaden stream of bullets
-into the charging mass.</p>
-
-<p>As coolly as if he were merely steering a
-boat, O&#8217;Neil played the leaden hose on the
-startled enemy. They went down like chaff
-before the reaper; while from behind urging
-them onward, the cordite shells of the gunboat,
-which had followed them, burst with terrific
-havoc.</p>
-
-<p>Throwing down their rifles&mdash;it did not
-enter their heads to ask for the quarter which
-the Americans would have been only too willing
-to give&mdash;they turned inland directly toward
-the burning town.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Cease firing,&#8221; Phil cried out in alarm, as
-he saw suddenly appear, almost in the path of
-the routed natives, the small band of men<span class="pagenum" id="Page_125">[125]</span>
-who had come so near death at their hands.
-Rifles in hand, the relieved soldiers advanced
-toward the now terrified insurgents and
-poured a deadly fire into their already mortally
-stricken ranks.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on,&#8221; yelled Phil, leading the way
-on a run, followed by his men. &#8220;We can bag
-them all in that swamp.&#8221; But the lad did
-not realize what fear can do for a native
-Filipino. The Colt gun on the left where
-O&#8217;Neil had advanced it on the run, and the
-rifles of the threescore jubilant soldiers lent
-wings to their enemy&#8217;s feet as those finding
-themselves miraculously spared from instant
-death plunged into that impenetrable mangrove
-thicket. Volley after volley was fired
-in the direction in which they had disappeared,
-and the crash of the bullets could be
-distinctly heard, but no white man could
-have followed where they fled.</p>
-
-<p>The sun was now above the horizon and the
-light of day showed a gruesome sight to Phil&#8217;s
-eyes. Many hundreds of natives lay dead or
-in their death agonies on the sandy soil. The
-doctor from the garrison and his assistants attempted
-to help the sufferers, but after one<span class="pagenum" id="Page_126">[126]</span>
-hospital man had been maimed for life by a
-wounded native to whom he was administering,
-there could be little more to do. Graves
-were at once dug in the little cemetery back
-of the church and there they were placed one
-on top of the other in long rows and then the
-earth was thrown on top and covered with
-rock to keep out the hungry mongrel dogs,
-more savage even than their masters.</p>
-
-<p>The fight had hardly terminated before a
-small boat came quickly ashore from the gunboat.
-Phil&#8217;s good spirits left him as he saw
-Lieutenant Tillotson come swaggering up to
-the group of soldiers and sailors. Sergeant
-Sweeney, who had been in command of the
-small garrison, had been excitedly giving Phil
-the details of the attack, when the lieutenant&#8217;s
-flushed, angry face brought him to a sudden stop.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well, sergeant,&#8221; he cried in an insolent
-harsh voice, &#8220;make your report to me; I am
-in command here; this man has no standing.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil was so stunned at the words that he
-didn&#8217;t understand or at least realize its meaning.</p>
-
-<p>Then his righteous anger and loathing
-welled into his throat.</p>
-
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_126.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap2"><i>&#8220;I AM IN COMMAND HERE!&#8221;</i></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_127">[127]</span>&#8220;How dare you talk of me that way before
-your men?&#8221; he cried, his face pale as death,
-and his strong fists clinched.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well, who are you, anyway?&#8221; Tillotson
-exclaimed swaggeringly. &#8220;A midshipman!&mdash;ashore
-you have no status, so from now on
-please mind your own business.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil whispered, grasping
-firmly but respectfully Phil&#8217;s arm. The sailor
-felt the lad&#8217;s muscles standing out like whip-cords.
-He foresaw that something was about
-to happen. &#8220;Don&#8217;t spoil all our fun, sir. If
-you hit him, which he richly deserves, you&#8217;ll
-lose your ship, and where will Mr. Monroe and
-Jack O&#8217;Neil be then?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>In spite of his anger and mortification the
-remark of his favorite brought a faint smile to
-Phil&#8217;s face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I guess you&#8217;re right, Jack,&#8221; he replied, his
-voice shaking with emotion, calling him unconsciously
-by the name which he always
-used in his thoughts, and allowed himself to
-be led away.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipman called his men together
-and walked quietly toward the beach, while
-Lieutenant Tillotson took entire charge of gathering
-up the spoils.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_128">[128]</span>&#8220;The lieutenant&#8217;s compliments, sir,&#8221; spoke
-an orderly at Phil&#8217;s side as he was about to
-step into his boat to go to the &#8220;Mindinao,&#8221;
-where at least he did have some status. &#8220;And
-he says, he orders you to send your men to
-report to him to put things in order.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil turned on the messenger fiercely, and
-then in time remembered the soldier was but
-the innocent bearer of this insolent command.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on, O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; the lad said with a tone
-of humiliation in his voice, leading the way
-back toward the burning town. &#8220;I suppose
-I must pocket my pride. I am only a midshipman,
-after all, and on shore here I am under
-his orders.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After Sydney had anchored the gunboat he
-hailed a boat from the shore and soon stood
-by Phil&#8217;s side. The fire was quite beyond
-their control and inside of a few hours a great
-part of the nipa town was in ashes. By almost
-superhuman efforts most of the supplies
-and ammunition of the garrison were rescued,
-and piled in the little plaza in front of the
-church, where tents were pitched and all
-preparations made to receive the soldiers of
-Captain Baker when they returned from their<span class="pagenum" id="Page_129">[129]</span>
-expedition to the northward. In interrupted
-and fragmentary sentences Phil told Sydney
-of the insults offered him by the army man.
-Sydney&#8217;s eyes blazed in anger.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The dastardly coward,&#8221; he exclaimed after
-the story had been unfurled before him.
-&#8220;While you were risking your life, he was
-sitting on the quarter-deck apparently glad to
-be in a place of safety, and now he comes and
-wants to reap all the reward. I don&#8217;t see how
-he has the face to appear before his men.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He&#8217;s not a regular, anyway,&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-in a relieved voice. &#8220;O&#8217;Neil says the
-sergeant told him he was some rich politician&#8217;s
-son, a black sheep, appointed in a regular regiment.
-That explains him somewhat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He&#8217;s a yellow dog, that&#8217;s what he is,&#8221;
-Sydney exploded, &#8220;and I&#8217;d like to tell him
-so to his face, and I will, the first chance I
-get.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;No, you won&#8217;t, Syd,&#8221; Phil said firmly;
-&#8220;remember ashore here we&#8217;re under his orders.
-Don&#8217;t give him an opportunity to make it
-unpleasant. It&#8217;s bad enough as it stands.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There&#8217;s where we can be of service,&#8221; he
-suddenly exclaimed as his eye followed the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_130">[130]</span>
-trailing end of a wire. &#8220;The telegraph instruments
-were saved and are over there in
-the grass; we&#8217;ll connect up and see if we can
-get Palilo.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After a half hour&#8217;s work with the help of the
-single signal corps man, the instrument had
-been remounted inside of a tent and the lads
-watched eagerly as the operator endeavored to
-call up headquarters. The instrument clicked
-rhythmically for a fraction of a minute and
-as it ceased the receiving relay clicked loudly
-in return.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The line&#8217;s O. K., sir,&#8221; the soldier said as
-his hand rested on the sending key, and he
-looked up for orders. &#8220;Shall I tell Palilo
-that we&#8217;re all right?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil was about to answer when he suddenly
-remembered the stinging words of the lieutenant.
-Pocketing his pride once more he shook
-his head. &#8220;Report to the lieutenant that the
-line is through,&#8221; he said as the two lads
-turned away.</p>
-
-<p>A few moments afterward, while they stood
-outside the tent they heard the clicks of the
-sending key. Each listened intently; not
-with any idea of eavesdropping but because<span class="pagenum" id="Page_131">[131]</span>
-on board ship it had been a custom formed in
-their Annapolis days to read all signals. In
-this way they both had perfected themselves
-in all forms of signaling and could read in all
-codes.</p>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-
-<p>&#8220;<i>To Adjutant-General, Palilo</i>:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I attacked insurgents besieging garrison
-at daylight. Placing the gunboat on
-one flank, I sent guard with Colt gun on the
-other. Attack was a perfect success. We have
-captured nearly two hundred rifles. We
-have no casualties. Baker still away.</p>
-
-<p class="right">&#8220;<span class="smcap">Tillotson.</span>&#8221;</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>The midshipmen read the message, their
-eyes opening wide with wonder as the busy
-little instrument proceeded.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well, of all the nerve!&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-as the signature was reached. &#8220;I attacked, I
-placed the gunboat, I sent guard. But where
-was he?&mdash;he doesn&#8217;t say, does he!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>At noontime the midshipmen found themselves
-unwilling guests at Lieutenant Tillotson&#8217;s
-table for the midday meal. Phil had
-asked permission to withdraw his men on<span class="pagenum" id="Page_132">[132]</span>
-board ship but the lieutenant had curtly refused.</p>
-
-<p>Napkins were a luxury not supplied, and
-after finishing his dinner, consisting of wholesome
-army rations, Phil drew out of his
-pocket his handkerchief to use in place of the
-missing square of linen. The letter taken
-from the dead native fell at his feet. The excitement
-and worry of the last few hours had
-driven the knowledge of its presence from his
-mind.</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson&#8217;s keen eye was upon the letter and
-he stretched out his hand for it in stony
-silence. Phil gave it up instantly. The
-lieutenant broke the seal and ran his eyes
-quickly over its contents. His face showed
-keen interest as he read; then he put the
-letter carefully into his own pocket. The
-midshipmen regarded him with interest, half
-expecting to hear the purport of its contents;
-but were disappointed, for in a few minutes he
-arose and left them without a word.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The rest of the garrison are returning,
-captain,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil announced, joining the midshipmen
-after his dinner with the soldiers.
-&#8220;You can see their dust down the beach.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_133">[133]</span>The lads watched with ill-concealed delight,
-much to Tillotson&#8217;s discomfiture, the arrival
-of Captain Baker and his eighty dust-covered
-soldiers. As they swung into the
-Plaza, apparently for the first time, they realized
-that something extraordinary had happened,
-for they quickened their pace and
-Captain Baker, unable to control his anxiety
-further, shouted eagerly to ask what had happened.</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson, assurance in his every motion,
-walked out to meet him.</p>
-
-<p>Phil could not refrain from comparing
-these two figures&mdash;one that of Captain
-Baker, alert, muscular, tanned by the sun, his
-uniform dirty and stained by travel, with
-grime on his soldierly countenance, while the
-other, slender, his clothes neat and of a dandified
-cut, seemed more in place in a drawing-room
-than in the jungles of the Philippines.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I saw the gunboat when we struck the
-beach below there,&#8221; Captain Baker exclaimed,
-his anxiety relieved after Tillotson had
-assured him all was safe, and he advanced
-hand outstretched, a hearty smile of greeting
-on his strong face. &#8220;Is this the new captain<span class="pagenum" id="Page_134">[134]</span>
-of the &#8216;Mindinao&#8217;? I am glad to meet you
-both,&#8221; he said as he shook the hands of the
-midshipmen in turn. &#8220;I suppose we are
-once more indebted to the navy.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson frowned. &#8220;I have fifty men with
-me,&#8221; he exclaimed protestingly. &#8220;Of course
-the gunboat was useful in bringing us here
-and shelling the beach.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s become of all the town natives?&#8221;
-Captain Baker asked suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They all left town yesterday morning,&#8221; the
-sergeant replied. &#8220;That&#8217;s how we knew that
-all was not going just right.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The cowardly beggars!&#8221; Captain Baker
-exclaimed. &#8220;You&#8217;d have thought we were
-their best friends. Well, I suppose they&#8217;ve
-got to look out for themselves. Have you
-buried all the bodies?&#8221; he asked suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, sir,&#8221; Tillotson replied, &#8220;but your
-sergeant has the names of all those he recognized;
-apparently there were some of the
-town people in the attack.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Baker nodded his head, a sorrowful
-expression on his face. &#8220;Who can we trust
-among these people?&#8221; he said in a low voice
-as he scanned the list handed him. &#8220;Even<span class="pagenum" id="Page_135">[135]</span>
-my own servant against us. Pedro might
-have stuck a knife in me any night he
-wished.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A telegram, sir,&#8221; the captain&#8217;s orderly announced
-handing him a sheet of paper.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Send gunboat &#8216;Palilo.&#8217; If desirable retain
-Tillotson and men.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Baker read the message aloud,
-then his soldier eye gazed intently at the
-lieutenant. The inspection from the expression
-on the captain&#8217;s face had not been reassuring;
-however, in a second he turned a
-smiling face to Phil.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Perry, I am sorry I am not to
-have the pleasure longer; however, I am
-deeply grateful to you and the navy for saving
-my men. Tillotson, you can return; I&#8217;ll
-keep your men.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson&#8217;s face, which had become
-sorely troubled as the telegram had
-been read, suddenly cleared. Phil felt that
-he would have died if a soldier of Captain
-Baker&#8217;s standing and reputation had even
-hinted at his uselessness, as he had at this
-hard-skinned, self-satisfied lieutenant.</p>
-
-<p>After a night&#8217;s run the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; was<span class="pagenum" id="Page_136">[136]</span>
-again tied up to the dock at Palilo. On the
-trip down the lads had left their unpleasant
-passenger severely alone, while he had spent
-his evening writing, filling sheet after sheet
-of paper with closely spaced lines.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Official report of a spectator,&#8221; Sydney
-whispered loud enough purposely for Tillotson
-to hear. The latter looked up and
-scowled.</p>
-
-<p>After breakfast the next morning Phil reported
-at the general&#8217;s office. Major Marble
-received him with a grave face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;For the land&#8217;s sake, Perry! What have
-you done to Tillotson? He denounces you in
-scathing terms in his official report to the
-general; accuses you of weakening his authority
-before his men; humiliating him on your
-own ship; deliberately shoving off from the
-ship without him because he did not approve
-of the entire plan which you devised without
-his concurrence, and lastly reports you for
-insubordination when under his orders ashore
-and treating your superior officer with contempt.
-In fact,&#8221; Major Marble ended, &#8220;he
-has started at the top and gone to the bottom
-of all the military offenses.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_137">[137]</span>Phil gasped in astonishment. Major Marble
-stood gazing compassionately at his young
-friend, apparently hoping to hear him clear
-up the mystery. But Phil was silent. He
-must have time to think.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_138">[138]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER IX<br />
-
-
-<small>THE KATIPUNAN SOCIETY</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">After</span> Phil had reached his ship he
-scarcely remembered how he had behaved to
-his anxious and sympathetic friend, Major
-Marble. The boy&#8217;s mind was dazed. He
-had not believed that Tillotson would dare
-make charges against him, but now that they
-had been made, how should he act? The
-mere words of each charge were only too true
-but Phil felt that he had had strong and
-sufficient reasons for acting as he did. But
-now he must refute these charges or else go
-before a court-martial. But how could he
-refute them? There was but one way and
-that was to go to General Wilson and tell his
-story, which would be corroborated by Sydney.
-It would be tantamount to telling the general
-that one of his officers was an arrant coward
-and unfit to be trusted with hazardous expeditions.
-And even then the charges would
-still hold. They were true in substance,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_139">[139]</span>
-every one of them. As commanding officer
-of a gunboat Phil was within his rights when
-he laid his plans as to where the attack of the
-gunboat should be and the locality to land
-his own men; but he could only advise the
-army man from his nautical experience as to
-where the best place would be to land the
-soldiers in order that their co&ouml;peration might
-be harmonious. Lieutenant Tillotson was
-free to accept his suggestions or refuse them
-as he saw fit. So long as they were both
-afloat the army officer could give no orders to
-him, nor could Phil give orders to his superior
-in rank. To the anxious lad it was certainly
-a perplexing situation. His conscience was
-quite clear upon the soundness of the plan
-he had proposed, and he felt that in carrying it
-out they had struck a severe blow at the insurrection
-and had saved the beleaguered garrison.
-The lieutenant&#8217;s action might in feeble
-minds be excused through the plea of caution,
-but no strong man would hesitate to say that
-it was a case where caution should not have
-been considered.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney was beside himself with indignation
-when he learned of the spiteful charges of the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_140">[140]</span>
-lieutenant and was for seeking him out and
-bestowing personal vengeance, but Phil dissuaded
-him from any such rash act.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I should have ordered his men out of
-the boats,&#8221; Phil said bitterly, &#8220;when I saw
-Tillotson was not coming. We might have
-won without them, although they were a great
-comfort, and if the Colt gun had gone back on
-us they would have been a necessity.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What will you do?&#8221; Sydney asked, exasperated
-at the apparent indecision of his
-friend. &#8220;Tell the straight story to the general
-and he&#8217;ll make it hot for that dandified gentleman
-soldier.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The worst of it is,&#8221; Phil replied gravely,
-&#8220;Tillotson is the son of an influential man in
-the Philippine government, and if he takes
-our part the general will incur the father&#8217;s
-displeasure, for a father will never believe
-wrong of a son. A general has been suspended
-for less, and that would ruin his army career.
-I think our best plan is to try to compromise
-with Tillotson, and if he won&#8217;t listen to reason
-then ask the general to send us to another
-part of the island.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Major Marble, as much as he disliked the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_141">[141]</span>
-task, was in duty bound to hand this report to
-the general through his judge-advocate general.
-Captain Blynn believed he was a fair
-man and was proud of his reputation of being
-scrupulously honest, yet when he read this
-arraignment of the young midshipman, a
-smile, almost of pleasure, passed over his face.
-Here was a case in which he took the greatest
-delight. The captain instinctively disliked
-Tillotson. He saw that he did not have the
-making of a soldier, and this expedition had
-been one of the few with which he had been
-entrusted. On another occasion his command
-had suffered severely from an ambush of
-bolo-men, and there had been vague rumors
-that Tillotson had not behaved as it was traditional
-a &mdash;&mdash;th Infantry officer should, but
-there had been nothing official, thanks doubtless
-to his father&#8217;s influence. As Captain
-Blynn read he recognized the work of a law
-graduate. Each charge was described at
-length in an enclosed letter. Undoubtedly
-the circumstances were true.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Queer youngster, that fellow Perry,&#8221; Captain
-Blynn exclaimed almost in admiration as
-he finished and folded the communication<span class="pagenum" id="Page_142">[142]</span>
-preparatory to laying it before his chief.
-&#8220;He&#8217;s got grit, but I fear bad judgment. I
-could never see why he allowed that Martinez
-to escape. Espinosa says it was deliberate.
-Well, he must pay for his ill-judged acts. I
-don&#8217;t want any one about here who&#8217;s going
-to have qualms of conscience about killing a
-Filipino who won&#8217;t surrender. He handled
-that attack at Binalbagan splendidly, though,&#8221;
-he thought. &#8220;But I am afraid we&#8217;ve got to
-make an example of him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As Captain Blynn approached the general&#8217;s
-office, he caught the sound of voices from
-within, and soon saw that the midshipman
-himself was talking earnestly with the general.
-Captain Blynn was not deterred; with him
-business was business and here was the officer
-charged with a grave offense.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have a letter here, sir,&#8221; he said in his
-cold, official voice addressing his chief, &#8220;written
-by Lieutenant Tillotson, making very
-serious charges of misconduct against Midshipman
-Perry.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Perry has just told me that he
-had heard of these charges,&#8221; the general replied
-in an annoyed voice. &#8220;It seems to me,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_143">[143]</span>
-Perry, you have stirred up quite a hornet&#8217;s
-nest in the few days you have been in Kapay.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil blushed furiously, and his eyes flared
-forth his indignation at such an unfair remark.
-Especially as he could make no answer
-to an officer of such rank.</p>
-
-<p>The general adjusted his glasses and read
-from beginning to end the report placed on
-his desk by the captain; then he glanced up,
-a puzzled look on his deeply lined face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is a very ugly business,&#8221; he said
-sharply. &#8220;We have no time to investigate
-such matters. We are busy putting down
-this rebellion. Yet such conduct as charged
-in this report, Mr. Perry, cannot go unheeded.
-There&#8217;s but one thing to do,&#8221; he continued
-after a moment&#8217;s thought. &#8220;Wire to the admiral
-at Manila and request your detachment
-for private reasons.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That would be a tacit acknowledgment
-that I am in the wrong,&#8221; Phil cried out, his
-voice trembling with anger at the injustice in
-the general&#8217;s words.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Read this letter,&#8221; the general said
-brusquely, &#8220;and if you can clear yourself do
-so before Captain Blynn and myself.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_144">[144]</span>Phil took the letter and read page after page
-of incriminating evidence against him. It
-told of the disagreement as to the plan of
-landing and the time of landing. Then of the
-departure of the expedition from the gunboat,
-when the accuser claimed that Phil had deliberately
-shoved off without him, &#8220;doubtlessly
-jealous of being outranked,&#8221; the report
-read. Then of his insubordination ashore
-after the attack when he, Tillotson, had taken
-charge of the work of clearing up the battle-field.
-Of the withdrawal of the sailors and
-their refusal to help until an imperative order
-had been sent the midshipman not to go to
-the gunboat, but to return and give aid to the
-soldiers.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s heart thumped as he read. The report
-was untrue in so far as the imputations
-on his reasons were concerned, but the incidents
-were only too true, and except by bringing a
-charge of cowardice and calling soldiers and
-sailors to corroborate him, he could not deny
-the report. Tillotson&#8217;s report stated further
-that both midshipmen had during the return
-trip acted toward him in a manner which lessened
-the respect of the sailors for him. That<span class="pagenum" id="Page_145">[145]</span>
-one of them had made remarks derogatory to
-his character as a soldier.</p>
-
-<p>Phil handed the report back, his eyes swimming.
-His anger was rife within him and he
-dared not speak.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is a case for a Court of Inquiry,&#8221; Captain
-Blynn said to the general, &#8220;but I cannot
-see how an army court can decide on the case
-of a naval officer. Mr. Perry apparently cannot
-deny these charges, so if he is disinclined
-to wire the admiral, I suggest that you send a
-message asking to have him relieved.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The general nodded his head in the affirmative
-and Captain Blynn withdrew to prepare
-the fatal telegram.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am sorry, Mr. Perry,&#8221; the general said,
-his face softening. &#8220;I have heard of your
-fight, and it was a masterpiece. I believe you
-have the stuff in you; but insubordination
-cannot be condoned. You must learn to obey
-and be respectful to officers higher in rank.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why couldn&#8217;t he tell the general just how
-everything had happened?&#8221; he thought as he
-listened to the kindly voice, &#8220;not to ask that
-he might retain his ship but simply to clear
-his name of this cloud.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_146">[146]</span>Captain Blynn appeared, telegram in hand,
-which he laid before the general for his
-signature.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Before I send this,&#8221; the latter said turning
-to Phil, &#8220;see Lieutenant Tillotson yourself,
-and if he is willing to withdraw this report
-I shall forget the incident.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil left the office, knowing that it was but
-a respite. He had passed Tillotson on the
-street when on the way to the general&#8217;s office
-and had saluted and spoken, but his greeting
-had been ignored.</p>
-
-<p>It was dark when Phil left the headquarters
-building and walked toward the docks. As
-he passed slowly through a narrow street, the
-forbidding windowless walls towering over him
-with here and there a dark alleyway, where an
-assassin might lurk, he instinctively felt for the
-handle of his navy revolver lying in its holster
-slung to his left hip. At the end of the street
-near the river and but a few paces from the
-gunboat he saw a calesa drawn up, its curtains
-drawn closely, just beyond the glare of a street
-lamp, and he was surprised to see a hand wave
-to him from the gloom inside.</p>
-
-<p>Stepping cautiously to the side of the awaiting<span class="pagenum" id="Page_147">[147]</span>
-vehicle, he heard his name called in a
-familiar woman&#8217;s voice. It was the unknown
-girl of the &#8220;Negros.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;or Perry, may I speak to you?&#8221; she
-inquired excitedly in Spanish.</p>
-
-<p>Phil took her outstretched hand eagerly, forgetting
-for the moment his own trouble.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What is it, se&ntilde;orita?&#8221; he asked eagerly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come to-night to the northeast corner of the
-Plaza, at nine o&#8217;clock; bring some of your men
-with you. Maria Rodriguez will show her
-gratitude to the brave American officers.&#8221; He
-would have detained her, to learn more, but
-her sharp command to the alert driver had
-come before he could recover from the startling
-summons and the next moment the calesa
-was racing madly up the street.</p>
-
-<p>Full of his news, he boarded the gunboat
-and confided to Sydney the girl&#8217;s
-message.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Maria Rodriguez,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed.
-&#8220;She&#8217;s the daughter of Juan Rodriguez, the
-wealthiest Filipino in Kapay. I wonder
-what&#8217;s up? Her father, you know, refuses to
-join the insurgents, and yet will not aid the
-Americans, and the general will not molest<span class="pagenum" id="Page_148">[148]</span>
-him. He lives on his estates just beyond the
-city on the river.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil was summoned and told to make up
-a party of five good men to accompany them
-and then the midshipmen sat down to dinner;
-but neither had an appetite for food.</p>
-
-<p>Phil told Sydney of the outcome of his visit
-to the general and the latter was cast down
-with gloom.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shan&#8217;t stay without you,&#8221; he asserted.
-&#8220;Can&#8217;t something be done? Is there no way
-to make this man Tillotson back down?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head. &#8220;I shan&#8217;t try. I&#8217;ll
-just take my medicine. It&#8217;s bitter, but every
-one who was there knows that he was in the
-wrong.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Nine o&#8217;clock saw the small party at the
-northeast corner of the Plaza. The city seemed
-deserted. There was no one on the streets.
-Suddenly the clanking of a sword was heard
-and the sailors slunk quietly out of sight
-into the shadow of a near-by doorway.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s Lieutenant Tillotson,&#8221; Phil whispered,
-&#8220;inspecting sentries; he&#8217;s officer of the guard
-to-night.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After the officer had passed, the party waited<span class="pagenum" id="Page_149">[149]</span>
-anxiously for several minutes and then a native
-appeared walking slowly toward them
-from a cross street. He stopped fifty yards
-away and beckoned; then turned quickly and
-walked away.</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney leading, they followed the
-vanishing figure ahead of them. He guided
-them through street after street, leading
-farther and farther away from the occupied
-part of the city. Suddenly the native stopped,
-beckoned with his hand, and entered a doorway
-of a pretentious Filipino dwelling.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your men must wait here, se&ntilde;or; it is the
-se&ntilde;orita&#8217;s order,&#8221; the native told the lads.
-&#8220;The officers are to come with me.&#8221; He
-raised his finger to his lips to caution silence.
-&#8220;If we are discovered it will mean death,
-se&ntilde;or.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s the game, sir?&#8221; O&#8217;Neil asked
-eagerly, not having heard the whispered words
-of the native.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You&#8217;re to stay here out of sight,&#8221; Phil explained
-quietly. &#8220;If we need help I&#8217;ll fire
-my revolver.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>With a parting caution the midshipmen
-stealthily followed their guide up the street,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_150">[150]</span>
-hugging the dark shadow of the houses, and
-entered the wide archway of a large native
-building. Inside was total darkness, and it
-needed all their confidence in the girl who had
-invited them to come to still their awakening
-suspicions.</p>
-
-<p>The guide gave a low whistle and the slight
-sound caused their hearts to beat faster amid
-the profound silence within.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;ores, you have come,&#8221; a woman&#8217;s
-musical voice dispelled their fears. &#8220;Please
-step this way; I am sorry there can be no light.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil quietly led the way in the direction of
-the voice, and his eyes soon discerned the
-figure of the girl, a darker object among the
-surrounding gloom. He felt a warm, confiding
-hand in his, and allowed himself to be led
-deeper into the blackness of the building.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen followed blindly; their
-eyes, unaccustomed to the darkness, could see
-nothing. They knew from an occasional contact
-with a wall that they were in a narrow
-passage and from the damp odor they knew it
-must be some depth below the ground. Several
-times their heavily shod feet slipped on
-the muddy floor, and occasionally they could<span class="pagenum" id="Page_151">[151]</span>
-hear the tinkly drip of water. The passageway
-led gradually downward, the dampness
-increasing.</p>
-
-<p>Finally the girl stopped and the sound of
-the heavy breathing of the four people filled
-the narrow limits of their surroundings.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;These are underground passages, built
-years ago during a threatened uprising of the
-natives against the Spaniards,&#8221; Se&ntilde;orita Rodriguez
-whispered. &#8220;This passage leads to the
-secret chamber of the &#8216;Sociedad de Katipunan.&#8217;
-To be present at a meeting the penalty for a
-non-member is to take the oath or suffer death.
-Only the direst necessity has brought me here
-to-night. I have no right to ask you, se&ntilde;ores,&#8221;
-she said pleadingly, &#8220;to take this great risk
-for my sake, and if you so decide we can now
-turn back. Lopez, my father&#8217;s trusted patron,
-will go with me.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We will go with you, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; Phil answered
-without a second&#8217;s hesitation. &#8220;What
-are we to see?&#8221; he asked, unable to control his
-curiosity at the mystery of it all.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come, you shall discover for yourself,&#8221;
-she said as she moved forward, her hand still
-in Phil&#8217;s, while Sydney held his companion by<span class="pagenum" id="Page_152">[152]</span>
-the coat sleeve and Lopez, as noiseless as an
-Apache, brought up the rear. &#8220;The meeting
-will not take place for some time, and meanwhile
-we shall have time to talk.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Silently they moved forward until presently,
-from the sound of their footfalls, Phil knew
-that the walls had receded and that they had
-entered a large chamber.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The stairs, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; Maria whispered, and
-the lads found themselves mounting earthen
-steps. Again their feet struck wooden boards
-and they knew that they had ascended from
-the passage and were in a large room directly
-over the one which they had just left.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is the old Spanish inquisition room,&#8221;
-the girl said in a low voice, &#8220;and a fitting
-meeting-place for the Katipunan murderers.
-But come, they may be here any moment.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil admired the daring of this frail girl.
-She had led them into the very nest of these
-traitorous outlaws, for it now dawned upon
-him what was the true meaning of these
-meetings.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do they enter the same way as we have
-come?&#8221; he asked anxiously, casting an apprehensive
-glance behind him.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_153">[153]</span>&#8220;No,&#8221; Maria answered, a smile on her face
-as she felt the lad&#8217;s hand tremble imperceptibly
-on her own. &#8220;We are not in the
-room; it is beyond us, as you shall see soon.
-We are in a covered gallery which is secret
-and known to but few even of the society.
-The passage through which we came has not
-been used for years, and until last night was
-closed with earth. Lopez has spent all day
-with some of his most trusty men clearing it
-in order that we might pass.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil cautiously peered about him, but his
-eyes could not penetrate the darkness. He
-knew that his feet were on boards, and that
-his hand rested upon a wall which was
-rough and dry. Then suddenly as if by a
-flash of lightning a vivid picture of his surroundings
-was shown him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They are coming,&#8221; Maria whispered in a
-startled voice. &#8220;Lie down and for your life
-do not speak.&#8221; The next second all was again
-blackness. The lads and their companions
-had noiselessly thrown themselves down on
-the floor and were holding their breath in an
-agony of suspense. The cool handle of Phil&#8217;s
-revolver, which he had unconsciously drawn<span class="pagenum" id="Page_154">[154]</span>
-from its holster, brought back his confidence.
-At least they would not die without some
-injury to their enemy.</p>
-
-<p>Again came the flash of light; it flickered
-and seemed on the point of extinction, and
-then continued dimly. Phil recognized that
-this time the match had not gone out in the
-room over which their gallery looked, and that
-a candle was dimly burning. Then another
-and another candle was lighted and little by
-little the great room was exposed to their view.</p>
-
-<p>Figures of men could be seen clustered
-about a table in the far end of the hall, some
-seated in chairs, but most of them on the
-ground in native fashion, while beyond the
-table was a niche in which an image glittered.
-The midshipmen soon discovered that it was
-an exaggerated emblem of the Katipunan
-society which they had seen on insurgent
-flags; the sun within a flaming triangle,
-all of pure silver.</p>
-
-<p>A noise of feet and guarded voices came to
-their ears as the room slowly filled with men.
-As the light from the many candles shone
-upon their faces the anxious watchers saw
-that each man was masked.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_155">[155]</span>After an interminable interval of time all
-was hushed and a man arose from a seat near
-the symbol of the society and beckoned one
-of the others to approach.</p>
-
-<p>Phil felt the girl beside him tremble
-violently, and give a sharp gasp of pain.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Garcia,&#8221; she breathed, &#8220;my father&#8217;s
-trusted friend.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Our unknown brother,&#8221; the leader said in
-Spanish, which Phil was to learn was the accepted
-language of the society, &#8220;has been
-summoned to join our society; his name is
-recorded secretly in the recording book; his
-number is one thousand and ten.&#8221; The
-leader then drew from his scabbard a sharp
-glistening bolo and circled it with the adroitness
-of a juggler about the head of the newly
-enrolled member. Gradually one after another
-of the masked natives arose, their keen-bladed
-bolos held aloft, while in single file
-they moved slowly with a rhythmical dancing
-step toward the silent &#8220;one thousand and ten.&#8221;
-As they advanced a weird chant broke from
-twoscore throats. It was not loud, but the
-volume filled the high vaulted chamber and
-lent an uncanny air to the mysterious initiation.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_156">[156]</span>
-It seemed to Phil as he watched, his
-eyes fairly bulging from their sockets, that
-the unfortunate man would surely be severed
-into a thousand pieces by these fierce, savage
-fanatics, but he stood silent, his arms folded
-across his breast, while his eyes gleamed in
-exultant excitement.</p>
-
-<p>Slowly the members danced by their new
-comrade and returned to their seats.</p>
-
-<p>Then the new member, by sign from the
-leader, advanced and prostrated himself before
-the emblem.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The sign of giving his life to the cause,&#8221;
-Maria whispered. Then she stiffened and a
-stifled sob broke from between her clenched
-lips as the voice of the speaker filled the
-room.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Rodriguez has refused the summons. He
-is no longer our friend. He has gone over to
-the despised Americans. Through him our
-men were attacked and killed at Banate, and
-also at Binalbagan. He holds his servants
-from joining our cause only through fear.
-Once he is removed they will all join us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is all untrue!&#8221; Maria&#8217;s voice, clear, low,
-and distinct, sounded through the room, and at<span class="pagenum" id="Page_157">[157]</span>
-once the assemblage was on its feet, gazing distrustfully
-at each other. Phil&#8217;s hand had
-grasped the girl&#8217;s arm with a grip of steel,
-fearing that in her indignation and anger she
-would expose herself to the view of these twoscore
-traitors.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_158">[158]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER X<br />
-
-
-<small>IN THE SHADOW OF A SUSPICION</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Phil&#8217;s</span> heart beat tumultuously as he laid a
-restraining hand on Maria&#8217;s arm to prevent
-her from rising up from the floor of the gallery.
-The instant the girl&#8217;s indignant, vibrating
-voice was heard an uncanny silence fell upon
-the masked men. Each looked fearfully at the
-other. Every man mistrusted his neighbor.
-The girl&#8217;s heavy breathing sounded ominously
-loud in the lad&#8217;s ears, and he was dumb with
-apprehension that she would sacrifice them all
-by a second outburst of passionate denial.
-They dared not move. There was naught to do
-but wait. If the society determined upon a
-search then their one chance was to make a
-dash for the passageway, and hold the angry
-men at bay with their revolvers. O&#8217;Neil and
-his five men were near the entrance, and Phil
-felt sure that their cause was not altogether
-desperate.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_159">[159]</span>After an interval that seemed hours the
-leader&#8217;s voice broke the heavy silence.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Who dared deny that Rodriguez has betrayed
-his people?&#8221; he cried.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s strong fingers pressed firmly the girl&#8217;s
-arm and his eyes begged obedience.</p>
-
-<p>The masked men sat as if turned to stone.
-No sound broke the stillness.</p>
-
-<p>A loud knock on the door behind the
-speaker brought the assemblage to their feet
-in sudden fear. Phil saw that many had
-drawn their bolos, while others stood ready to
-extinguish the long rows of candles.</p>
-
-<p>A challenge was called and answered, and
-the next second the door was opened from
-within and a native entered. Phil beheld in
-admiration the air of grace and fearlessness
-while he advanced boldly toward the startled
-leader.</p>
-
-<p>A smothered exclamation from Maria caused
-the lad&#8217;s eyes to travel quickly to her face.
-She was staring, a horrible dread stamped on
-her face, while she murmured in a trembling
-voice: &#8220;Mi Padre!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>So this was Juan Rodriguez, who had been
-denounced but a moment since by the terrible<span class="pagenum" id="Page_160">[160]</span>
-Katipunan society, come to answer in person
-to the charge!</p>
-
-<p>Another native followed him closely; neither
-were masked, and Phil recognized, in startled
-wonder, Colonel Martinez.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Fellow countrymen,&#8221; Rodriguez exclaimed
-in a loud, commanding voice, &#8220;I have obeyed
-your summons, but I shall not join the society.
-I shall never take sides in this war until I feel
-in my heart that to do so will better my
-countrymen. You who are deceiving the
-Americans, pretending that you are loyal and
-yet aiding your countrymen to kill them,
-doubtless believe that you are doing your
-country a service, but I know that in the end
-you will bring terrible suffering on our people.
-Take the field and fight openly and honorably,
-and you will be treated by your enemy
-as a brave antagonist, but fight with a knife,
-stabbing your enemy in the back, under the
-guise of friendship, and the end is surely the
-gallows tree.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A murmur of harsh voices filled the room
-as Rodriguez stopped speaking.</p>
-
-<p>All eyes were turned to this striking figure,
-as the light from many candles revealed the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_161">[161]</span>
-finely moulded face, flashing eyes and firmly
-chiseled lips and chin.</p>
-
-<p>As Phil watched, his eyes opened wider in
-dread. The leader had edged, during the long
-speech, nearer and yet nearer to Rodriguez.
-Martinez was standing silently on the other
-side. Phil&#8217;s anxious gaze caught the flash of
-brightly polished steel in the hands of this
-masked native, now but a few feet from his
-intended victim. Maria saw, but her voice was
-frozen within her. Phil gauged the distance
-to the would-be murderer, for his intention was
-only too evident. It was not over fifty paces.
-Surely it was possible; he had often practiced
-at that distance. His revolver was now pointing
-at the Katipunan leader, whose hand
-could be seen to be stealthily rising. Phil
-steadied one shaking hand with the other and
-pulled the trigger. The loud report of the
-discharge was deafening, and below in an instant
-all was the wildest confusion. Swiftly
-all lights were extinguished and the room was
-plunged into inky darkness.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come,&#8221; Phil urged excitedly, &#8220;we must
-get O&#8217;Neil and save Juan Rodriguez.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Blindly they felt for the stairs and quickly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_162">[162]</span>
-descended; then hand in hand they ran along
-the dark, slippery tunnel. Reaching the
-street Phil gave a low whistle, which soon
-brought O&#8217;Neil and his men.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Did you fire a shot?&#8221; the sailor asked
-anxiously. &#8220;We thought we heard one, but
-it seemed a long ways off.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; Phil replied, &#8220;but follow us; there&#8217;s
-work to be done; the se&ntilde;orita&#8217;s father is in
-danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Led by the native, Lopez, each sailor with
-his revolver drawn sped down the narrow
-street. At the corner they saw a small band
-of men approaching. Phil halted his party
-and waited ready to attack if they turned out
-to be enemies. The next moment Maria had
-thrown herself into her father&#8217;s arms, and was
-sobbing hysterically, while his native followers
-withdrew to some distance and stood on guard
-in respectful silence.</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney wrung the hand of their
-former captor Martinez.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What would Captain Blynn say now?&#8221;
-Phil exclaimed laughingly as O&#8217;Neil too
-squeezed the colonel&#8217;s hand until the latter
-winced. &#8220;He&#8217;d shoot us for traitors sure.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_163">[163]</span>Sydney smiled. &#8220;It would be rather difficult
-to explain the situation,&#8221; he replied, the
-drollness of the meeting suddenly striking him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You saved my life, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; Rodriguez exclaimed
-suddenly, as Maria led him to the
-Americans. &#8220;My daughter has told me all. I
-do not know how she could have gone where
-she did, or how she found out that I had been
-summoned, but bringing you there has shown
-that often one&#8217;s greatest enemy lives in one&#8217;s
-house and eats his bread. I came this evening
-bringing with me my own men, for I know
-these blackguards too well to trust myself
-alone. As all were masked I recognized no
-one, but I have suspicions as to many and especially
-he who you probably have killed,
-for he fell limply at my feet just before the
-lights were extinguished.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A sudden pang of remorse came into Phil&#8217;s
-thoughts.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Martinez came with me as my
-friend and protector,&#8221; said Rodriguez, &#8220;and
-although he is an enemy within your lines I ask
-that he be allowed to withdraw in safety. You
-see,&#8221; he added with a smile, &#8220;we had no idea
-of meeting those who would recognize him.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_164">[164]</span>Phil as the leader of the Americans gave a
-ready assent. He well knew that a strict interpretation
-of his duty required that he arrest
-Colonel Martinez on the spot and take him
-prisoner before the general, but intuitively he
-realized that to do so would hurt the American
-cause. He felt that Rodriguez had
-reached a crisis in his avowed intention of
-neutrality. By arresting Martinez after this
-appeal Phil might lose the government a valuable
-friend, now wavering between his loyalty
-to his own people and the more earnest duty
-of fighting against them to protect them from
-the domination of this treacherous band of
-murderers.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Good-bye, se&ntilde;ores,&#8221; Maria cried eagerly,
-as her father signified his intention to depart.
-&#8220;I can never thank you enough for what you
-have done to-night. If your bullet,&#8221; she
-added earnestly, &#8220;has silenced forever that
-terrible leader of the Katipunan society, my
-father will be in no further danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Can you pass through the lines?&#8221; Sydney
-asked, &#8220;or shall we vouch for you?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If it is not too much trouble,&#8221; Rodriguez
-replied gratefully. &#8220;My carriage is just there,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_165">[165]</span>
-and we are then near the last patrol. The
-general has allowed me free conduct always,
-but this disturbance may have aroused suspicion,
-so I shall be grateful for your services.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The mixed party of sailors and natives
-walked briskly through the silent streets.
-The carriage drawn by two fast horses was
-reached, and Maria, her father, and Martinez
-entered, while Lopez mounted the box and
-drove slowly forward followed by the Americans
-on foot.</p>
-
-<p>A loud American challenge suddenly
-brought the horses on their haunches.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Halt! Who comes there?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Officer,&#8221; answered Phil.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Advance one, and be recognized,&#8221; the
-sentry called.</p>
-
-<p>Phil walked slowly forward until he was
-within ten paces of the alert soldier.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Halt.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil stopped in his tracks.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I guess you&#8217;re a naval officer,&#8221; the soldier
-said in a puzzled voice. &#8220;You&#8217;re too young
-to be a brigadier-general, although you&#8217;ve got
-a star there on your shoulder-strap.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil smiled.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_166">[166]</span>&#8220;Yes, sentry, I am Captain Perry of the
-gunboat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sure, sir, you can pass me, any time,&#8221;
-the soldier exclaimed gladly. &#8220;That was certainly
-great work you done in Binalbagan.
-All the boys is talking about you two officers
-and Jack O&#8217;Neil. I&#8217;d like to meet him; he
-must be a corker.&#8221; The sentry had grounded
-his rifle and now stood at ease talking sociably,
-very much at home with the young midshipman.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He is here,&#8221; Phil replied. &#8220;If I may
-pass my party, I&#8217;ll call him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Certainly, captain, anything you say goes
-with me,&#8221; the sentry returned enthusiastically.</p>
-
-<p>The carriage, followed by the band of a
-dozen natives, drove down the street away
-from the city. Phil caught a wave of a hand
-from the window as he turned and started for
-the gunboat and his bunk, for it was near
-midnight.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil had stopped to shake hands with
-the admiring sentry and he soon overtook
-them.</p>
-
-<p>In silence they marched to the ship. So<span class="pagenum" id="Page_167">[167]</span>
-much had happened, crowded into such a
-short space of time, that the lads wanted a
-chance to think.</p>
-
-<p>The next morning while Phil and Sydney
-were at breakfast on the small quarter-deck
-of the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; Captain Blynn crossed the
-gangway from the dock. He walked to
-where the lads had risen from their chairs to
-greet him. Refusing their offer of breakfast
-with an impatient movement of his hand he
-sat down in the proffered seat held for him
-by the attentive Chinese steward. Both lads
-saw in his grave face that something unpleasant
-had happened to account for this early
-morning visit. The army man did not keep
-them long in suspense, and had his say with
-his usual directness.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Lieutenant Tillotson, the officer of the
-guard yesterday, is missing. His bed shows
-that he did not sleep in it at all last night. I
-have investigated the case as far as I have
-been able, and I find that no one passed
-through the sentries except a closed carriage
-and a squad of Filipinos. This sentry says
-that you and Mr. Monroe vouched for them.
-Tillotson was last seen an hour before this<span class="pagenum" id="Page_168">[168]</span>
-time by a sentry at the bridge whom he
-visited. As soon as I heard of the carriage
-episode I cautioned the sentry to say nothing.
-I wanted to see you and clear up that part before
-I investigated further.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil sat speechless in his seat while the
-judge-advocate general talked on earnestly.
-Tillotson had disappeared! How could he
-have been forcibly carried past the numerous
-guards stationed at every outlet of the garrisoned
-city? He must surely still be within
-the town.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you suspect foul play?&#8221; Phil questioned.
-&#8220;Would the enemy have the daring
-to make way with him inside the town?
-Why should he alone be molested? And, besides,
-he carried his revolver, and could not
-be struck down without being able to fire a
-warning shot.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;One sentry,&#8221; the captain replied quickly,
-&#8220;reported having heard a shot from the part
-of town near the sea, but he said it was very
-indistinct, and after all he was not sure.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney exchanged glances and
-the captain looked up sharply, a faint suspicion
-entering his thoughts.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_169">[169]</span>&#8220;What I&#8217;d like to know,&#8221; he added coldly,
-&#8220;is who was in that closed carriage; the
-sentry says there were four people.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil flushed as he read the insinuation in
-the captain&#8217;s voice.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Juan Rodriguez, his daughter and a
-Filipino overseer by the name of Lopez,&#8221; he
-answered promptly, but he lowered his eyes
-before the direct, searching gaze of the judge-advocate
-general. The presence of Colonel
-Martinez need not be told. It would but
-complicate the case and not aid in the search
-for Tillotson; but the army officer knew
-human nature too accurately, and Phil was
-too poor a hand at telling less than the truth.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There was besides a Filipino with the
-driver?&#8221; he questioned pointedly.</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head in the negative.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Was this Lopez within the carriage with
-Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez and his daughter?&#8221; the
-captain asked curtly, and Phil felt as if he were
-on the witness stand having the whole truth
-dragged from him. He might just as well
-make a clean breast of it. Before those piercing
-black eyes, he found that he was not
-good at dissembling.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_170">[170]</span>&#8220;Lopez was driving,&#8221; Phil said blushing
-furiously in mortification at being so easily
-tripped in his testimony. &#8220;The other occupant
-of the carriage was Colonel Martinez!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>If a bombshell had exploded at Captain
-Blynn&#8217;s feet he could not have appeared more
-astounded.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;And you passed this insurgent officer out
-of our lines?&#8221; he asked incredulously.</p>
-
-<p>Phil nodded, his throat dry and his mind
-stunned with a sudden fear.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is certainly a queer proceeding!&#8221;
-the army man exclaimed. &#8220;I cannot fathom
-it. Do you realize what you have done?
-Can you not see that Lieutenant Tillotson&#8217;s
-disappearance will be laid at your door?
-But surely,&#8221; he added, &#8220;there is some explanation
-which you can make? You could
-hardly be so foolish as to plot against the
-life or even the liberty of a brother officer.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gave a sudden exclamation of surprised
-indignation, and with flashing eyes he turned
-angrily on his accuser.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I didn&#8217;t see your meaning at first,&#8221; he
-said in a low, intense voice but one that carried
-distinctly over the ship. &#8220;How dare you to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_171">[171]</span>
-insinuate this to my face and on board my
-ship?&mdash;Captain Blynn, there&#8217;s the gangway!&#8221;
-he cried sternly, his face now deathly pale
-but his jaw set firmly.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn rose hurriedly from his
-chair, his dark face swollen with passion; his
-black eyes flashed, while his strong hands
-clutched his chair nervously. He was about
-to speak, but Phil cut him short, pointing his
-finger toward the exit to the deck.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I hope, Captain Blynn,&#8221; he said quietly
-though his lips were trembling, &#8220;that you
-will see the uselessness of further talk and
-will go ashore as I have bid you.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You confounded little whipper-snapper!&#8221;
-the captain exploded wrathfully. The stern
-judge-advocate was unused to such treatment;
-he had always bullied those under him and
-in a measure by the very force of his will,
-many of those senior to him in rank. But
-angry as he was he realized that the midshipman
-was quite within his rights. He
-was on board his own ship, and there he was
-supreme.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Blynn, I hope it will not be
-necessary for me to have you escorted across<span class="pagenum" id="Page_172">[172]</span>
-the gangway,&#8221; Phil reiterated, his voice showing
-perfect control of temper. The lad
-glanced forward meaningly to where many of
-the crew had collected, intently listening to
-the heated colloquy between their young captain
-and this big, blustering army officer.</p>
-
-<p>Then a voice from the dock made both the
-combatants turn suddenly and gaze in surprise
-at the general, who, unobserved, had
-stopped abreast them and had been an amused
-spectator of the discomfiture of his judge-advocate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ll tear up that telegram as soon as I get
-to the office,&#8221; he exclaimed chuckling gleefully;
-&#8220;and, Blynn, you&#8217;d better come ashore
-here before Captain Perry pitches you over the
-gangway.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn had but one great fault and
-that was his inability to consider that anything
-mattered outside of his beloved work.
-Ruthlessly he would trample over those in
-the way of success. Once he was on the trail
-of a wrong-doer, he would follow it fearlessly
-until the culprit was behind bars.</p>
-
-<p>Doubtless if Captain Blynn had stopped for
-just a moment and considered the young officer<span class="pagenum" id="Page_173">[173]</span>
-before him, he would not have cut him
-to the quick by an insinuation so cruel. To
-do the brusque captain justice, he had regretted
-his words immediately he had spoken and
-seen the look of injured innocence and anger
-in Phil&#8217;s face, but the masterful way in which
-Phil had turned the tables on him was too
-much for the army man&#8217;s temper and hence
-the invective. In his heart he did not really
-believe that Phil was guilty of plotting against
-Tillotson. Without the interruption from the
-dock he might even have apologized to the
-spirited young navy man, but the general&#8217;s
-words injected a salutary humor into this dramatic
-situation and made him see how untenable
-and cruel was the attitude he had assumed.
-His face softened and an apology of a smile
-struggled for place on his sun-tanned countenance.
-&#8220;You&#8217;re dead game, youngster,&#8221; he
-exclaimed impetuously. &#8220;I believe you&#8217;re on
-the level, only you&#8217;re a bit too reticent; anyway,
-here&#8217;s my hand, and from now on we&#8217;ll
-work together instead of at cross purposes.&#8221;
-He took the surprised midshipman&#8217;s hand and
-shook it heartily.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come up to the office at ten o&#8217;clock,&#8221; he<span class="pagenum" id="Page_174">[174]</span>
-added as he walked toward the gangway, the
-smile having disappeared and the alert business
-expression taking its place on his face.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen watched him cross the
-gangway and join the general, who had been
-taking his usual morning exercise before going
-to his office, and as the two walked along
-apparently deep in conversation an orderly
-stopped them, handing a telegram to the general.
-The lads saw him open it and read and
-then pass it to Captain Blynn. Both turned
-as if by a mutual impulse and glanced toward
-the gunboat, then changing their minds apparently,
-they again turned and walked briskly
-toward the headquarters building.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Something in the telegram concerns us in
-some way,&#8221; exclaimed the analytical Sydney.
-&#8220;I wonder what it said?&#8221; But Phil&#8217;s mind
-was too much occupied in thinking of the
-chameleon character of his new friend to give
-more than a passing thought to the contents
-of the telegram.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_175">[175]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XI<br />
-
-
-<small>A TRAITOR UNMASKED</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">&#8220;How</span> dared he accuse me of knowing about
-Tillotson&#8217;s disappearance?&#8221; Phil exclaimed as
-he sought unsuccessfully a solution to the
-mystery.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t believe he really suspected us,&#8221;
-Sydney replied deprecatingly, &#8220;but it must
-have struck him as odd to say the least that
-you should pass an insurgent officer through
-the guards. You didn&#8217;t tell him why you did
-it or even give him any of the circumstances.
-I think it was natural that he should act as
-he did.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I didn&#8217;t realize,&#8221; Phil said half laughing,
-&#8220;how queer it must have seemed to him.
-Well, I&#8217;m going up and make a clean breast of
-it.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you any suspicion as to the identity
-of the man I shot?&#8221; Phil suddenly asked.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I thought at once of Espinosa,&#8221; Sydney
-answered, &#8220;but I&#8217;m not sure; he talked in a<span class="pagenum" id="Page_176">[176]</span>
-voice that was not familiar, but that may have
-been feigned. Think of it,&#8221; he exclaimed,
-&#8220;those masked men are all in the employ of
-our government. They have taken the oath
-of allegiance and yet they are plotting to massacre
-our soldiers.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It seems queer,&#8221; Phil exclaimed in a puzzled
-voice, &#8220;that the meeting and Tillotson&#8217;s
-disappearance should happen the same evening.
-Do you suppose it was only a coincidence?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Let&#8217;s get Captain Blynn to unravel that,&#8221;
-he answered. &#8220;He&#8217;s not half as clever as some
-believe, not to have discovered in six months
-what we have in less than two days. But remember,
-we promised Se&ntilde;orita Maria to say
-nothing of her share in the work.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>An hour later the lads had laid their startling
-discoveries before the judge-advocate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How many of these men did you count?&#8221;
-he asked excitedly, after he had listened with
-rising indignation to the account of the Katipunan
-meeting and the accusation against
-Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;About forty, I should say,&#8221; Phil answered.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_177">[177]</span>&#8220;I don&#8217;t understand,&#8221; the captain exclaimed
-aloud, &#8220;why Espinosa has not told me of
-the existence of this society. Of course I knew
-it was active elsewhere, but I had no idea they
-would dare plot against us within our lines.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you never suspected Espinosa?&#8221;
-Phil asked quietly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, once,&#8221; the captain answered, after a
-moment&#8217;s hesitation, &#8220;but I found I was mistaken.
-He would not have led us against this
-fellow Martinez if he had been a traitor. I
-have the note here which I took from Espinosa
-that gives the information. It is in Visayan
-but I have translated it.&#8221; He handed the
-scrap of paper to Phil, who read it and passed
-it back.</p>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Martinez and two hundred men
-encamp to-night at Barotoc Hill near Banate
-en route to join Diocno.&#8221;</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>Phil pondered over the words of the message.
-Then he remembered the terrible personal
-attack of Espinosa against Martinez.
-Was this a clue to his betrayal? Were Martinez
-and Espinosa personal enemies?</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_178">[178]</span>&#8220;No,&#8221; the captain continued assuredly.
-&#8220;Espinosa has aided us in every way. It was
-through him that we sent Captain Gordon to
-the north to prevent more of these deserters
-from Aguinaldo&#8217;s army landing. He has kept
-us well posted on the movements of our
-enemy.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But still,&#8221; Phil insisted, &#8220;there have been
-no big fights and we&#8217;ve lost a number of men
-cut up through surprise.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That&#8217;s due in a great measure to the country
-and the inexperience of our volunteer
-officers,&#8221; the captain explained readily.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Are you so sure of the honesty of Rodriguez?&#8221;
-he asked suddenly. &#8220;I have heard it
-insinuated that he aspires to the leadership if
-Diocno were removed.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil was about to cry out his assured belief
-that Rodriguez was sincere, but with the
-words on his lips he hesitated. He had seen
-Rodriguez but once, and to be convinced of
-his honesty after such a short acquaintance
-would sound ridiculous. He saw that Maria&#8217;s
-part would have to be told if Captain Blynn
-was to be convinced.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have every reason to believe in his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_179">[179]</span>
-sincerity,&#8221; Phil said instead. &#8220;I can understand
-Spanish and I heard the leader
-denounce him as a traitor to the natives.
-Then I heard Rodriguez&#8217;s eloquent appeal to
-the men against their two-faced dealings.
-He surely had the courage of his convictions,
-for every hand there was against him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, the general had him down here the
-other day,&#8221; the captain said, &#8220;and he was impressed
-the same way. He&#8217;s a power among
-the lower classes, although he has many
-enemies among the educated ones.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn had been holding a telegram
-in his hand while the above conversation was
-taking place and now he passed it over in
-silence for Phil to read.</p>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-
-<p>&#8220;Colonel Martinez is not the name of insurgent
-officer that left Manila about the time
-of sailing of steamer &#8216;Negros.&#8217; Our secret
-service men are sure that he is the noted outlaw
-&#8216;Remundo.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>&#8220;So you see,&#8221; the captain said not unkindly,
-&#8220;you have twice allowed this desperado to
-escape.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But now,&#8221; the captain continued, &#8220;what<span class="pagenum" id="Page_180">[180]</span>
-we&#8217;ve got to do is to break up this secret
-society and find poor Tillotson if he is still
-alive. I can hardly believe that they have
-been able to carry him away unless it was
-by water. However, Espinosa should know
-of this. I will send for him to come here at
-once.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The captain rang his bell and sent the
-orderly who answered for the Filipino.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen sat silently waiting while
-the judge-advocate returned to his interrupted
-office work.</p>
-
-<p>The orderly soon returned, reporting that
-Se&ntilde;or Espinosa was not at his house, and that
-his servant reported that he had not been
-home since the evening before.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen exchanged knowing
-glances. Was Espinosa then the leader whom
-Phil had shot?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come!&#8221; Captain Blynn exclaimed, starting
-up from his chair. He led the lads down
-to his carriage at the door and motioned them
-to enter. Then giving an address to the
-driver they went whirling through the narrow
-streets.</p>
-
-<p>After a ten minutes&#8217; drive the carriage<span class="pagenum" id="Page_181">[181]</span>
-stopped in front of a large Filipino house.
-Without knocking the army man pushed open
-the door intruding his great bulk into the
-room.</p>
-
-<p>A half dozen natives arose from the floor,
-sudden fear in their faces as they saw the
-officers.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;or Cardero,&#8221; the captain said in a quiet
-voice, &#8220;where has Se&ntilde;or Espinosa gone?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I do not know,&#8221; the native replied sullenly.</p>
-
-<p>The captain glared fiercely at the small
-brown man before him; then he reached out a
-strong hand and caught the native fiercely by
-the neck, shaking him as a dog would a rat.
-The little man turned a sickly color and his
-teeth chattered, but the bullying American
-held him closely while his eyes flashed angrily
-as he questioned him. &#8220;Tell me, where is
-Se&ntilde;or Espinosa?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He is hurt, se&ntilde;or commandante,&#8221; the native
-cried out finally in a terrified voice after he had
-regained his breath. &#8220;It was an accident. I
-do not now know where he is, but he is not in
-the city.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen were overjoyed at this
-news. So Espinosa was the Katipunan<span class="pagenum" id="Page_182">[182]</span>
-leader and spy. Phil glanced at the surprised
-judge-advocate, a light of triumph in
-his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Captain Perry,&#8221; the captain ordered
-hurriedly, &#8220;you and Mr. Monroe stay here
-and guard these rats; I am going to have
-every native of prominence in the town
-arrested at once. Thanks to you, we have at
-last found the leak.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Throwing the cringing native from him,
-he strode out of the door, and the lads heard
-the rumble of his carriage wheels as he drove
-rapidly away.</p>
-
-<p>After the captain&#8217;s menacing presence had
-been removed the half dozen captive Filipinos
-showed signs of restlessness, and once
-or twice Phil surprised a covert glance toward
-a dark corner of the large living-room.
-Both lads felt the responsibility of their position.
-They knew that they were outside of
-the line of sentries, almost beyond the sound
-of firearms. It seemed to Phil that the
-captain was over-reckless in coming with
-only themselves into the haunts of a probable
-enemy. Both lads were armed, their revolvers
-were held ready in hand and their<span class="pagenum" id="Page_183">[183]</span>
-prisoners knew full well that Americans were
-dangerous shots.</p>
-
-<p>The inside of the room was but dimly
-lighted by a single oil wick, and the darkness
-became blacker toward that part of the
-house where no windows had been cut. Phil
-had heard the captain give instructions to his
-orderly as he left headquarters to have a
-guard follow the carriage. But would the
-guard be sent here to aid them, or would
-Captain Blynn send them elsewhere to make
-arrests?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Let&#8217;s get out of this trap,&#8221; Phil whispered
-anxiously to Sydney at his side, his idea
-being to order the men at the point of his revolver
-to pass out to the street.</p>
-
-<p>Suiting the action implied in his words,
-Phil opened the door leading from the living-room.
-He saw by the aid of the additional
-light from outside that the five men had
-cautiously and stealthily moved backward
-toward the wall nearest them, and were apparently
-supporting their weights upon it.
-Suddenly he felt a jar and read in the eyes
-of the Filipino nearest him revenge battling
-with fear. Then the floor shook, and grasping<span class="pagenum" id="Page_184">[184]</span>
-Sydney by the shoulder Phil threw himself
-bodily through the open door as the floor
-of the building crashed down twenty feet
-into the cellar below. The natives, he could
-see, were hung on the wall like so many old
-coats, while through the bamboo floor on
-which he and Sydney had just stood numberless
-bamboo spears bared their sharp, venomous
-points. The lad shuddered as he realized
-the murderous trick which had failed. If
-they had fallen with the floor, heavily
-weighted as it was with stones at the side,
-and resting on supports, which had been
-dislodged by a rope in the hands of one of
-the villains now hanging on the wall of the
-room, they would at this moment be lying
-pierced through and perhaps dying before the
-eyes of their cruel enemy.</p>
-
-<p>He raised his revolver and covered the
-nearest cringing native, a terrible anger in
-his eyes. In another second he would have
-pulled the trigger, but Sydney&#8217;s hand closed
-firmly over his wrist, forcing his revolver upward
-and the ball sped harmlessly over the
-terrified native&#8217;s head.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They are more valuable alive,&#8221; Sydney<span class="pagenum" id="Page_185">[185]</span>
-exclaimed to Phil&#8217;s angry cry of protest.
-&#8220;Come, let&#8217;s get outside before more of this
-hinged floor is loosened. We can better prevent
-their escape in that way.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil followed his companion down the
-bamboo stairs and into the street, where a
-crowd of curious natives had gathered on hearing
-the startling shot. The lads moved their
-weapons menacingly, not knowing or trusting
-the temper of the crowd which backed away
-cringingly from the Americans. A glance
-down the street brought a glad cry from the
-midshipmen as they saw a squad of soldiers
-advancing from the direction of headquarters.
-A loud voice in the Visayan tongue from the
-building they had just left was answered by
-many excited voices in the gathered crowd,
-and then several women advanced slowly,
-holding up their hands in sign of peace, their
-bodies close together as if for mutual protection.
-The lads scarcely noticed the approach
-of the women, so occupied were they
-in watching the building in which were imprisoned
-five of the traitors who had been
-biting the hand of the master that fed them.
-A swift glance over his shoulder showed Phil<span class="pagenum" id="Page_186">[186]</span>
-that the advancing women were scarce ten
-paces away from Sydney, who was guarding
-one corner of the house, while he was some
-thirty feet away, guarding the other three
-sides. The soldiers were not over a block
-away and hastening toward him; he could
-hear the rattle of their gun slings, and the
-thud of their heavy shoes on the hard road-bed.
-Then again as he cast an uneasy glance
-at this line of women his heart froze within
-him while his voice failed, for he had caught
-a fleeting glimpse of a savage face peering
-over their shoulders.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Look out for yourself,&#8221; Phil cried, directing
-his revolver at the line of women and firing
-blindly. In that second his disgust and
-wrath were so great at the dastardly strategy
-under the guise of friendship that he would
-not have felt a qualm of conscience if one of
-these unnatural women had fallen before his
-bullet.</p>
-
-<p>The women halted, sudden fear on their
-faces, while from between them dashed a half
-dozen savage natives armed with bolos. As
-they charged on the surprised midshipmen
-they cried out lustily in their guttural language<span class="pagenum" id="Page_187">[187]</span>
-the war-cry of the bolo-man who has received
-the charm of the Anting-Anting which
-to his superstitious mind makes him invulnerable
-against the Americans&#8217; bullets. They
-came boldly on while Sydney jumped backward
-quickly to Phil&#8217;s side and the two lads
-emptied the contents of their revolvers into
-the mass of naked brown men flourishing
-their keen blades above their heads in an endeavor
-to close with their hated foe. The
-women had run screaming with terror back
-to the safety of the crowd, taking refuge
-within the densely packed houses.</p>
-
-<p>With their revolvers empty and but three
-of their half dozen assailants writhing in the
-road, the plucky midshipmen faced the onrush
-of the fanatics. Converting their revolvers
-into clubs, they awaited what seemed
-to them certain death. Their one hope for
-safety lay in running away from the charging
-bolo-men and toward the soldiers now scarce
-two hundred yards away, but turn their backs
-on an enemy they could not.</p>
-
-<p>Within ten feet of the midshipmen the
-fanatics suddenly stopped and a fear crept
-into their superstitious faces. The next<span class="pagenum" id="Page_188">[188]</span>
-second, to the lads&#8217; astonishment, their sharp
-swords dropped from nerveless fingers, and
-the three natives prostrated themselves in the
-dust of the road.</p>
-
-<p>The lads gazed in startled wonder, scarcely
-believing their eyes.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_189">[189]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XII<br />
-
-
-<small>THE MIDSHIPMEN RECONNOITRE</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> midshipmen were so utterly astonished
-at the actions of their fanatical enemies that
-they could only gasp out their surprise in one
-heartfelt word of relief. Then a familiar
-voice at their elbow awoke them from their
-stupefied inactivity. It was in Visayan and
-they turned to gaze into the impassive face
-of Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have ordered them to escape,&#8221; he added
-in Spanish, casting a quick glance toward the
-squad of soldiers. &#8220;Poor fellows, it would be
-a pity to kill them, for they are but acting
-under orders.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lads were too grateful to their rescuer
-for saving their lives to make useless inquiries
-as to why his influence could be exerted over
-the acts of their enemy. Phil&#8217;s first thought
-was for the men whom the captain had left
-them to guard.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_190">[190]</span>&#8220;Surround this house,&#8221; he commanded,
-and the sergeant in charge gave a short command
-and led the way himself to the rear of
-the large native building.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is too late, se&ntilde;or commandante,&#8221; Rodriguez
-said shaking his head; &#8220;they have all
-escaped through the rear door and are by now
-safely away.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen ran quickly up the steps
-and gazed disappointedly into the gloom beyond.
-The floor still lay at the bottom of the
-cellar, the bamboo spears sticking half-way
-through, but the natives had gone. The back
-door stood open and to the ground was a jump
-of twenty feet. They had safely escaped while
-the lads were engaged defending themselves
-against the attack of the bolo-men.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am on my way to see General Wilson,&#8221;
-Rodriguez announced after a search had failed
-to disclose any signs of the fugitives, &#8220;and
-offer my services.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you mean that you will fight with us
-against the insurgents?&#8221; Phil asked in glad
-surprise.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, from now on I shall aid the Americans
-to restore order in the island of Kapay,&#8221;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_191">[191]</span>
-Rodriguez replied, pleased at the cordial reception
-given him by the two midshipmen.</p>
-
-<p>Together the party made their way back to
-headquarters in search of Captain Blynn.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It was providential that I happened
-along,&#8221; Rodriguez said after they had passed
-through the sentries; &#8220;those bolo-men knew
-me and obeyed my sign. I see,&#8221; he added smilingly,
-&#8220;that you are already arresting the traitors.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We were not very successful with Se&ntilde;or
-Cardero and his friends yonder,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed
-ruefully, &#8220;but I suppose we should be
-thankful to have gotten off so easily.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Cardero is one of the craftiest of our outlaws,&#8221;
-Rodriguez returned. &#8220;It is a marvel to
-me how he could have remained unmasked so
-long. Of course,&#8221; he added, &#8220;I have known
-of this intrigue for some months, but until
-they deliberately plotted against my life I
-could not betray them.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you discovered who is the Katipunan
-leader who tried to murder you last night?&#8221;
-Sydney asked excitedly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; Rodriguez replied. &#8220;You have
-doubtless guessed that he was Espinosa. I<span class="pagenum" id="Page_192">[192]</span>
-know it now for sure. He has gone to Matiginao,
-where there is a strong fort, and is in
-command of all the insurgent forces there.
-The bullet only crippled him last night, and I
-hear he is rapidly recovering. General Diocno
-was murdered last night in his bed and no
-doubt I should have shared the same fate.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>They were by this time at the headquarters
-building, and were glad to find that Captain
-Blynn had returned. The midshipmen informed
-the army man of their luckless adventure
-and stood in silence expecting to hear his
-harsh rebuke for allowing such important
-prisoners to escape, but he only grasped their
-hands and congratulated them upon their rare
-good fortune.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;By George,&#8221; he exclaimed excitedly,
-&#8220;we&#8217;ve been contentedly living over an active
-volcano. It&#8217;s a marvel we haven&#8217;t all
-been massacred long ago.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Every native of any consequence in the
-town has departed,&#8221; he added sadly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Rodriguez with you, and wishes to aid
-us?&#8221; he cried gladly, as Phil told of the intention
-of the wealthy native. &#8220;Well, that
-certainly is cheering news.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_193">[193]</span>Rodriguez came into the office and stood
-with dignified bearing before the big judge-advocate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;So you are tired of being neutral?&#8221; the
-army officer said pointedly in Spanish. &#8220;Do
-you wish to occupy the position just vacated
-by our mutual friend Espinosa?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez drew himself up proudly while the
-midshipmen gasped at this harsh arraignment.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I do not blame you, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; the native answered,
-no evidence of anger on his placid
-face. &#8220;I know that you can have but little
-reason to trust the honesty of the men of my
-race. But I do not desire a position. I am
-now ready to take the field with my men,
-heretofore neutral. I have three hundred
-rifles.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You are ready then to take the oath of
-allegiance?&#8221; Captain Blynn asked in official
-tones.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, se&ntilde;or, and keep it,&#8221; Rodriguez returned,
-his eyes unflinching.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you any news that will lead to our
-knowing the whereabouts of Lieutenant Tillotson?&#8221;
-Blynn asked.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Ah, I have,&#8221; the native answered eagerly.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_194">[194]</span>
-&#8220;I was about to ask you&mdash;my spies report a
-captive with Espinosa.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans gave sighs of relief. At
-least Tillotson was alive.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson received Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez
-with marked courtesy and appointed him on
-the spot a colonel in command of his own
-men whom he offered to enlist as native
-troops, rationing and feeding them from army
-funds, but Rodriguez declined the latter,
-agreeing to defray all expenses.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen insisted that their new
-ally should go down to the dock and inspect
-the gunboat, so after explaining to General
-Wilson that they would like to be absent for
-a few days on reconnaissance work, the three
-strolled leisurely down the street.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where is Colonel Martinez?&#8221; Phil asked
-after they had arrived on board and the
-Chinese servant had brought refreshments.</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez shrugged his shoulders and
-pointed toward the interior of the island.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Will he serve under Espinosa as leader?&#8221;
-Sydney asked incredulously.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Who knows?&#8221; Rodriguez answered evasively.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_195">[195]</span>The lads saw that their friend had reasons
-for being non-committal and tactfully ceased
-their interrogation, yet inwardly they were
-consumed with curiosity. Espinosa had attempted
-to kill Colonel Martinez on the
-morning of Blynn&#8217;s attack, and now would
-they serve amicably side by side against a
-common enemy?</p>
-
-<p>The hour for lunch arrived, and as
-Rodriguez was not leaving for several hours
-to return to his home up the river he gladly
-accepted the midshipmen&#8217;s pressing invitation
-to eat with them.</p>
-
-<p>Phil had made up his mind to explore the
-river, though this idea was unformed in his
-mind when he left headquarters.</p>
-
-<p>During the meal the midshipmen questioned
-their guest about Espinosa&#8217;s impregnable
-stronghold and of its approach by
-water.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There is a trail from my ranch to the
-foot of the mountain,&#8221; Rodriguez replied
-thoughtfully, &#8220;but it will be filled with traps,
-and will be dangerous if Espinosa hears an attack
-is to be attempted. The river flows
-through a narrow gorge at Matiginao, and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_196">[196]</span>
-from the cliffs huge boulders can be dropped
-into the river many hundred feet below.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The gunboat!&#8221; he exclaimed in amazement,
-after Phil had questioned in regard to
-the depth of water. &#8220;If it were possible!&#8221;
-Rodriguez glanced admiringly at the heavy
-cannon mounted near him. &#8220;Yes, with this
-gunboat in the river the tops of the cliffs
-could be swept, and soldiers could scale the
-difficult trail unopposed, and once through
-the narrows the trail leading from the stronghold
-could be commanded by the cannon to
-cut off the retreat of the insurgents. It is
-wonderful! But the bridge, Se&ntilde;or Perry,&#8221;
-he ended, his voice betraying his sudden disappointment;
-&#8220;it is strongly built and a gunboat
-cannot pass.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If I find there&#8217;s water enough to float
-the &#8216;Mindinao,&#8217;&#8221; Phil replied assuredly,
-&#8220;the bridge will not stand in the way long.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Does your daughter know the country?&#8221;
-Phil asked earnestly.</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez gazed a full minute at his questioner
-before he answered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Every foot of it,&#8221; he added; &#8220;she was
-born near the stronghold. But what is your<span class="pagenum" id="Page_197">[197]</span>
-intention, se&ntilde;or? This is no work for a
-woman.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil would willingly have bitten off his
-tongue for having led him into such an embarrassing
-situation. He could not tell Rodriguez
-that he wanted Maria because she
-alone would he trust as a guide on the perilous
-mission which he had made up his mind
-to make.</p>
-
-<p>Major Marble fortunately arrived at this
-moment and saved the lad from becoming
-more deeply involved. He gave them the
-latest news.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Tillotson&#8217;s father is keeping the wires
-hot,&#8221; he told them. &#8220;We are ordered to spare
-nothing to recapture him, but of course we
-shall do that anyway. The general has wired
-back the good news the se&ntilde;or has brought, that
-Tillotson is believed to be a prisoner and alive.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Before the party dispersed, Phil confided to
-his hearers his plan to explore the river and
-his intention to start that very night.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Then you will visit me on my ranch?&#8221;
-Rodriguez exclaimed gladly. &#8220;Everything I
-have is at your service,&#8221; he added with the
-grandiloquent air of a Spanish gentleman.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_198">[198]</span>Phil nodded gratefully, realizing that unlike
-the Spaniard, whose form of address the
-native copied, Rodriguez made no empty offer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I believe,&#8221; the lad continued, a spark of
-enthusiasm in his voice, &#8220;that a gunboat of
-the tonnage of this vessel is capable of reaching
-the insurgent stronghold.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you can accomplish that,&#8221; Major Marble
-exclaimed excitedly, &#8220;you and your &#8216;Mindinao&#8217;
-will make an enviable name for yourselves,
-for once that stronghold is taken we
-shall have many surrenders throughout the
-island.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why not force the insurgents to concentrate
-on Matiginao,&#8221; Phil asked earnestly,
-&#8220;and attack them there?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The general has already sent out orders,&#8221;
-Major Marble told them, smiling at the lad&#8217;s
-eagerness, &#8220;to attack the insurgents wherever
-they can be located and for all the troops to
-concentrate on Palilo, leaving small garrisons
-in the towns to guard the peaceful natives.
-He is working up a big plan to attack this
-stronghold with a large force, and will undoubtedly
-take the field in person. He is determined
-to rescue Tillotson, and will give<span class="pagenum" id="Page_199">[199]</span>
-Espinosa no rest until he is captured or
-killed.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen listened in delight to this
-plan, which fitted in so well with their own
-ideas.</p>
-
-<p>The major soon departed, promising short
-work in destroying the bridge if the lads discovered
-the river to be navigable above the
-house of Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil was ordered to have a boat&#8217;s crew of
-four men ready to leave the gunboat at one
-o&#8217;clock at night. The distance to Rodriguez&#8217;s
-ranch was somewhat over fifteen miles and the
-lads did not desire to be seen, so they would
-pass at night and be safely within friendly
-land by sunrise. Rodriguez left them soon
-after to return by land and promised a hearty
-welcome on their arrival up the river.</p>
-
-<p>Promptly at one o&#8217;clock the expedition
-started. O&#8217;Neil had provided the usual gear
-for surveyors; a compass, a lead line, and also
-a rifle for each man and a revolver for himself.</p>
-
-<p>Silently they shoved off and rowed with
-muffled oars up the river, and under the
-bridge, built substantially in the days of the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_200">[200]</span>
-Spaniards. &#8220;A few charges of dynamite
-would settle it,&#8221; Phil thought.</p>
-
-<p>Already O&#8217;Neil had uncoiled his lead line
-and was sounding in the channel of the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;ll be a cinch, sir,&#8221; the boatswain&#8217;s mate
-exclaimed after several soundings had given
-him no less than four fathoms of water.
-&#8220;Seven feet is all we need and we can carry
-that for miles until the mountains commence
-to go up steep; then there&#8217;ll be rocks to look
-out for.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Mile after mile was pulled in silence except
-for the light dip of the oars and the dull, almost
-soundless splash of the lead as it was
-heaved a short distance forward of the boat.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen gazed with apprehension
-at the forbidding banks of the river. The
-rank tropical foliage would conceal an army.
-Riflemen might lie concealed and fire without
-the slightest fear of discovery.</p>
-
-<p>Gradually the river narrowed, but the depth
-of water did not grow less.</p>
-
-<p>It was just before dawn when the boat arrived
-at the bend behind which, by the description
-given them, would be the landing
-pier of the Rodriguez ranch.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_201">[201]</span>In a half hour the boat was being cared for
-by one of the many willing attendants and the
-sailors were escorted to the palatial residence
-of Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>It was the se&ntilde;orita who came first to meet
-her old friends.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Now we are fighting together,&#8221; she exclaimed
-gladly, &#8220;and I would like to go out
-as a man and help.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil thought that nothing so far had deterred
-her. She had seen as much fighting as
-most men and had withstood it bravely, and
-he said so to her.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You might be valuable, se&ntilde;orita, to put
-courage in men&#8217;s hearts,&#8221; Sydney added smiling,
-&#8220;but you would not be very formidable
-as a soldier.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Maria bit her lips vexedly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I can shoot as well as a man,&#8221; she cried half
-angrily, &#8220;and I can ride a horse and paddle a
-canoe. What more is needed?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Something which is not in your makeup,&#8221;
-Phil answered admiringly. &#8220;You are
-not vindictive and are not cruel. But you can
-do us a favor, if you will. We want to explore
-the country between here and Matiginao.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_202">[202]</span>Maria clapped her hands with joy.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I know every foot of the country,&#8221; she
-cried eagerly. &#8220;You couldn&#8217;t have better
-guides than my little brother and I. But,&#8221;
-she added, her voice becoming lower and a
-fear in her eyes, &#8220;my father is now an enemy
-to the ladrones and insurgents, and it is unsafe
-to wander away on the lonely trails.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney exchanged glances as
-much as to say, &#8220;There is your woman&#8217;s argument.
-One moment she wants to fight and
-the next she speaks of danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez welcomed the midshipmen,
-and together all sat down to a large
-table where a delicious breakfast was served.</p>
-
-<p>Phil saw his men were provided for, as he
-intended leaving them behind, and after
-breakfast Maria led the party out where
-five finely bred horses were held by native
-grooms.</p>
-
-<p>Maria and Juan, who sat his pony as gracefully
-as if he were a part of the animal, led
-the way across the open fields surrounding
-the ranch houses. Then they plunged into a
-path cleaving the giant trees of the tropical
-jungle. Limbs of trees brushed their faces<span class="pagenum" id="Page_203">[203]</span>
-and great care was necessary to prevent themselves
-from being unhorsed.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s idea was for the boat to wait until
-dark, and then row up the river as far as
-possible and return by morning, in order
-that the general could be informed of the
-feasibility of the plan and the work of destroying
-the bridge started. His party, meanwhile,
-were bent on following this trail
-toward Matiginao, to reach the ranch before
-the boat and wait for it. He realized that
-they were running a great risk, but he believed
-the necessity for the information was
-worth the risk run. The trail led mostly
-within sight of the snake-like river. They
-passed many dwellings, most of them deserted
-of all save hungry mongrels and starving
-pigs.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This seems to be a fine trail,&#8221; Sydney said
-surprisedly, as they walked their horses two
-abreast.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It leads but five miles further,&#8221; Maria
-replied, &#8220;and from where it ends, all other
-trails are those made by animals, and followed
-seldom by men.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>At a brisk trot Maria started ahead. The<span class="pagenum" id="Page_204">[204]</span>
-jungle bent away from the road, leaving a
-high arched canopy over the heads of the
-travelers, through which the tropical sun
-shone with sullen impotence.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There is a small bungalow up here,&#8221; the
-girl announced in pleasurable anticipation.
-&#8220;We shall have our lunch there. Before the
-big house was built we lived there.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How long has it been since you were
-there?&#8221; Sydney asked in sudden anxiety, the
-fear entering his mind that it might now
-have other occupants.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Not for years, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; the girl replied in
-a low voice. &#8220;It is very lonesome, besides
-there are many pulijanes<a id="FNanchor_3" href="#Footnote_3" class="fnanchor">[3]</a> in the mountains.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The house soon appeared through the thick
-grove of cocoanut palms with its unkept lawn
-sloping gently to the river. The grass in
-front of the house was overhead high, and
-everything had grown wild and in luxuriant
-profusion. The house itself was in ruins.</p>
-
-<p>While Maria and little Juan had taken
-charge of the horses and tethered them amid
-a good repast of alfalfa, the two lads strolled
-down to the river.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_205">[205]</span>&#8220;Hello, here are some canoes!&#8221; Phil exclaimed;
-&#8220;and they&#8217;ve been tied here recently,&#8221;
-he added anxiously, as he saw clearly
-the fresh footprints and the grass trodden
-down near the landing.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_204.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap"><i>&#8220;HELLO, HERE ARE SOME<br />
-CANOES!&#8221;</i></p>
-
-<p>The lads&#8217; intention had been to investigate
-the depth of the water in the river, but their
-startling discovery made them forget all else
-save the visible evidence that a small body of
-men had recently landed at this very spot
-and had taken the almost obliterated trail to
-the abandoned house. Maria and her brother
-might even now be prisoners among their
-enemy. The two midshipmen gazed at each
-other through eyes wide with apprehension.
-What was to be done?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We can&#8217;t desert the girl,&#8221; Sydney declared,
-gazing at the trodden grass. &#8220;Otherwise we
-might reach the horses and escape before they
-discover us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come,&#8221; Phil exclaimed, &#8220;there are not
-many of them, and maybe,&#8221; he added reassuringly,
-&#8220;they are not all armed.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The two lads walked noiselessly toward the
-house along the dim trail.</p>
-
-<p>The building was now in plain sight. The<span class="pagenum" id="Page_206">[206]</span>
-wide porch with its profusion of clinging
-vines was deserted. The long flight of bamboo
-steps was half in ruins. To the right not
-a hundred yards distant their horses were
-standing, their noses deep in the rich grass.</p>
-
-<p>At the foot of the steps the midshipmen
-halted. There was a mysterious silence in
-the air about them and they imagined that
-from the deserted building unfriendly eyes
-were peering down upon them.</p>
-
-<p>Phil gave a sigh of relief as he saw Maria,
-leading little Juan, come slowly through the
-tall grass toward them from the neighborhood
-of the horses. He made up his mind
-quickly. Nothing further could be gained
-here, and the evidence that others had been
-on this spot very recently was too strong not
-to take the warning. He caught Sydney&#8217;s
-arm and wheeled him away from the house.
-The lads had not taken a half dozen steps before
-a shrill cry from Maria riveted them in
-their tracks. Over their shoulders they saw
-that now the porch was filled with natives
-who were pointing their rifles at them menacingly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on, we might as well face them,&#8221;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_207">[207]</span>
-Phil whispered, his teeth tightly clenched
-and with his hand on his pistol.</p>
-
-<p>Turning, Phil led the way back to the
-steps, and there he halted, glancing inquiringly
-at the unfriendly guns covering him.</p>
-
-<p>A native, apparently an officer, dressed in
-a dull gray cotton uniform, walked slowly toward
-him down the rickety steps.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How dare you insult me and my friends
-on my own door-step?&#8221; Maria&#8217;s voice was
-high pitched in anger. &#8220;These gentlemen
-are my guests. By what right are you
-here?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Filipino officer had stopped half-way
-on the steps in surprise, his revolver held in
-front of him. Unconsciously he dropped its
-muzzle toward the ground and regarded the
-girl in unfeigned admiration.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Pardon, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he said apologetically,
-using the Spanish of the higher classes of
-Filipinos. &#8220;You, then, are Se&ntilde;orita Rodriguez,
-and I ask your forgiveness for my rudeness.
-I thought these se&ntilde;ores,&#8221; indicating
-the two midshipmen with a nod of his head,
-&#8220;were Americans and my enemies.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s ears were startled by a loud peal of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_208">[208]</span>
-laughter, and he gazed in almost horror at
-the girl, believing that she had become
-hysterical. But a glance at her smiling face
-showed that her nerves were well in hand.
-An angry flush suffused his face as it crossed
-his mind that this was a trap of her own
-laying. But he blamed himself instantly for
-even entertaining such a thought. What
-would she say? She must acknowledge that
-he and Sydney were Americans, naval officers,
-though they were not in uniform, having on
-khaki riding suits. Phil&#8217;s hand slowly drew
-out his revolver from its holster, while his
-eyes were turned now on the averted face of
-the native officer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;From what part of the island have you
-come?&#8221; Maria asked quickly, the smile of
-superiority still on her face and Phil saw that
-to the native the smile was disconcerting.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am just from Matiginao,&#8221; he replied.
-&#8220;I came for fresh meat. To forage on your
-father&#8217;s land.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The smile died on Maria&#8217;s face, but luckily
-the native had withdrawn his eyes and was
-regarding closely the young men before him.</p>
-
-<p>Maria felt that the Filipino officer must<span class="pagenum" id="Page_209">[209]</span>
-know of her father&#8217;s enmity to his new
-leader, Espinosa. Then as the native&#8217;s eyes
-again traveled to her face the smile reappeared.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I see all white men are to you Americans.
-These se&ntilde;ores are my guests. I vouch for
-them,&#8221; she told him in a confiding voice.
-&#8220;It was a natural mistake for you to make,
-Se&ntilde;or&mdash;&mdash;&#8221; she stopped questioningly, and he
-supplied the name. &#8220;Salas, colonel in the
-Filipino army, se&ntilde;orita, at your service,&#8221; he
-said bowing gallantly.</p>
-
-<p>Maria had not guessed at the officer&#8217;s
-identity although she knew most of the important
-leaders, having known them as a girl
-at her father&#8217;s house before the war had begun.
-Now the mention of his name almost
-made her heart stop beating. This frail creature,
-with the face and figure of a boy, was
-feared by all who had fallen under his control.
-He had won the unenviable reputation of
-being the most cruel of the insurgent leaders,
-first in Luzon under Aguinaldo and then on
-the island of Kapay. He was scarcely older
-than Phil, and yet he held the rank of colonel.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your name, se&ntilde;or,&#8221; she smiled, &#8220;is one<span class="pagenum" id="Page_210">[210]</span>
-well known throughout Kapay. In appearance
-you are not the ogre that you are
-painted.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Colonel Salas&#8217; white, even teeth gleamed between
-his thin lips. He felt himself the
-master of the situation. Here was the proud
-daughter of Rodriguez complimenting him.
-His small soul was nourished by the thought
-that he was feared by all.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Then, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he said, &#8220;if you do not
-consider me an ogre, will you and your English
-friends accept the offer of a share in my
-frugal meal? It is now ready inside.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen had watched with beating
-hearts this plucky girl&#8217;s brave fence with the
-subtle native and as he pronounced the word
-English he glanced at the silent lads. Phil
-thought he saw a gleam of joy in his cruel
-eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They do not speak Spanish?&#8221; he asked,
-shrugging his shoulder expressively as much
-as to answer the question himself in the negative.
-It was better so; one could play the
-game better than two and the lads now knew
-that Maria was an adept in diplomacy, and
-could be depended upon to make a better and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_211">[211]</span>
-intelligent fight for their lives. That their
-lives were in danger was but too evident to the
-lads. The native soldiers still covered them
-with their rifles, and Colonel Salas had moved
-to Maria&#8217;s side as they had talked, leaving the
-line of fire quite clear. A word from him and
-a score of bullets would be tearing through
-their bodies. Did the officer believe that they
-were English? Had he already seen through
-the deception, and made up his mind to
-maneuver so as to kill them at the least risk
-to himself and men? Phil gauged the distance
-between himself and the insolent face of
-this young colonel and resolved that the word
-of command to his men to fire should be a
-dear one for the smiling colonel.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_212">[212]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIII<br />
-
-
-<small>UNWELCOME COMPANIONS</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> lads indeed found themselves in an
-awkward predicament. Just the faintest
-thread really bound them to life, for they saw
-in the cruel expression in the eyes of the
-Filipino officer that nothing would delight
-him so much as to have these white men shot.
-Phil very much feared that in spite of his
-cordial words this boyish native had before
-now guessed the truth. However there was
-nothing to do but remain silent and inactive.
-Phil had a great desire to speak to Sydney in
-English, but he feared this dapper little
-Filipino might have learned enough of that
-language to understand what he might say.</p>
-
-<p>With his cold eye on the midshipmen the
-native officer gave a gruff command to his
-men behind him on the porch. Phil&#8217;s hand
-moved a hair&#8217;s breadth, and the revolver muzzle
-on his hip pointed squarely at the body of
-Colonel Salas, while his finger pressed ever so<span class="pagenum" id="Page_213">[213]</span>
-slightly the trigger. For the fraction of a
-second their eyes met. Then the lad saw
-with relief that the soldiers had lowered their
-guns and were filing through the door into
-the house. With a deft motion he allowed
-his revolver to slip noiselessly back into its
-holster.</p>
-
-<p>Colonel Salas had already turned and was
-leading the way up the steps, Maria and her
-brother following, and the midshipmen bringing
-up the rear.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you think he suspects us?&#8221; Sydney
-whispered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He must,&#8221; Phil answered hurriedly. &#8220;Be
-careful, Syd,&#8221; he added anxiously. &#8220;We&#8217;ve
-got to fight our way out. There seems no
-other way. There are twenty of them against
-us two.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>At the top of the steps Salas turned and
-looked questioningly at the midshipmen.
-Phil dared not meet his eye for fear that the
-little native would see the anxiety which he
-strove to hide.</p>
-
-<p>On the floor of the big room a cloth had
-been spread and a repast set out.</p>
-
-<p>With a graceful wave of his thin hands<span class="pagenum" id="Page_214">[214]</span>
-Colonel Salas made a sign for all to be seated
-and took, himself, the place beside Maria.
-Phil sat on the other side of Maria, while
-Sydney and little Juan were placed opposite.</p>
-
-<p>Their brisk ride had given them all an appetite,
-but the terrible predicament in which
-they now found themselves had quite taken
-away their relish for food. The lads did their
-best to appear undisturbed, but any one with
-half an eye could have seen the restlessness
-behind their forced tranquillity.</p>
-
-<p>It is not the Filipino custom to talk while
-eating, and it was not until his dish was
-emptied that Colonel Salas broke the awkward
-silence.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your English friends are very fond of adventure,&#8221;
-he said suddenly. &#8220;Our camp is
-only a league up the river, and would be well
-worth a visit. I did not intend to return so
-soon, but I shall be glad to take you there.
-You can return to-day or remain until to-morrow
-morning. It is the strongest fortified
-camp in the islands, and has never been successfully
-attacked. You can see where three
-Spanish regiments were annihilated by having
-rocks rolled down upon them.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_215">[215]</span>Phil&#8217;s heart beat faster. Here was the very
-opportunity he had wished for. If they could
-only see this camp with their own eyes; photograph
-the surroundings in their minds; test
-the depth of the water and the width of the
-channel, would it not be worth the fearful risk
-they would run? Then the thought of Espinosa
-drove the possibility of such a hazardous
-undertaking from his mind. They would
-then surely be recognized even if they had not
-been already, and he shuddered to think of
-the penalty. What was his astonishment
-when Maria agreed gladly to the plan.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That would be fun, wouldn&#8217;t it?&#8221; she
-cried in English, appealing to the utterly bewildered
-lads.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Bueno! We can ride to &#8216;El Salto de
-Diablo&#8217; (the devil&#8217;s leap), and there I shall
-have &#8216;bankas&#8217; ready to take us to the foot of
-the trail,&#8221; Salas returned delightedly as he
-left them to instruct his men sleeping on the
-shady porch at the back of the house.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you realize what you are doing?&#8221; Phil
-muttered excitedly. &#8220;At any moment he
-may discover who we really are. Suppose
-word should come to him from the city? We<span class="pagenum" id="Page_216">[216]</span>
-must not accept his invitation,&#8221; he ended
-hurriedly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I fear,&#8221; Maria whispered, &#8220;that he already
-suspects who you are, and for that reason I
-have accepted. If I refused we are already in
-his hands, and what can we do against his
-twenty rifles?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We must act it out, and, if opportunity
-offers, escape. Above all, don&#8217;t show by sign
-or word that you suspect him and don&#8217;t show
-how much Spanish you know,&#8221; she ended
-fearfully, as she saw Salas approaching with
-several of his men.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s heart beat like a trip-hammer at this
-disquieting belief of Maria. She was certainly
-keen. By what system of argument had she
-arrived at such a conclusion? To Phil Salas
-had appeared to believe the story told by the
-girl. Sydney and Juan had listened attentively
-to her words.</p>
-
-<p>In a short time the party were in motion.
-A horse had been captured from the herd of
-those that had run wild during the absence of
-their owner, and Salas sat it well. Phil
-thought he had never seen such a graceful
-horseman. The wild horse reared and plunged<span class="pagenum" id="Page_217">[217]</span>
-in its efforts to unseat the rider, but he could
-not be disturbed. The native followers formed
-about them, and the party moved slowly along
-the uneven road.</p>
-
-<p>After a half hour&#8217;s ride, Salas ordered a
-halt at the base of a bluff several hundred feet
-high. The midshipmen gazed with inward
-emotion at the towering cliffs ahead of them,
-through which ran like a torrent the muddy
-Tubig River.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;From here we must go by banka,&#8221; the outlaw
-explained. &#8220;My men will go on foot, for
-they are accustomed to the rough trail; but for
-the se&ntilde;orita it would be impossible.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>One of the natives approached his chief
-timidly, and spoke a few short sentences in a
-frightened voice.</p>
-
-<p>On hearing the man&#8217;s words, Salas&#8217; face
-darkened in anger and he struck him brutally
-with his heavy whip. The startled native recoiled
-in terror from his incensed master.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He tells me that there is but one banka
-ready,&#8221; he explained apologetically; &#8220;the other
-bankas are at the foot of the trail two miles up
-the river. The ones we used this morning I
-left at the ranch. I am sorry, but as only five<span class="pagenum" id="Page_218">[218]</span>
-can go in this boat some of the party must
-walk. Who shall it be?&#8221; he asked abruptly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There are just five of us,&#8221; Maria suggested
-enthusiastically. &#8220;My brother and I are at
-home with a paddle and surely the se&ntilde;or
-colonel has often propelled his own boat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Salas glanced keenly at the girl&#8217;s face. He
-saw nothing there save youthful eagerness for
-adventure.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;As you wish,&#8221; he replied carelessly. &#8220;It&#8217;s
-a tedious journey: two miles against the swift
-current. My men are used to it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>But Maria&#8217;s mind was set upon their going
-together. Phil pondered upon what her plan
-might be. The river was now narrow and the
-colonel&#8217;s men would always be within hail.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What shall we do with our horses?&#8221; Phil
-questioned. &#8220;Are we to return here?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shall leave some men here with them,&#8221;
-the Filipino leader assured him. &#8220;We shall
-either return by the way we came or else over
-the trail.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Vamos,&#8221; he concluded, waving his hand
-toward the large canoe which two of the
-natives were holding close up to the steep
-river bank.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_219">[219]</span>Maria took her place in the bow while the
-others distributed themselves evenly upon the
-frail low seats, grasping their paddles ready to
-balance the boat when it was cast adrift in the
-swift current.</p>
-
-<p>Salas stood undecided upon the bank; his
-men had gone over the trail leading through
-the almost impenetrable jungle between them
-and the high palisade upon which was the
-outlaw&#8217;s stronghold.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Leave the horses here,&#8221; he said finally to
-his two men, &#8220;and go back to the palm grove
-and bring up one of the canoes we left there
-this morning.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil from his seat in the stern of the banka
-caught a significant look flung to him out of
-the eyes of the girl who was seated in the
-bow, her head bent gracefully backward regarding
-the Filipino leader. In the rear of
-Maria was little Juan, his small hands
-grasping a paddle, much too large for his
-strength.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Give the se&ntilde;or your paddle, Juan,&#8221; the
-girl ordered, then turning to Salas she added
-persuasively, &#8220;Sit behind Juan, se&ntilde;or. I&#8217;m
-afraid he might fall overboard and I don&#8217;t<span class="pagenum" id="Page_220">[220]</span>
-know what my father would do if anything
-should happen to him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw smiled and took the empty
-seat, taking from the boy&#8217;s unwilling hands
-the large paddle.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Bueno,&#8221; he exclaimed, while the two men
-released the boat, pushing it gently away out
-into the stream.</p>
-
-<p>Under the strong strokes of four paddles,
-for the midshipmen were both expert, having
-owned canoes at the Naval Academy, the
-native boat swept swiftly through the water.
-To avoid the strength of the current the canoe
-was steered close in to the steep bank under
-the protecting shade of the overhanging trees.
-Great crocodiles basking on the muddy banks
-were passed, the animals slinking away as
-the boat approached, their long tails lashing
-furiously in their haste. Monkeys filled the
-trees, whistling and jabbering fearlessly as the
-boat passed under them.</p>
-
-<p>While Phil exerted himself manfully at his
-paddle, his thoughts busily sought a plan to
-escape the enforced hospitality of Salas. A
-great fear filled his mind as he dwelt upon the
-horrors of imprisonment among these lawless<span class="pagenum" id="Page_221">[221]</span>
-men. To Sydney and him it would eventually
-mean death, and to Maria and her little
-brother a long and dangerous imprisonment
-and harsh treatment. But why had not Salas
-made them prisoners at once if he suspected
-their real identity? Phil did not guess that
-the outlaw had read defiance and action in the
-midshipmen&#8217;s eyes, and alert as the outlaw&#8217;s
-faculties had become to scent danger even
-though carefully concealed, he had detected
-the stealthy motion of Phil&#8217;s hand when he
-had been confronted by his men. Salas was
-not a coward, but he had realized instantly
-that if he ordered his men to open fire, unless
-the first shots killed the Americans, he himself
-would fall the victim of their vengeance.
-So he was biding the time when he would
-have them safe without danger to himself.</p>
-
-<p>The boat had now covered nearly half the
-distance. Phil wondered what he could do.
-The slight figure of the outlaw, seated upon
-the low thwart just in front of him, was so
-temptingly close and apparently so unconscious
-of any threatening danger. The native&#8217;s
-revolver lay in its holster just within reach
-of the lad&#8217;s hand, the flap securely buttoned<span class="pagenum" id="Page_222">[222]</span>
-upon its polished handle. Phil realized that
-when Salas expected treachery his first act
-would be to capsize the canoe. Being a strong
-swimmer the native doubtless believed he
-could reach the bank first and have at his
-mercy those still struggling in the water. To
-attempt to unbutton the flap of the holster
-and take the revolver without the owner&#8217;s
-knowledge was impossible. Phil needed both
-of his hands to wield the heavy paddle and
-if he stopped paddling Salas would at once
-suspect treachery. His heart rose in his throat
-and his pulses throbbed painfully as a bold
-plan flashed suddenly into his thoughts. It
-seemed the one chance of escape. At the rate
-the boat was going it would soon be at the
-foot of the trail to the stronghold where
-Salas&#8217; men would be waiting in force to
-escort them up the steep incline to the top of
-the mountain. A huge crocodile lay asleep
-about a hundred yards ahead and this sight
-had awakened the plan to action in Phil&#8217;s
-mind.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Go slowly,&#8221; he whispered loud enough to
-be heard by all in the boat. &#8220;Let&#8217;s see if we
-can&#8217;t get a shot at that big crocodile over there.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_223">[223]</span>Salas slowly drew in his paddle, laying it
-across his knees, while his hand went back to
-the holster strap.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You keep paddling slowly, Syd, and the
-se&ntilde;orita can prevent us from capsizing when
-we fire,&#8221; the lad continued eagerly. His own
-revolver still rested in its holster, while his
-eyes were bent upon the outlaw&#8217;s hand fumbling
-with the buttoned flap. Mentally he
-measured the slight figure before him and
-then the frail boat in which they were seated.
-The terrible risk he was running came to him
-almost overpoweringly. Overboard in this
-river full of hungry crocodiles was unnerving
-enough to those who could swim, but Maria
-had said that her small brother could not,
-and for him death in this swift current would
-be assured. With his own paddle resting on
-his knees he braced his feet cautiously but
-firmly on the round of the bilge so as to put
-an equal pressure on each side. The outlaw,
-with his eyes on the crocodile as yet undisturbed
-in his doze, had succeeded in releasing
-the flap; his thumb and forefinger grasped
-lightly the revolver handle, drawing it slowly,
-thoughtfully, from its cover. Phil&#8217;s hand was<span class="pagenum" id="Page_224">[224]</span>
-partly raised, as if he held his revolver ready
-to shoot at the formidable animal. He muttered
-a silent prayer that the crocodile would
-not awake before his plan had succeeded. He
-felt that out of the corner of his eye the outlaw
-was watching him, but Phil&#8217;s hope was
-that his act would be so swift and unexpected
-that Salas would have no time to avoid it
-and jeopardize the lives of those in the boat.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_225">[225]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIV<br />
-
-
-<small>CLEVERLY OUTWITTED</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">As</span> Salas&#8217; hand slowly drew his revolver
-from its holster, Phil&#8217;s right hand with the
-speed of a mongoos seizing its prey clutched
-the slender wrist of the outlaw; the lad&#8217;s left
-hand had moved deftly to the slack of the
-native&#8217;s strong khaki trousers, and the next
-second he had raised the surprised Filipino
-from off his seat and held him for an instant
-balanced in the air.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Turn her down-stream,&#8221; the midshipman
-ordered in a hoarse voice, as he flung the
-struggling man into the water clear of the
-rocking boat.</p>
-
-<p>Maria by a well-timed stroke had instantly
-spun the canoe about, and all four bent
-desperately to their paddles. Phil saw the
-broad-brimmed sombrero of their enemy floating
-on the surface and a fear instantly filled
-his thoughts that Salas might not swim. The
-next second he was reassured; the head of the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_226">[226]</span>
-native covered with thick black hair could be
-plainly seen swimming toward the far shore;
-the menacing presence of the crocodile had
-deterred him from attempting to reach the
-land but a few strokes away. Every second
-the lad expected to hear a loud call for help
-from the outraged officer. Phil, over his
-shoulder, measured the distance yet to be
-gained by the struggling native. Why had
-he not cried out a warning to his men? Surely
-they were within hearing; the trail over
-which they had gone must be but a short distance
-from the river.</p>
-
-<p>Under the straining muscles of the midshipmen,
-helped by the swiftness of the current,
-the canoe sped toward the grassy slope where
-their horses were waiting. A bend in the
-river, and the swimmer disappeared from sight.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why hasn&#8217;t he given the alarm?&#8221; Phil
-demanded nervously. &#8220;What does it mean?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He will as soon as he reaches shore,&#8221;
-Maria gasped breathlessly. &#8220;The monkeys
-when they fall in the water always scream, so
-Salas knows better than to signal to all the
-crocodiles within hearing.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Little Juan, try as he would, could not<span class="pagenum" id="Page_227">[227]</span>
-keep up with the furious pace set him by his
-companions, and he lay quietly balancing
-himself in the boat and gazing about him
-with frightened eyes.</p>
-
-<p>The skiff was run full speed against the
-steep bank of the river, and the midshipmen
-clutched eagerly the loose earth until Maria
-and her brother had gained the shore. Then
-to their expectant ears there came a loud
-halloo! from up the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There&#8217;s no time to be lost,&#8221; Phil urged
-excitedly as he darted ahead to where their
-horses had been tied. A sickening fear took
-possession of him until he had climbed to the
-top of the slope.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They&#8217;re here!&#8221; he cried joyfully, as he
-saw the five horses grazing contentedly.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen lifted Maria and her
-brother upon the backs of their horses, cutting
-loose the hempen lariats with which they had
-been tethered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Lead the way, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he cried hurriedly;
-&#8220;we must not spare ourselves.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>For one second Phil lingered. The fifth
-horse, if he left it there, would afford the
-means of catching other horses to pursue<span class="pagenum" id="Page_228">[228]</span>
-them; for he knew that a single outlaw would
-not dare attempt to follow. With a few swift
-strokes of his knife he severed the bridle and
-then with his open hand struck the restless
-animal across the flanks. As he swung himself
-into his saddle he saw it plunge eagerly
-away into the dense jungle, happy to be again
-free of its domestic yoke.</p>
-
-<p>As the lad dashed ahead after his companions,
-he heard the low moaning note of
-the concha (a shell bugle), a signal of warning
-used by the ladrones of the mountains.
-The sound was insidious. It seemed to come
-from a long way off. Yet Phil knew the
-operator could not be a mile away. The low
-tones were known to travel many miles, even
-farther than the high notes of a bugle. To
-those whose ears had not been trained to
-listen to the warning note, the sound might
-be mistaken for the coo of a wood pigeon.
-The lad&#8217;s heart leaped as he foresaw that the
-two men who had gone to bring the missing
-canoe were between them and the only
-avenue of escape and their trained ears had
-already heard the warning sound. If they
-had started back in the boat when they<span class="pagenum" id="Page_229">[229]</span>
-heard the warning, they would remain concealed
-until the fugitives had drawn within
-close range and then would open fire upon
-them. Even though the persons of the party
-might escape the hastily aimed shots, the
-great bulk of a horse could never escape and
-the crippling of one animal would mean at
-the least their recapture, and probably death
-to all four.</p>
-
-<p>With the energy of despair he drove his
-horse forward to join those in the lead.
-Breathlessly, trembling with his terrible
-anxiety, he reached Maria&#8217;s side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you know of any other road?&#8221; he
-gasped. &#8220;There!&#8221; he exclaimed hopelessly,
-as a low coo came from the direction of the
-bungalow, &#8220;they have answered.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I know of a road,&#8221; the girl returned
-breathlessly, &#8220;but it is across the river, and is
-very narrow and uneven.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gazed frantically at the swift current
-as it appeared intermittently through vistas
-in the trees while they sped along. Once
-across undiscovered they would be safe.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But Juan, he cannot swim; he will be
-afraid,&#8221; he cried hoarsely.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_230">[230]</span>&#8220;Never fear for him. It was necessary
-Colonel Salas should think so in order to
-persuade him to sit in front of you. He fell
-into my trap very obligingly,&#8221; she returned,
-a half smile curving the corners of her
-mouth.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The river then is our only chance,&#8221; Phil
-declared decidedly. &#8220;It will be death for us
-all to attempt to pass the two armed outlaws.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;These horses are all good swimmers,&#8221;
-Maria answered hurriedly. &#8220;Just hold on to
-the saddle and give them their heads. I
-know where we can land, so follow me.
-Look out for Juan,&#8221; she ended in sisterly
-fear.</p>
-
-<p>As Maria, followed by the midshipmen and
-Juan, forced her horse to enter the forbidding
-river, a fusillade of rifle-shots sounded from a
-point in the river some thousand yards above
-them, and the smack of bullets struck the water
-close to the horses&#8217; forefeet. A new danger
-now confronted the fugitives. Those above
-them had discovered their intention to cross
-the river. Fortunately as yet they were beyond
-the effective range of rifles, but if the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_231">[231]</span>
-two men at the ranch should discover the
-move they were making to put the river between
-them and their enemies, they could
-quickly cross in their canoe and locate themselves
-in the path of escape.</p>
-
-<p>The horses drew back at first, erecting their
-ears and neighing timidly, doubtless scenting
-the huge crocodiles hidden in the rank
-growth upon the banks.</p>
-
-<p>Phil heaved a relieved sigh as he saw
-Maria&#8217;s horse emerge from the water on the
-far side, and scramble up the steep bank, the
-dripping girl clutching securely the saddle.</p>
-
-<p>Little Juan behaved like a veteran, guiding
-his horse with a gentle hand across the
-current until the animal&#8217;s feet took the bottom
-on the other side and when the horse&#8217;s
-back emerged, he was sitting again securely
-in the saddle.</p>
-
-<p>Just as Phil, the last to reach the shore,
-gained the steep ascent, a sharp crack of a
-rifle, followed by a loud smack as the bullet
-dug itself into the muddy soil, announced
-that those at the ranch had also discovered
-their presence. As Phil drew himself into
-the saddle shaking free his reins, a single<span class="pagenum" id="Page_232">[232]</span>
-swift glance down the river showed him the
-two natives running toward the palm grove
-where the canoe was tied. A few swift
-strokes and they would again bar the way.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come, Syd, we must ride ahead,&#8221; Phil
-cried in a fever of dread, as he dashed by
-Maria and her brother. &#8220;Never mind what
-happens, se&ntilde;orita, you ride on as fast as you can
-go,&#8221; he continued earnestly as Sydney spurred
-ahead to join him. &#8220;We&#8217;ve got to turn those
-fellows back,&#8221; he explained breathlessly. &#8220;If
-they succeed in getting across they will be
-able to stop us completely.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As the midshipmen galloped madly down
-the rough trail toward a clearing in the trees
-from which they could get a clear view of
-their enemy, both drew their revolvers and
-held them in readiness.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Look out for your horse, Syd,&#8221; Phil continued;
-&#8220;he&#8217;ll probably balk when we fire
-and to be unseated now would mean the
-end.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As the two horsemen came into view of the
-boat the two natives, half-way across the
-river, suddenly dropped their paddles. Two
-flashes of flame and a light, filmy smoke told<span class="pagenum" id="Page_233">[233]</span>
-that their bullets had been sent speeding in
-the midshipmen&#8217;s direction. But fortunately
-the rocking canoe had spoiled their aim.
-The missiles sang harmlessly above the lads&#8217;
-heads.</p>
-
-<p>On a mad gallop the two midshipmen
-rushed out upon the clearing, revolvers in
-hand. As if on drill, the two horses were
-drawn back upon their haunches and the
-Americans&#8217; weapons spoke furiously&mdash;shot
-after shot struck about the panic-stricken
-natives. They first attempted to paddle away,
-but the close hiss of the bullets became more
-than their waning courage could stand. Forgetting
-their rifles in their mad fear, they
-jumped overboard and dived below the surface
-of the water, while the empty canoe, in
-the grasp of the current, went sailing swiftly
-down-stream, forever beyond their reach.</p>
-
-<p>With wild exultation the midshipmen
-turned and raced after their fleeing friends.</p>
-
-<p>Darkness overtook them long before they
-could again recross the river and take the
-wide trail on which it was possible to ride
-with greater speed.</p>
-
-<p>It was after midnight before the great house<span class="pagenum" id="Page_234">[234]</span>
-of Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez loomed up ahead, and
-after they had been stopped a number of
-times by the vigilant sentries they gained
-the hospitable roof.</p>
-
-<p>After a hearty supper, which Maria insisted
-upon their eating, Phil declared his wish to
-return to Palilo.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But your boat has not returned,&#8221; Maria
-insisted. &#8220;You must sleep here to-night,
-then you can return in the morning.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil knew that O&#8217;Neil would not return
-until he had reached a depth of water in the
-river too shallow for the gunboat to pass.
-How far would he have to go? Maybe to the
-ca&ntilde;on beneath the insurgent stronghold. In
-that case he could scarcely expect them before
-morning. A slight uneasiness filled his
-thoughts, but he tried to put it aside, for
-O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s ready resourcefulness could get them
-out of almost any difficulty.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is important, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; Phil declared
-firmly, &#8220;that I should return to-night. I will
-leave a message for my men to follow down
-on their return. May I have a boat or a
-couple of horses?&#8221; he asked.</p>
-
-<p>Maria spoke a few words to an attendant.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_235">[235]</span>&#8220;Lopez will guide you,&#8221; she answered. &#8220;I
-am sorry you will not stay, but you, of course,
-know best.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez, after he had been told of
-the miraculous escape of the explorers, shook
-the lads warmly by the hand, and thanked
-them for taking care of his two children.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It was the other way around,&#8221; Sydney
-cried in admiration. &#8220;Your daughter really
-saved us and herself, too. If it had not been
-for her we should have blundered into a fight
-with the ladrones and been killed for our
-pains.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The old man shook his head thoughtfully.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Salas, eh? So he is with Espinosa. The
-two blackest rogues we have in the islands.
-You are lucky to be free of them.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How many men have you guarding your
-plantation?&#8221; Phil inquired, his mind bent
-upon the possibility of an attack.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have five hundred men, but only three
-hundred rifles,&#8221; Rodriguez replied. &#8220;Captain
-Blynn will send sufficient guns to arm all the
-men by to-morrow. I do not fear an attack
-until after Espinosa is more recovered. My
-spies report that he is still suffering from his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_236">[236]</span>
-wound. I suppose I must expect an attack
-eventually,&#8221; he added sadly, gazing lovingly
-at his daughter and little son.</p>
-
-<p>Within the hour, Lopez appeared and reported
-all was ready for the trip to Palilo.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you want more men,&#8221; Phil suggested,
-&#8220;I can speak to Major Marble, the adjutant-general.
-But I, myself, hope soon to be anchored
-off your house in the &#8216;Mindinao.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Lopez&#8217;s old eyes opened wide. &#8220;A gunboat
-has not been for many years up this river,&#8221;
-he said gravely. &#8220;The Spaniards built the
-bridge after the bloody fight at Matiginao
-over thirty years ago. It is said that many
-rocks were placed in the channel by the
-natives at that time, and after the Spaniards
-found the river was blocked for their gunboats
-they built that bridge to endure. It is
-all of stone and iron. A steam-launch can
-barely pass through the archway.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s heart sank. The channel blocked
-with rock! If this was true only a careful
-survey could assure safety for the gunboat.
-The lead might easily miss the shallow places
-while the gunboat would discover the obstruction
-for the first time with its frail bottom.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_237">[237]</span>The lad shook hands with the dignified old
-man. They regarded him almost with reverence.
-Had they not seen him stand bravely
-before a score of his countrymen, who he
-knew would like nothing better than to murder
-him, and tell them boldly that he was for
-the right even if to be so would cause him to
-be called a traitor! Now he had declared for
-the American cause and almost every influential
-native&#8217;s hand was against him.</p>
-
-<p>Maria went with them to where the grooms
-held their horses.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;orita, we can never thank you
-enough,&#8221; Phil declared gladly. &#8220;You are
-forever putting us in your debt.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Ah, you have forgotten the night you
-saved Colonel Martinez,&#8221; she said softly,
-and Phil imagined in the moonlight that her
-eyes shone brighter.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;By Jove, Phil!&#8221; Sydney exclaimed eagerly
-a moment later, after they and Lopez
-had swung themselves into their saddles and
-were trotting down the broad roadway, &#8220;I
-didn&#8217;t believe it was in any girl to have such
-grit, least of all one of her race. How on
-earth did you come to think of such a trick<span class="pagenum" id="Page_238">[238]</span>
-as you played on that dapper little colonel?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil smiled deliciously.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That was planned telepathically between
-the se&ntilde;orita and me,&#8221; he replied. &#8220;She
-purposely sat in front of Salas and I was
-placed behind him; reason one. She knew
-that I knew if Salas remained in that canoe
-we would all be made prisoners, and as Espinosa
-would be our jailer&mdash;well! The crocodile
-was sent by a kind Providence, but if not
-one way it would have been another. The
-idea occurred to me and I firmly believe that
-she divined what I was about to do, for did
-you see her spin the canoe about so as to get
-out of the colonel&#8217;s reach when he was sent
-floundering in the water? She first induced
-him against his caution and better judgment
-to trust himself alone with us in one canoe.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But why didn&#8217;t he disarm us?&#8221; Sydney
-questioned perplexedly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I dare say he wonders why he didn&#8217;t too,
-by now,&#8221; Phil laughed. &#8220;Maria threw him
-quite off the scent, apparently. These brown
-fellows are very keen on dramatic scenes, and
-he doubtless thought it would be a fine situation<span class="pagenum" id="Page_239">[239]</span>
-to spring the fact that we were prisoners
-when we had arrived in Espinosa&#8217;s presence.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The guide Lopez rode silently at their side.
-The lads were too much occupied to give him
-more than a passing thought until the road
-emerged from the woods of the valley and
-wound gradually around a hill which was
-half-way between Rodriguez&#8217;s ranch and
-Palilo. Their conversation had flagged; for
-the first time they realized that they needed
-sleep. After their hard ride they felt tired and
-stiff. By mutual consent they stopped on the
-crest of the hill. Phil took out his watch
-and held it up to the moon&#8217;s rays.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Two o&#8217;clock!&#8221; he exclaimed. &#8220;Not much
-sleep for us to-night.&#8221; Then a look in Lopez&#8217;s
-face caused him alarm. He saw the native,
-eyes intent on the horizon from which they
-had come and his hands pressing forward his
-ears, apparently trying to intercept a sound
-which he had either heard or imagined.</p>
-
-<p>Phil was about to ask an eager question but
-before he could speak he was answered by a
-distant rumble from the direction of the ranch.
-Again and again the slight sound trembled
-on the still night. Like statues silhouetted<span class="pagenum" id="Page_240">[240]</span>
-against the sky, for a second or more the three
-men sat transfixed with apprehension. Then
-as one man they whirled their horses about and
-galloped madly back over the road in the direction
-from which they had come. That far-distant
-sound could have but one interpretation;&mdash;the
-Rodriguez ranch was being attacked,
-and they might be needed.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_241">[241]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XV<br />
-
-
-<small>A NIGHT OF ALARM</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">After</span> the midshipmen had ridden away
-Maria returned to the large living-room to bid
-her father good-night. A new pleasure had
-come into her life, and what was more natural
-than that she should wish to share it with him?
-These frank, young Americans had proved
-themselves to be of a quality which she had
-not thought existed outside of the story-books
-of her childhood. She believed that in their
-friendship her father&#8217;s difficulties would melt
-away. Juan Rodriguez, interested as he had
-always been in the political trials of his country
-together with the management of his
-vast estates, from which he had reaped great
-riches, like most Filipinos of the upper class,
-had treated his only daughter more as a
-heaven-sent treasure rather than as a daughter
-to confide in and in whom to seek womanly
-sympathy in his perplexities. Her principal
-care had been for her brother, Juan, the pride<span class="pagenum" id="Page_242">[242]</span>
-of the old man&#8217;s life. Upon this seven-year-old
-boy the greater part of his affection was
-centred. Maria was not at all sleepy, and,
-seeing a light in her father&#8217;s bedroom, she
-slipped in quietly to pour out her heart to the
-stern but kindly parent.</p>
-
-<p>On the threshold she stopped in startled
-amazement. Her slippered feet had made no
-sound and the door as she pushed it open caused
-him to glance up in annoyed surprise. She
-saw her father on his knees in the corner before
-several heavy iron-bound chests, and their
-opened covers displayed to her anxious eyes a
-great wealth of gold and silver coins. More
-money than her young imagination had ever
-dreamed of.</p>
-
-<p>As Rodriguez&#8217;s eyes encountered the startled
-look in his daughter&#8217;s face, an expression of
-stern annoyance came into his own as he
-snapped the huge lids shut and rose to his
-feet.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why do you keep all that money here?&#8221;
-she asked anxiously.</p>
-
-<p>Her father looked worried at the question.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;All the money I have is in those chests,
-daughter,&#8221; he answered in a low voice. &#8220;It has<span class="pagenum" id="Page_243">[243]</span>
-been buried, but when Garcia deserted me,
-Lopez and I dug it up and brought it in here.
-I fear these native banks, and if I should be
-robbed by the insurgents I would leave you
-and Juan penniless. My lands are valuable,
-but these,&#8221; pointing to the chests, &#8220;contain
-the most of my wealth. My ambition is to
-take my children abroad, away from this turmoil
-and strife where they can see the world
-and be educated in a way befitting the blood
-in their veins.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Maria put her arms about the old man&#8217;s
-neck and kissed him fondly. &#8220;Father,&#8221; she
-began, her eyes smiling with happiness, &#8220;I
-came in to speak to you of the two young men
-who have just left us. Tell them of your
-troubles and I know they will be able to solve
-the difficulty.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez smiled sadly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your knights, child, I see have already been
-endowed with magic powers,&#8221; he answered lovingly,
-patting her smooth black hair, &#8220;but we
-have a cruel and unscrupulous enemy against
-us, and I am sure by now he knows of the existence
-of this treasure. Garcia and I were
-the only ones who knew where it was buried,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_244">[244]</span>
-and I trusted him as a brother but he has deserted
-and betrayed me. Lopez is from the
-people, but his honesty and loyalty are beyond
-doubt. Captain Blynn knows that this
-money is here and has promised to send a
-company of soldiers to take it to safety in the
-government vaults at Palilo. I had hoped he
-would be here before now,&#8221; he ended in a
-worried tone.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why bury it?&#8221; Maria exclaimed. &#8220;Our
-American friends would gladly take it on the
-gunboat, where it will be perfectly safe.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez&#8217;s face lighted up.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I will ask them to-morrow,&#8221; she added as
-she kissed her father in parting, &#8220;and now
-don&#8217;t lose any sleep over your troublesome
-gold.&#8221; She turned, a happy smile on her face,
-and glided noiselessly to the door, to enter her
-own room; she stopped and the smile froze
-on her face and the fear within her made her
-faint; she clutched reeling at the door and
-steadied herself. The face of a man had been
-pressed against the dark glass of the window
-in her room, and she knew instantly that he
-had seen through the opened door the three
-coveted chests of treasure. She passed her<span class="pagenum" id="Page_245">[245]</span>
-hands across her face in horror, hoping that
-it was but a trick of the imagination, conjured
-up by her anxiety. But no, the face had been
-too vividly distinct. As she had entered the
-darkness of her room, for an instant the light
-from her father&#8217;s lamp had been reflected on
-the intruder&#8217;s face, and in that terrible moment
-she had recognized her father&#8217;s former
-confidant, but now his enemy, Garcia. She
-stood panic-stricken, at a loss how to act.
-To give the alarm might insure her father&#8217;s
-death. Perhaps the enemy had made their
-way within and were at that very moment
-concealed in the great vacant rooms, lying
-hidden in the darkness waiting until the
-household were all asleep, and then murder
-and robbery would be their aim. If she told
-her father now, she knew that he would fearlessly
-and at once give the alarm and call for
-his armed men to protect him. Then a
-thought made the blood freeze in her veins,
-as her active mind sought for the means
-Garcia had employed to pass her father&#8217;s sentries.
-There could be but one solution.
-Garcia had sowed dissension among her father&#8217;s
-retainers. How many of his men could now<span class="pagenum" id="Page_246">[246]</span>
-be trusted? While she stood in terrified
-silence, a loud knock on the outside door
-caused her young body to tremble in mortal
-terror. What could it mean? Who would
-come at this hour in the morning? She saw
-her father make ready to answer, for the servants
-all slept in a house adjoining.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ll open it,&#8221; she cried, trying to disguise
-the tremble in her voice, and with shaking
-limbs she crept down the stairs. Holding her
-breath, she listened. Then she drew back the
-bolts in trembling haste and threw wide the
-door.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil and his tired companions, the boat&#8217;s
-crew, stood in open-eyed wonder as this
-wild-eyed but now joyous girl dragged them
-inside and again barred the door.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s the trouble, se&ntilde;orita?&#8221; O&#8217;Neil
-asked in calm surprise.</p>
-
-<p>She put her finger to her lips and led them
-into the dining-room, where the remnants of
-the midshipmen&#8217;s supper still remained. The
-five men fell upon the food ravenously while
-Maria stood by, fear and hope in turns showing
-in her dark eyes.</p>
-
-<p>She told them of the trip up the river and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_247">[247]</span>
-the escape from the ladrone leader, then of
-the valuable treasure in her father&#8217;s room and
-the face she had seen at the window. After
-she had finished she watched O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s face as
-if it were an oracle and she a petitioner before
-it. The boatswain&#8217;s mate ate for several minutes
-in silence.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where are your men posted?&#8221; he asked
-suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They are divided into four companies, one
-at each of the outposts,&#8221; she answered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Does any one except your father and
-Colonel Martinez know of Garcia&#8217;s treachery?&#8221;
-he asked.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes, two, Lopez and Lukban,&#8221; she replied,
-&#8220;and they are both away from the ranch.
-Lopez has just gone to Palilo with our
-friends.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That&#8217;s bad,&#8221; the sailor exclaimed, a cloud
-on his otherwise expressionless face. &#8220;Then
-your men believe that Garcia is still their
-friend? He has, of course, accomplices among
-them and his object surely must be the treasure.
-He has discovered that it has been dug
-up, and now knows it is in your father&#8217;s room.
-I do not believe there is any immediate<span class="pagenum" id="Page_248">[248]</span>
-danger unless at the same time the insurgents
-are to make an attack in force.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The girl listened eagerly, nodding her head
-in agreement with the wise words of this cool
-and calm American. O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s companions,
-understanding no Spanish, had finished their
-meal and were dozing contentedly in their
-chairs.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Have you a servant you can trust?&#8221;
-O&#8217;Neil asked after a moment&#8217;s thought.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My maid, Inez,&#8221; she answered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;All right; give her a revolver and tell her
-to go to each company and quietly wake the
-men and tell them to get ready immediately
-to repel an attack. If she is in danger of being
-captured by a lurking enemy tell her to
-use the revolver. I&#8217;ll leave two men with
-you and your father, while I&#8217;ll take two to
-try to bag this Garcia.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Maria listened eagerly, hope rising as the
-sailor clearly outlined his plan of action.
-She was sure Inez could be depended upon.
-Quietly she flew up the stairs. As she passed
-her father&#8217;s room she saw that he had retired,
-but had left the light burning for her. She
-stopped a second, listening to his easy breathing.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_249">[249]</span>
-He was asleep. Then she went through
-her own room, a chill passing through her as
-her eyes turned in fear toward the window.</p>
-
-<p>She took hold of Inez&#8217;s arm and shook her
-into wakefulness. The old woman, who had
-nursed Maria as a baby, sat up rubbing the
-sleep out of her eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Keep quiet,&#8221; Maria whispered in a commanding
-voice. &#8220;We are all in danger of
-being murdered. I want you to take this
-revolver and go to each outpost, tell the officer
-on guard that it is Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez&#8217;s
-order to form his men to repel an attack at
-once. If you fail fire the revolver as a
-signal to us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The old woman rose to her feet trembling
-violently. She counted her beads, murmuring
-her prayers, but there was never a word
-of fear or hesitancy.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Good, Inez,&#8221; Maria whispered, kissing
-the old wrinkled face. The girl saw it was
-set determinedly, yet a great and unknown
-terror looked out of her appealing
-eyes. But the girl knew that she would be
-the safest messenger. No one else could be
-depended upon like Inez, and she would<span class="pagenum" id="Page_250">[250]</span>
-sacrifice her old life willingly to help her
-beloved master.</p>
-
-<p>When Maria again entered the dining-room
-O&#8217;Neil had turned out the lamp and was
-ready to carry out his daring plan.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Two of my men will remain here with
-you, se&ntilde;orita,&#8221; he told Maria as she held
-open the door. &#8220;We&#8217;ll soon bag this fellow
-Garcia, if he&#8217;s still hanging about.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil, followed cautiously by his two men,
-walked slowly about the great house. As
-noiselessly as Indians they crept within its
-shadow, straining their eyes toward the portico
-and covered porches above their heads. There
-still remained the light in the room above
-where the girl and her two protectors were
-doubtless now guarding her father and his
-treasure. While O&#8217;Neil stood listening eagerly,
-a shadow crossed the windows; it moved
-slowly inch by inch. The house was silent.
-Off to his left O&#8217;Neil could hear a babble of
-excited voices and the rattle of military accoutrements.
-Inez&#8217;s warning had been given
-and the native soldiers were hastening to their
-stations to repel an enemy. The shadow
-slowly crossed and disappeared and then the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_251">[251]</span>
-light was suddenly extinguished. O&#8217;Neil was
-about to seek further when a noise from above
-arrested his attention. He recognized at once
-that a sash was being opened slowly. Then
-as he watched a dark figure appeared and
-dropped noiselessly to the porch roof a few feet
-below the window. Quietly it lowered itself
-to the edge of the roof and then with the
-agility of an acrobat or a sailor climbed down
-the post near which the boatswain&#8217;s mate and
-his men were standing. The next moment
-two powerful arms enfolded it and a cry of
-fear was promptly stifled.</p>
-
-<p>Then from the dark shadow of the woods to
-the northward came a volley of musketry, followed
-by the war-cry of the bolo-man.</p>
-
-<p>Hastily binding their prisoner with their
-neckerchiefs, the sailors flung him on to the
-porch and rushed to join the defenders scarcely
-four hundred yards away. Rodriguez had
-carefully laid out his plan of defense, and before
-the attacking enemy could come to a hand
-to hand fight, over three hundred yards of
-cleared land must be traversed. As O&#8217;Neil
-and his men reached the trenches where the
-native soldiers were excitedly firing blindly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_252">[252]</span>
-into the night, he could see a bobbing line of
-men rapidly running across this open space,
-firing as they advanced. Hastily surveying
-his surroundings, he saw that on one flank
-was the river defended by a company of men
-and on the flank away from the river was still
-another company. The excited native officers
-were shouting orders to their men, the purport
-of which O&#8217;Neil could but guess. The
-bobbing figures seemed in vast numbers and
-they advanced rapidly in spite of the fire from
-the trenches. Suddenly the company from
-the river bank left its post and came at double
-time to the middle of the line of defense.
-O&#8217;Neil and his men had seized a rifle each
-from lifeless hands and were elbow to elbow&mdash;vociferously
-haranguing the men, cautioning
-them to aim at the constantly moving enemy.
-Before they could realize its significance, a
-line of men arose suddenly from the short
-grass, only a few score of yards in front of the
-trenches, to which point they had crawled
-unobserved, while the defenders had been firing
-at the visible enemy. The next second
-this avalanche of naked humanity had cleared
-the intervening yards and were hacking at the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_253">[253]</span>
-surprised defenders with their sharp bolos.
-Their friends in their rear still kept up a
-brisk fire and many of the bolo-men suffered
-by it. O&#8217;Neil suddenly found himself occupied
-by three fanatics bent upon his destruction,
-while his companions near him were in
-as perilous a position. Throwing away his
-empty rifle he drew his revolver and fired unerringly
-at the nearest native. Then seizing
-the fallen man&#8217;s bolo he rushed upon his
-other two assailants. So fierce had been the
-onslaught of the bolo-men that they had
-surged into and even beyond the rifle-pits,
-leaving a trail of destruction in their path.</p>
-
-<p>The bolo-men, now at close quarters with
-those in the trenches, made good use of their
-keen-bladed knives, but Rodriguez&#8217;s men, familiar
-with the method of attack of these fanatics,
-appeared to flee, and then turning shot their
-would-be pursuers down by the score. O&#8217;Neil
-and his companions were in these few exciting
-minutes many times in peril of their lives
-but soon the last of the attacking horde lay
-gasping on the grass behind the intrenchment
-and the sailors and their dusky allies were
-again in comparative security awaiting grimly<span class="pagenum" id="Page_254">[254]</span>
-the final attack of the bobbing figures some
-hundreds of yards in their front, from whose
-direction a hail of bullets whistled incessantly.
-O&#8217;Neil felt himself all over hardly believing
-that he had escaped unscathed. The sailor
-during his many years of service had never
-seen a fight more desperate. He had frequently
-heard of the insurgent method of employing
-bolo-men; using their riflemen as a
-screen, the practically unarmed horde, who believed
-that their &#8220;Anting-Anting&#8221; charms
-rendered them invulnerable, crawling snake-like,
-unobserved beyond their firing line until
-they reached the rifle-pits of their enemy. Now
-he felt sure the attack on the ranch would fail.
-Rodriguez&#8217;s natives had successfully weathered
-the bolo rush, which they had learned to
-fear most. He did not know the numbers of
-the attackers, but if they could be held off
-until morning the soldiers who had been
-promised from Palilo to guard Rodriguez&#8217;s
-treasure would surely be there to turn the tide
-in their favor. By the fire from the trenches
-surrounding the ranch house on all sides except
-that covered by the river, beyond which
-was an impenetrable swamp, he knew that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_255">[255]</span>
-their line had not been broken. With a
-lighter heart he counseled the natives near
-him to be careful of their ammunition, setting
-them an example by firing deliberately only
-when a target native exposed himself in the
-clearing in front of them. So much occupied
-were those in the trenches that they failed to
-see several great canoes land near the pier, and
-their occupants in single file noiselessly steal
-toward the ranch house.</p>
-
-<p>Again and again the insurgents made their
-onslaught, but each time were received unflinchingly
-and driven back in confusion
-across the cleared ground, many being left dead
-or dying on the field.</p>
-
-<p>A disheveled, terrified figure came running
-from the house toward the trenches; it glanced
-about wildly seeking some one and then
-threw itself at O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s feet, clasping his legs
-tightly, almost upsetting him among the stiffening
-bodies of the dead on the floor of the
-trench. In the dim light he recognized the
-woman Inez who had courageously spread the
-alarm among the native soldiers and her incoherent
-words filled the sailor&#8217;s heart with
-dire forebodings.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_256">[256]</span>&#8220;Oh, se&ntilde;or, save my master,&#8221; she cried; &#8220;he
-is in mortal danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil bent down and unclasped the
-woman&#8217;s hands and lifted her to her feet,
-but her body crumpled and the American
-saw with a sob of horror that Inez had done
-her last service to the Rodriguez family;
-a bolo cut on her old body had claimed her
-among the victims slain in this unnecessary
-war.</p>
-
-<p>The boatswain&#8217;s mate laid the woman&#8217;s
-body aside and with a score of willing men
-started on a run for the house. Half-way
-there they stopped precipitously, hardly believing
-their eyes, a great fear in their hearts,
-for from the river there came a noiseless band
-of men, dim shadows under the gloom of the
-trees. O&#8217;Neil counted them as their silhouettes
-crossed a vista in the trees, and his hopes
-died within him. Here was a new enemy,
-striking from the rear. The men in the
-trenches could not leave their positions; to do
-so would allow many hundreds of the insurgents
-to sweep the ranch.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Forward!&#8221; he cried; &#8220;we must reach the
-ranch house first.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_257">[257]</span>He saw that this was their only hope to
-save the inmates.</p>
-
-<p>Then a cry of joy leaped from his lips as
-tongues of flame leaped from the vicinity of
-the house, directed upon the advancing men
-from the river. He heard an order given
-sharply in the English tongue and a volley
-shattered the darkness asunder.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;American soldiers!&#8221; he cried jubilantly.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil and his men had meanwhile circled
-away from the river in hopes of making a
-rush for an entrance; now with sudden consternation
-O&#8217;Neil saw that the appearance of
-the soldiers from the river would place him
-in the line of retreat of those now surrounding
-the ranch house. Selecting the protection
-of a tree trunk he called upon his men to
-do likewise. He heard the order &#8220;Charge&#8221;
-given in the silvery peals of a bugle and the
-next moment the terrified natives were fleeing
-directly toward him, the hindmost slashing
-with their bolos those in front of them in
-their mad haste to seek safety. Then the
-drumming of hoof-beats was heard and three
-horsemen appeared suddenly from the night,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_258">[258]</span>
-emptying their revolvers as they came into
-the fleeing savages.</p>
-
-<p>A woman&#8217;s scream pierced the night and the
-figure of a man silently dropped from the
-roof and disappeared in the darkness.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_259">[259]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVI<br />
-
-
-<small>A FILIPINO MARTYR</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Phil</span> and Sydney were hard pushed to
-keep up with the native as he spurred his
-horse forward over the dark road.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The ranch is being attacked!&#8221; Lopez
-cried in a voice of fear. &#8220;My poor master will
-surely be killed!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s thoughts were only for the frail girl
-whom he had begun to look upon as his own
-especial charge. He knew the cruelty of the
-Filipinos when once their anger was aroused
-and he believed that her part in Espinosa&#8217;s
-betrayal must now be known to that treacherous
-leader. Probably Colonel Salas himself
-formed a part of the attacking force, and
-the lad thought fearfully of the vengeance he
-would take upon the helpless girl if she fell
-into his hands. As they approached the
-ranch, the volume of fire increased alarmingly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They are in force!&#8221; Phil exclaimed, his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_260">[260]</span>
-heart sinking within him as he urged his
-tired mount forward.</p>
-
-<p>The ranch with its surrounding orchard of
-fruit trees now lay just below them and the
-white road winding down the hill glistened
-in the dim moonlight. Tongues of flame
-darted here and there from the shadows of
-trees and shrub, even close to the house itself,
-while further in the background toward the
-river a line of flame resembling fireflies on a
-summer evening told him the soldiers of
-Rodriguez were stubbornly resisting the main
-attack from their solidly built trenches. As
-they plunged madly down the hill road, his
-alert eyes tried to disentangle the situation.
-He saw many moving figures flitting through
-the trees, the moonlight glinting on their
-bright bladed bolos, while toward the river a
-long line of flashing rifles told of a rescue
-party approaching, from whom the flitting
-figures were fleeing.</p>
-
-<p>Three white figures appeared suddenly from
-behind a tree close to the retreating bolo-men
-and the lad&#8217;s heart gave a great leap of joy as
-he recognized even in the dim light the stalwart
-figure of O&#8217;Neil.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_261">[261]</span>Then as he charged forward with his companions
-close beside him, Maria&#8217;s cry made
-his heart sink and at the same instant he saw
-the figure of a man emerge from the house
-and dart away after the retreating bolo-men.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where are we needed?&#8221; a familiar voice
-shouted from the company which had now
-halted at the house, and the anxious lads,
-after firing their revolvers in vain at the fleeing
-figure, were shaking Captain Blynn&#8217;s
-hand.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;In the trenches, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil volunteered
-eagerly. &#8220;They are hard pushed, sir.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn gave a hurried order and
-his company of American soldiers rushed
-eagerly toward the thick of the firing, followed
-by O&#8217;Neil and his men. All were
-eager to again try conclusions with the elusive
-foe.</p>
-
-<p>Phil and Sydney followed the anxious
-Lopez to the house. As they entered the hall
-they were horrified to find everything in confusion.
-The furniture was wrecked in many
-places, and there were blood-stains on floor
-and wall, showing there had been a terrible
-struggle. A light was burning dimly in an<span class="pagenum" id="Page_262">[262]</span>
-alcove. In the corner lay the white form of
-an American sailor mutilated and dead.
-Further up the stairs they saw the other poor
-sailor breathing his last. Clearing the body
-with a bound the lads gazed with sinking
-heart upon the dead face of Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez,
-lying on the floor of his bedroom, while all
-about him was confusion and ruin.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where is the girl?&#8221; Sydney asked in a
-faint, fearful voice.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;orita!&#8221; Phil called hopelessly.</p>
-
-<p>A faint sob came to their ears from an
-inner room. Rushing in they found the girl
-on the floor, her hands and feet securely
-bound. About her mouth a gag had been
-placed, but it had fallen, leaving the mouth
-free.</p>
-
-<p>They quickly released her and placed her
-tenderly on the bed.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;She managed to get off the gag and
-scream,&#8221; Phil whispered with admiration, &#8220;before
-she fainted. Bring that light, Syd, she
-may be hurt.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The light was soon brought, and the lads
-were relieved to find that she was unharmed.</p>
-
-<p>Lopez meanwhile had stayed at the bedside<span class="pagenum" id="Page_263">[263]</span>
-of his dead master, moaning piteously. The
-noise caught the girl&#8217;s ear as she awaked
-from her stupor under the administration of
-the midshipmen.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It was Espinosa himself,&#8221; she exclaimed
-in an anguish of sorrow. &#8220;They forced the
-door and killed the brave sailors. My father
-defended himself but he is no match for five
-men. Espinosa struck him down from behind.
-I ran to guard little Juan, but they
-caught me and bound me.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The money is gone too,&#8221; groaned Lopez.
-This to him seemed as great a sorrow as the
-death of his master.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They lowered it out the window,&#8221; Maria
-said. She entered her father&#8217;s room, walking
-unsteadily between the two midshipmen, and
-knelt in prayer before her father&#8217;s couch.</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s eyes fell before those of the girl as
-she arose dry-eyed and calm. He saw the
-anguish in her face, however, and vowed that
-he would lighten her task wherever it lay in
-his power.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Is Juan safe?&#8221; Lopez asked suddenly, his
-mind at last grasping the horrible calamity
-which had fallen on his master&#8217;s house and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_264">[264]</span>
-realizing that his first duty was with the
-living.</p>
-
-<p>The girl nodded.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Inez brought the alarm that the house
-was surrounded. She hid the boy and herself.
-Espinosa searched for him and his intention
-was to carry us both away as his
-prisoners.&#8221; Then a sudden fear came into
-her voice and her eyes flashed with excited
-terror. &#8220;He said that Colonel Martinez had
-been killed. Is it so?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The lads shook their heads.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We have no news, Maria,&#8221; Phil said
-kindly. &#8220;No, it cannot be so. It was but
-prompted by this cruel man to taunt you.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>She sighed hopefully.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If he had known of this attack and was
-alive he would have prevented it,&#8221; she exclaimed
-suddenly, her hope turning to dejection.</p>
-
-<p>While they were talking the fusillade
-slowly diminished and soon ceased altogether
-and in a short time Captain Blynn&#8217;s voice
-was heard in the hall below.</p>
-
-<p>In the large living-room the army and
-navy men sat, until the daylight sifted in<span class="pagenum" id="Page_265">[265]</span>
-through the shell windows, talking of the
-perplexing situation, while Maria was made
-to go to bed and sleep. The doctor who accompanied
-the captain regarded her with eyes
-of grave concern.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;She must not be overexcited. She is
-outwardly calm but her heart acts queerly.
-It may snap at any moment,&#8221; he had told
-the lads.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have received a long letter from your
-friend, Colonel Martinez,&#8221; the captain exclaimed
-to the midshipmen after disposing of
-a steaming cup of coffee. &#8220;He said he would
-willingly surrender to General Wilson if the
-price on his head were removed, and he sent
-me papers and documents which I have
-already sent to the governor-general in
-Manila which prove Martinez&#8217;s innocence of
-certain crimes committed in Luzon and implicate
-a Filipino now high in the good
-graces of the government.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil thoughtfully sent Lopez to Maria to
-tell her of Captain Blynn&#8217;s news and then
-gave Captain Blynn the story of the recent
-tragedy on the floor above.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Poor Rodriguez,&#8221; the captain murmured.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_266">[266]</span>
-&#8220;If he had taken the other side he would
-now be alive. The money,&#8221; he added, his
-face troubled&mdash;&#8220;I am too late. I promised
-him I would come, but I was delayed by important
-matters with the general.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A search at once,&#8221; Phil exclaimed rising
-hastily from his chair; &#8220;they can&#8217;t have gone
-far with those heavy chests.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Lopez smiled grimly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;or, it would be impossible to follow
-them. By now the treasure is either carefully
-hidden or else in a banka hurrying up
-the river to Espinosa&#8217;s stronghold. We must
-capture Espinosa; where he is the money will
-be also.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Quite right, Lopez,&#8221; Captain Blynn agreed.
-&#8220;It&#8217;s not pleasant to hike in this country at
-night either, young man,&#8221; he added to Phil,
-whose sudden show of excitement in the
-prospect of another fight had died down;
-&#8220;every trail is trapped, and I don&#8217;t relish a
-green bamboo spear through me even for all
-old Rodriguez&#8217;s money. Espinosa undoubtedly
-has planned this attack carefully and in the
-darkness we would simply be wasting our
-time and be losing sleep.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_267">[267]</span>&#8220;Some of our friend Espinosa&#8217;s plotting, in
-the light of this affair, is now quite plain.
-Rodriguez was in his way, and so is Martinez,
-but I don&#8217;t exactly see why; and this attack
-was made easy through his winning of
-Garcia, the trusted friend of Rodriguez.
-But how did he learn of this money?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why,&#8221; Phil exclaimed, a scowl on his
-face, &#8220;Lopez tells me that Garcia alone knew
-of its existence and coveted it, and readily
-persuaded Espinosa to help him obtain it and
-share it. With that amount of money they
-can make this war very difficult for us or
-they can escape with their booty to Hongkong.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well,&#8221; said the captain yawning outright,
-&#8220;I must get some sleep. The bridge
-is clear; I&#8217;ll wait here until you bring up the
-gunboat. The general is coming himself to
-look over the ground. We&#8217;ve had reports
-that the rebel army is massing at Matiginao,
-where supplies for a year have been collected.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;re going to have the biggest fight in
-the history of the war,&#8221; he added in a sleepy
-voice as he lay full length on the wicker
-lounge. &#8220;By the way, old man Tillotson
-promises all kinds of rewards to any one who<span class="pagenum" id="Page_268">[268]</span>
-will rescue his son. He&#8217;s coming down himself&mdash;sailed
-from Manila the day after he got
-the news.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Although the midshipmen and their men
-would have liked nothing better than to
-follow Captain Blynn&#8217;s example for a few
-hours&#8217; nap, they felt that the startling news
-that the entire rebel army was collecting
-upon Matiginao made it imperative for them
-to leave the situation at the Rodriguez ranch
-in the hands of Captain Blynn and return to
-their gunboat. So far their work had not
-been crowned with success. True, they had
-exposed a traitor, but in doing so the American
-soldiers had acquired a new and sagacious
-enemy in Espinosa. The remaining members
-of the Katipunan society had taken flight,
-and had fled before the vengeance of Captain
-Blynn whom they all hated and feared.
-Rodriguez had been killed, and enough gold
-to continue the war indefinitely had been
-taken almost before their eyes, and they had
-been powerless to prevent it. This was not a
-pleasant retrospective dream in which to indulge
-as they watched in silence the even
-breathing of the complacent army man.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_269">[269]</span>&#8220;We seem so powerless against them,&#8221;
-Sydney complained. &#8220;Our enemies are everywhere.
-One moment the natives about us
-seem friendly, and the next they are sticking
-us in the back with knives. When we start
-on an expedition the enemy know just how
-many men we have and where we are going,
-so there can be no surprise, while they always
-take us unawares.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But now, it&#8217;s different since Espinosa and
-the Katipunans have been forced to leave
-Palilo,&#8221; Phil exclaimed. &#8220;In the last few
-days Captain Blynn says our soldiers in the
-provinces have surprised several bands of insurgents.
-So you see they have ceased to be
-kept posted by spies at headquarters.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Espinosa is collecting all his men in
-Matiginao with the idea of safety and a hope
-of being able to capture Palilo before the two
-extra regiments arrive, but General Wilson
-will checkmate him by withdrawing half his
-men to surround him in his mountain stronghold.
-Now we have some chance; before,
-they simply knew when we were coming, and
-if they couldn&#8217;t meet us with three times our
-number they kept out of the way. But<span class="pagenum" id="Page_270">[270]</span>
-come,&#8221; he added suddenly jumping to his
-feet, &#8220;we are wasting time.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The Americans returned down the river in
-their cutter, this time the midshipmen taking
-turns at the oars, and it was nearly eight
-o&#8217;clock before they stood once more on the
-deck of the &#8220;Mindinao.&#8221; The bodies of the
-dead sailors were sent at once to the army
-hospital for burial.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Major Marble has been here twice to see
-you, sir,&#8221; the quartermaster informed Phil;
-&#8220;he said he&#8217;d return again in an hour.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Breakfast first,&#8221; Phil shouted to the
-Chinese steward, who came aft, smiling
-blandly at the return of his officers, steaming
-coffee in hand.</p>
-
-<p>While they were still at table Major Marble
-arrived, and was told all the news of the
-river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The audacity of those beggars,&#8221; he exclaimed,
-&#8220;attacking in force within ten miles
-of headquarters. It&#8217;s a shame, the few men
-we are allowed to cover this entire country.
-The general sees now that what is needed is
-concentration, but if we withdraw our entire
-garrisons from the towns it will mean that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_271">[271]</span>
-the innocent people there who have befriended
-us will suffer.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I suppose you are right, major,&#8221; Phil
-said thoughtfully, &#8220;but in war it seems to me
-that one can&#8217;t stop to consider the feelings of
-innocent people where the success of the cause
-is concerned. Espinosa has twice as many
-troops as the general, and they are fighting
-on their home soil. They know every footpath.
-Some are not armed with a rifle but
-are far more dangerous to us with their bolos
-and fanatical bravery. We did not see his
-stronghold, I am glad to say,&#8221; he smiled
-grimly at the words, &#8220;but we know that one
-thousand men held it successfully against five
-times that number of Spaniards a generation
-ago. From what I have seen I say concentrate
-every available man and crush this fellow
-Espinosa before he gets any stronger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Major Marble nodded his head in agreement
-with the views of the young navy
-man.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If we could always do what our military
-training dictates,&#8221; he answered sadly, &#8220;this
-war might not have begun.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shall go up the river in an hour,&#8221; Phil<span class="pagenum" id="Page_272">[272]</span>
-announced, &#8220;and if the general wishes I shall
-be honored to have him on board.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The general is waiting anxiously to know
-that,&#8221; the major replied promptly; &#8220;that was
-my mission here, but your exploits so interested
-me I had nearly forgotten my mission.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Within the hour the &#8220;Mindinao,&#8221; flying
-the blue flag with one white star at her main
-truck in honor of her distinguished passenger,
-General Wilson, cast off from the dock and
-steamed up the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That was a fine piece of work,&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-in admiration, as he examined the
-cleverly constructed drawbridge built within
-the twenty-four hours by the army engineers.
-Its width was just sufficient to admit the
-&#8220;Mindinao.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil stood on the bridge beside the man at
-the wheel, piloting the gunboat through the
-ever-changing shoals, while O&#8217;Neil in person
-heaved the lead in the chains, calling out the
-depth in feet.</p>
-
-<p>After leaving the town the river ran
-through several miles of nipa swamp land,
-the home of the carnivorous land crab,
-the crocodile and the bandit Filipino. The<span class="pagenum" id="Page_273">[273]</span>
-gunboat continued cautiously, Phil keeping
-the sharp bow within the deep water, sometimes
-so close to the thickly wooded shore
-that he could have reached out and touched
-with his hand the overhanging trees.</p>
-
-<p>Before noon the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; had anchored
-off Rodriguez&#8217;s ranch and the general and
-party were landed to view the scene of the
-recent fight. The shore was lined with curious
-and excited natives, those of Rodriguez&#8217;s men,
-who had been spared from the fierce attack.
-To them the presence of the gunboat so far up
-the river was almost a miracle. They pointed
-knowingly at the big guns and clapped their
-hands in savage joy at the thought of what
-they could do against the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn had taken the situation in
-hand and had distributed the soldiers of his
-company to reinforce the native companies.
-A feeling of relief was now manifested by all.
-They were confident that no attack would be
-attempted while the gunboat&#8217;s guns frowned
-menacingly out there in the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That&#8217;s worth a regiment,&#8221; Captain Blynn
-exclaimed as he saluted the general and
-helped him from the &#8220;Mindinao&#8217;s&#8221; cutter to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_274">[274]</span>
-the bamboo pier, pointing to the graceful
-white ship, standing sharply against the dark
-background of jungle grass and banana trees.
-As they walked toward the house Captain
-Blynn dropped behind and took Phil&#8217;s arm
-confidingly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;After you had gone my men found a native
-tied up in all sorts of sailor knots with
-silk neckerchiefs, just under Rodriguez&#8217;s window.
-Se&ntilde;orita Rodriguez recognized him at
-once as a former friend of her father who
-she said had betrayed him. He was pretty
-well frightened and to save his skin, for he believes
-we are going to kill him, he has offered
-to show us the trail to Espinosa&#8217;s stronghold.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil shook his head in mystery.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t know how he got there, unless&mdash;&mdash;&#8221;
-He turned and called O&#8217;Neil from
-the boat. &#8220;O&#8217;Neil, do you know anything
-about a native securely bound with sailor
-neckerchiefs?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sure, sir. It was the one that crawled out
-of the window,&#8221; he explained hastily; &#8220;the
-young lady saw his face spying on her father.
-His name is Garcia.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Do you know,&#8221; the captain said knowingly,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_275">[275]</span>
-&#8220;that he is the only prisoner captured?
-There wasn&#8217;t a single wounded man in sight
-this morning. It isn&#8217;t the custom of the country,
-you see.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil involuntarily shuddered. &#8220;How callous
-one becomes,&#8221; he thought, &#8220;in war time.
-Think of maybe a hundred wounded men
-cruelly butchered by brother natives.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Before they reached the house the party was
-startled by a rifle-shot from behind them.
-Glancing about quickly they saw a large canoe
-manned by natives appear from behind the
-trees and paddle directly for the gunboat; a
-large white flag flew prominently from the
-bow of the boat. Phil and Captain Blynn
-walked quickly back and sent O&#8217;Neil and his
-cutter out to learn the meaning of the flag of
-truce. The general and the rest of the party
-halted and waited, eager to see what this
-strange move might mean.</p>
-
-<p>The boat came quickly back and Phil took
-a letter from a native&#8217;s hand scanning it
-with beating heart. &#8220;For the general,&#8221; he
-said.</p>
-
-<p>All watched the general break the seal and
-fumble with his glasses. It seemed ages before<span class="pagenum" id="Page_276">[276]</span>
-he finished the few short lines and handed
-the letter to Captain Blynn.</p>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-
-<p>&#8220;Lieutenant Tillotson is my prisoner. I
-will surrender him safely in exchange for the
-deserter Colonel Martinez. If you attack me
-I shall have him shot.</p>
-
-<p class="right">&#8220;<span class="smcap">Espinosa.</span>&#8221;</p>
-</div>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_277">[277]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVII<br />
-
-
-<small>A DARING PLAN</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Phil</span> stood silently by, his mind occupied
-over the details of a daring plan.</p>
-
-<p>The exchange proposed by Espinosa was out
-of the question, even if Colonel Martinez had
-surrendered, which he had not done up to the
-present time; and until his sins in Luzon
-were forgiven Phil knew that he preferred his
-liberty. But this threat against Tillotson&#8217;s
-life worried Phil. Espinosa was sufficiently
-cruel to carry it out, he was sure.</p>
-
-<p>Leaving the group of officers, who were still
-pondering over the contents of Espinosa&#8217;s
-communication, Phil went in search of Maria.
-There were points in his plan which she could
-throw light upon.</p>
-
-<p>He found her in the house, heavy-eyed with
-sorrow and loss of sleep, but she greeted him
-with a smile and waited patiently until the
-room was empty before signing him to speak,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_278">[278]</span>
-for she saw that he had something of importance
-to communicate.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How much dependence can we put upon
-Garcia as a guide?&#8221; he asked eagerly. &#8220;I
-have a plan, and all depends upon whether
-he can be trusted to lead us against Espinosa,
-if not willingly, then under intimidation.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Before they killed my father and carried
-away the treasure,&#8221; the girl answered, a spark
-of excitement entering her dull eyes, &#8220;Espinosa
-and Salas got the information necessary
-for their work from Garcia, bound and
-helpless where your sailors had left him.
-They refused to liberate him and hoped he
-would be killed by the Americans. You
-can be sure,&#8221; she added, &#8220;that he will
-take keen pleasure in running his enemies to
-earth.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;And now for my favor from you,&#8221; the
-lad continued in a lower tone; &#8220;as Garcia will
-take Lopez&#8217;s place as guide for the soldiers to
-the trail up the mountain, I want twenty-five
-of your men whom you would trust to the
-death, under the command of Lopez, to take
-O&#8217;Neil and me as prisoners to Espinosa&#8217;s
-camp.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_279">[279]</span>The girl gave a low exclamation of surprised
-horror, regarding Phil fixedly, half
-believing the lad was out of his mind.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I mean it,&#8221; he exclaimed earnestly. &#8220;It&#8217;s
-the only chance we have of saving Tillotson&#8217;s
-life. Your men must pretend to have deserted
-after the death of their master,&#8221; he
-dropped his voice as he saw the look of pain
-in Maria&#8217;s eyes at the mention of her father&#8217;s
-sad fate. &#8220;Lopez will claim to have taken us
-prisoners and then deserted to the insurgents.
-It&#8217;s a good plan,&#8221; he cried enthusiastically,
-&#8220;and is sure to be successful.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Maria paled at the mere thought of such
-rashness, but seeing Phil could not be moved
-from his avowed intention, she gave her consent
-grudgingly.</p>
-
-<p>The general was not so easily convinced.
-His natural and inherent cautiousness could
-not be changed even under the combined persuasion
-of the midshipman and his staff officers,
-Major Marble and Captain Blynn, who
-were both enthusiastic over the conception of
-such a daring strategy.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The very impertinence of it will make it
-successful,&#8221; Major Marble exclaimed. &#8220;They<span class="pagenum" id="Page_280">[280]</span>
-will not believe that one could be so rash as
-to willingly place his life in danger.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You&#8217;ll have to stay with the gunboat,&#8221;
-Phil explained to Sydney, who was visibly
-put out that he too could not be allowed to
-go. &#8220;I shall take only O&#8217;Neil. The general
-has ordered that all the soldiers who can be
-spared from the garrisons throughout the
-island be despatched to rendezvous here and
-will need the &#8216;Mindinao&#8217; to carry troops and
-shell the stronghold from the river. If you
-find it possible take her through the ca&ntilde;on;
-there is a trail on the other side from the
-westward. If you are successful we shall
-have them between our two parties.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>That evening Maria and her small brother
-followed their father&#8217;s body to his grave in
-the family cemetery. The general himself
-read the solemn burial service and a company
-of American infantry fired three volleys over
-the grave of the murdered patriot.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson established his field headquarters
-in the house of mourning and before
-three o&#8217;clock of the next day the first of the
-detachments of soldiers arrived and went into
-camp on the river slope.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_281">[281]</span>&#8220;We shall have about one thousand rifles
-for the attack,&#8221; Captain Blynn told the midshipmen,
-after Phil had unfolded to him and
-Major Marble the details of his plan to rescue
-Lieutenant Tillotson, &#8220;and by to-morrow
-afternoon they should all be assembled here.
-The general,&#8221; he added, &#8220;is very much
-worked up over Espinosa&#8217;s threat, and realizes
-that it is not an empty one, but he still refuses
-to allow you to take this terrible chance.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Within a short time Phil was summoned to
-the general&#8217;s room.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I cannot allow you to take this risk,&#8221; he
-said kindly, a light of admiration in his eyes.
-&#8220;Why should two American lives be jeopardized
-to save one? And perhaps some will
-say that Lieutenant Tillotson does not deserve
-such a sacrifice at your hands.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That makes me more anxious to take the
-risk,&#8221; Phil urged. &#8220;We did not part friends,
-and I can&#8217;t help feeling that our quarrel has
-had some part in his misfortune.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Under the confiding influence of the general&#8217;s
-manner, Phil told of his affair with
-Tillotson, doing his best to make a good case
-for his one time enemy.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_282">[282]</span>The general shook his head thoughtfully.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is very hard for me to allow you to undertake
-such a rash adventure,&#8221; he answered, putting
-his hand affectionately on the midshipman&#8217;s
-shoulder, &#8220;but war is war, and if pluck
-will bring success, Tillotson&#8217;s life will be
-saved. Tell me now,&#8221; he added, seating himself
-and motioning Phil to a chair, &#8220;how far
-you have worked out the details of your plan,
-for every point must be covered; there must
-be no loophole for failure. Can you expect
-that each of your twenty-five men will keep the
-secret after they have mixed with the enemy?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil outlined each step as he had thought
-it out during the last anxious twenty-four
-hours, while the general listened, his face
-grave and thoughtful.</p>
-
-<p>They would start after nightfall, and by
-sending men ahead to announce their coming
-would be received by the insurgents with acclamation.
-They would spend the next day
-at the camp and Lopez would endeavor to
-keep his men from mixing with the enemy,
-and the next night the gunboat and as many
-troops as the general could muster would lay
-siege to the stronghold. The remainder Phil<span class="pagenum" id="Page_283">[283]</span>
-had not thought out. Chance alone must decide
-the outcome, but he hoped to save Lieutenant
-Tillotson&#8217;s life and their own, and
-maybe by Lopez and his men commanding
-the top of the trail they could aid the American
-troops in their fight for the stronghold.
-When the attack was made he would use
-Lopez&#8217;s men to prevent Espinosa from carrying
-out his threat against Tillotson&#8217;s life.
-The gunboat must use its fire against the
-fortifications, but be careful to direct its shell
-to the left of the stronghold, for he hoped
-that his own men would be at the right near
-the trail leading down the precipice.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There are a great many chances for
-failure,&#8221; the general said thoughtfully as Phil
-finished, &#8220;but with your energy and perseverance
-I believe you will win.&#8221; He shook the
-lad&#8217;s hand warmly in parting.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I wish I could go with you,&#8221; Maria said
-sadly as Phil bade her good-bye; &#8220;but you
-can put your full trust in Lopez. It was he
-who betrayed the Katipunan society to me to
-save my father&#8217;s life. How he got the information
-I do not know, but if his act were known
-his life would be forfeited.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_284">[284]</span>Without ceremony Phil and O&#8217;Neil, their
-hands tied securely with ropes made fast to
-their bodies and held in the hands of the
-make-believe deserting natives, filed along the
-narrow trail leading parallel to the fast flowing
-river. Two messengers had been sent
-ahead to notify the insurgent leader of
-the joyful tidings of the important captures.
-Their progress was rapid, and inside of three
-hours the house which had been the scene of
-Phil&#8217;s and Maria&#8217;s strategy was reached. There
-the party waited.</p>
-
-<p>After what seemed an interminable time to
-the anxious prisoners, a challenge suddenly
-broke the stillness of the dismal woods and
-Phil&#8217;s old enemy, Colonel Salas, stood before
-him. A great joy shone from his
-dark vengeful eyes as he beheld the bound
-prisoners.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My chief will be delighted to receive such
-distinguished visitors,&#8221; he laughed, kicking
-Phil viciously as he lay helpless upon the
-ground. &#8220;That is for your cleverness of yesterday,&#8221;
-he snarled. &#8220;We&#8217;ll see you are
-kindly treated. We shall give you all the refined
-initiations that we can think of to make<span class="pagenum" id="Page_285">[285]</span>
-your stay with us pleasant and then&mdash;&mdash;&#8221; He
-stopped with a significant gesture.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; Phil whispered after Colonel Salas
-had left him to join Lopez, who had assembled
-his men ready to advance, &#8220;I am afraid we
-are in for a pretty bad time of it. But if I ever
-get the opportunity I&#8217;ll make that little brown
-piece of pomposity pay for that kick he gave me.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Well, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil replied evasively, &#8220;I
-may have been in worse situations&mdash;no doubt
-I have&mdash;but this one seems rather more complicated.
-I think we&#8217;ll have many kicks and
-worse to pay back before we can call our bodies
-our own and not footballs for these little brown
-brothers to score with.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>After a rapid parley the party were again in
-motion. Phil and O&#8217;Neil were roughly seized
-by two natives and forced ahead up the trail.
-Two or three times Phil&#8217;s foot slipped into
-yawning holes at either side of the trail, but
-each time he was dragged back to safety by
-the natives behind him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This whole place is trapped,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil
-whispered, pointing to where his foot had uncovered
-the top of a square hole some six feet
-deep, the lantern carried by a man in front betraying<span class="pagenum" id="Page_286">[286]</span>
-to view the green bamboo spears at the
-bottom.</p>
-
-<p>Phil shivered as he gazed down on the
-pointed sticks as sharp as a needle, and
-poisoned, he knew, with a deadly vegetable
-sap that would kill within the hour.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Be careful, Mr. Perry,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil cautioned
-in a low, anxious voice. &#8220;These men know
-where the traps are, and will try to catch you
-if you make a misstep&mdash;but they might fail,&#8221;
-he added with a shudder.</p>
-
-<p>A halt was called suddenly as they moved
-through a densely wooded section of the level
-trail, while several of Colonel Salas&#8217; men
-moved cautiously ahead and appeared to
-work quietly in the jungle. After a few
-minutes they reappeared and signaled for the
-column to proceed.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Spring traps,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil informed the midshipman.
-&#8220;They&#8217;ve detached them from
-their springs. If we hadn&#8217;t known they were
-there one of us would have caught his foot in
-a piece of innocent looking vine which would
-have pulled a trigger and sent twenty or
-more spears across the trail with force sufficient
-to penetrate a pine board.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_287">[287]</span>Phil half wished that he had not volunteered
-for this nerve-racking ordeal. After
-all what did he owe Tillotson? Had not the
-army man tried to injure him in every way?
-Yet the lad knew for that very reason he had
-asked to be allowed to risk his own life to
-rescue him. Then he thought suddenly of
-O&#8217;Neil. His stalwart form was just ahead of
-him, dimly outlined in the darkness. Had
-he acted generously to this brave and willing
-sailor?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;O&#8217;Neil, I am mighty sorry I brought you
-along,&#8221; he exclaimed suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil stopped in his tracks so suddenly
-that the two brown men bumped their heads
-with some force against his back and cried
-out with surprise.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why, sir!&#8221; he answered in an aggrieved
-tone. &#8220;Have I done anything to displease
-you, sir?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil laughed outright, only to be prodded
-by the sharp bayonets of his captors for his
-incautiousness.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If that&#8217;s the way you feel about it,&#8221; he
-said, &#8220;I am glad you are here.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Inside of ten minutes, conversation was<span class="pagenum" id="Page_288">[288]</span>
-impossible, for they needed all their breath
-for the precipitous climb up the face of the
-cliff leading to the top of the mountain. The
-natives on each side of the prisoners pulled
-and pushed them up the jagged and rocky
-trail until their bodies were bruised and their
-skin torn in many places by the cruel cactus
-and &#8220;Spanish bayonet,&#8221; which seemed to
-have been planted by nature as a further
-difficulty for those who dared to ascend the
-secret trail to the insurgent stronghold.</p>
-
-<p>After many rests, out of breath, footsore,
-bleeding and tired, the top was reached and
-with scant courtesy O&#8217;Neil and Phil were
-thrown into a nipa shack, where they fell unceremoniously
-on top of a sleeping human
-being who awakened with a cry of alarm and
-fear, striking at them with his manacled hands.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s Lieutenant Tillotson,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil exclaimed
-gladly, as he rolled away to the
-farthest side of the small hut, to put himself
-out of reach of the startled prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Who are you?&#8221; came from the figure, in
-a weak voice. &#8220;Yes, I am Lieutenant Tillotson.
-Tell me I&#8217;m not dreaming. Didn&#8217;t I
-hear a white man&#8217;s voice?&#8221;</p>
-
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_288.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap"><i>UP THE FACE OF THE<br />
-CLIFF</i></p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_289">[289]</span>Phil could see him dimly by the light of
-the camp-fire outside. The man had been
-completely cowed. What terrible torture had
-been inflicted to cause him to become such an
-abject figure, groveling before them, his voice
-hollow, and in his eyes a light of unreasonable
-fear?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It is Midshipman Perry and O&#8217;Neil from
-the gunboat, Tillotson,&#8221; the lad whispered.
-&#8220;We hope to save you if you will keep quiet
-and do just what we tell you.&#8221; Phil could
-have wept in pity at the sight of the physical
-wreck before him. He was shocked at the
-sight. Tillotson&#8217;s eyes were dull and the face
-empty of hope.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You don&#8217;t know what you are saying,&#8221;
-he answered in a monotonous voice. &#8220;No
-one can be saved who is brought to this
-place. Death is the one avenue of escape.
-Oh! No one knows of the tortures I have
-endured from that fiend&#8217;s hands.&#8221; Then his
-face lit up for a second as he raised himself
-from the ground and stared at Phil, who had
-approached and stood looking down pityingly
-upon him. &#8220;How can you save me? Oh, tell
-me the truth. Are you not prisoners also?&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_290">[290]</span>Phil seated himself by the side of the unnerved
-man and begged him to be calm and
-reserve his strength. After a few moments
-he told him of the plan and his hopes for
-success.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Let us pray for success,&#8221; the captive cried
-weakly. &#8220;I had determined to throw myself
-off the cliff rather than undergo another day&#8217;s
-torture.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Tillotson talked for an hour, gruesomely
-dwelling on the details of his horrible treatment
-by Espinosa. He told of his mission to
-the spy, with the letter which Phil had taken
-from the dead messenger at Binalbagan. The
-message was in Espinosa&#8217;s own handwriting,
-and warned the attackers of the gunboat&#8217;s
-approach.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I see now that I have been repaid for my
-stupidity,&#8221; he moaned. &#8220;I believed that I
-could unmask him and earn the thanks of the
-general, but first I wished to get from him a
-full confession and implicate his accomplices.
-I showed him the letter and told him I would
-call at his house after visiting the sentries.&#8221;
-The overwrought officer broke down and
-sobbed for several minutes before continuing.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_291">[291]</span>
-&#8220;I was a child in his hands; I did not know
-his power. His followers trapped me and carried
-me away by water, bringing me to this
-awful place. Every day some new torture is
-devised for me. To-day I was suspended by
-my neck with only my toes on the ground.
-That was the worst so far. I don&#8217;t know what
-it will be to-morrow,&#8221; he ended with a
-shudder.</p>
-
-<p>Phil tried to console him as best he could,
-but a great fear had entered his thoughts. If
-this terrible punishment had been meted out
-to Tillotson, what would the treacherous and
-cruel Espinosa devise for him? Surely something
-many, many times more horrible.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_292">[292]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVIII<br />
-
-
-<small>A RIVER EXPEDITION</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">After</span> Phil and his party had gone on their
-hazardous mission, Sydney went aboard the
-gunboat to make ready for the work which
-had been left in his hands. He felt it keenly
-that he could not share this dangerous expedition,
-but there was some consolation in the
-knowledge that O&#8217;Neil was with Phil.</p>
-
-<p>Another detachment, footsore and tired from
-its forced march from a distant post, had arrived
-at the ranch, and the two staff officers
-were untiringly arranging all the details for
-the attack in force.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney, upon his arrival on the gunboat,
-gave orders that all obstructions be cleared
-away from the guns, and directed the placing
-of iron sheeting to protect the officers and men
-who would be, with him, exposed on the gunboat&#8217;s
-bridge.</p>
-
-<p>The plan of attack was to divide the force
-of soldiers; the gunboat to carry as many of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_293">[293]</span>
-the men as her limited deck space would accommodate,
-and the remainder were to go by
-trail, guided by Garcia. A sufficient force
-would remain to guard the ranch, to which
-point supplies were on their way up the river
-from Palilo.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson would command the expedition
-in person from on board the gunboat.</p>
-
-<p>At sunrise Sydney was awake, and already
-the camp ashore was alive and the lad saw
-the companies drawn up, their rifles stacked,
-eating their morning meal. Hurriedly dressing
-he was rowed ashore, but before leaving
-he had ordered all his boats to be lowered for
-transporting the soldiers to the gunboat.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Major Lukban, one of Rodriguez&#8217;s officers,
-will go with you as a guide,&#8221; Captain Blynn
-informed the lad as he stepped ashore. &#8220;He
-was wounded in the attack on the ranch, but
-he is well enough to go on the gunboat, and
-he knows the navigation of the river. He is
-now questioning an insurgent officer who was
-brought in by one of our companies; they
-captured him in a village several miles from
-here.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Lukban is like a wild beast; they have<span class="pagenum" id="Page_294">[294]</span>
-just told him of Rodriguez&#8217;s murder by Espinosa
-and Salas, so I suppose we had best keep
-an eye on this unfortunate prisoner.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn led Sydney down to the
-basement of the ranch house. The midshipman,
-when his eyes became accustomed to the
-gloom, gave an exclamation of surprised horror
-as he saw a half-strangled native on the
-floor with several others astride his heaving
-chest. Sydney noticed the wounded major
-in a chair, looking down upon his victim, a
-savage smile on his face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s not strictly orthodox,&#8221; Captain Blynn
-whispered as he saw the horror in Sydney&#8217;s
-eyes, &#8220;but it&#8217;s effective.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;A little more,&#8221; Major Lukban ordered in
-a cold voice, after nodding a welcome to the
-newcomers.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney saw the native at the prisoner&#8217;s
-head slowly pour the water which he held in
-a bamboo cup between the prisoner&#8217;s teeth.
-The unfortunate man choked, while the veins
-in his neck stood out like whip-cords. His
-eyes turned glassy and staring, while his colorless
-face became a sickly blue.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You&#8217;ll kill him,&#8221; Sydney cried aghast.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_295">[295]</span>
-&#8220;It shouldn&#8217;t be allowed, captain,&#8221; he appealed,
-turning to the army man.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t you worry, Monroe,&#8221; the captain
-answered calmly, &#8220;he knows within a few
-drops of how much the man can stand&mdash;watch!&#8221;
-he added quietly, as the natives
-raised the prone captive to a sitting position
-and struck him smartly on the back with
-their open hands. The native coughed and
-sputtered; gradually his color returned and
-he drew great gasping breaths.</p>
-
-<p>After the prisoner had returned to a comparatively
-normal condition, the inquisitor
-reached out his hand and struck him smartly
-across the cheek. Where his hand had fallen,
-a white imprint was left, dying out gradually,
-as the sluggish blood flowed back again.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is the &#8216;water cure,&#8217;&#8221; Captain Blynn
-observed as Major Lukban fired question after
-question at the thoroughly cowed and now
-tractable prisoner. &#8220;He will exact a confession
-from him which will give us all the information
-we need. If you or I did this we
-would be court-martialed and maybe dismissed
-but&mdash;&mdash;&#8221; He ended with an expressive
-shrug.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_296">[296]</span>Sydney turned sick at the sight of a human
-being tortured beyond endurance and a fear
-rose in his mind as he thought of poor Phil in
-Espinosa&#8217;s hands. As he watched, the native
-appeared to hesitate in answering a question,
-but a wave of Lukban&#8217;s hand, bringing the
-attending natives and the water cup nearer,
-caused him to answer the question immediately.
-Once the native refused to answer and
-then despite his cries of fear and struggles almost
-superhuman, he was forced back upon his
-back, and his jaws pried rudely open with a
-stick, while the bamboo cup was poised menacingly
-above his open mouth.</p>
-
-<p>The next moment the cup was sent spinning
-from the native&#8217;s hand and Sydney had
-jerked the captive to his feet, and stood flushed
-with anger and excitement between him and
-his torturer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shan&#8217;t stand by and see any more of this
-torture,&#8221; he exclaimed forcefully. &#8220;It&#8217;s a disgrace
-for us to allow it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn shrugged his shoulders,
-while Lukban glared angrily at the indignant
-champion.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But, se&ntilde;or, I must have that question answered,&#8221;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_297">[297]</span>
-he declared. &#8220;It will not injure
-him, and it may save us many lives.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;What was the question?&#8221; Captain Blynn
-asked.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Whether there is a third trail from the
-stronghold and how it may be reached,&#8221; he
-answered. &#8220;You see, captain, if there is we
-must guard it, for otherwise all will escape us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Captain Blynn nodded, glancing amusedly
-at Sydney&#8217;s excited face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am afraid, major, that question must remain
-unanswered,&#8221; he said in a level tone,
-turning and leading the way out.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney turned the half-drowned prisoner
-over to one of Captain Blynn&#8217;s soldiers with
-orders to guard him carefully and to allow no
-interference by their native allies.</p>
-
-<p>By nine o&#8217;clock two hundred men had been
-embarked on the gunboat and five hundred
-more had started under the command of Captain
-Blynn along the trail leading up the
-river; Garcia as leader was at their head.</p>
-
-<p>In the party on the gunboat were General
-Wilson, Major Marble and Major Lukban; the
-latter, still sullen and angry with Sydney for
-his unwarranted presumption in making him<span class="pagenum" id="Page_298">[298]</span>
-discontinue his torture, stood with his former
-victim on the bridge of the &#8220;Mindinao.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney headed the vessel into the narrow
-channel, cautiously picking his way through
-the numerous shoals; one minute the gunboat
-clung closely to the steep river bank on
-one side and the next it was scraping the overhanging
-trees on the other side.</p>
-
-<p>From the masthead the lookout kept the
-soldiers on shore in sight, and Sydney regulated
-his speed to just keep pace with them.
-He thought often and with grave concern of
-Phil. What luck had he had? His heartbeats
-quickened as he vaguely wondered if he
-were alive! He realized the terrible cruelty
-of the Filipino leader, and Espinosa had reason
-to hate the young naval man!</p>
-
-<p>The small house, where the midshipmen
-had unexpectedly met Colonel Salas, flashed
-into view as they rounded a bend in the river,
-and from the bridge Sydney could discern
-with his glasses far in the distance the
-enemy&#8217;s stronghold, Matiginao, &#8220;the impregnable.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>As the gunboat swept slowly by close inshore
-the soldiers waved their campaign hats<span class="pagenum" id="Page_299">[299]</span>
-in silent salute to their formidable navy
-ally.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This, from here on, is unknown river,
-sir,&#8221; Sydney reported to the general, sitting
-calmly talking with his adjutant-general.</p>
-
-<p>The general nodded and answered with a
-smile.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;All right, admiral, I am entirely satisfied
-to rely upon your judgment.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Major Lukban had during the gunboat&#8217;s
-progress up the river stood by Sydney&#8217;s side,
-showing his appreciation of the lad&#8217;s navigation
-at intervals by a silent nod, while at
-the same time he kept one guarding eye upon
-his captive, whose crafty, sullen eyes roved incessantly
-along the wooded slopes of the narrowing river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;This is not new to you then, major?&#8221; Sydney
-asked suddenly, as he directed the ship&#8217;s
-head toward a large dead tree which stood
-out a lone sentinel on a rocky point ahead.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;As a boy I was brought up on this river,&#8221;
-the native replied sadly. &#8220;Then many thousand
-of my people lived in plenty and happiness
-along its banks.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where have they all gone?&#8221; the lad inquired<span class="pagenum" id="Page_300">[300]</span>
-interestedly, his eyes gazing about for
-the signs of a deserted population.</p>
-
-<p>Lukban pointed to the tall mountains
-ahead of them.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Time and again the Spaniards have endeavored
-to drive out the outlaws from yonder
-stronghold, and the poor people who
-made their living on the river were mercilessly
-preyed upon by the war parties of the
-contending factions, until none were left.
-Juan Rodriguez alone has managed to remain,
-but only by his fearless courage and the devotion
-of his followers. Neither side cared to
-provoke him in his security until Espinosa
-coveted his lands and his money and, who
-can say, maybe his beautiful daughter.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Maria!&#8221; Sydney exclaimed.</p>
-
-<p>The native lowered his voice to a whisper.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Espinosa has had but one ambition all his
-life; to marry the daughter of Rodriguez; but
-she scorned him, and to save her from his
-persistent attention, Se&ntilde;orita Maria was sent
-away to Manila to school. Now he has robbed
-her of her father and stolen the treasure which
-had been hoarded for her. For many years
-Espinosa has been the head of the outlaws of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_301">[301]</span>
-Kapay. Holding positions of trust under
-Spanish rule, he directed the rebel movements
-and prevented their annihilation by the Spanish
-columns. This identical work he has attempted
-under the American rule, but his
-treachery has at last been exposed. Until he
-openly threatened the life of Rodriguez, none
-of us dared to thwart him. His murderers
-are everywhere, and his society of the Katipunan
-is far-reaching. Nowhere in the archipelago
-is one safe from their vengeance.
-Maria, woman as she is, has been marked for
-the assassin&#8217;s knife if she continues to refuse
-to become the wife of its leader. Garcia,
-Rodriguez&#8217;s trusted friend and overseer, was
-lured by terrible threats of vengeance and
-hopes of reward to betray his benefactor. He
-had been chosen by the society to commit the
-repulsive crime of murdering his friend. He
-came to the Rodriguez house intending to kill
-the father and carry away the daughter into
-captivity, which would have been for her a
-living death. Through the administering of
-the water and the voluntary confessions of
-Garcia, I have found out every motive which
-has actuated both Espinosa and Garcia. The<span class="pagenum" id="Page_302">[302]</span>
-would-be murderer entered the room of his
-victim, but in the light of the lamp could not
-bring himself to murder his lifelong friend.
-He at least had remaining some of the kindlier
-feelings in his heart. Turning out the
-light he was about to despatch him with a
-swift dagger thrust as he lay innocently sleeping;
-then hearing a noise on the stairs he
-withdrew into the darkness of an adjoining
-room. It was Se&ntilde;orita Maria and the two
-Americans who had remained to protect her.
-Seeing that to stay would mean discovery, he
-escaped by a window, intending to meet Espinosa
-and his men as they stole through the
-uproar of the bolo attack and tell him of the
-locality of the treasure. Espinosa is a leader
-of no mean order. His attack on the ranch
-was masterfully executed. Even though
-wounded, he came unhindered through the
-thick of the attack, with his body-guard of
-twenty faithful men. These were the ones
-who entered the house and carried away the
-treasure chests.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;When Garcia, escaping, reached the
-ground, your trusty boatswain&#8217;s mate, O&#8217;Neil,
-was on the spot.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_303">[303]</span>Major Lukban&#8217;s eyes were on his restive
-captive as he talked in low tones to Sydney.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We must keep an eye on him,&#8221; he continued.
-&#8220;He has given me so much information that he
-would be killed if he fell into
-Espinosa&#8217;s hands. Knowing the danger he
-runs, acting as our guide, he may attempt to
-escape.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; was now where the dapper
-little colonel had taken his involuntary
-bath. The river had become sensibly narrower
-and the shores more treacherously rocky.</p>
-
-<p>The captive suddenly turned and excitedly
-spoke to Major Lukban in the native language,
-his gaze meanwhile roving over the
-cliffs just visible ahead.</p>
-
-<p>Lukban gave Sydney the man&#8217;s words in
-Spanish:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He says the gunboat can pass through the
-ca&ntilde;on, but you must keep close to the left
-hand shore to avoid the huge rocks which the
-insurgents will hurl from the top of the
-stronghold.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney&#8217;s heart beat faster. They had not
-as yet come in sight of the whirling maelstrom
-of water as it hurled itself through the narrow<span class="pagenum" id="Page_304">[304]</span>
-gorge, but the top of the ca&ntilde;on was in plain
-sight. One huge boulder dislodged from the
-heights, striking the deck of the &#8220;Mindinao,&#8221;
-could easily pierce her frail steel shell.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Will you go through on the gunboat,
-sir?&#8221; Sydney asked the general eagerly as the
-&#8220;Mindinao&#8221; rounded a bend in the river, and
-the muddy racing water loomed ahead straight
-as if nature had laid a ruler along its path.
-About a mile away the other end of the ca&ntilde;on
-appeared, a white streak of light between the
-sombre rocks.</p>
-
-<p>The general regarded him in surprise.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;How would you expect me to go?&#8221; he
-asked, a twinkle appearing in his eyes for a
-fraction of a second.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I was thinking of the danger, sir,&#8221; the lad
-added hurriedly in apology. &#8220;They&#8217;ll probably
-throw rocks down on us.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The commanding general cannot always
-be three miles in the rear,&#8221; the veteran replied,
-now smiling broadly.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney had sent word to the engine room
-that he desired all speed possible and despite
-the current against them, the wooded shores
-were passed quickly.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_305">[305]</span>&#8220;To your guns,&#8221; he called in a clear voice
-without a note of excitement. &#8220;Major,&#8221; he
-added turning to the adjutant-general, &#8220;some
-of your best shots might take station to
-pick off the enemy on the cliffs. Those on
-this end I hope will be Phil and his friendly
-natives.&#8221; He turned suddenly pale as the
-possibility occurred to him of shelling his own
-people.</p>
-
-<p>The gunboat sped swiftly toward the ca&ntilde;on.
-Through glasses the jagged rocks at the top
-could be seen covered with a curious crowd of
-natives. Several sharp reports came muffled
-to his ears. The soft coo of the alarm concha
-vibrated above the stillness. He called his
-three gun-pointers up on the bridge and cautioned
-them with painstaking care of their
-important duty. &#8220;Shoot at the middle and
-the left; Captain Perry is on that mountain
-and I hope at this end. All three will fire together
-and I will control from here.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The men listened gravely and returned to
-their guns.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Load,&#8221; Sydney ordered harshly. The
-breech-blocks clicked shut and the crew stood
-expectantly alert. The soldiers, unaccustomed<span class="pagenum" id="Page_306">[306]</span>
-to artillery, unconsciously edged away from
-the three bow guns.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Set your sights at 1,500 yards,&#8221; Sydney
-directed, at the same time giving a signal to
-the helmsman to hold the ship steady on her
-course.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Fire when you&#8217;re on, aim at the edge of the
-rock,&#8221; he said in a tense voice.</p>
-
-<p>The three guns roared almost in unison and
-three black dots winged swiftly out toward
-the frowning cliffs ahead of the gunboat.
-Three dull brown splashes suddenly appeared
-just under the edge of the cliff and the reverberations
-died out slowly to an unearthly
-wail.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Seventeen hundred,&#8221; the lad cried out
-sharply, for the shots had fallen short of the
-mark.</p>
-
-<p>The sight-setters corrected their sights by a
-swift movement of the wheel under their
-hand and the air was again rent by the discharges.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Fine shots,&#8221; the general exclaimed excitedly
-as he leveled his glass at the top of the
-mountain where the three shells had exploded,
-scattering the rock and dirt in all directions<span class="pagenum" id="Page_307">[307]</span>
-and causing the inquisitive insurgents to hurriedly
-seek shelter.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Rapid fire,&#8221; Sydney ordered calmly and
-his voice had scarcely died away when a puff of
-white smoke belched from the stronghold.</p>
-
-<p>The lad&#8217;s heart almost stopped beating.
-Artillery he did not fear, if he could return
-the fire. He was confident that he could take
-care of himself with those three unerring
-guns, but this gun of the enemy was mounted
-just where Phil had warned him not to shoot.
-He sickened at the thought of disobeying the
-order, yet there was the menacing screech of
-the shell in his ears, as it struck the water
-only a few hundred yards ahead of his approaching
-gunboat.</p>
-
-<p>What else could he do? The gun must be
-silenced before the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; could proceed,
-and the gorge was only a thousand yards
-ahead.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_308">[308]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIX<br />
-
-
-<small>A WILLING CAPTIVE</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">The</span> sun was high the next morning before
-Phil awakened from his sound sleep. He had
-tossed on his hard bed listening to the half
-morbid ravings of poor Tillotson. Ever before
-him was the fear that after all he would
-be unable to save him. He knew only too
-well the difficulties that must be overcome before
-a rescue were possible. He recalled the
-difficult trails over which he and O&#8217;Neil had
-been led. At every point they had been under
-the eyes of unseen men on top of the
-mountain and within the range of modern
-rifles. There was not a tree nor rock large
-enough to offer cover to the men who on the
-morrow would assault the stronghold. His
-heart ever beat faster as he pictured the fight
-in his imagination: The natives behind intrenchments,
-cornered, no retreat open to
-them, fighting with the courage of despair;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_309">[309]</span>
-and the American soldiers, fearlessly charging
-upward, giving no heed to the danger at the
-top. On the summit, the lad knew, it would
-be a fight to the death. The part he was to
-play had seemed only too simple in the light
-of day, but now in the silence of the night,
-bound as he was hand and foot, and guarded
-by cruel enemies who would gladly shoot him
-down at the first show of force, all seemed
-different. O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s healthy body had long
-since been wrapped in slumber and when
-Phil&#8217;s feverish eyes opened he was up and
-seated calmly by the lad&#8217;s side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There are over a thousand of these gugus
-here in the camp,&#8221; he exclaimed as Phil with
-difficulty arose and endeavored to stretch his
-cramped limbs. &#8220;I have been spying from
-the door there, and I see Lopez has encamped
-his men right at the top of the trail, and the
-men who were there have been sent somewhere
-else. The natives who are guarding us
-are our own men, and one of &#8217;em tried to stick
-his bayonet in me when I asked him for some
-water to wash in. I wish they were not so
-careful of appearances,&#8221; he added with a grim
-smile.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_310">[310]</span>This was certainly cheering news. Lopez
-then had won his first point with the insurgent
-leader. Espinosa had believed his story.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Tillotson still lay like a log,
-completely overcome from exhaustion, caused
-by his torture of yesterday. Phil looked with
-compassion on the weak, boyish face; he was
-breathing evenly, but his skin was of an unhealthy
-pallor.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He looks ill, sir,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil declared as Phil
-turned away with a sigh. &#8220;A few more days
-will do for him. He&#8217;s got too sensitive a nature
-for soldiering.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The doorway was darkened by the entrance
-of two natives. Phil regarded them coldly as
-they advanced, and led him not ungently by
-the arm out into the sunshine. There they
-cut his binding cords and gave both him and
-O&#8217;Neil a bucket of water to wash in. They
-had been on the point of arousing Tillotson
-by a cruel kick, but through Phil&#8217;s insistence,
-they left the shack without disturbing the
-sleeping man.</p>
-
-<p>After eating and enjoying a scanty breakfast,
-the two Americans surveyed with great
-interest the scenes about them.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_311">[311]</span>&#8220;Do you see that gun there, sir?&#8221; O&#8217;Neil exclaimed,
-suddenly nodding his head toward a
-Spanish howitzer mounted on the cliff just
-to the right of the trail. &#8220;It&#8217;s manned by
-Espinosa&#8217;s men!&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That&#8217;s bad,&#8221; Phil replied anxiously; &#8220;and
-you notice, it commands the river.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Good-morning,&#8221; in Spanish from behind
-them caused Phil to swing about quickly and
-gaze into the amused but wicked eyes of
-Colonel Salas. &#8220;So we are to have the pleasure
-of your company as our guest, after all?&#8221;
-the Filipino continued tauntingly. &#8220;General
-Espinosa is making great preparations for
-your reception. It is needless for me to tell
-you how delighted he is that you have
-changed your mind. He was very angry at
-me for not insisting on your coming with me
-the other day.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil regarded the little native, a fine scorn
-in his eyes. He would have liked nothing
-better than to have answered him in the same
-ironical vein, but he realized that to do so and
-anger him would only make more difficult
-their position.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He will be here to pay his respects shortly,&#8221;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_312">[312]</span>
-Salas continued ironically. &#8220;Ah! here he
-comes now.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>With his heart beating fast and the muscles
-in his throat tightening, Phil saw Espinosa
-sauntering toward them. He was dressed in
-the uniform of a Filipino general, made in the
-Spanish fashion, of a mouse-colored duck with
-a rolling collar, on which a silver star glistened.
-He came slowly forward, a wicked
-smile on his face.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;or Perry! So! I have you now in my
-power?&#8221; he said in a low, hard voice. &#8220;I
-knew that my time would come. Your cleverness
-caused me some inconvenience. Colonel
-Martinez is still to be accounted for.
-But&#8221;&mdash;and he shrugged his shoulders&mdash;&#8220;that
-is but a matter of days. You can see that I
-am now master of the situation. I shall annihilate
-your untried, inefficient volunteers with
-as much ease as I can kill flies on the wall of
-a butcher shop. Your general dare not call
-in his men from the garrisons in the north.
-After I have worn out and killed those sent
-against me, then I shall attack Palilo itself.
-Then when I have the city in my hands and
-your general has withdrawn or surrenders, I<span class="pagenum" id="Page_313">[313]</span>
-shall wire to Manila my willingness to accept
-civil government. I shall go through the
-form of surrendering to the vanquished Americans,
-and shall be made the governor of Kapay.
-I shall then carry on my authority under your
-own flag. Is it not a very clever plan? Ah,
-there is one point that I have forgotten, a governor
-of an island as rich as Kapay must have
-a suitable dwelling. Very well. Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez
-is no more; his house is vacant and
-adequate for the worthy purpose; and the
-se&ntilde;orita&mdash;how well the title of wife to the
-governor of Kapay would become her!</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;So you see, se&ntilde;or, after all, Espinosa has
-lost nothing,&#8221; he ended with mock politeness.</p>
-
-<p>Phil glared angrily at this vain, boastful
-Malay half-breed. How dare he even think
-of marrying a girl like Maria Rodriguez?
-Phil knew that she would rather die first.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Every man in the American army will
-fight you to the last fence,&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-savagely. &#8220;Your villainy and treachery are
-too well known among even your own people,
-who serve you only through fear. You will
-never be made a governor under the civil
-government. That won&#8217;t aid you to carry out<span class="pagenum" id="Page_314">[314]</span>
-your vengeful purposes upon those whom you
-might choose to call your enemies.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa&#8217;s face paled slightly, and his eyes
-kindled in anger.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am sorry that I cannot allow you to remain
-alive to see my prophecy come true,&#8221; he
-replied with a cruel shrug. &#8220;And before I
-am found out, as you Americans say, and displaced,
-I shall have enough money put aside
-in banks outside of the Philippines to live in
-ease and luxury for the remainder of my life.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;These thoughts,&#8221; he added, &#8220;may cheer
-your last hours. It should be a pleasure to
-you to know that you haven&#8217;t done me as
-much harm as you supposed.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil glared at his tormentor, a bitter hatred
-in his eyes. How cleverly had this half-breed
-played upon the credulity of the Americans!
-For months this despicable native had ruled
-over both the warring parties; on one hand
-controlling the native bands of insurgents,
-telling them how, when and where to attack
-their enemy and then by his plausible words
-and treacherous cunning had exerted sufficient
-influence over General Wilson and his
-aides to enable him to so dispose the scattered<span class="pagenum" id="Page_315">[315]</span>
-American troops as to make them impotent,
-helpless against the insurgent ambushes and
-attacks. The lad noticed with a certain satisfaction
-that the native wore his left arm in a
-sling. Was that then the effect of his shot
-the night of the meeting of the Katipunan
-society? How he blamed himself for not
-having taken a more careful aim; he remembered
-with disappointment that when he had
-pulled the trigger of his revolver, his aim had
-been to the left of Espinosa&#8217;s body. Phil&#8217;s
-gaze was not lost on the half-breed. With a
-snarl he glanced down at his almost helpless
-arm.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;For this I took Rodriguez&#8217;s life with my
-own hands, although Garcia had been chosen
-for the deed,&#8221; he exclaimed darkly, &#8220;and for
-this I shall force his daughter to become the
-wife of Manuel Espinosa.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil gasped, a flood of angry blood
-mounting to his temples.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It was I who fired the shot,&#8221; the lad cried
-exultantly, &#8220;and the next time you won&#8217;t
-get off so easily.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa in sullen rage regarded the angry
-midshipman through his slit-like eyes.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_316">[316]</span>&#8220;You?&#8221; he cried in unfeigned surprise.
-&#8220;How did you get there?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I was there,&#8221; Phil replied quickly, a keen
-satisfaction entering his thoughts at being
-able to beard the lion in his den, &#8220;and afterward
-exposed you to the general&mdash;but,&#8221; he
-asked suddenly, &#8220;why did you desert? If
-you hadn&#8217;t we would have had a pleasant little
-hanging party in the Plaza the next morning.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa was evidently enraged at the lad&#8217;s
-daring words.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;You are brave,&#8221; he said suddenly, a spark
-of suspicion coming into his mind, &#8220;to speak
-this way before me knowing that I can have
-you hung, or tortured, by simply giving the
-order.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I know your yellow soul too well,&#8221; Phil
-declared in answer, &#8220;to believe that anything
-I might say now would influence the plan for
-revenge which you have already made.
-But I am curious to know why you left Palilo
-so suddenly. Did you believe that Rodriguez
-would betray you?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw glared at the midshipman, his
-hands twitching longingly to take forcible
-hold on his tormentor.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_317">[317]</span>&#8220;Because of that shot,&#8221; Espinosa answered
-finally, &#8220;I feared there might have been an
-enemy at the meeting and I feared Captain
-Blynn&#8217;s hand,&mdash;I would give a box of old
-Rodriguez&#8217;s gold to have him here a prisoner,&#8221;
-he added, a flash of terror in his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He may be here any moment now,&#8221; Phil
-said quietly. Then he would have bitten off
-his tongue as he saw the sudden gleam of
-suspicion in his enemy&#8217;s eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa gave the lad a searching look.
-&#8220;What do you mean?&#8221; he asked casting a
-glance of fear about him.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Oh, nothing,&#8221; the lad answered carelessly,
-&#8220;only he knows you killed Rodriguez,
-stole his money and tried to carry off his
-daughter; also by this time he will know that
-I&#8217;m a prisoner in your hands. And if for no
-other reason, you hold Lieutenant Tillotson,
-and his father is overturning the war department
-to rescue him. You made a bad fist of
-it there.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil had been watching the native leader&#8217;s
-anxious face, as he glanced about him as if
-half fearing the big American to appear suddenly
-from the ground. He now saw it light<span class="pagenum" id="Page_318">[318]</span>
-up with keen enjoyment as his eyes encountered
-something which amused him.
-Looking up quickly the lad uttered an exclamation
-of horror as he realized with overwhelming
-force the true position in which he
-had placed himself and his trusted boatswain&#8217;s
-mate.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil, bound hand and foot, had been
-triced up, his toes just resting on the ground,
-and his strong bronzed face swollen and blue
-from a strangling rope knotted about his
-neck, the end thrown over a framework apparently
-built for this diabolical torture.</p>
-
-<p>Phil turned his face away. He saw as
-through a red mist the throngs of curious
-natives who had quickly gathered to see their
-enemy slowly murdered before their eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa gave a guttural order and immediately
-Phil was seized and forced to gaze at
-the revolting torture of his companion.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We shall not kill him yet,&#8221; Espinosa
-said, while he smiled in keen delight at the
-discomfited midshipman. &#8220;I have promised
-my men a field day. We have many
-amusing ways of treating our guests,&mdash;but,&#8221;
-he added, &#8220;before your turn comes I wish<span class="pagenum" id="Page_319">[319]</span>
-some information which I know you can
-give.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where is General Wilson?&#8221; he asked
-anxiously, &#8220;and is it true that your gunboat is
-in the river?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Where are your scouts?&#8221; Phil exclaimed
-haughtily. &#8220;Ask them, not your prisoner.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I choose to ask my prisoner,&#8221; the native
-retorted with a meaning glance at those who
-held Phil&#8217;s head turned so that he must see
-out of the tail of his eyes the cruel suffering
-of O&#8217;Neil.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Your prisoner does not choose to answer,&#8221;
-the lad declared stoutly.</p>
-
-<p>The next second Phil was jerked suddenly
-upon his back, and his hands and feet hauled
-out, spread eagle fashion to stakes driven
-in the solid ground. He was quite helpless,
-and the pain in his arms and legs was excruciating.
-He opened his mouth to cry out
-when quickly a wedge of hard wood was inserted,
-holding his jaws wide apart.</p>
-
-<p>He closed his eyes and stiffened his muscle
-in a supreme endeavor to withstand the pain
-and prevent himself showing his suffering to
-the delighted natives.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_320">[320]</span>&#8220;Now maybe you will consider your answer&mdash;Colonel
-Salas, a little water may loosen his
-tongue,&#8221; he heard the cruel voice of Espinosa
-say.</p>
-
-<p>A horrible fear overcame the lad. The
-water cure was to be given him. He was to
-be half drowned. To be made to feel all the
-torturing sensations of a drowning man; not
-once but many times, until his spirit was
-broken and he would answer questions which
-would make him traitorously injure his own
-cause. His eyes opened, and he saw dimly
-Espinosa&#8217;s mocking face above him. The
-sun had flamed forth from under a cloud and
-burned down unmercifully on his staring
-eyes. He noted vaguely that it had passed
-the meridian. Then a terrible fear came into
-his mind. Where were the gunboat and the
-soldiers? Surely by this time they would have
-made their presence known. Had the gunboat
-run aground and the expedition been delayed?
-Would a delay mean death to him and O&#8217;Neil
-or only one more awful day of diabolical torture?</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you will cease torturing my man,&#8221; Phil
-said with difficulty through his wedged jaws,
-&#8220;I will answer your questions.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_321">[321]</span>Espinosa laughed cruelly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;So you would dictate your own terms,&#8221; he
-cackled. &#8220;Colonel Salas, just a few cupfuls.
-Captain Perry seems thirsty.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil swallowed the water as it was poured
-down his throat, holding his breath long intervals
-at a time. It seemed to him that the
-water was never ending; he had swallowed
-quarts and yet he drank. Finally he could
-swallow no longer and yet the cruel hand
-above him poured the liquid without ceasing
-into his wide open mouth. The water
-splashed and ran out. He managed yet to
-breathe by contracting the muscles of his
-throat and then taking a slow breath but
-even then he felt the irritation of a few drops
-of water in his lungs and he knew if he
-coughed, as he must in a second, that all the
-water in his throat and mouth would enter
-his windpipe and fairly choke him. A feeling
-of suffocation oppressed him, as if a heavy
-weight lay pressing on his chest. He knew
-as yet he had not suffered, that this was but a
-taste of what was to come. Once more, this
-time as if from a great distance, he heard the
-cold, sinister voice of the half-breed.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_322">[322]</span>&#8220;Before it is too late,&#8221; he said, &#8220;will you
-answer my questions?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil opened his eyes and gazed at his tormentors.
-Then he closed them and steeled
-himself to what was to come.</p>
-
-<p>He felt his nose held securely by muscular
-fingers and his head thrown back, making a
-reservoir of his mouth, which was kept full
-of water.</p>
-
-<p>Just before he closed his eyes Phil had
-taken a full breath and now with his lungs
-full of air he knew that the agony was less
-than two minutes away. Strong swimmer as
-he was, he knew that was the limit of his endurance,
-and then afterward would come the
-sickening sensation of water agonizingly
-breathed into his lungs. Congestion would
-follow and if there was any trouble with his
-heart it would stop. If not, the cruel Colonel
-Salas who, with a delighted smile, was pouring
-the water, would stop and free the lad&#8217;s
-mouth of water, permitting him to regain his
-breath, working over him as if he were a
-half-drowned man, and after he had been
-brought to by artificial respiration, the
-cruel torture would be begun again and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_323">[323]</span>
-carried out until he agreed to do his enemy&#8217;s
-bidding.</p>
-
-<p>Those two minutes were the longest in the
-lad&#8217;s life. His entire past flashed before his
-eyes and he shed tears of disappointment at
-the thought that this might be his death. He
-wondered how much time had passed. Then
-he began to count the seconds, but soon
-stopped in horror; it was too much like self-destruction.
-He held his breath now tightly,
-allowing just a little air at a time to escape
-through his throat. He opened his eyes once
-or twice, but he could see nothing but a fiery
-sun overhead. He had the sensation that his
-entire body was swelling. Every vein seemed
-to have hardened. The sweat poured from
-his forehead, stinging his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>He could hold his breath no longer. His
-blood throbbed painfully in his temples. An
-awful nausea overcame him, and he gasped
-for air.</p>
-
-<p>Then a sharp sound as of the discharge of
-a cannon sounded in his ears and he fought
-and struggled with the strength of a score of
-men for the precious air.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_324">[324]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XX<br />
-
-
-<small>THE STRUGGLE FOR THE STRONGHOLD</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">While</span> Phil and O&#8217;Neil were being tortured
-by Espinosa, Lopez had kept watch from his
-station, guarding the trail leading up the
-precipitous mountain from the valley below.
-His eyes fascinatedly held upon the scene in
-front of him had nevertheless guardedly
-turned backward, scanning anxiously the
-wooded foothills below him and the vista of
-the river as it entered the ca&ntilde;on. As yet no
-signs of the rescuers were visible. He trembled
-when he saw that Espinosa had determined
-to give the midshipman the water torture.
-But few white men had survived its harshness.
-Lopez&#8217;s face wore an increasingly
-anxious look as the minutes dragged into
-hours. The sun had passed the meridian and
-was dipping slowly in the western sky. His
-own men had not left their posts; each understood
-his duty; Rodriguez&#8217;s faithful followers
-alone had been selected to guard this southern<span class="pagenum" id="Page_325">[325]</span>
-bastion of the stronghold. The faithful native
-could see a handful of Espinosa&#8217;s men at the
-howitzer mounted to command the approach
-by water and farther along the edge of the
-precipice small knots of men squatting under
-shelters of bamboo. These latter he knew
-were to dislodge great boulders, which had
-been delicately balanced ready to be thrown
-downward, five hundred or more feet, into the
-racing river. Those who dared to enter the
-treacherous waters of the ca&ntilde;on must run the
-gauntlet of these huge rocks, but Lopez knew
-that the Americans would take any risk to
-reach the trail leading away from the stronghold
-and further into the mountain fastness,
-over which the trapped insurgents would endeavor
-to escape.</p>
-
-<p>Several hundred natives, their weapons in
-hand, had gathered about their cruel leader.
-Every eye was turned in rapt enjoyment toward
-the delighting spectacle of the torture
-of a despised American. None save Lopez
-and his faithful guards had observed the glint
-of steel far down in the valley below. None
-save he discerned two small white poles creeping
-along above the high trees on the river<span class="pagenum" id="Page_326">[326]</span>
-bank. He glanced uneasily toward the torture.
-Phil was on his back securely bound,
-while Colonel Salas held above his head a
-long bamboo cane filled with water.</p>
-
-<p>Lopez whispered an order to a native sergeant
-and the latter noiselessly edged his way
-in the direction of the sailor, now apparently
-senseless, deserted by those who had been torturing
-him, now that they were being indulged
-in a more interesting spectacle.</p>
-
-<p>Lopez, his heart beating and his bronze
-face set determinedly, watched the two topmasts
-of the gunboat as they traveled toward
-the bend in the river. The next second the
-&#8220;Mindinao&#8217;s&#8221; white bow came slowly, majestically
-from behind the land and turned gracefully
-up the river toward the ca&ntilde;on. At
-the foot of the trail khaki-clad figures suddenly
-appeared and mounted slowly up the
-narrow path. He could see the guides in
-front clearing and uncovering the treacherous
-man traps. His men had now seen the
-approaching deliverers and their black eyes
-snapped excitedly. Any one with half an
-eye would have known that something out of
-the ordinary was going forward. The eager<span class="pagenum" id="Page_327">[327]</span>
-brown soldiers of Rodriguez moved about
-restlessly, glancing excitedly down into the
-valley below them. Fortunately the leader
-and his followers were too absorbed in watching
-the suffering of poor Phil to take heed of
-the strange behavior of the deserters from
-Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>Lopez saw the little gunboat stop suddenly
-in the river and he observed plainly groups
-of men at the bow guns. Then came a flash
-of flame from her white hull and a reverberation
-which shook the mountain stronghold to
-its foundation.</p>
-
-<p>The tortured and half-dead Americans were
-forgotten; their captors had rushed away to see
-the meaning of this interruption. It was but
-the work of an instant for the watchful Lopez
-to sever with a few swift strokes of his bolo
-the cords that bound his white chief. O&#8217;Neil
-was likewise cut down, and the two nearly
-lifeless men were dragged to the safety of that
-part of the stronghold guarded by Lopez and
-his small band.</p>
-
-<p>Shell after shell came speeding up from the
-gunboat, and meanwhile the khaki-clad soldiers,
-unobserved, toiled onward up the slope.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_328">[328]</span>&#8220;To your posts,&#8221; Espinosa cried out in
-alarm. &#8220;Open fire with that gun.&#8221; The surprised
-and terrified leader raved like a madman,
-taking all to task for their stupidity.
-Phil had been released so promptly, while all
-was uproar and confusion, that as yet the insurgents
-had not realized that Lopez and his
-men were against them. Espinosa, in a fever
-of excitement, himself ran to the howitzer
-and with his own hands pointed and fired the
-first shot. But that was the last shot the gun
-would ever fire, for Lopez with a number of
-his men pushed quietly forward, cutting its
-binding ropes and shoved it over the edge of
-the cliff from which it crashed downward to
-the river below.</p>
-
-<p>Espinosa turned aghast and met the cold,
-defiant eye of Lopez. In them he read his
-doom. Lopez&#8217;s sharp bolo was already circling
-about his head. But the next second it had
-flashed harmlessly by and rattled on the
-rocky ground. Fearful of his life Espinosa
-had dodged the blow aimed at him and had
-taken flight, screaming as he ran for his men
-to open fire on the traitors. The shells of the
-gunboat seemed to fall in every part of the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_329">[329]</span>
-stronghold and the havoc of their explosions
-was terrible to witness; but the small band
-under Lopez remained unharmed.</p>
-
-<p>Mad with fear, the natives who had been
-witnessing Phil&#8217;s torture, upon hearing the
-terrifying words of their leader and seeing the
-awful havoc behind them caused by the
-bursting shell, charged boldly on the natives
-in their front, believing that in that direction
-lay their one avenue of escape, but a well directed
-volley from Lopez&#8217;s men made them
-recoil in disorder.</p>
-
-<p>Like one who is chained, powerless in the
-grip of an unnerving nightmare, Phil felt
-rather than saw the wild scenes about him.
-He heard the sharp rattle of musket fire and
-the sonorous discharge of cannon, the wild,
-vibrant cries of the natives as they dashed
-now forward and again retreating from the
-clash of contact and the avenging strokes of
-bayonet and bolo. By a mighty effort he
-struggled to his feet and leaned heavily for
-support upon the bamboo frame of his prison.
-His lungs seemed on fire and a red mist was
-still in his eyes. The riot of forms about him
-confused his brain and made him dizzy. Then<span class="pagenum" id="Page_330">[330]</span>
-his eyes fell upon the body of O&#8217;Neil lying on
-the ground where the natives had dragged
-him; the cruel marks of the rope stood out in
-blue welts on his muscular neck. His eyes
-were closed, but the lad saw with joy that he
-was alive. He knelt by the sailor&#8217;s side ministering
-to him as tenderly as if he were a
-child. Then in great anxiety he saw that
-Lopez&#8217;s men were slowly giving ground.
-Stubbornly they fought, but the overwhelming
-ranks of the enemy, now alive to the
-actual conditions and spurred forward by
-their leaders, came frantically forward across
-the open ground.</p>
-
-<p>Phil dragged the senseless body of the sailor
-back until they were on the very edge of the
-hill and then a sight which made him mad
-with joy caused him to stand upright and
-swing his hat jubilantly, unheeding the leaden
-missiles on all sides. There scarcely a hundred
-yards below him struggling forward and
-upward was Captain Blynn and his five hundred
-soldiers. Dropping the sailor&#8217;s head he
-rushed madly into the company of loyal natives.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Charge them,&#8221; he cried, beside himself<span class="pagenum" id="Page_331">[331]</span>
-with eagerness, for he saw that if the enemy,
-one thousand strong, should obtain possession
-of the top of the trail the struggling men below
-would never reach the top alive, and their
-retreat could mean but one thing&mdash;a rout and
-massacre.</p>
-
-<p>The natives did not understand the lad&#8217;s
-words, but his meaning was only too plain as
-he snatched a rifle from the ground and led
-the remnant of that plucky band.</p>
-
-<p>The next moment he was in the midst of
-the shrieking horde. In his nostrils was the
-reek of the Malay, almost sickening in its
-overpowering pungency. Blow after blow at
-his body he warded off with the barrel of his
-rifle.</p>
-
-<p>Now the savage horde had given way and
-his men had quickly closed in, warily protecting
-their flanks, knowing full well the cunning
-of their enemy. To his left the lad saw
-hundreds of natives hurling rocks into the
-river below them, and he cut a lane toward
-them, yelling to the loyal natives to prevent
-what he feared would be the destruction of
-his ship. From below the ominous rattle of
-a Colt gun gladdened his heart and he saw<span class="pagenum" id="Page_332">[332]</span>
-with delight the men on the cliffs flee in terror,
-leaving great boulders balanced menacingly
-on the very edge of the abyss. An
-American cheer rang out from behind him
-and he became dizzy with joy at the good
-news it brought. He read in the natives&#8217; eyes
-a look of terror at the sudden appearance of
-an unlooked for enemy, and at the same instant
-he realized that if he and his loyal natives
-were to be saved he must extricate them
-from this dangerous position between the fire
-of the two opposing forces. He looked wildly
-about him for Lopez, but he was nowhere in
-sight, and already the soldiers had begun to
-open a withering fire in their direction. Mad
-with their exertions, brought suddenly face to
-face with the enemy, the soldiers would have
-no discretion; friend and foe alike were mixed
-in one writhing mass of brown.</p>
-
-<p>Then a sinister face showed itself on his
-right hand and all thoughts of safety were
-thrown to the winds. Espinosa, the tyrant
-and murderer, was within his reach. With a
-score of men as a body-guard he was hurrying
-away, deserting the field of battle. The midshipman
-pressed against the enemy to his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_333">[333]</span>
-right, fighting his way even through the remnant
-of the loyal natives, crying out to them
-to follow, while behind him he could hear the
-heavy footfalls of the soldiers.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_333.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap"><i>HE GAZED DOWN INTO THE<br />
-STILL FACE</i></p>
-
-<p>A body brushed him nearly off his feet and
-he turned toward it, his rifle raised as if to
-ward off an expected blow and then as his
-eyes fell upon the disheveled figure, he gave a
-cry of delight.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; he shouted above the noise of the
-fighting, as he put his arm about the great
-figure to steady himself from the force of the
-impact from the khaki-clad soldiers pressing
-eagerly upon them.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There&#8217;s that devil,&#8221; the sailor cried in
-smothered rage, and Phil saw with astonishment
-that O&#8217;Neil had naught but his bare
-hands though the lust of battle was in his eyes.
-The horror of his recent torture pressed
-heavily on his mind and he was bending every
-exertion to reach the retreating insurgent
-leader.</p>
-
-<p>So closely did the Americans press their
-foes that the lifeless body of Lieutenant Tillotson
-was abandoned, and Phil stopped, kneeling
-at his side and gazed down into the still<span class="pagenum" id="Page_334">[334]</span>
-face. There was a deep wound in the neck.
-Phil saw that the troubled spirit had been released.
-Ahead the pursuers had stopped and
-were firing fiercely in the direction of the retreating
-enemy.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We can&#8217;t allow Espinosa to escape,&#8221; the
-lad cried, aghast as he regained his men and
-saw with horror that many lay moaning on
-the ground.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They&#8217;re intrenched there, sir,&#8221; a sergeant
-exclaimed. &#8220;It would be suicide to charge
-them;&#8221; but Phil had gone too far and had
-suffered too much to be stopped by any
-thoughts of discretion or danger.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Charge, I say,&#8221; he cried; &#8220;that murderer
-Espinosa must not escape.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant from his security on the
-ground gazed up at the lad, believing quite
-properly that he had lost his mind, but before
-he could be stopped, Phil was beyond reach,
-charging blindly forward, while from the intrenchments
-came a volume of fire which it
-seemed folly to face.</p>
-
-<p>The seasoned old sergeant shook his head
-knowingly, but when an officer orders a charge
-there is but one thing to do.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_335">[335]</span>As one man the line arose from its shelter
-and raced madly after the midshipman.</p>
-
-<p>Hand to hand they battled&mdash;the natives with
-a courage born of desperation, for their backs
-were almost at the sheer edge of a precipice.
-Slowly they gave way before the onslaught of
-the Americans.</p>
-
-<p>Phil and O&#8217;Neil fought shoulder to shoulder
-and the lad in his weakened condition, bleeding
-profusely from a score of wounds, never
-more sorely needed the help that the brave
-sailorman could give.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He&#8217;s getting away,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil cried out in an
-agonized voice as the stubborn defenders fell
-one by one before the avenging bayonets.</p>
-
-<p>The natives died bravely, in fanatical fervor,
-fighting to the last man, not wishing nor asking
-for quarter. O&#8217;Neil and Phil at last
-stood upon the brink of a yawning chasm
-while they saw, far below them, and just disappearing
-within the shadow of the woods, a
-small band of natives, while there dangled
-from the rocks at their feet the severed end of
-a rope&mdash;the leader&#8217;s road to safety.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_336">[336]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXI<br />
-
-
-<small>THE GUNBOAT TAKES A HAND</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Sydney</span> gazed in consternation at the black
-speck clinging to the top of the cliff. His
-hands trembled excitedly as he held his glasses
-to his eyes focusing upon this spiteful piece of
-artillery.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;ve got to silence that gun,&#8221; he said in
-a hoarse voice to Major Marble at his side, as
-he rang the engine room telegraphs for full
-speed astern. &#8220;They can&#8217;t miss us, and one
-shell would sink us. Yet Phil and O&#8217;Neil are
-probably there.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There are our men, general,&#8221; Major Marble
-reported, pointing to a creeping point of color
-just emerging from the jungle and showing
-itself against the neutral tints of the treeless
-mountainside.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Make up your mind quickly, Mr. Monroe,&#8221;
-the general exclaimed anxiously. &#8220;Shell it,
-or else let&#8217;s try to get by; we can&#8217;t afford to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_337">[337]</span>
-leave the neck of the sack open for Espinosa
-and his cutthroats to escape.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney saw there was no way out of the
-situation, save to silence the battery:&mdash;one
-shot through the boiler of the &#8220;Mindinao,&#8221;
-and the gunboat with all on board would be
-killed by the explosion or else drowned in the
-madly racing current of the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Take a few shots at that gun,&#8221; he ordered
-hoarsely. The gun-pointers when they heard
-the spiteful hiss of the enemy&#8217;s shell had, as
-though by an order, ceased their fire and
-waited obediently for the command which
-they felt sure the midshipman would give.
-They did not relish being fired upon and not
-allowed to return the fire.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney&#8217;s glasses were upon the cliff: he
-saw a group of struggling figures about the
-cannon, and then to his surprise and joy the
-black object detached itself and dropped
-swiftly to the water six hundred feet below.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t fire,&#8221; he cried out quickly, but the
-gun-pointers through their sight telescopes
-had also been watching the struggle about
-their target and had waited.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_338">[338]</span>The lad rang up full speed ahead and again
-the gunboat sped toward the ca&ntilde;on.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Open fire on the left flank of the hill,&#8221;
-Sydney ordered.</p>
-
-<p>The three-pounders barked, and shell after
-shell was sent against the gathering crowds
-forming to attack the mere handful on the
-right, where the trail ended. The soldiers
-under Captain Blynn could now be plainly
-seen plodding upward.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney&#8217;s boyish nerves were at the highest
-pitch of excitement. He realized that he was
-to perform one of the most difficult feats of
-his life, and he had the life of a general of the
-army in his keeping. An error of judgment
-on his part would send them all to their
-deaths. He glanced searchingly at the frowning
-cliff, now scarcely a thousand yards away.
-He could plainly see that at the top a fierce
-fight was raging. The narrow gorge ahead
-seemed barely wide enough to permit the
-gunboat to pass, and above it, he knew only
-too well great boulders were standing ready
-to be dropped like meteors on the frail deck
-of the &#8220;Mindinao.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Are you ready there with the Colt gun?&#8221;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_339">[339]</span>
-he called loudly to the sailors in the foretop,
-where the gun was mounted.</p>
-
-<p>There was no answer; a glance aloft showed
-him the crew of the gun grouped anxiously
-about it.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Jammed again, I suppose,&#8221; he exclaimed.</p>
-
-<p>Closer and closer loomed the ca&ntilde;on.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Look out for the prisoner,&#8221; Sydney cried
-out as he saw the native, his hands on the
-rail, about to leap overboard. Major Marble
-was near enough to grasp him and the next
-minute ready hands had bound him securely
-to the rail and from there he gazed up in
-terror at the rapidly approaching cliffs.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;There goes the first one,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed
-excitedly as a great boulder swayed
-unsteadily and then rolled slowly over the
-edge of the chasm and descended with the
-speed of a shooting star. Every man on the
-gunboat was on his feet; above them now was
-the camp of the outlaws, and several hundred
-such boulders were there ready to be dropped
-upon their defenseless heads. The firing of
-the &#8220;Mindinao&#8217;s&#8221; guns had long since
-stopped as the elevation was much too great.</p>
-
-<p>With a terrific splash which hurled the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_340">[340]</span>
-water completely over the bow of the gunboat,
-the first rock took the water; but another
-and another followed it in rapid succession,
-and so close did they fall that Sydney
-felt the rushes of air caused by their passage.
-General Wilson stood calmly by as unconcerned
-as though he were only a spectator at a
-display of fireworks. Major Marble paced
-rapidly across the bridge, his hands nervously
-clutching a rifle which every few seconds he
-would discharge at the frowning cliffs above
-him.</p>
-
-<p>To add to the danger there now came the
-song of enemy&#8217;s bullets while the water near
-the gunboat became disturbed as if from the
-fall of hail. Occasionally there was heard a
-commotion forward and a man sorely hit
-would be carried below decks to be attended by
-the hospital corps located in the men&#8217;s quarters.</p>
-
-<p>Many of the soldiers and sailors had now
-opened fire with their rifles, but the falling
-rocks disconcerted them. Suddenly the Colt
-gun commenced its sharp drumming discharge.
-Sydney glanced aloft. He could see
-his crew directing the stream of lead slowly
-covering every point of the cliff ahead.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_341">[341]</span>A cry of delight rose from the Americans,
-and a cheer broke out from the anxious but
-relieved men as they noted the immediate effect
-of the leaden stream. As it swept along
-the cliffs, those who stood ready to project the
-balanced rocks upon the heads of their enemy
-had taken fright, and instead of waiting until
-the gunboat was immediately beneath them,
-had in their impatience let go their rocks,
-and they were falling harmlessly in the water
-ahead of the gunboat. Sydney steered as near
-the opposite shore as he dared, fearing that a
-boulder might have closed the channel. On
-top of the cliff the sound of strife could still
-be heard.</p>
-
-<p>Major Marble and Major Lukban anxiously
-questioned the prisoner. He alone knew the
-whereabouts of the trail which Espinosa and
-his men relied upon to furnish an avenue of
-escape in case the stronghold was successfully
-attacked. The Filipino officer held his revolver
-threateningly before the frightened native&#8217;s
-eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If you allow us to pass it, I&#8217;ll have no
-mercy,&#8221; he exclaimed.</p>
-
-<p>The &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; had now emerged from<span class="pagenum" id="Page_342">[342]</span>
-the dangerous ca&ntilde;on and the sound of firing
-above became less distinct.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson was becoming impatient.
-He had held himself well in hand to steady
-the officers and men under him during the
-trial through which they had passed so successfully.
-Now his anxiety was more than he
-could keep to himself. He rushed up to the
-cringing native, taking him roughly by the
-shoulders and crying out to him in English,
-a language unintelligible to the terrified prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>But the general&#8217;s act was crowned with success.
-The insurgent soldier had steeled himself
-against the threats of Major Lukban, even
-reinforced as they were with the deadly revolver
-held to his head, but the wildly gesticulating
-general had put a terrible fear into
-his soul. Like all orientals he reverenced and
-feared rank, and this taciturn American general
-had so suddenly turned upon him that
-he was too frightened to do aught else but tell
-the truth.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Back there is the place,&#8221; the native cried
-in his own language, and Major Lukban in
-feverish haste translated the man&#8217;s words,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_343">[343]</span>
-while Sydney swung the gunboat about, reversing
-his engines at full speed to keep from
-grounding on the rocky shores, and giving
-small thought to the dangers of the madly
-racing current.</p>
-
-<p>Within ten minutes, which seemed ages to
-the eager Americans, the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; was
-anchored in the river and the troops were
-landed.</p>
-
-<p>Major Lukban with the guide, whose hands
-were securely bound to prevent his escape, led
-the party through the tangled underbrush
-over the secret trail which without the aid of
-one who had been there before would have
-been impossible. Tediously the distance was
-covered, the sounds of battle ever becoming
-more distinct. General Wilson&#8217;s age was no
-handicap to him as he eagerly pressed forward
-behind the native guides.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy, by the volume of rifle fire
-which came down to the ears of the anxious
-column of soldiers, were making a desperate
-stand to recover the advantage lost by the
-suddenness of the surprise, and so absorbed
-were they with Captain Blynn&#8217;s men that
-those under the general&#8217;s command stood on<span class="pagenum" id="Page_344">[344]</span>
-the level plateau of the mountain before their
-presence was discovered. The sight of this
-unexpected force turned the tide for the
-Americans and the terrified insurgents threw
-away their arms and huddled together, expecting
-to be executed by their enemy without
-mercy.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson quietly controlled his eager
-soldiers, bent upon annihilating these treacherous
-brown men now within their power.
-The soldier mind knew but one style of warfare
-with a savage foe. No quarter had been
-the insurgent watchword. Kill! kill! had
-frequently rung in their ears as the fanatical
-hordes had charged down upon them on many
-a battle-field.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Cease firing!&#8221; General Wilson&#8217;s commanding
-voice rang out above the discharges
-of musketry, and the bugles signaled the
-order across the battle-field. &#8220;Major Lukban,
-tell them no harm will come to them if they
-submit without further resistance,&#8221; he cried
-to the native officer at his elbow, pointing toward
-the panic-stricken hundreds.</p>
-
-<p>The Filipino major calmly walked forward,
-his hands held above his head in sign of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_345">[345]</span>
-peace, and raised his voice in his native
-language. A hush fell upon the babbling
-throngs, while the terror in their eyes slowly
-died out and they dropped on their knees,
-giving thanks for their miraculous deliverance.</p>
-
-<p>Major Marble and the native officer went
-fearlessly among the natives, leading them to
-a point near the river, and placed guards
-over them to prevent their escape and then,
-seeing that a struggle was still going forward
-on the eastern side of the mountain, gathered
-a force of soldiers about him and hastened
-to aid those still in the throes of combat.</p>
-
-<p>Almost out of breath the reinforcing
-column arrived in time to greet Phil and
-O&#8217;Neil standing on the brink of the precipice
-and hear their exclamations of disappointment
-at the escape of the coveted insurgent leader.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_346">[346]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXII<br />
-
-
-<small>THE ESCAPED OUTLAW</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Lukban</span> was the first to recover from the
-stunning news that Espinosa had, by a
-miracle, escaped out of the Americans&#8217; hands
-when all outlets were supposed to have been
-covered.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;He doesn&#8217;t dare stay in Kapay,&#8221; the
-native exclaimed after Phil had explained to
-the general the manner of his escape. &#8220;The
-natives fear him, but without his followers
-and with the incumbrance of Rodriguez&#8217;s
-treasure, the dangers he must face will make
-him do his utmost to leave the island.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson listened intently, his eyes
-wandering over the victorious battle-field behind
-him where Captain Blynn&#8217;s men were
-quietly disarming the now docile natives.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I fear we cannot stop him now,&#8221; General
-Wilson said disappointedly, &#8220;but I suppose
-we should be satisfied with our victory.
-This means the end of the war on Kapay.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_347">[347]</span>Lukban had turned and was earnestly engaged
-in conversation with Lopez, and then
-he asked several eager questions of Garcia,
-who had joined the group. Finally he
-turned to General Wilson, his black eyes
-snapping with renewed eagerness.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Lopez wishes to follow him,&#8221; he exclaimed
-excitedly. &#8220;He will take his hundred
-men, who are only too anxious to see
-him captured and punished for his many
-crimes, and especially for the murder of
-Se&ntilde;or Rodriguez. If he is pressed closely he
-will make for the nearest point of escape
-which by the trail is Banate. This Garcia
-assures me was his intention if he was defeated.
-Garcia wishes to go with Lopez, and
-he can arrange a signal by fires on the hill
-behind the swamps to be seen by the gunboat
-at sea. The gunboat must go down the river
-at once and at sea await the signal. Espinosa
-must attempt his escape by proa to Megras.
-It is only fifty miles away and if he reaches
-there he will be safe for the time among his
-friends living on that island.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil&#8217;s face suddenly beamed in smiles as
-Lukban&#8217;s plan slowly unfolded before him.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_348">[348]</span>
-Highly delighted, he shook hands enthusiastically
-with the speaker, until the latter cried
-out in pain from the well meant but rough
-show of appreciation.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Major Marble and I will return with you
-at once,&#8221; General Wilson added quietly to
-Phil after he had in but a few words approved
-the proposed plan. &#8220;Blynn can settle
-the question of prisoners. I&#8217;d like to have
-Espinosa behind bars before I wire to Manila
-giving them this news.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil solemnly told of the sad fate of Lieutenant
-Tillotson and the general shook his
-head mournfully.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Maybe it is better so,&#8221; he whispered half
-to himself, but to Phil, standing close by,
-these words from the old soldier&#8217;s heart came
-distinctly.</p>
-
-<p>A detail of men carried the body of the
-dead officer across the battle-field, and as they
-passed solemnly through the joyful troops
-who had collected to cheer the white-haired
-veteran, the soldiers became suddenly silent
-as their eyes fell upon the stretcher and were
-told the identity of that figure underneath the
-flag. None had reverenced the officer in life,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_349">[349]</span>
-but in death all were anxious to render respect.</p>
-
-<p>Phil told the general of the pitiful plight of
-Lieutenant Tillotson, and of the cruel manner
-of his death, and generously praised the doubtful
-courage of the army man.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s a glorious end for a soldier,&#8221; General
-Wilson murmured. &#8220;I have always felt that I
-could welcome it, and now,&#8221; he added disappointedly,
-&#8220;I shall probably die in my bed
-like an ordinary citizen. My career is almost
-over; in another year I shall have left active
-service behind.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While the general and his party climbed
-down the difficult trail to reach the gunboat
-at anchor in the river below them, Lopez and
-Garcia with their trusty company had nimbly
-descended the almost precipitous side of the
-mountain and were eagerly following the trail
-of the fleeing insurgent and his ill-gotten
-spoils.</p>
-
-<p>The &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; steamed fearlessly down
-the river, her flag at half-mast in honor of
-those whose mortal remains lay covered on
-the quarter-deck; the soldiers who had given
-their lives in the attack on the most formidable<span class="pagenum" id="Page_350">[350]</span>
-of insurgent strongholds. Phil and
-O&#8217;Neil were given prompt attention by the
-surgeon and several ugly wounds were carefully
-dressed. Phil was glad to relinquish
-his command to Sydney and remained luxuriously
-in his cot.</p>
-
-<p>At Rodriguez&#8217;s ranch the gunboat stopped
-and reverently landed the dead heroes, to be
-buried in the cemetery, and here General
-Wilson and his adjutant-general disembarked
-to return to Palilo by road.</p>
-
-<p>Just as the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; started ahead, after
-landing her passengers, on its way to the
-mouth of the river, a native canoe paddled
-rapidly from the landing, and ran up alongside
-of the gunboat. An excited hail came
-from its occupant, answered by an angry cry
-from Major Lukban who turned, his face
-deathly pale, and his hands trembling, to the
-midshipmen at his side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Se&ntilde;orita Maria is missing,&#8221; he gasped.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen were stunned at the suddenness
-of this unexpected and disquieting
-news. Maria captured! What did it mean?</p>
-
-<p>Lukban declared that his first duty was to
-his young mistress and the lads heartily approved<span class="pagenum" id="Page_351">[351]</span>
-of his desire to be landed to attempt to
-trail the lost girl and her brother.</p>
-
-<p>The excited native was brought on board
-from his canoe and told the eager men the
-meagre details of her loss.</p>
-
-<p>She and Juan had gone out to the cemetery
-in the morning, and had not returned. A
-search had been made in the afternoon and
-the footprints of men had been discovered,
-showing that the girl had fallen into the hands
-of a party of natives.</p>
-
-<p>The midshipmen bade good-bye to their native
-friend who entered the canoe and paddled
-shoreward, and then Phil rang for full speed
-ahead on the engines.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The loyalty of these natives to the Rodriguez
-family is touching,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed
-in admiration. &#8220;Garcia alone betrayed his
-friend; but he did it through superstitious
-fear of the Katipunan society. Lopez is as
-staunch as a rock, and Lukban, you can see,
-would lay down his life willingly for his young
-mistress.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Two hours later the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; had
-steamed through the harbor of Palilo and
-turned her bow northward.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_352">[352]</span>During the night Sydney and O&#8217;Neil took
-turns with Phil in standing watch on the gunboat&#8217;s
-bridge, carefully searching the shore for
-the signal agreed upon with Lopez. Would
-he succeed in coming up with the fleeing outlaw?</p>
-
-<p>The night wore slowly along and morning
-dawned clear, finding all three of the Americans
-up and on the bridge of the rapidly moving
-vessel.</p>
-
-<p>No sails were in sight. A wide expanse of
-water was before them, while on the port hand
-the low swamp land of Banate was in plain sight.</p>
-
-<p>Phil steered his ship in toward the bamboo
-town nestling in the hollow of two small hills
-in the midst of the swampy mouth of the
-Mani River. As they approached, the Americans
-could discover naught but the usual listless
-life of a Filipino village.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I&#8217;ll patrol here,&#8221; Phil said, as he steered
-further offshore.</p>
-
-<p>All day long the gunboat steamed backward
-and forward over fifteen miles of coast line.
-An occasional sail was sighted and overhauled,
-only to find in it a handful of
-frightened fishermen.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_353">[353]</span>As night approached the gunboat was
-brought to a stop in the centre of the line of
-patrol in order that it might be at an equal
-distance from all possible points of departure,
-in case Espinosa had eluded his pursuers.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If he has a proa in waiting, hidden in the
-swamps of one of these estuaries, he will
-choose night for his escape,&#8221; Phil declared as
-he studied his inaccurate chart, &#8220;and at night
-he can easily elude us, for it is too dark to see
-a half mile. Our only hope is that there will
-be no wind, and if the air is sufficiently calm
-we can hear the dip of oars for miles.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil stationed his sailors as lookouts everywhere,
-with orders to listen alertly and make
-known to him if they heard the slightest
-sound.</p>
-
-<p>The night drew on. The others had gone
-below for their broken night&#8217;s sleep, and
-Sydney was alone on the bridge. A half dozen
-lookouts were alert, peering into the night,
-their energies bent on catching the faintest
-sound from the distant shore.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly Sydney&#8217;s ears caught a dull
-sound which seemed to come from the direction
-of the land. He listened intently, his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_354">[354]</span>
-breath held tight. The dawn wind brought
-to his nostrils the sweet damp smell of earth
-mingled with the pungent odor of smoke from
-the early morning fires of the villagers.</p>
-
-<p>All lights were extinguished on the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221;
-and the midshipman knew that the
-vessel was, even at a short distance, invisible.</p>
-
-<p>Now the sound came distinctly to his ears.
-It was the steady dip of oars and their rattle
-in the locks. He could hear the low muffled
-swish as the blades shook themselves clear of
-the water.</p>
-
-<p>Several of the lookouts reported in whispers
-the presence of the strange craft.</p>
-
-<p>Gradually the sound approached, the boat
-invisible, while slowly the gray streak of
-dawn spread in the east. The sound was now
-located ahead and the boat appeared to be
-traveling fast, doubtless propelled by both oars
-and sail. Was it only a fisherman going out
-early to spread his nets? Or was it the outlaw
-Espinosa attempting escape, and carrying
-off Rodriguez&#8217;s gold and the more precious
-treasures, Maria and Juan?</p>
-
-<p>Sydney sent one of the men to call Phil to
-the bridge immediately.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_355">[355]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXIII<br />
-
-
-<small>COLONEL MARTINEZ</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Maria</span> watched with a heavy heart her
-young friend Phil Perry go cheerfully away
-to put himself in the hands of the cruel native
-leader in his endeavor to save the life of a
-brother officer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I never expect to see him alive again,&#8221; she
-whispered sorrowfully to her small brother as
-he stood with big round eyes of wonder gazing
-at the military preparations for the attack
-on the insurgent stronghold.</p>
-
-<p>The next day she and Juan gazed wistfully
-after the long column of khaki-clad American
-soldiers as they filed silently past the ranch
-house, taking the trail over which she and her
-American friends had ridden so merrily but a
-few days before.</p>
-
-<p>The guard left at the ranch, consisting of
-two companies of soldiers, quietly stationed
-its sentries and took up the monotonous<span class="pagenum" id="Page_356">[356]</span>
-routine of guarding the many supplies which
-were arriving by boats from Palilo.</p>
-
-<p>For several long hours the girl brooded
-over the situation, wondering how she could
-aid the friends for whom she had learned to
-hold a high regard. Bemoaning the fate that
-had made her a helpless woman, she took
-Juan by the hand and strolled away up the
-wooded slope toward the family burying
-grounds where the body of her father peacefully
-rested. Reaching the newly made
-mound she placed upon his grave the handful
-of flowers which she had gathered. In
-her heart was a great bitterness. Juan, too
-young to appreciate the magnitude of his loss,
-chased gleefully the monkeys which chattered
-in the trees about him, leaping almost
-into his arms as they eluded his embrace.
-Following her brother Maria listlessly strolled
-farther into the gloom of the forest.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly a low whistle from deeper in the
-woods attracted her attention. With startled
-eyes she stopped, her head erect and her
-bosom heaving in sudden fright.</p>
-
-
-<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_356.jpg" alt="" /></div>
-<p class="drop-cap2"><i>A MAN STEPPED SILENTLY FROM<br />
-BEHIND A TREE</i></p>
-
-<p>A man stepped silently from behind a tree
-and walked toward her. With a glad cry she<span class="pagenum" id="Page_357">[357]</span>
-ran to him. It was the officer known to the
-Americans as Colonel Martinez.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have heard,&#8221; he said sorrowfully as the
-girl incoherently sobbed the sad news of her
-father&#8217;s death. &#8220;I would have come sooner,
-but I believed the Americans would have
-been strong enough to prevent it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;His last words were for you, Gregorio,&#8221;
-Maria whispered as he patted caressingly her
-straight black hair. &#8220;He hoped that you
-would follow his example and surrender to
-General Wilson. Why do you not take your
-own name again?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sister,&#8221; the insurgent officer answered
-earnestly, &#8220;when my father disowned me for
-fighting under Aguinaldo in the north, I took
-the name of Remundo, and because I would
-not surrender after most of my men had
-been killed or captured I have been declared
-by the government of the islands an outlaw,
-and a price was put on my head. I am accused
-of many crimes of which I am not
-guilty. I have an enemy, who now stands
-high in government favor. It was he who
-harried the country using my name falsely,
-and for his deeds I am blamed. Captain Blynn<span class="pagenum" id="Page_358">[358]</span>
-has my written proofs. So you see I could
-not comply with our father&#8217;s wish before, but
-now I am willing to lay down my life in
-order that Juan Rodriguez&#8217;s soul may rest in
-peace, which it cannot do until his murderer
-has received his just punishment.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>While they talked Gregorio Rodriguez had
-taken the small hand of Juan in his own,
-leading his sister along a tiny trail away from
-the river.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I have a few trusty followers awaiting me
-a short distance beyond,&#8221; he added, &#8220;and I
-wish you both to come with me. Your lives are
-too precious to allow you to be out of my sight.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Maria smiled happily and pressed her
-brother&#8217;s hand.</p>
-
-<p>After a quarter of an hour&#8217;s walk the forest
-opened and they found themselves in the
-midst of a company of native soldiers. The
-men arose from the ground as their leader
-passed, doffing their hats to the woman walking
-so proudly with their officer. Gregorio
-stood silently in their midst, holding up his
-hand to demand attention.</p>
-
-<p>In a few short lines he told his men of his
-real identity and of the horrible murder of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_359">[359]</span>
-his father by Espinosa; of the expedition
-which he had watched start out to attack the
-stronghold. To serve their best interests, he
-told them he should surrender with his force
-to the Americans, who would give them all
-fair and honorable treatment. Then he raised
-his voice and excitedly cried:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Those who still desire to fight against
-their own interests under a traitor and a murderer
-may go forth unmolested. At once!&#8221;
-he cried, pointing to the trail leading inland,
-while his black eyes flashed.</p>
-
-<p>Not a man gave ground; all looked trustfully
-up to their leader.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Viva los Americanos,&#8221; one shouted and
-the woods rang with their lusty cheers.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Will you come to the ranch with me and
-surrender there to the Americans?&#8221; Maria
-asked, after the cheering had died away.</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My first quest is Espinosa,&#8221; he replied
-earnestly. &#8220;At once we shall march toward
-the stronghold. If he is captured or killed
-in the battle I shall seek General Wilson and
-surrender myself and men. If Espinosa escapes
-I shall follow him to the death.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_360">[360]</span>Maria knew the native spirit too well to attempt
-to urge her brother to give up this
-perilous quest of their father&#8217;s murderer, so
-she bowed her head submissively.</p>
-
-<p>An hour saw the band on the march, with
-Maria and Juan mounted on two ponies;
-quietly the native soldiers led by Gregorio
-Rodriguez circled the Americans encamped
-at the ranch and struck the trail taken in the
-morning by Captain Blynn and his five hundred
-soldiers.</p>
-
-<p>Long before they came in sight of the
-stronghold the distant rumble of musketry
-and the thunder of artillery told them of the
-struggle at the top of the mountain.</p>
-
-<p>Despairing of reaching the battle-field by
-the treacherous trail already covered by the
-Americans, Gregorio led his party to high
-ground across the valley from Matiginao.
-They arrived breathlessly at the summit and
-viewed the distant figures of men fighting in
-a hand-to-hand struggle.</p>
-
-<p>Maria gasped in fear as she comprehended
-the awful sight of the struggle.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The Americans are victorious,&#8221; Gregorio
-exclaimed excitedly as he saw the wave of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_361">[361]</span>
-khaki sweep from two sides across the broad
-plateau. He saw the native insurgents huddled
-together in the centre of the American
-soldiers. But his eager eyes followed a small
-band of Americans and natives on the right
-of the mountain; he saw the natives in front
-of them give way slowly, contesting the battle-field
-foot by foot, while behind them he
-saw several score more of natives reach the
-edge of the plateau and rapidly disappear
-down the sheer side of the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They are escaping,&#8221; he cried in sudden
-alarm. &#8220;See, they are holding the Americans
-back to give those fleeing time to escape.
-It&#8217;s Espinosa,&#8221; he shouted hoarsely, beside
-himself with apprehension.</p>
-
-<p>Between him and the valley at the foot of
-the precipice, Gregorio knew were many miles
-of impenetrable jungle, through which there
-was no trail. Yet he must push through this
-formidable barrier in an effort to cut off his
-enemy&#8217;s escape. Calling up one of his trusty
-lieutenants he gave Maria and Juan in his
-charge.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Take the trail and join the Americans,&#8221;
-he ordered his sister. &#8220;Come,&#8221; he commanded,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_362">[362]</span>
-selecting a score of men by a motion
-of his hand. In another minute Gregorio,
-followed obediently by his selected followers,
-had plunged through the dense woods straight
-down the mountainside toward the avenue of
-escape over which Espinosa would soon be
-traveling, while Maria and her guard left their
-place of vantage and headed for the distant
-mountain top now in the hands of Captain
-Blynn and his victorious men.</p>
-
-<p>Laboriously, but spurred forward by the
-eagerness of their leader, Gregorio and his
-small band toiled through the dense jungle.
-The distance was slowly covered and, almost
-exhausted, they were finally rewarded by
-reaching the trail leading from the stronghold
-to the northward.</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio uttered an exclamation of surprise
-as his knowledge of woodcraft told him that
-a large force of men had recently passed over
-this road. Surely he had seen but a few score
-escape from the plateau.</p>
-
-<p>Nothing daunted, in the lead, he urged his
-men forward. He would attack, no matter
-what were the odds against him. Espinosa
-should not escape!</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_363">[363]</span>After several hours of strenuous marching a
-straggler was found on the side of the trail
-and after a hasty interview gave the anxious
-native the good tidings that Lopez was ahead
-on the same quest as himself.</p>
-
-<p>Hurrying forward, most of the time on a
-run, he overtook his father&#8217;s faithful servant
-just before darkness arrived, and together, unsparingly,
-they urged onward their tired men.</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio&#8217;s keen eyes were ever on the trail;
-in his heart was a desperate resolve. The
-thought of escape of Espinosa maddened him
-beyond endurance. The newly made grave in
-the family burying grounds spurred him on
-to almost superhuman exertions. Lopez,
-hardened as he was to toil in the fields, kept
-pace with his untiring young master, but
-many of the pursuing natives were left far behind.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We are nearly to Banate,&#8221; Lopez said intensely
-as they saw the high jungle slowly
-merge into nipa swamp. The cocoanut palms
-were becoming more and more infrequent and
-the mud of the trail clung to their tired feet.</p>
-
-<p>So silently had they approached the little
-settlement at the foot of the hills rising from<span class="pagenum" id="Page_364">[364]</span>
-the delta of the river that the sudden barking
-of a dog caused them to stop in consternation.</p>
-
-<p>With eyes open wide with anxiety and apprehension,
-Gregorio and Lopez pressed onward
-through the narrow street. They saw
-the natives were not as yet awake, the houses
-were closed and no human being was visible.
-On the ocean beach they saw many native
-boats hauled high above the tide. Anxiously
-they visited each in turn, but all were abandoned.</p>
-
-<p>The sandy soil gave them no news of their
-quarry. Many footmarks were evident, but
-the tracks were so crossed and recrossed that
-even Gregorio gave up all hope of learning
-from them the direction taken by Espinosa
-and his men.</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio stood in deepest dejection at the
-edge of the beach; his eyes sorrowfully scanned
-the dark waters. Had Espinosa turned off
-into the jungle, allowing him to go by, chuckling
-in his sleeve at the cleverness of his
-ruse? or had he embarked, and was he now
-sailing rapidly away toward freedom and
-wealth? Many of the straggling natives had
-now gathered about their chief and waited for<span class="pagenum" id="Page_365">[365]</span>
-his orders. They had ruthlessly entered the
-huts of the sleeping villagers and had dragged
-several of them trembling before their leaders.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;But a half hour ago a large proa was
-launched from down the beach,&#8221; a native villager
-spoke up. &#8220;It had been waiting, and
-we were commanded to keep indoors on
-penalty of being shot. Through my bamboo
-shutter I saw it start.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio waited for no further words.
-Hastily turning to Lopez and Garcia he cried
-eagerly:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Light three fires on the top of the hill,
-the signal to the gunboat.&#8221; Then without
-spoken orders a half score of men helped the
-anxious Gregorio launch one of the small fishing
-boats lying high on the beach. As Lopez
-and his men hurried away, the native boat, with
-Gregorio at the helm, hoisted its bamboo sail
-to catch the light morning breeze and disappeared
-into the night.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_366">[366]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXIV<br />
-
-
-<small>THE GUNBOAT ON GUARD</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">&#8220;There&#8217;s</span> a fire ashore there, sir,&#8221; a lookout
-called in an eager voice as Phil accompanied
-by O&#8217;Neil stepped on deck, and the midshipman&#8217;s
-joy was unbounded as he saw three
-points of light gradually grow into three unmistakable
-fires.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;The signal,&#8221; he exclaimed. &#8220;We&#8217;ve got
-him. He can&#8217;t escape us now.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Eagerly he listened to the sweet music of
-those hollow sounds caused as he knew by the
-play of the oars in their rowlocks. Scarcely
-a half mile away was Espinosa, blissfully unconscious
-of the presence of his sentinel gunboat.
-Then a great fear came into his mind
-as he thought of the cargo the approaching
-boat might be carrying. Were Maria and her
-brother captives of this cruel villain?</p>
-
-<p>The anxious midshipman rang the engine
-bell for full speed ahead and the little gunboat
-quickly leaped to life. Espinosa was as<span class="pagenum" id="Page_367">[367]</span>
-good as captured. Inside of an hour day
-would break.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Keep a sharp lookout,&#8221; he shouted. The
-gunboat&#8217;s bow had turned directly for the
-sound of the passing boat and he did not
-know at what moment it would appear suddenly
-from out of the darkness ahead.</p>
-
-<p>Sydney and O&#8217;Neil stood beside Phil as the
-gunboat rushed forward.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;That&#8217;s Espinosa, all right,&#8221; O&#8217;Neil exclaimed
-joyfully as he went below, after taking
-a look about him, to get the forward three-pounder
-ready.</p>
-
-<p>The two midshipmen strained their ears in
-vain into the night, but no sound of their
-quarry was evident.</p>
-
-<p>The gunboat was again stopped and the
-word passed for silence. A stillness crept
-over the gunboat. The sailors stood alert,
-silent in strained attitudes of listening, but no
-sound could be heard to cheer the now depressed
-Americans.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;They&#8217;ve stopped rowing,&#8221; Sydney exclaimed,
-&#8220;and with this breeze they must be
-going away from us fast.&#8221; The midshipmen
-gazed at each other in consternation. What<span class="pagenum" id="Page_368">[368]</span>
-should be done? Should they steam ahead
-blindly, awaiting the day? Might not the
-proa have discovered the presence of the
-gunboat and changed its course? Both knew
-that ten miles to the eastward treacherous coral
-reefs covered the sea, through which the gunboat
-must navigate cautiously, even if it were
-possible to go at all. Was the outlaw again
-to escape? Then their attention was attracted
-by a new sound as the chug of oars came to
-their ears, but this time from a direction opposite
-to that taken by the first boat.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s a second boat,&#8221; Phil exclaimed in a
-troubled voice. &#8220;What can it mean?&#8221; The
-noise of the approaching boat came closer and
-closer and then suddenly out of the night a
-great sail appeared, while a Spanish hail drifted
-across the waters:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Espinosa is in a proa ahead of us. This
-is Colonel Martinez.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Both lads recognized their friend&#8217;s voice,
-even before he declared his identity, and now
-with his mind made up that he must act
-quickly, Phil called back:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I shall steam directly ahead for the reefs;
-stand by to take a line.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_369">[369]</span>The active natives caught the tow-line
-heaved to them from the stern of the gunboat,
-and the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; at full speed raced toward
-the gray in the eastern sky, while the
-proa astern lowered her sail and leaped joyfully
-in tow of the steamer.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil stood like a statue at the bow&#8217;s gun,
-his eyes endeavoring to pierce the gloom
-ahead. His eager eyes were conscious of the
-growing light. Farther and farther his range
-of vision grew; now a mile of sea on either
-bow was in sight, but barren of sail. Then
-from out the dissolving mist, the sailor saw a
-dim shadow and knew that the quarry at last
-was found and in easy range.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I see her, sir,&#8221; he hailed joyfully. &#8220;Can
-I give her a polite invitation to heave to?&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t hit her, O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; Phil answered excitedly;
-&#8220;put a shell as close as you can.
-She&#8217;s nearly up to the reefs.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>A roar and a blinding flash was O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s
-answer to his captain&#8217;s words.</p>
-
-<p>Shell after shell was hurled after the fleeing
-boat but the Americans could see no inclination
-to obey the order of the challenge. Now
-silhouetted against the eastern sky, with a<span class="pagenum" id="Page_370">[370]</span>
-great spread of sail, Espinosa was straining
-everything to escape. From out the sea ahead
-a fiery sun arose, throwing its brilliant light
-into the eyes of those on the gunboat.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Be careful, O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; Phil urged earnestly.
-&#8220;Se&ntilde;orita Rodriguez may be in that boat.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;She&#8217;s safe with our soldiers,&#8221; Sydney
-called from the deck below, at hearing his
-friend&#8217;s caution. &#8220;I&#8217;ve just talked with
-Martinez astern.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Put a shot in that boat,&#8221; Phil cried, and
-the roar of the three-pounder echoed his words.</p>
-
-<p>Then suddenly a gentle tremble of the
-&#8220;Mindinao&#8221; made her young captain turn
-pale, as he rang for full speed astern.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;re on the reef,&#8221; he cried in anguish.
-&#8220;What shall we do? Hit her, O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; he
-called beside himself; &#8220;he must not escape.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney had rushed aft with several sailors
-close at his heels and taking the tow-line of
-the native boat astern, they hauled it up clear
-of the backing screws until the outrigger was
-alongside the gangway.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Make room for ten of our sailors,&#8221; he
-shouted to Martinez. &#8220;We want men who
-know how to shoot.&#8221;</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_371">[371]</span>While the water boiled above the swiftly revolving
-propellers slowly hauling the gunboat
-backward from its perilous position on a coral
-reef, all but two of the natives in the fishing
-boat climbed nimbly aboard and ten eager
-sailors, their rifles in hand, scrambled in.</p>
-
-<p>The sharp detonations of the three-pounder
-added to the confusion of the scene.</p>
-
-<p>As he saw the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; was again
-afloat, Phil turned his eyes to the fleeing
-enemy. The boat, still untouched, was sailing
-swiftly away with an ever-increasing
-breeze behind it. Then his eyes opened in
-surprise and joy as he saw what Sydney had
-been doing.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Come on, O&#8217;Neil, she&#8217;s nearly out of
-range,&#8221; he called excitedly. The sailor
-turned, took in the situation at a glance and
-seizing a rifle from a sailor near him followed
-his captain.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;She&#8217;s dropped her sail,&#8221; he cried, as a
-swift look over his shoulder to mark the effect
-of the last shot revealed but a small black
-speck on the water.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I am sorry, Syd, but I must leave you to
-look out for the ship,&#8221; Phil said as he leaped<span class="pagenum" id="Page_372">[372]</span>
-for the side of the native boat and grasped
-Colonel Martinez&#8217;s hands. &#8220;Keep us in sight
-and see if you can work her through the reefs.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Sydney drew a long face, but he appreciated
-that Phil&#8217;s greatest desire was to be in at the
-death, when Espinosa was captured.</p>
-
-<p>The boat shoved off and the bamboo sail,
-far bigger in proportion than the sails carried
-by American boats, was quickly hoisted. The
-boat appeared to skim over the surface of the
-water. The gunboat slowly dropped astern,
-but now the proa had again hoisted its
-sail and the distance between the two boats
-seemed to be ever the same.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We&#8217;ll catch him if we have to chase him
-the whole fifty miles of water and then some,&#8221;
-O&#8217;Neil cried angrily. &#8220;I don&#8217;t see how I
-could have missed him.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil smiled feebly. &#8220;You were beginning
-to get pretty close,&#8221; he said. &#8220;They lowered
-their sail so as to offer a smaller target for you
-to aim at.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I thought I&#8217;d done it with a shell,&#8221;
-the boatswain&#8217;s mate replied disappointedly.
-&#8220;Well, if we get within the range of this little
-piece of iron,&#8221; patting his rifle, &#8220;I&#8217;ll take<span class="pagenum" id="Page_373">[373]</span>
-great pleasure in writing my initials on that
-Espinosa&#8217;s yellow carcass.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>The midshipman did not take this soft-hearted
-sailorman seriously. In a fight, he
-knew he was as brave as twenty men, but
-with a vanquished enemy he was as gentle as
-a woman.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;If we can catch him alive, I don&#8217;t wish to
-kill him,&#8221; Phil answered now, in Spanish, to
-include Rodriguez, who had not understood
-the declarations of the disappointed sailor.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I claim the privilege of doing that, Se&ntilde;or
-Perry,&#8221; the colonel replied.</p>
-
-<p>Phil regarded him sternly. The native
-looked into the midshipman&#8217;s eyes unwaveringly.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Why should you?&#8221; the lad asked.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Ah, se&ntilde;or, I had forgotten,&#8221; the native
-said earnestly, taking his revolver from its
-holster and holding it butt forward to the
-midshipman. &#8220;Colonel Remundo in Luzon,
-Colonel Martinez in Kapay, and now Gregorio
-Rodriguez, surrenders to you as a prisoner of
-war.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil looked aghast, while O&#8217;Neil mumbled
-inarticulate nautical phrases of surprise.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_374">[374]</span>&#8220;Are you then Maria&#8217;s brother?&#8221; the lad
-asked.</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio nodded his head slowly, still holding
-his revolver for Phil to take.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Put your revolver back,&#8221; the midshipman
-ordered peremptorily. &#8220;You and I never
-have been enemies&mdash;except for a very short
-time,&#8221; he added as the remembrance of those
-two anxious days after his capture on the
-&#8220;Negros&#8221; came into his mind. &#8220;Anyway,
-we have now the same objective, that murderer
-yonder, but,&#8221; and he lowered his voice
-to a cold, hard tone, &#8220;you shall not kill him
-if we can capture him alive. I forbid it.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Gregorio&#8217;s black eyes blazed, and despite
-the avowed friendship of the native, O&#8217;Neil
-reached hastily for his revolver. Then as
-suddenly the native mastered himself and
-with a shrug turned away his telltale eyes.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I know how you feel, colonel,&#8221; Phil declared
-conscious of the passion in the native&#8217;s
-soul, &#8220;but I&#8217;d rather have it done regularly.
-We&#8217;ll try him by a military commission for
-treason and hang him in the Plaza in Palilo
-as a warning to all traitors.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Slowly the fishing boat overhauled the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_375">[375]</span>
-bigger craft. Now the distance was but five
-hundred yards. The sun had risen and
-shone down on the green opalescent water.
-A report of a rifle-shot startled the Americans
-who had settled themselves for a long and
-monotonous chase.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;So they are going to offer resistance,&#8221;
-Phil exclaimed.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Yes; let him have it, O&#8217;Neil,&#8221; he added
-as the sailor threw the muzzle of his piece
-forward and looked questioningly at the midshipman.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil&#8217;s rifle cracked and a figure standing
-on the rail near the mast doubled up and fell
-forward in the boat.</p>
-
-<p>A fusillade of shots followed from the fleeing
-boat, the bullets hissing in the water
-dangerously near the dozen huddled Americans.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;We can&#8217;t allow this,&#8221; Phil exclaimed uneasily;
-&#8220;they can&#8217;t miss us if we get any closer.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Open fire!&#8221; he ordered suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>Ten rifles were discharged almost as one,
-and as quickly fired again and again. The
-sharp rattle of the breech-blocks was continuous.</p>
-
-
-
-<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_376">[376]</span>By this time the Americans had approached
-abreast the enemy, but above its rail no
-human being was visible. Had all been
-killed by the unerring shooting of Phil&#8217;s
-men?</p>
-
-<p>Scarcely twenty yards separated the two
-boats. The larger craft, with sheets slacked,
-sailed silently onward. The helm swung
-idle; the hand that had steered it probably
-now lay limp in the bottom of the proa.
-Phil rose cautiously, his hand grasping the
-sail; he placed his foot on the high gunwale
-in an endeavor to discover the state of the
-enemy concealed in the bottom of the boat. As
-he drew himself up above his companions, the
-two boats slid noiselessly nearer and to the
-lad&#8217;s horror he suddenly found himself looking
-squarely into the black muzzle of a pistol.
-Behind it burned the cruel eyes of Espinosa,
-while on the latter&#8217;s face was a leer of triumph.</p>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_377">[377]</span>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXV<br />
-
-
-<small>CONCLUSION</small></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Scarcely</span> a second elapsed between the
-time Espinosa had leaped to the proa&#8217;s
-deck and the discharge of his revolver, but in
-that second Phil had seen the awful havoc
-among the traitor&#8217;s followers. Espinosa himself,
-sorely wounded as he was, could hardly
-have helped hitting his mark. Phil was
-conscious of a shot from his own boat almost
-simultaneously with a sharp pain in his left
-shoulder, and saw the would-be slayer pitch
-forward into the sea. In that second the outriggers
-of the two boats came together and
-Gregorio and his two natives quickly jumped
-on board to lower the captured vessel&#8217;s sails,
-while O&#8217;Neil put the helm of his own craft
-over to bring the wind ahead and stop their
-progress.</p>
-
-<p>Phil balanced himself on the sail of the
-boat, his eyes following the bubbles which
-closed over the body of the wounded man.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_378">[378]</span>
-Then a trembling seized him as a great black
-fin protruded from the water and the sun&#8217;s
-rays reflected deep red against the green of
-the reef.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Sharks,&#8221; he cried hoarsely, balancing
-himself with a great effort, for he had been
-about to plunge overboard to rescue his
-enemy.</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil as if by intuition had seized the
-lad by the foot and forcibly hauled him back
-into the boat.</p>
-
-<p>The two boats were soon secured together
-and the Americans, putting aside their weapons
-of destruction, looked down pityingly
-upon the terrified natives huddled together
-in the bottom of the proa. Many were
-wounded by the Krag bullets and several
-had died not knowing pain, so swiftly had
-death come. Far astern a black curl of
-smoke marked the gunboat.</p>
-
-<p>All hands turned to willingly and administered
-to the stricken enemy and soon all the
-wounded were made as comfortable as possible,
-their bleeding stanched, while the two
-boats were being steered toward the west.
-The treasure was found hidden under the footboards<span class="pagenum" id="Page_379">[379]</span>
-of the proa and this treasure had
-sealed the traitor&#8217;s doom, for in carrying it he
-had delayed his flight, allowing Gregorio and
-Lopez to all but overtake him.</p>
-
-<p>Inside of two hours the &#8220;Mindinao,&#8221;
-steaming cautiously between the numberless
-shoals, took the Americans and their captives
-on board and was steaming joyfully back to
-Palilo with her glad tidings.</p>
-
-<p>The wound in Phil&#8217;s shoulder turned
-out happily to be but a glancing blow and
-under Sydney&#8217;s administration he suffered
-only the inconvenience of carrying his arm
-in a black silk sling about his neck.</p>
-
-<p>As Phil brought his gunboat for the last
-time to her berth, there on the dock stood
-General Wilson and his aides, and before the
-gangway had been down a moment they came
-on board to praise the work of the navy men,
-and hear the thrilling story of the end of
-Espinosa.</p>
-
-<p>A sad-eyed stranger in civilian&#8217;s clothes
-stood silently by as Phil modestly told how
-the outlaw had died. Then he grasped the
-lad&#8217;s hand while the general murmured a
-name which made the young man blush as if<span class="pagenum" id="Page_380">[380]</span>
-with shame. He stood in the presence of
-Lieutenant Tillotson&#8217;s father.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My boy,&#8221; the bereaved man said in a low
-voice, &#8220;you have a father&#8217;s blessing. The
-general has told me of your unselfish and
-reckless act in a vain endeavor to save my son.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Phil turned away to hide his emotion.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Tillotson, taking the body of his son,
-sailed the following day for Manila.</p>
-
-<p>For ten days the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; remained
-quietly at her dock, while from all over the
-island there came to Palilo to surrender to
-the general small bands of insurgent soldiers.
-Gregorio Rodriguez, the acknowledged leader
-after Espinosa&#8217;s death, had sent word to all his
-captains to stop fighting, and their obedience
-was instant.</p>
-
-<p>One evening somewhat over a week later,
-on board the &#8220;Mindinao&#8221; a dinner party was
-in progress. The happy general, a weight of
-care lifted from his shoulders, sat on Phil&#8217;s
-right, while about the board were the well-known
-faces of his friends. O&#8217;Neil, barred
-by naval etiquette from partaking at his captain&#8217;s
-table, in the shadow of the night, stood
-near, hanging on every word spoken. The<span class="pagenum" id="Page_381">[381]</span>
-Chinese servants with smiling faces flitted between
-the galley and the quarter-deck.</p>
-
-<p>Maria sat between the two midshipmen, and
-the sadness in her eyes still lingered, but a
-look of admiration would kindle as she talked
-to each of her two friends in turn.</p>
-
-<p>General Wilson held in his hand two unopened
-telegrams which had just been handed
-him by an orderly.</p>
-
-<p>The general tore one of the yellow envelopes
-and ran his eye hurriedly over the contents.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;My congratulations, governor,&#8221; he exclaimed,
-as he passed the paper to Gregorio
-Rodriguez.</p>
-
-<p>The native could hardly believe his eyes,
-for these were the words he read:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;Gregorio Rodriguez appointed civil governor
-of the Island of Kapay to-day by the
-governor-general.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>Rodriguez rose to his feet and strode quietly
-to the general&#8217;s side.</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;General Wilson,&#8221; he said reverently, &#8220;this
-fulfils my father&#8217;s dearest wish. I would that
-he could know.&#8221; Then he dropped on one
-knee and, much to the surprise of the gray-haired
-prosaic veteran, raised the blue-veined<span class="pagenum" id="Page_382">[382]</span>
-hand to his lips. Maria remained seated, but
-her dark eyes beamed lovingly on her brother.</p>
-
-<p>Then the other telegram was opened and a
-smile appeared on the warrior&#8217;s face.</p>
-
-<p>The lads were consumed with impatience,
-for by the look in the general&#8217;s eyes they
-realized it concerned them. He read the
-message.</p>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-
-<p>&#8220;I am appointed ambassador to Japan.
-Have selected Blynn as military attach&eacute; and
-Midshipmen Perry and Monroe naval attach&eacute;s
-to our embassy. Wire their answers.</p>
-
-<p class="right">&#8220;<span class="smcap">Tillotson.</span>&#8221;</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>The midshipmen&#8217;s hearts beat fast and they
-were about to cry out their delight, when the
-tearful face of Maria caught their eye; and
-instead Phil answered soberly, &#8220;I doubt if
-we have sufficient rank to accept.&#8221;</p>
-
-<p>O&#8217;Neil had heard enough, and as he moved
-forward toward his hammock slung on the
-forecastle he murmured gruffly:</p>
-
-<p>&#8220;I can&#8217;t let &#8217;em go alone. They need me
-to look out for them.&#8221; And Phil and Sydney,
-had they heard, would have said he was
-right.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-<div class="chapter">
-<span class="pagenum" id="Page_383">[383]</span>
-
-<p class="center">Other books in this same series are:</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container">
-<div class="poetry">
-<p>A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN AFLOAT<br />
-A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN CHINA<br />
-A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN JAPAN<br />
-A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN THE SOUTH SEAS</p>
-</div></div>
-</div>
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p class="ph1">FOOTNOTES:</p>
-
-
-<div class="footnote">
-
-<p><a id="Footnote_1" href="#FNanchor_1" class="label">[1]</a> A lorcha is a Filipino schooner; its sails are usually made of a
-rough canvas, yellow in color, manufactured from a native fibre,
-usually hemp.</p>
-
-</div>
-
-<div class="footnote">
-
-<p><a id="Footnote_2" href="#FNanchor_2" class="label">[2]</a> &#8220;Friend, a letter.&#8221;</p>
-
-</div>
-
-<div class="footnote">
-
-<p><a id="Footnote_3" href="#FNanchor_3" class="label">[3]</a> Pulijanes&mdash;ladrones, outlaw</p>
-
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<div class="transnote">
-<p class="ph1">TRANSCRIBER&#8217;S NOTES:</p>
-
-
-
-<p>Obvious typographical errors have been corrected.</p>
-
-<p>Inconsistencies in hyphenation have been standardized.</p>
-
-<p>Archaic or alternate spelling has been retained from the original.</p>
-</div></div>
-
-
-<div style='display:block; margin-top:4em'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A UNITED STATES MIDSHIPMAN IN THE PHILIPPINES ***</div>
-<div style='text-align:left'>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Updated editions will replace the previous one&#8212;the old editions will
-be renamed.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG&#8482;
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
-the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
-of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
-copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
-easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
-of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
-Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away&#8212;you may
-do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
-by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
-license, especially commercial redistribution.
-</div>
-
-<div style='margin:0.83em 0; font-size:1.1em; text-align:center'>START: FULL LICENSE<br />
-<span style='font-size:smaller'>THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE<br />
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK</span>
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-To protect the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase &#8220;Project
-Gutenberg&#8221;), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person
-or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.B. &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (&#8220;the
-Foundation&#8221; or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg&#8482; work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country other than the United States.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work (any work
-on which the phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; appears, or with which the
-phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-</div>
-
-<blockquote>
- <div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
- other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
- whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
- of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
- at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
- are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws
- of the country where you are located before using this eBook.
- </div>
-</blockquote>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase &#8220;Project
-Gutenberg&#8221; associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg&#8482; License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg&#8482;.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; License.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work in a format
-other than &#8220;Plain Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg&#8482; website
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original &#8220;Plain
-Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg&#8482; works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-provided that:
-</div>
-
-<div style='margin-left:0.7em;'>
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &#8226; You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, &#8220;Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation.&#8221;
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &#8226; You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
- works.
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &#8226; You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &#8226; You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works.
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
-the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
-forth in Section 3 below.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain &#8220;Defects,&#8221; such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the &#8220;Right
-of Replacement or Refund&#8221; described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you &#8216;AS-IS&#8217;, WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg&#8482;&#8217;s
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg&#8482; collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg&#8482; and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation&#8217;s EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state&#8217;s laws.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Foundation&#8217;s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
-Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
-to date contact information can be found at the Foundation&#8217;s website
-and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; depends upon and cannot survive without widespread
-public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state
-visit <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/donate/">www.gutenberg.org/donate</a>.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
-facility: <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-This website includes information about Project Gutenberg&#8482;,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-</div>
-
-</div>
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 347b150..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_068.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_068.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index c173b39..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_068.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_126.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_126.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f9cb7a7..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_126.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_204.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_204.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index dacde6f..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_204.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_288.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_288.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index c18a13c..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_288.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_333.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_333.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 2052d11..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_333.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_356.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_356.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 9ae46ad..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_356.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 5ec0dc6..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_logo.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_logo.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index a9333cb..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_logo.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_title.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_title.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 556155e..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_title.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/67438-h/images/i_titlelogo.jpg b/old/67438-h/images/i_titlelogo.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f8eb68a..0000000
--- a/old/67438-h/images/i_titlelogo.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ